Implement 'catch syscall' for gdbserver
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 @node Sample Session
545 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551 @iftex
552 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554 @end iftex
555
556 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
563 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
566 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569 @smallexample
570 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571 $ @b{./m4}
572 @b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574 @b{foo}
575 0000
576 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578 @b{bar}
579 0000
580 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583 @b{baz}
584 @b{Ctrl-d}
585 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591 @smallexample
592 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
595 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602 (@value{GDBP})
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609 that examples fit in this manual.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619 @code{break} command.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634 @b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636 @b{foo}
637 0000
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
642 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643 context where it stops.
644
645 @smallexample
646 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 at builtin.c:879
650 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655 the next line of the current function.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
665 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669 @smallexample
670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 at input.c:530
673 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
679 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
680 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682 stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 at input.c:530
688 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 at builtin.c:882
690 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 at macro.c:71
693 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
699 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
706 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
707 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
719 (@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721 @smallexample
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735 533 xfree(rquote);
736 534
737 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741 537
742 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744 540 @}
745 541
746 542 void
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757 540 @}
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 $3 = 9
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761 $4 = 7
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
768 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770 assignments.
771
772 @smallexample
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 $5 = 7
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776 $6 = 9
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783 example that caused trouble initially:
784
785 @smallexample
786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787 Continuing.
788
789 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791 baz
792 0000
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
797 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @b{Ctrl-d}
802 Program exited normally.
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
808 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810 @smallexample
811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @node Invocation
815 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818 The essentials are:
819 @itemize @bullet
820 @item
821 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 @item
823 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824 @end itemize
825
826 @menu
827 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
828 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
829 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831 @end menu
832
833 @node Invoking GDB
834 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
837 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842 The command-line options described here are designed
843 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844 options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847 specifying an executable program:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 @noindent
854 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855 specified:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859 @end smallexample
860
861 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862 to debug a running process:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
876 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
880 option processing.
881 @smallexample
882 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 @end smallexample
884 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
889 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
890
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --silent
893 @end smallexample
894
895 @noindent
896 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
897 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
898
899 @noindent
900 Type
901
902 @smallexample
903 @value{GDBP} -help
904 @end smallexample
905
906 @noindent
907 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
908 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
909
910 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
911 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
912 @samp{-x} option is used.
913
914
915 @menu
916 * File Options:: Choosing files
917 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
918 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
919 @end menu
920
921 @node File Options
922 @subsection Choosing Files
923
924 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
925 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
926 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
927 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
928 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
929 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
930 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
931 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
932 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
933 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
934 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
935 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
936 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
937
938 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
939 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
940 argument and ignore it.
941
942 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
943 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
944 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
945 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
946 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
947
948 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
949 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
950 @c it.
951
952 @table @code
953 @item -symbols @var{file}
954 @itemx -s @var{file}
955 @cindex @code{--symbols}
956 @cindex @code{-s}
957 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
958
959 @item -exec @var{file}
960 @itemx -e @var{file}
961 @cindex @code{--exec}
962 @cindex @code{-e}
963 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
964 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
965
966 @item -se @var{file}
967 @cindex @code{--se}
968 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
969 file.
970
971 @item -core @var{file}
972 @itemx -c @var{file}
973 @cindex @code{--core}
974 @cindex @code{-c}
975 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
976
977 @item -pid @var{number}
978 @itemx -p @var{number}
979 @cindex @code{--pid}
980 @cindex @code{-p}
981 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
982
983 @item -command @var{file}
984 @itemx -x @var{file}
985 @cindex @code{--command}
986 @cindex @code{-x}
987 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
988 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
989 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
990
991 @item -eval-command @var{command}
992 @itemx -ex @var{command}
993 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
994 @cindex @code{-ex}
995 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
996
997 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
998 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
999
1000 @smallexample
1001 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1002 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1003 @end smallexample
1004
1005 @item -init-command @var{file}
1006 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1007 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1008 @cindex @code{-ix}
1009 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1010 after loading gdbinit files).
1011 @xref{Startup}.
1012
1013 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1014 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1015 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1016 @cindex @code{-iex}
1017 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1018 after loading gdbinit files).
1019 @xref{Startup}.
1020
1021 @item -directory @var{directory}
1022 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1023 @cindex @code{--directory}
1024 @cindex @code{-d}
1025 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1026
1027 @item -r
1028 @itemx -readnow
1029 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1030 @cindex @code{-r}
1031 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1032 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1033 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1034
1035 @end table
1036
1037 @node Mode Options
1038 @subsection Choosing Modes
1039
1040 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1041 batch mode or quiet mode.
1042
1043 @table @code
1044 @anchor{-nx}
1045 @item -nx
1046 @itemx -n
1047 @cindex @code{--nx}
1048 @cindex @code{-n}
1049 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1050 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1051
1052 @table @code
1053 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1054 This is the system-wide init file.
1055 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1056 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1057 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1058 have been processed.
1059 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1060 This is the init file in your home directory.
1061 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1062 command options have been processed.
1063 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1064 This is the init file in the current directory.
1065 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1066 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1067 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1068 @end table
1069
1070 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1071 For documentation on how to write command files,
1072 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1073
1074 @anchor{-nh}
1075 @item -nh
1076 @cindex @code{--nh}
1077 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1078 in your home directory.
1079 @xref{Startup}.
1080
1081 @item -quiet
1082 @itemx -silent
1083 @itemx -q
1084 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1085 @cindex @code{--silent}
1086 @cindex @code{-q}
1087 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1088 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1089
1090 @item -batch
1091 @cindex @code{--batch}
1092 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1093 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1094 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1095 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1096 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1097 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1098 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1099
1100 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1101 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1102 make this more useful, the message
1103
1104 @smallexample
1105 Program exited normally.
1106 @end smallexample
1107
1108 @noindent
1109 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1110 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1111 mode.
1112
1113 @item -batch-silent
1114 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1115 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1116 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1117 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1118 for an interactive session.
1119
1120 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1121 messages, for example.
1122
1123 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1124 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1125
1126 @item -return-child-result
1127 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1128 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1129 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1130
1131 @itemize @bullet
1132 @item
1133 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1134 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1135 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1136 @item
1137 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1138 @item
1139 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1140 the exit code will be -1.
1141 @end itemize
1142
1143 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1144 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1145 interface.
1146
1147 @item -nowindows
1148 @itemx -nw
1149 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1150 @cindex @code{-nw}
1151 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1152 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1153 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1154
1155 @item -windows
1156 @itemx -w
1157 @cindex @code{--windows}
1158 @cindex @code{-w}
1159 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1160 used if possible.
1161
1162 @item -cd @var{directory}
1163 @cindex @code{--cd}
1164 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1165 instead of the current directory.
1166
1167 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1168 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1169 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1170 @cindex @code{-D}
1171 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1172 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1173 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1174
1175 @item -fullname
1176 @itemx -f
1177 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1178 @cindex @code{-f}
1179 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1180 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1181 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1182 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1183 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1184 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1185 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1186 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1187 frame.
1188
1189 @item -annotate @var{level}
1190 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1191 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1192 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1193 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1194 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1195 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1196 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1197 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1198 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1199
1200 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1201 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1202
1203 @item --args
1204 @cindex @code{--args}
1205 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1206 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1207 This option stops option processing.
1208
1209 @item -baud @var{bps}
1210 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1211 @cindex @code{--baud}
1212 @cindex @code{-b}
1213 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1214 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1215
1216 @item -l @var{timeout}
1217 @cindex @code{-l}
1218 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1219 for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -tty @var{device}
1222 @itemx -t @var{device}
1223 @cindex @code{--tty}
1224 @cindex @code{-t}
1225 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1226 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1227
1228 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1229 @item -tui
1230 @cindex @code{--tui}
1231 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1232 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1233 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1234 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1235 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1236 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1237
1238 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1239 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1240 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1241 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1242 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1243 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1244
1245 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1246 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1247 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1248 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1249 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1250 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1251
1252 @item -write
1253 @cindex @code{--write}
1254 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1255 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1256 (@pxref{Patching}).
1257
1258 @item -statistics
1259 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1260 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1261 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1262
1263 @item -version
1264 @cindex @code{--version}
1265 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1266 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1267
1268 @item -configuration
1269 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1270 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1271 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1272 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1273
1274 @end table
1275
1276 @node Startup
1277 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1278 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1279
1280 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1281
1282 @enumerate
1283 @item
1284 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1285 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1286
1287 @item
1288 @cindex init file
1289 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1290 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1291 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1292 that file.
1293
1294 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1295 @item
1296 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1297 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1298 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1299 that file.
1300
1301 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1302 @item
1303 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1304 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1305 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1306 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1307 gets loaded.
1308
1309 @item
1310 Processes command line options and operands.
1311
1312 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1313 @item
1314 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1315 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1316 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1317 This is only done if the current directory is
1318 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1319 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1320 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1321 @value{GDBN}.
1322
1323 @item
1324 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1325 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1326 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1327 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1328
1329 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1330 you must do something like the following:
1331
1332 @smallexample
1333 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1334 @end smallexample
1335
1336 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1337 off too late.
1338
1339 @item
1340 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1341 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1342 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1343
1344 @item
1345 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1346 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1347 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1348 @end enumerate
1349
1350 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1351 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1352 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1353 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1354 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1355 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1356
1357 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1358 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1359
1360 @cindex init file name
1361 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1362 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1363 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1364 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1365 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1366 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1367 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1368 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1369
1370
1371 @node Quitting GDB
1372 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1373 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1374 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1375
1376 @table @code
1377 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1378 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1379 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1380 @itemx q
1381 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1382 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1383 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1384 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1385 error code.
1386 @end table
1387
1388 @cindex interrupt
1389 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1390 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1391 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1392 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1393 until a time when it is safe.
1394
1395 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1396 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1397 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1398
1399 @node Shell Commands
1400 @section Shell Commands
1401
1402 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1403 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1404 just use the @code{shell} command.
1405
1406 @table @code
1407 @kindex shell
1408 @kindex !
1409 @cindex shell escape
1410 @item shell @var{command-string}
1411 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1412 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1413 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1414 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1415 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1416 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1417 @end table
1418
1419 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1420 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1421 @value{GDBN}:
1422
1423 @table @code
1424 @kindex make
1425 @cindex calling make
1426 @item make @var{make-args}
1427 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1428 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1429 @end table
1430
1431 @node Logging Output
1432 @section Logging Output
1433 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1434 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1435
1436 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1437 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1438
1439 @table @code
1440 @kindex set logging
1441 @item set logging on
1442 Enable logging.
1443 @item set logging off
1444 Disable logging.
1445 @cindex logging file name
1446 @item set logging file @var{file}
1447 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1448 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1449 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1450 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1451 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1452 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1453 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1454 @kindex show logging
1455 @item show logging
1456 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1457 @end table
1458
1459 @node Commands
1460 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1461
1462 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1463 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1464 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1465 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1466 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1467
1468 @menu
1469 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1470 * Completion:: Command completion
1471 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1472 @end menu
1473
1474 @node Command Syntax
1475 @section Command Syntax
1476
1477 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1478 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1479 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1480 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1481 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1482 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1483
1484 @cindex abbreviation
1485 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1486 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1487 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1488 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1489 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1490 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1491 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1492
1493 @cindex repeating commands
1494 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1495 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1496 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1497 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1498 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1499 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1500 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1501
1502 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1503 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1504 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1505
1506 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1507 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1508 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1509 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1510 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1511
1512 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1513 @cindex comment
1514 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1515 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1516 Files,,Command Files}).
1517
1518 @cindex repeating command sequences
1519 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1520 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1521 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1522 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1523 for editing.
1524
1525 @node Completion
1526 @section Command Completion
1527
1528 @cindex completion
1529 @cindex word completion
1530 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1531 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1532 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1533 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1534
1535 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1536 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1537 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1538 enter it). For example, if you type
1539
1540 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1541 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1542 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1543 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1544 @smallexample
1545 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1546 @end smallexample
1547
1548 @noindent
1549 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1550 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1551
1552 @smallexample
1553 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1554 @end smallexample
1555
1556 @noindent
1557 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1558 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1559 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1560 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1561 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1562 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1563
1564 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1565 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1566 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1567 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1568 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1569 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1570 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1571 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1572 example:
1573
1574 @smallexample
1575 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1576 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1577 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1578 make_abs_section make_function_type
1579 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1580 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1581 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1582 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1583 @end smallexample
1584
1585 @noindent
1586 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1587 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1588 command.
1589
1590 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1591 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1592 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1593 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1594 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1595
1596 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1597 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1598 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1599
1600 @smallexample
1601 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1602 main
1603 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1604 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1605 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1606 @end smallexample
1607
1608 @noindent
1609 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1610
1611 @table @code
1612 @kindex set max-completions
1613 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1614 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1615 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1616 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1617 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1618 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1619 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1620 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1621 completion slow.
1622 @kindex show max-completions
1623 @item show max-completions
1624 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1625 during completion.
1626 @end table
1627
1628 @cindex quotes in commands
1629 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1630 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1631 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1632 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1633 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1634 @value{GDBN} commands.
1635
1636 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1637 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1638 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1639 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1640 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1641 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1642 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1643 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1644 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1645 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1646 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1647
1648 @smallexample
1649 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1650 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1651 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1652 @end smallexample
1653
1654 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1655 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1656 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1657 place:
1658
1659 @smallexample
1660 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1661 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1662 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1663 @end smallexample
1664
1665 @noindent
1666 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1667 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1668 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1669
1670 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1671 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1672 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1673 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1674
1675 @cindex completion of structure field names
1676 @cindex structure field name completion
1677 @cindex completion of union field names
1678 @cindex union field name completion
1679 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1680 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1681 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1682 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1683 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1684 left-hand-side:
1685
1686 @smallexample
1687 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1688 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1689 to_data to_isatty to_write
1690 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1691 to_flush to_read
1692 @end smallexample
1693
1694 @noindent
1695 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1696 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1697 follows:
1698
1699 @smallexample
1700 struct ui_file
1701 @{
1702 int *magic;
1703 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1704 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1705 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1706 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1707 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1708 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1709 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1710 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1711 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1712 void *to_data;
1713 @}
1714 @end smallexample
1715
1716
1717 @node Help
1718 @section Getting Help
1719 @cindex online documentation
1720 @kindex help
1721
1722 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1723 using the command @code{help}.
1724
1725 @table @code
1726 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1727 @item help
1728 @itemx h
1729 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1730 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1731
1732 @smallexample
1733 (@value{GDBP}) help
1734 List of classes of commands:
1735
1736 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1737 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1738 data -- Examining data
1739 files -- Specifying and examining files
1740 internals -- Maintenance commands
1741 obscure -- Obscure features
1742 running -- Running the program
1743 stack -- Examining the stack
1744 status -- Status inquiries
1745 support -- Support facilities
1746 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1747 stopping the program
1748 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1749
1750 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1751 commands in that class.
1752 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1753 documentation.
1754 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1755 (@value{GDBP})
1756 @end smallexample
1757 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1758
1759 @item help @var{class}
1760 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1761 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1762 help display for the class @code{status}:
1763
1764 @smallexample
1765 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1766 Status inquiries.
1767
1768 List of commands:
1769
1770 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1771 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1772 info -- Generic command for showing things
1773 about the program being debugged
1774 show -- Generic command for showing things
1775 about the debugger
1776
1777 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1778 documentation.
1779 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1780 (@value{GDBP})
1781 @end smallexample
1782
1783 @item help @var{command}
1784 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1785 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1786
1787 @kindex apropos
1788 @item apropos @var{args}
1789 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1790 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1791 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1792
1793 @smallexample
1794 apropos alias
1795 @end smallexample
1796
1797 @noindent
1798 results in:
1799
1800 @smallexample
1801 @c @group
1802 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1803 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1804 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1805 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1806 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1807 @c @end group
1808 @end smallexample
1809
1810 @kindex complete
1811 @item complete @var{args}
1812 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1813 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1814 command you want completed. For example:
1815
1816 @smallexample
1817 complete i
1818 @end smallexample
1819
1820 @noindent results in:
1821
1822 @smallexample
1823 @group
1824 if
1825 ignore
1826 info
1827 inspect
1828 @end group
1829 @end smallexample
1830
1831 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1832 @end table
1833
1834 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1835 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1836 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1837 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1838 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1839 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1840 Index}.
1841
1842 @c @group
1843 @table @code
1844 @kindex info
1845 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1846 @item info
1847 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1848 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1849 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1850 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1851 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1852 @w{@code{help info}}.
1853
1854 @kindex set
1855 @item set
1856 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1857 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1858 @code{set prompt $}.
1859
1860 @kindex show
1861 @item show
1862 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1863 @value{GDBN} itself.
1864 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1865 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1866 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1867 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1868
1869 @kindex info set
1870 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1871 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1872 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1873 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1874 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1875 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1876 @end table
1877 @c @end group
1878
1879 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1880 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1881
1882 @table @code
1883 @kindex show version
1884 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1885 @item show version
1886 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1887 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1888 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1889 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1890 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1891 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1892 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1893 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1894 @value{GDBN}.
1895
1896 @kindex show copying
1897 @kindex info copying
1898 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1899 @item show copying
1900 @itemx info copying
1901 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1902
1903 @kindex show warranty
1904 @kindex info warranty
1905 @item show warranty
1906 @itemx info warranty
1907 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1908 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1909
1910 @kindex show configuration
1911 @item show configuration
1912 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1913 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1914 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1915 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1916 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1917 your report.
1918
1919 @end table
1920
1921 @node Running
1922 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1923
1924 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1925 debugging information when you compile it.
1926
1927 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1928 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1929 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1930 kill a child process.
1931
1932 @menu
1933 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1934 * Starting:: Starting your program
1935 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1936 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1937
1938 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1939 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1940 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1941 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1942
1943 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1944 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1945 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1946 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1947 @end menu
1948
1949 @node Compilation
1950 @section Compiling for Debugging
1951
1952 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1953 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1954 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1955 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1956 and addresses in the executable code.
1957
1958 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1959 the compiler.
1960
1961 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1962 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1963 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1964 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1965 executables containing debugging information.
1966
1967 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1968 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1969 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1970 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1971 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1972
1973 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1974 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1975 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1976
1977 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1978 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1979 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1980 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1981 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1982 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1983
1984 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1985 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1986 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1987
1988 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1989 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1990 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1991 format in @value{GDBN}.
1992
1993 @need 2000
1994 @node Starting
1995 @section Starting your Program
1996 @cindex starting
1997 @cindex running
1998
1999 @table @code
2000 @kindex run
2001 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2002 @item run
2003 @itemx r
2004 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2005 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2006 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2007 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2008 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2009
2010 @end table
2011
2012 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2013 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2014 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2015 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2016 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2017 message like this one:
2018
2019 @smallexample
2020 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2021 Try "help target" or "continue".
2022 @end smallexample
2023
2024 @noindent
2025 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2026 first (@pxref{load}).
2027
2028 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2029 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2030 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2031 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2032 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2033 divided into four categories:
2034
2035 @table @asis
2036 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2037 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2038 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2039 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2040 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2041 the arguments.
2042 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2043 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2044 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2045 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2046 below for details).
2047
2048 @item The @emph{environment.}
2049 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2050 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2051 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2052 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2053
2054 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2055 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2056 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2057 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2058
2059 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2060 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2061 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2062 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2063 set a different device for your program.
2064 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2065
2066 @cindex pipes
2067 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2068 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2069 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2070 wrong program.
2071 @end table
2072
2073 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2074 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2075 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2076 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2077 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2078
2079 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2080 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2081 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2082 your current breakpoints.
2083
2084 @table @code
2085 @kindex start
2086 @item start
2087 @cindex run to main procedure
2088 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2089 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2090 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2091 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2092 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2093 procedure, depending on the language used.
2094
2095 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2096 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2097 the @samp{run} command.
2098
2099 @cindex elaboration phase
2100 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2101 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2102 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2103 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2104 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2105 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2106 will remain to halt execution.
2107
2108 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2109 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2110 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2111 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2112 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2113
2114 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2115 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2116 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2117 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2118 elaboration code before running your program.
2119
2120 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2121 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2122 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2123 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2124 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2125 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2126 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2127 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2128 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2129 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2130 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2131 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2132
2133 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2134 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2135 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2136 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2137
2138 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2139 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2140 environment:
2141
2142 @smallexample
2143 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2144 (@value{GDBP}) run
2145 @end smallexample
2146
2147 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2148 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2149
2150 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2151 @item set startup-with-shell
2152 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2153 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2154 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2155 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2156 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2157 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2158 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2159 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2160 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2161 startup failures such as:
2162
2163 @smallexample
2164 (@value{GDBP}) run
2165 Starting program: ./a.out
2166 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2167 @end smallexample
2168
2169 @noindent
2170 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2171 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2172 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2173 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2174 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2175 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2176
2177 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2178 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2179 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2180 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2181 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2182 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2183
2184 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2185 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2186 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2187 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2188 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2189 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2190
2191 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2192 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2193 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2194
2195 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2196 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2197
2198 @smallexample
2199 (@value{GDBP}) run
2200 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2201 @end smallexample
2202
2203 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2204 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2205
2206 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2207 @code{target native} command. For example,
2208
2209 @smallexample
2210 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2211 (@value{GDBP}) run
2212 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2213 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2214 (@value{GDBP}) run
2215 Starting program: ./a.out
2216 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2217 @end smallexample
2218
2219 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2220 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2221 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2222 disconnect.
2223
2224 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2225 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2226 proc}, @code{info os}.
2227
2228 @kindex set disable-randomization
2229 @item set disable-randomization
2230 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2231 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2232 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2233 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2234 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2235
2236 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2237 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2238
2239 @smallexample
2240 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2241 @end smallexample
2242
2243 @item set disable-randomization off
2244 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2245 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2246 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2247 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2248 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2249 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2250
2251 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2252 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2253 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2254 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2255 a code at its expected addresses.
2256
2257 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2258 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2259 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2260 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2261 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2262 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2263 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2264 a randomly chosen address.
2265
2266 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2267 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2268 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2269 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2270 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2271
2272 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2273 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2274
2275 @item show disable-randomization
2276 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2277 the virtual address space of the started program.
2278
2279 @end table
2280
2281 @node Arguments
2282 @section Your Program's Arguments
2283
2284 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2285 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2286 @code{run} command.
2287 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2288 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2289 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2290 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2291 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2292
2293 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2294 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2295 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2296 the program, not by the shell.
2297
2298 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2299 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2300
2301 @table @code
2302 @kindex set args
2303 @item set args
2304 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2305 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2306 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2307 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2308 it again without arguments.
2309
2310 @kindex show args
2311 @item show args
2312 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2313 @end table
2314
2315 @node Environment
2316 @section Your Program's Environment
2317
2318 @cindex environment (of your program)
2319 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2320 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2321 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2322 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2323 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2324 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2325 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2326
2327 @table @code
2328 @kindex path
2329 @item path @var{directory}
2330 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2331 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2332 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2333 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2334 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2335 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2336 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2337
2338 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2339 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2340 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2341 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2342 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2343 @var{directory} to the search path.
2344 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2345 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2346
2347 @kindex show paths
2348 @item show paths
2349 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2350 environment variable).
2351
2352 @kindex show environment
2353 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2354 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2355 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2356 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2357 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2358
2359 @kindex set environment
2360 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2361 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2362 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2363 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2364 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2365 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2366 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2367 null value.
2368 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2369 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2370
2371 For example, this command:
2372
2373 @smallexample
2374 set env USER = foo
2375 @end smallexample
2376
2377 @noindent
2378 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2379 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2380 are not actually required.)
2381
2382 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2383 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2384 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2385 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2386 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2387
2388 @kindex unset environment
2389 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2390 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2391 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2392 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2393 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2394 @end table
2395
2396 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2397 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2398 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2399 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2400 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2401 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2402 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2403 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2404 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2405 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2406
2407 @node Working Directory
2408 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2409
2410 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2411 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2412 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2413 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2414 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2415 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2416
2417 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2418 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2419 Specify Files}.
2420
2421 @table @code
2422 @kindex cd
2423 @cindex change working directory
2424 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2425 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2426 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2427
2428 @kindex pwd
2429 @item pwd
2430 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2431 @end table
2432
2433 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2434 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2435 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2436 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2437 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2438 current working directory of the debuggee.
2439
2440 @node Input/Output
2441 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2442
2443 @cindex redirection
2444 @cindex i/o
2445 @cindex terminal
2446 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2447 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2448 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2449 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2450 running your program.
2451
2452 @table @code
2453 @kindex info terminal
2454 @item info terminal
2455 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2456 program is using.
2457 @end table
2458
2459 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2460 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2461
2462 @smallexample
2463 run > outfile
2464 @end smallexample
2465
2466 @noindent
2467 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2468
2469 @kindex tty
2470 @cindex controlling terminal
2471 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2472 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2473 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2474 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2475 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2476
2477 @smallexample
2478 tty /dev/ttyb
2479 @end smallexample
2480
2481 @noindent
2482 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2483 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2484 that as their controlling terminal.
2485
2486 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2487 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2488 terminal.
2489
2490 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2491 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2492 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2493 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2494
2495 @cindex inferior tty
2496 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2497 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2498 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2499 program.
2500
2501 @table @code
2502 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2503 @kindex set inferior-tty
2504 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2505
2506 @item show inferior-tty
2507 @kindex show inferior-tty
2508 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2509 @end table
2510
2511 @node Attach
2512 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2513 @kindex attach
2514 @cindex attach
2515
2516 @table @code
2517 @item attach @var{process-id}
2518 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2519 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2520 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2521 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2522 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2523
2524 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2525 executing the command.
2526 @end table
2527
2528 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2529 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2530 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2531 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2532
2533 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2534 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2535 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2536 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2537 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2538 Specify Files}.
2539
2540 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2541 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2542 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2543 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2544 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2545 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2546 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2547
2548 @table @code
2549 @kindex detach
2550 @item detach
2551 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2552 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2553 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2554 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2555 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2556 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2557 executing the command.
2558 @end table
2559
2560 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2561 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2562 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2563 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2564 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2565 Messages}).
2566
2567 @node Kill Process
2568 @section Killing the Child Process
2569
2570 @table @code
2571 @kindex kill
2572 @item kill
2573 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2574 @end table
2575
2576 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2577 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2578 is running.
2579
2580 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2581 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2582 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2583 outside the debugger.
2584
2585 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2586 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2587 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2588 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2589 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2590 breakpoint settings).
2591
2592 @node Inferiors and Programs
2593 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2594
2595 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2596 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2597 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2598 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2599 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2600 from multiple executables.
2601
2602 @cindex inferior
2603 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2604 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2605 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2606 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2607 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2608 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2609 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2610 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2611 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2612 threads running in it.
2613
2614 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2615 inferiors}}:
2616
2617 @table @code
2618 @kindex info inferiors
2619 @item info inferiors
2620 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2621
2622 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2623
2624 @enumerate
2625 @item
2626 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2627
2628 @item
2629 the target system's inferior identifier
2630
2631 @item
2632 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2633
2634 @end enumerate
2635
2636 @noindent
2637 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2638 indicates the current inferior.
2639
2640 For example,
2641 @end table
2642 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2643
2644 @smallexample
2645 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2646 Num Description Executable
2647 2 process 2307 hello
2648 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2649 @end smallexample
2650
2651 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2652
2653 @table @code
2654 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2655 @item inferior @var{infno}
2656 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2657 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2658 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2659 @end table
2660
2661
2662 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2663 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2664 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2665 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2666 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2667 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2668
2669 @table @code
2670 @kindex add-inferior
2671 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2672 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2673 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2674 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2675 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2676 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2677
2678 @kindex clone-inferior
2679 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2680 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2681 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2682 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2683 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2684
2685 @smallexample
2686 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2687 Num Description Executable
2688 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2689 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2690 Added inferior 2.
2691 1 inferiors added.
2692 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2693 Num Description Executable
2694 2 <null> helloworld
2695 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2696 @end smallexample
2697
2698 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2699
2700 @kindex remove-inferiors
2701 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2702 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2703 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2704 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2705
2706 @end table
2707
2708 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2709 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2710 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2711 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2712
2713 @table @code
2714 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2715 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2716 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2717 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2718 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2719 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2720
2721 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2722 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2723 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2724 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2725 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2726 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2727 @end table
2728
2729 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2730 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2731 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2732 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2733
2734
2735 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2736 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2737
2738 @table @code
2739 @kindex set print inferior-events
2740 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2741 @item set print inferior-events
2742 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2743 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2744 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2745 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2746 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2747 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2748
2749 @kindex show print inferior-events
2750 @item show print inferior-events
2751 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2752 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2753 @end table
2754
2755 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2756 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2757 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2758
2759
2760 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2761 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2762 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2763 info program-spaces}} command.
2764
2765 @table @code
2766 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2767 @item maint info program-spaces
2768 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2769 @value{GDBN}.
2770
2771 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2772
2773 @enumerate
2774 @item
2775 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2776
2777 @item
2778 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2779 the @code{file} command.
2780
2781 @end enumerate
2782
2783 @noindent
2784 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2785 indicates the current program space.
2786
2787 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2788 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2789 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2790
2791 @smallexample
2792 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2793 Id Executable
2794 * 1 hello
2795 2 goodbye
2796 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2797 @end smallexample
2798
2799 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2800 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2801 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2802 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2803 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2804
2805 @smallexample
2806 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2807 Id Executable
2808 * 1 vfork-test
2809 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2810 @end smallexample
2811
2812 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2813 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2814 @end table
2815
2816 @node Threads
2817 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2818
2819 @cindex threads of execution
2820 @cindex multiple threads
2821 @cindex switching threads
2822 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2823 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2824 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2825 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2826 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2827 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2828 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2829
2830 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2831 programs:
2832
2833 @itemize @bullet
2834 @item automatic notification of new threads
2835 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2836 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2837 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2838 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2839 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2840 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2841 messages on thread start and exit.
2842 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2843 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2844 isn't compatible with the program.
2845 @end itemize
2846
2847 @cindex focus of debugging
2848 @cindex current thread
2849 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2850 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2851 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2852 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2853 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2854
2855 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2856 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2857 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2858 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2859 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2860 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2861 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2862 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2863 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2864 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2865
2866 @smallexample
2867 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2868 @end smallexample
2869
2870 @noindent
2871 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2872 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2873 further qualifier.
2874
2875 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2876 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2877 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2878 @c program?
2879 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2880 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2881 @c threads ab initio?
2882
2883 @cindex thread number
2884 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2885 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2886 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2887
2888 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
2889 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
2890 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
2891
2892 @table @code
2893 @kindex info threads
2894 @item info threads @r{[}@var{id}@dots{}@r{]}
2895 Display a summary of all threads currently in your program. Optional
2896 argument @var{id}@dots{} is one or more thread ids separated by spaces, and
2897 means to print information only about the specified thread or threads.
2898 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2899
2900 @enumerate
2901 @item
2902 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2903
2904 @item
2905 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2906
2907 @item
2908 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
2909 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
2910 program itself.
2911
2912 @item
2913 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2914 @end enumerate
2915
2916 @noindent
2917 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2918 indicates the current thread.
2919
2920 For example,
2921 @end table
2922 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2923
2924 @smallexample
2925 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2926 Id Target Id Frame
2927 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2928 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2929 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2930 at threadtest.c:68
2931 @end smallexample
2932
2933 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2934 Solaris-specific command:
2935
2936 @table @code
2937 @item maint info sol-threads
2938 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2939 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2940 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2941 @end table
2942
2943 @table @code
2944 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2945 @item thread @var{threadno}
2946 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2947 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2948 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2949 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2950 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2951
2952 @smallexample
2953 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2954 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
2955 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
2956 8 printf ("hello\n");
2957 @end smallexample
2958
2959 @noindent
2960 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2961 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2962 threads.
2963
2964 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2965 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2966 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2967 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2968 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2969 information on convenience variables.
2970
2971 @kindex thread apply
2972 @cindex apply command to several threads
2973 @item thread apply [@var{threadno} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
2974 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2975 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2976 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2977 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2978 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2979 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply
2980 a command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
2981 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
2982 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
2983
2984
2985 @kindex thread name
2986 @cindex name a thread
2987 @item thread name [@var{name}]
2988 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
2989 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
2990 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
2991
2992 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
2993 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
2994 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
2995 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
2996 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
2997
2998 @kindex thread find
2999 @cindex search for a thread
3000 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3001 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3002 matches the supplied regular expression.
3003
3004 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3005 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3006 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3007 is the LWP id.
3008
3009 @smallexample
3010 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3011 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3012 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3013 Id Target Id Frame
3014 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3015 @end smallexample
3016
3017 @kindex set print thread-events
3018 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3019 @item set print thread-events
3020 @itemx set print thread-events on
3021 @itemx set print thread-events off
3022 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3023 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3024 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3025 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3026 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3027
3028 @kindex show print thread-events
3029 @item show print thread-events
3030 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3031 have started and exited.
3032 @end table
3033
3034 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3035 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3036 programs with multiple threads.
3037
3038 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3039 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3040
3041 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3042 @table @code
3043 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3044 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3045 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3046 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3047 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3048 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3049 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3050 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3051 macro.
3052
3053 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3054 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3055 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3056 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3057 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3058 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3059
3060 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3061 refers to the default system directories that are
3062 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3063 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3064 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3065
3066 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3067 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3068 was loaded in the inferior process.
3069
3070 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3071 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3072 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3073 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3074 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3075 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3076 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3077
3078 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3079 only on some platforms.
3080
3081 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3082 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3083 Display current libthread_db search path.
3084
3085 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3086 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3087 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3088 @item set debug libthread-db
3089 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3090 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3091 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3092 @end table
3093
3094 @node Forks
3095 @section Debugging Forks
3096
3097 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3098 @cindex multiple processes
3099 @cindex processes, multiple
3100 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3101 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3102 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3103 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3104 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3105 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3106 will cause it to terminate.
3107
3108 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3109 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3110 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3111 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3112 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3113 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3114 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3115 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3116 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3117 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3118
3119 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3120 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3121 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3122 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3123
3124 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3125 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3126 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3127
3128 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3129 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3130
3131 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3132 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3133
3134 @table @code
3135 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3136 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3137 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3138 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3139 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3140
3141 @table @code
3142 @item parent
3143 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3144 unimpeded. This is the default.
3145
3146 @item child
3147 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3148 unimpeded.
3149
3150 @end table
3151
3152 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3153 @item show follow-fork-mode
3154 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3155 @end table
3156
3157 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3158 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3159 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3160
3161 @table @code
3162 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3163 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3164 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3165 retain debugger control over them both.
3166
3167 @table @code
3168 @item on
3169 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3170 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3171 independently. This is the default.
3172
3173 @item off
3174 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3175 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3176 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3177 is held suspended.
3178
3179 @end table
3180
3181 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3182 @item show detach-on-fork
3183 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3184 @end table
3185
3186 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3187 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3188 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3189 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3190 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3191 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3192
3193 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3194 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3195 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3196 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3197 and Programs}.
3198
3199 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3200 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3201 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3202 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3203 the child process's @code{main}.
3204
3205 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3206 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3207
3208 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3209 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3210 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3211 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3212 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3213 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3214 command.
3215
3216 @table @code
3217 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3218 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3219
3220 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3221 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3222
3223 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3224
3225 @table @code
3226 @item new
3227 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3228 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3229 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3230 original inferior.
3231
3232 For example:
3233
3234 @smallexample
3235 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3236 (gdb) info inferior
3237 Id Description Executable
3238 * 1 <null> prog1
3239 (@value{GDBP}) run
3240 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3241 Program exited normally.
3242 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3243 Id Description Executable
3244 1 <null> prog1
3245 * 2 <null> prog2
3246 @end smallexample
3247
3248 @item same
3249 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3250 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3251 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3252 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3253 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3254
3255 For example:
3256
3257 @smallexample
3258 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3259 Id Description Executable
3260 * 1 <null> prog1
3261 (@value{GDBP}) run
3262 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3263 Program exited normally.
3264 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3265 Id Description Executable
3266 * 1 <null> prog2
3267 @end smallexample
3268
3269 @end table
3270 @end table
3271
3272 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3273 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3274
3275 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3276 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3277 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3278
3279 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3280 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3281
3282 @cindex checkpoint
3283 @cindex restart
3284 @cindex bookmark
3285 @cindex snapshot of a process
3286 @cindex rewind program state
3287
3288 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3289 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3290 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3291 later.
3292
3293 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3294 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3295 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3296 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3297 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3298
3299 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3300 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3301 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3302 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3303 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3304 start again from there.
3305
3306 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3307 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3308
3309 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3310
3311 @table @code
3312 @kindex checkpoint
3313 @item checkpoint
3314 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3315 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3316 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3317
3318 @kindex info checkpoints
3319 @item info checkpoints
3320 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3321 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3322 listed:
3323
3324 @table @code
3325 @item Checkpoint ID
3326 @item Process ID
3327 @item Code Address
3328 @item Source line, or label
3329 @end table
3330
3331 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3332 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3333 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3334 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3335 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3336 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3337 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3338
3339 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3340 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3341 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3342 the debugger.
3343
3344 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3345 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3346 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3347
3348 @end table
3349
3350 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3351 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3352 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3353 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3354 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3355 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3356 previously read data can be read again.
3357
3358 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3359 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3360 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3361 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3362 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3363 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3364
3365 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3366 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3367 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3368 different execution path this time.
3369
3370 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3371 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3372 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3373 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3374 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3375 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3376 potentially pose a problem.
3377
3378 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3379
3380 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3381 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3382 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3383 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3384 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3385 next.
3386
3387 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3388 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3389 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3390 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3391 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3392
3393 @node Stopping
3394 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3395
3396 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3397 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3398 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3399
3400 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3401 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3402 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3403 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3404 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3405 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3406 explicitly request this information at any time.
3407
3408 @table @code
3409 @kindex info program
3410 @item info program
3411 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3412 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3413 @end table
3414
3415 @menu
3416 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3417 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3418 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3419 Skipping over functions and files
3420 * Signals:: Signals
3421 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3422 @end menu
3423
3424 @node Breakpoints
3425 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3426
3427 @cindex breakpoints
3428 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3429 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3430 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3431 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3432 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3433 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3434 program.
3435
3436 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3437 the executable is run.
3438
3439 @cindex watchpoints
3440 @cindex data breakpoints
3441 @cindex memory tracing
3442 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3443 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3444 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3445 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3446 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3447 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3448 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3449 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3450 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3451 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3452 same commands.
3453
3454 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3455 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3456 Automatic Display}.
3457
3458 @cindex catchpoints
3459 @cindex breakpoint on events
3460 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3461 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3462 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3463 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3464 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3465 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3466 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3467
3468 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3469 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3470 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3471 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3472 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3473 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3474 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3475 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3476 enable it again.
3477
3478 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3479 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3480 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3481 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3482 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3483 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3484 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3485
3486 @menu
3487 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3488 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3489 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3490 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3491 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3492 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3493 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3494 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3495 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3496 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3497 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3498 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3499 @end menu
3500
3501 @node Set Breaks
3502 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3503
3504 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3505 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3506 @c
3507 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3508
3509 @kindex break
3510 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3511 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3512 @cindex latest breakpoint
3513 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3514 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3515 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3516 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3517 convenience variables.
3518
3519 @table @code
3520 @item break @var{location}
3521 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3522 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3523 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3524 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3525 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3526
3527 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3528 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3529 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3530 that situation.
3531
3532 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3533 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3534 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3535
3536 @item break
3537 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3538 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3539 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3540 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3541 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3542 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3543 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3544 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3545 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3546 inside loops.
3547
3548 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3549 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3550 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3551 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3552 existed when your program stopped.
3553
3554 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3555 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3556 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3557 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3558 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3559 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3560 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3561
3562 @kindex tbreak
3563 @item tbreak @var{args}
3564 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3565 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3566 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3567 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3568
3569 @kindex hbreak
3570 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3571 @item hbreak @var{args}
3572 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3573 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3574 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3575 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3576 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3577 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3578 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3579 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3580 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3581 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3582 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3583 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3584 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3585 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3586 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3587 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3588 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3589 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3590
3591 @kindex thbreak
3592 @item thbreak @var{args}
3593 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3594 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3595 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3596 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3597 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3598 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3599 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3600 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3601
3602 @kindex rbreak
3603 @cindex regular expression
3604 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3605 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3606 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3607 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3608 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3609 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3610 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3611 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3612 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3613
3614 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3615 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3616 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3617 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3618 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3619 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3620
3621 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3622 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3623 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3624 classes.
3625
3626 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3627 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3628 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3629
3630 @smallexample
3631 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3632 @end smallexample
3633
3634 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3635 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3636 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3637 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3638 every function in a given file:
3639
3640 @smallexample
3641 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3642 @end smallexample
3643
3644 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3645 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3646
3647 @kindex info breakpoints
3648 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3649 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3650 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3651 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3652 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3653 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3654 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3655
3656 @table @emph
3657 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3658 @item Type
3659 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3660 @item Disposition
3661 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3662 @item Enabled or Disabled
3663 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3664 that are not enabled.
3665 @item Address
3666 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3667 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3668 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3669 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3670 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3671 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3672 @item What
3673 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3674 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3675 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3676 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3677 @end table
3678
3679 @noindent
3680 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3681 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3682 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3683 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3684 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3685 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3686
3687 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3688 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3689 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3690 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3691
3692 @noindent
3693 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3694 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3695 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3696 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3697 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3698
3699 @noindent
3700 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3701 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3702 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3703 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3704 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3705 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3706
3707 @noindent
3708 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3709 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3710
3711 @end table
3712
3713 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3714 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3715 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3716 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3717
3718 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3719 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3720 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3721 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3722
3723 @itemize @bullet
3724 @item
3725 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3726
3727 @item
3728 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3729 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3730
3731 @item
3732 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3733 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3734
3735 @item
3736 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3737 several places where that function is inlined.
3738 @end itemize
3739
3740 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3741 the relevant locations.
3742
3743 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3744 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3745 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3746 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3747 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3748 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3749 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3750
3751 For example:
3752
3753 @smallexample
3754 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3755 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3756 stop only if i==1
3757 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3758 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3759 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3760 @end smallexample
3761
3762 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3763 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3764 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3765 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3766 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3767 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3768 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3769 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3770 that belong to that breakpoint.
3771
3772 @cindex pending breakpoints
3773 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3774 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3775 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3776 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3777 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3778 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3779 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3780 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3781 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3782 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3783 is not yet resolved.
3784
3785 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3786 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3787 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3788 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3789 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3790 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3791
3792 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3793 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3794 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3795 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3796
3797 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3798 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3799 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3800
3801 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3802 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3803 address specification to an address:
3804
3805 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3806 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3807 @table @code
3808 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3809 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3810 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3811
3812 @item set breakpoint pending on
3813 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3814 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3815
3816 @item set breakpoint pending off
3817 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3818 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3819 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3820
3821 @item show breakpoint pending
3822 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3823 @end table
3824
3825 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3826 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3827 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3828
3829 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3830 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3831 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3832 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3833 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3834 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3835 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3836 breakpoints.
3837
3838 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3839
3840 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3841 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3842 @table @code
3843 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3844 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3845 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3846 breakpoint must be used.
3847
3848 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3849 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3850 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3851 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3852 @end table
3853
3854 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3855 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3856 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3857 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3858 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3859 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3860 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3861 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3862 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3863
3864 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3865 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3866 @table @code
3867 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3868 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3869 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3870 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
3871
3872 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3873 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3874 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3875 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3876 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
3877 @end table
3878
3879 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3880 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3881 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3882
3883 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3884 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3885
3886 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3887
3888 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3889 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3890 @table @code
3891 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3892 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
3893 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
3894 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
3895 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
3896
3897 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
3898 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
3899 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
3900 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
3901 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
3902 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
3903 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
3904 that is only known to the host. Examples include
3905 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
3906 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
3907 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
3908 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
3909 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
3910
3911 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
3912 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
3913 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
3914 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
3915 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
3916 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
3917 @end table
3918
3919
3920 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3921 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3922 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3923 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3924 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3925 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3926 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3927 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3928
3929
3930 @node Set Watchpoints
3931 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3932
3933 @cindex setting watchpoints
3934 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3935 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3936 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3937 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3938 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3939
3940 @itemize @bullet
3941 @item
3942 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3943
3944 @item
3945 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3946 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3947 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3948
3949 @item
3950 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3951 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3952 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3953 @end itemize
3954
3955 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3956 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3957 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3958 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3959 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3960 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3961 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3962 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3963 the expression changes.
3964
3965 @cindex software watchpoints
3966 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3967 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3968 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3969 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3970 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3971 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3972 culprit.)
3973
3974 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
3975 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
3976 slow down the running of your program.
3977
3978 @table @code
3979 @kindex watch
3980 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3981 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3982 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3983 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3984 to watch the value of a single variable:
3985
3986 @smallexample
3987 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3988 @end smallexample
3989
3990 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3991 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3992 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3993 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3994 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3995 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3996
3997 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
3998 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
3999 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4000 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4001 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4002 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4003 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4004 error.
4005
4006 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4007 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4008 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4009 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4010 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4011 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4012 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4013 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4014 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4015 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4016 Examples:
4017
4018 @smallexample
4019 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4020 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4021 @end smallexample
4022
4023 @kindex rwatch
4024 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4025 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4026 by the program.
4027
4028 @kindex awatch
4029 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4030 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4031 or written into by the program.
4032
4033 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4034 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4035 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4036 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4037 @end table
4038
4039 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4040 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4041 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4042 a never-changing value:
4043
4044 @smallexample
4045 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4046 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4047 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4048 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4049 @end smallexample
4050
4051 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4052 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4053 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4054 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4055 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4056 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4057
4058 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4059 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4060 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4061 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4062 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4063 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4064 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4065 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4066
4067 @table @code
4068 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4069 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4070 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4071
4072 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4073 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4074 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4075 @end table
4076
4077 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4078 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4079 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4080
4081 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4082
4083 @smallexample
4084 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4085 @end smallexample
4086
4087 @noindent
4088 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4089
4090 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4091 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4092 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4093 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4094 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4095 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4096 will print a message like this:
4097
4098 @smallexample
4099 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4100 @end smallexample
4101
4102 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4103 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4104 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4105 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4106 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4107 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4108 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4109 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4110
4111 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4112 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4113 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4114 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4115 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4116 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4117
4118 @smallexample
4119 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4120 @end smallexample
4121
4122 @noindent
4123 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4124
4125 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4126 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4127 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4128 expression with separately allocated resources.
4129
4130 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4131 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4132 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4133
4134 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4135 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4136 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4137 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4138 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4139 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4140 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4141 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4142 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4143
4144 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4145 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4146 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4147 watched expression from every thread.
4148
4149 @quotation
4150 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4151 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4152 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4153 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4154 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4155 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4156 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4157 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4158 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4159 @end quotation
4160
4161 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4162
4163 @node Set Catchpoints
4164 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4165 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4166 @cindex exception handlers
4167 @cindex event handling
4168
4169 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4170 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4171 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4172
4173 @table @code
4174 @kindex catch
4175 @item catch @var{event}
4176 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4177
4178 @table @code
4179 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4180 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4181 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4182 @kindex catch throw
4183 @kindex catch rethrow
4184 @kindex catch catch
4185 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4186 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4187
4188 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4189 regular expression will be caught.
4190
4191 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4192 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4193 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4194 exception being thrown.
4195
4196 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4197 @value{GDBN}:
4198
4199 @itemize @bullet
4200 @item
4201 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4202 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4203 supported.
4204
4205 @item
4206 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4207 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4208 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4209 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4210 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4211 built.
4212
4213 @item
4214 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4215 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4216
4217 @item
4218 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4219 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4220 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4221 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4222
4223 @item
4224 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4225 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4226 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4227 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4228 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4229 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4230 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4231 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4232 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4233
4234 @item
4235 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4236
4237 @item
4238 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4239 @end itemize
4240
4241 @item exception
4242 @kindex catch exception
4243 @cindex Ada exception catching
4244 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4245 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4246 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4247 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4248 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4249
4250 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4251 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4252 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4253 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4254 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4255 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4256 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4257 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4258
4259 @item exception unhandled
4260 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4261 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4262
4263 @item assert
4264 @kindex catch assert
4265 A failed Ada assertion.
4266
4267 @item exec
4268 @kindex catch exec
4269 @cindex break on fork/exec
4270 A call to @code{exec}.
4271
4272 @item syscall
4273 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
4274 @kindex catch syscall
4275 @cindex break on a system call.
4276 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4277 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4278 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4279 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4280 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4281 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4282 will be caught.
4283
4284 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4285 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4286 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4287 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4288
4289 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4290 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4291 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4292 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4293
4294 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4295 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4296 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4297 available choices.
4298
4299 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4300 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4301 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4302 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4303 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4304 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4305 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4306 behind the OS upgrades).
4307
4308 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4309 arguments to it:
4310
4311 @smallexample
4312 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4313 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4314 (@value{GDBP}) r
4315 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4316
4317 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4318 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4319 (@value{GDBP}) c
4320 Continuing.
4321
4322 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4323 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4324 (@value{GDBP})
4325 @end smallexample
4326
4327 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4328
4329 @smallexample
4330 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4331 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4332 (@value{GDBP}) r
4333 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4334
4335 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4336 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4337 (@value{GDBP}) c
4338 Continuing.
4339
4340 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4341 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4342 (@value{GDBP})
4343 @end smallexample
4344
4345 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4346 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4347 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4348
4349 @smallexample
4350 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4351 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4352 (@value{GDBP}) r
4353 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4354
4355 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4356 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4357 (@value{GDBP}) c
4358 Continuing.
4359
4360 Program exited normally.
4361 (@value{GDBP})
4362 @end smallexample
4363
4364 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4365 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4366 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4367 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4368
4369 @smallexample
4370 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4371 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4372 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4373 (@value{GDBP})
4374 @end smallexample
4375
4376 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4377 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4378 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4379 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4380 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4381 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4382
4383 @smallexample
4384 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4385 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4386 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4387 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4388 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4389 (@value{GDBP})
4390 @end smallexample
4391
4392 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4393
4394 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4395 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4396
4397 @smallexample
4398 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4399 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4400 @end smallexample
4401
4402 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4403
4404 @item fork
4405 @kindex catch fork
4406 A call to @code{fork}.
4407
4408 @item vfork
4409 @kindex catch vfork
4410 A call to @code{vfork}.
4411
4412 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4413 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4414 @kindex catch load
4415 @kindex catch unload
4416 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4417 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4418 matches one of the affected libraries.
4419
4420 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4421 @kindex catch signal
4422 The delivery of a signal.
4423
4424 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4425 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4426 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4427
4428 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4429 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4430 signal names.
4431
4432 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4433 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4434 will be caught.
4435
4436 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4437 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4438 catchpoint.
4439
4440 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4441 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4442 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4443 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4444 commands.
4445
4446 @end table
4447
4448 @item tcatch @var{event}
4449 @kindex tcatch
4450 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4451 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4452
4453 @end table
4454
4455 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4456
4457
4458 @node Delete Breaks
4459 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4460
4461 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4462 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4463 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4464 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4465 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4466 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4467
4468 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4469 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4470 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4471 their breakpoint numbers.
4472
4473 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4474 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4475 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4476
4477 @table @code
4478 @kindex clear
4479 @item clear
4480 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4481 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4482 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4483 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4484
4485 @item clear @var{location}
4486 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4487 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4488 most useful ones are listed below:
4489
4490 @table @code
4491 @item clear @var{function}
4492 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4493 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4494
4495 @item clear @var{linenum}
4496 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4497 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4498 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4499 @end table
4500
4501 @cindex delete breakpoints
4502 @kindex delete
4503 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4504 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4505 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4506 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4507 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4508 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4509 @end table
4510
4511 @node Disabling
4512 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4513
4514 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4515 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4516 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4517 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4518 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4519
4520 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4521 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4522 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4523 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4524 do not know which numbers to use.
4525
4526 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4527 affects all of its locations.
4528
4529 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4530 different states of enablement:
4531
4532 @itemize @bullet
4533 @item
4534 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4535 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4536 @item
4537 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4538 @item
4539 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4540 disabled.
4541 @item
4542 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4543 N times, then becomes disabled.
4544 @item
4545 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4546 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4547 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4548 @end itemize
4549
4550 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4551 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4552
4553 @table @code
4554 @kindex disable
4555 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4556 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4557 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4558 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4559 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4560 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4561 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4562
4563 @kindex enable
4564 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4565 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4566 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4567
4568 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4569 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4570 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4571
4572 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4573 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4574 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4575 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4576 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4577 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4578 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4579
4580 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4581 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4582 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4583 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4584 @end table
4585
4586 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4587 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4588 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4589 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4590 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4591 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4592 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4593 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4594 Stepping}.)
4595
4596 @node Conditions
4597 @subsection Break Conditions
4598 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4599 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4600
4601 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4602 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4603 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4604 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4605 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4606 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4607 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4608 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4609
4610 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4611 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4612 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4613 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4614 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4615
4616 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4617 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4618 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4619 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4620 one.
4621
4622 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4623 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4624 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4625 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4626 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4627 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4628 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4629 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4630 conditions for the
4631 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4632 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4633
4634 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4635 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4636 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4637 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4638 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4639 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4640
4641 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4642 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4643 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4644 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4645 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4646
4647 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4648 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4649 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4650 with the @code{condition} command.
4651
4652 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4653 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4654 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4655 catchpoint.
4656
4657 @table @code
4658 @kindex condition
4659 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4660 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4661 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4662 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4663 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4664 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4665 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4666 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4667 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4668 prints an error message:
4669
4670 @smallexample
4671 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4672 @end smallexample
4673
4674 @noindent
4675 @value{GDBN} does
4676 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4677 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4678 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4679
4680 @item condition @var{bnum}
4681 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4682 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4683 @end table
4684
4685 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4686 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4687 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4688 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4689 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4690 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4691 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4692 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4693 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4694 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4695 your program reaches it.
4696
4697 @table @code
4698 @kindex ignore
4699 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4700 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4701 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4702 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4703 takes no action.
4704
4705 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4706 a count of zero.
4707
4708 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4709 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4710 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4711 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4712
4713 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4714 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4715 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4716
4717 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4718 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4719 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4720 Variables}.
4721 @end table
4722
4723 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4724
4725
4726 @node Break Commands
4727 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4728
4729 @cindex breakpoint commands
4730 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4731 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4732 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4733 enable other breakpoints.
4734
4735 @table @code
4736 @kindex commands
4737 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4738 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4739 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4740 @itemx end
4741 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4742 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4743 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4744
4745 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4746 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4747
4748 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4749 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4750 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4751 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4752 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4753 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4754 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4755 Expressions}).
4756 @end table
4757
4758 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4759 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4760
4761 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4762 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4763 that resumes execution.
4764
4765 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4766 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4767 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4768 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4769 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4770
4771 @kindex silent
4772 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4773 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4774 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4775 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4776 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4777 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4778
4779 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4780 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4781 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4782
4783 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4784 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4785
4786 @smallexample
4787 break foo if x>0
4788 commands
4789 silent
4790 printf "x is %d\n",x
4791 cont
4792 end
4793 @end smallexample
4794
4795 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4796 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4797 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4798 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4799 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4800 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4801 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4802
4803 @smallexample
4804 break 403
4805 commands
4806 silent
4807 set x = y + 4
4808 cont
4809 end
4810 @end smallexample
4811
4812 @node Dynamic Printf
4813 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4814
4815 @cindex dynamic printf
4816 @cindex dprintf
4817 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4818 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4819 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4820 having to recompile it.
4821
4822 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4823 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4824 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4825 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4826 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4827 redirects to files and so forth.
4828
4829 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4830 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4831 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4832 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4833 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4834 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4835 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4836
4837 @table @code
4838 @kindex dprintf
4839 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4840 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4841 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4842 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4843
4844 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4845 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4846 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4847 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4848 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4849 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4850
4851 @item gdb
4852 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4853 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4854
4855 @item call
4856 @kindex dprintf-style call
4857 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4858 @code{printf}).
4859
4860 @item agent
4861 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4862 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4863 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4864 support running commands on the target.
4865
4866 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
4867 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
4868 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
4869 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
4870 command.
4871
4872 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
4873 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
4874 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
4875 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
4876 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
4877 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
4878
4879 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
4880 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
4881 you could do the following:
4882
4883 @example
4884 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
4885 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
4886 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
4887 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
4888 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
4889 (gdb) info break
4890 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
4891 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
4892 continue
4893 (gdb)
4894 @end example
4895
4896 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
4897 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
4898 the variable settings.
4899
4900 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
4901 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
4902 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
4903 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
4904 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
4905 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
4906
4907 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
4908 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
4909 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
4910
4911 @end table
4912
4913 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
4914 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
4915 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
4916 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
4917 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
4918 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
4919
4920 @node Save Breakpoints
4921 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4922
4923 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4924 breakpoints}} command.
4925
4926 @table @code
4927 @kindex save breakpoints
4928 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4929 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4930 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4931 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4932 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4933 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4934 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4935 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4936 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4937 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4938 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4939 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4940 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4941 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4942 that can no longer be recreated.
4943 @end table
4944
4945 @node Static Probe Points
4946 @subsection Static Probe Points
4947
4948 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
4949 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
4950 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
4951 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
4952 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
4953
4954 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
4955 ELF-compatible systems:
4956
4957 @itemize @bullet
4958
4959 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
4960 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
4961 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
4962 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
4963 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
4964 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
4965 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
4966 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
4967
4968 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
4969 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
4970 C@t{++} languages.
4971 @end itemize
4972
4973 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
4974 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
4975 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
4976 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
4977 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
4978 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
4979 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
4980 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
4981 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
4982
4983 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
4984 probes}, with optional arguments:
4985
4986 @table @code
4987 @kindex info probes
4988 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
4989 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
4990 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
4991 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
4992
4993 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
4994 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
4995 probes from all providers are listed.
4996
4997 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
4998 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
4999 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5000
5001 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5002 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5003 given, all object files are considered.
5004
5005 @item info probes all
5006 List the available static probes, from all types.
5007 @end table
5008
5009 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5010 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5011 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5012 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5013 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5014
5015 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5016 commands, with optional arguments:
5017
5018 @table @code
5019 @kindex enable probes
5020 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5021 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5022 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5023 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5024
5025 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5026 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5027 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5028
5029 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5030 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5031 given, all object files are considered.
5032
5033 @kindex disable probes
5034 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5035 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5036 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5037 @end table
5038
5039 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5040 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5041 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5042 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5043 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5044 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5045 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5046 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5047 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5048 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5049 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5050 at the current probe point.
5051
5052 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5053 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5054 an error message.
5055
5056
5057 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5058 @node Error in Breakpoints
5059 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5060
5061 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5062 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5063
5064 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5065 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5066 @smallexample
5067 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5068 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5069 @end smallexample
5070
5071 @noindent
5072 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5073 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5074 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5075
5076 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5077 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5078
5079 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5080 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5081 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5082
5083 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5084 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5085 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5086 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5087
5088 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5089 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5090 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5091 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5092 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5093 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5094 first in the bundle.
5095
5096 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5097 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5098 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5099 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5100 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5101 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5102 is hit.
5103
5104 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5105 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5106
5107 @smallexample
5108 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5109 @end smallexample
5110
5111 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5112 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5113 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5114 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5115 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5116 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5117 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5118 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5119
5120 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5121 adjusted breakpoints:
5122
5123 @smallexample
5124 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5125 to 0x00010410.
5126 @end smallexample
5127
5128 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5129 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5130 frequently than expected.
5131
5132 @node Continuing and Stepping
5133 @section Continuing and Stepping
5134
5135 @cindex stepping
5136 @cindex continuing
5137 @cindex resuming execution
5138 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5139 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5140 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5141 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5142 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5143 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5144 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5145 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5146 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5147 handlers}).)
5148
5149 @table @code
5150 @kindex continue
5151 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5152 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5153 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5154 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5155 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5156 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5157 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5158 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5159 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5160 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5161
5162 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5163 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5164 @code{continue} is ignored.
5165
5166 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5167 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5168 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5169 @code{continue}.
5170 @end table
5171
5172 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5173 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5174 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5175 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5176
5177 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5178 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5179 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5180 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5181 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5182 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5183
5184 @table @code
5185 @kindex step
5186 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5187 @item step
5188 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5189 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5190 abbreviated @code{s}.
5191
5192 @quotation
5193 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5194 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5195 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5196 @c distinction here.
5197 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5198 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5199 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5200 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5201 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5202 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5203 below.
5204 @end quotation
5205
5206 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5207 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5208 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5209 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5210 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5211 called within the line.
5212
5213 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5214 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5215 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5216 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5217 was any debugging information about the routine.
5218
5219 @item step @var{count}
5220 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5221 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5222 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5223
5224 @kindex next
5225 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5226 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5227 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5228 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5229 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5230 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5231 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5232 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5233
5234 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5235
5236
5237 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5238 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5239 @c
5240 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5241 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5242 @c function are executed without stopping.
5243
5244 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5245 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5246 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5247
5248 @kindex set step-mode
5249 @item set step-mode
5250 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5251 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5252 @itemx set step-mode on
5253 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5254 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5255 information rather than stepping over it.
5256
5257 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5258 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5259 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5260
5261 @item set step-mode off
5262 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5263 debug information. This is the default.
5264
5265 @item show step-mode
5266 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5267 source line debug information.
5268
5269 @kindex finish
5270 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5271 @item finish
5272 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5273 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5274 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5275
5276 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5277 ,Returning from a Function}).
5278
5279 @kindex until
5280 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5281 @cindex run until specified location
5282 @item until
5283 @itemx u
5284 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5285 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5286 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5287 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5288 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5289 than the address of the jump.
5290
5291 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5292 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5293 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5294 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5295 through the next iteration.
5296
5297 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5298 stack frame.
5299
5300 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5301 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5302 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5303 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5304 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5305
5306 @smallexample
5307 (@value{GDBP}) f
5308 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5309 206 expand_input();
5310 (@value{GDBP}) until
5311 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5312 @end smallexample
5313
5314 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5315 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5316 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5317 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5318 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5319 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5320 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5321
5322 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5323 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5324 argument.
5325
5326 @item until @var{location}
5327 @itemx u @var{location}
5328 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5329 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5330 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5331 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5332 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5333 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5334 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5335 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5336 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5337 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5338 invocations have returned.
5339
5340 @smallexample
5341 94 int factorial (int value)
5342 95 @{
5343 96 if (value > 1) @{
5344 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5345 98 @}
5346 99 return (value);
5347 100 @}
5348 @end smallexample
5349
5350
5351 @kindex advance @var{location}
5352 @item advance @var{location}
5353 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5354 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5355 @ref{Specify Location}.
5356 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5357 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5358 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5359 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5360
5361
5362 @kindex stepi
5363 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5364 @item stepi
5365 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5366 @itemx si
5367 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5368
5369 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5370 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5371 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5372 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5373
5374 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5375
5376 @need 750
5377 @kindex nexti
5378 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5379 @item nexti
5380 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5381 @itemx ni
5382 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5383 proceed until the function returns.
5384
5385 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5386
5387 @end table
5388
5389 @anchor{range stepping}
5390 @cindex range stepping
5391 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5392 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5393 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5394 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5395 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5396 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5397 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5398 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5399 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5400 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5401 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5402 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5403 if necessary:
5404
5405 @table @code
5406 @kindex set range-stepping
5407 @kindex show range-stepping
5408 @item set range-stepping
5409 @itemx show range-stepping
5410 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5411
5412 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5413 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5414 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5415 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5416 default is @code{on}.
5417
5418 @end table
5419
5420 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5421 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5422 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5423
5424 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5425 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} comand lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5426 skip a function or all functions in a file when stepping.
5427
5428 For example, consider the following C function:
5429
5430 @smallexample
5431 101 int func()
5432 102 @{
5433 103 foo(boring());
5434 104 bar(boring());
5435 105 @}
5436 @end smallexample
5437
5438 @noindent
5439 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5440 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5441 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5442 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5443
5444 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5445 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5446 is called from many places.
5447
5448 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5449 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5450 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5451 @code{foo}.
5452
5453 You can also instruct @value{GDBN} to skip all functions in a file, with, for
5454 example, @code{skip file boring.c}.
5455
5456 @table @code
5457 @kindex skip function
5458 @item skip @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5459 @itemx skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5460 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5461 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5462 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5463
5464 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5465 will be skipped.
5466
5467 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5468 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5469
5470 @kindex skip file
5471 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5472 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5473 will be skipped over when stepping.
5474
5475 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5476 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5477 @end table
5478
5479 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5480 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5481
5482 @table @code
5483 @kindex info skip
5484 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5485 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5486 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5487 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5488
5489 @table @emph
5490 @item Identifier
5491 A number identifying this skip.
5492 @item Type
5493 The type of this skip, either @samp{function} or @samp{file}.
5494 @item Enabled or Disabled
5495 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}. Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5496 @item Address
5497 For function skips, this column indicates the address in memory of the function
5498 being skipped. If you've set a function skip on a function which has not yet
5499 been loaded, this field will contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Once a shared library
5500 which has the function is loaded, @code{info skip} will show the function's
5501 address here.
5502 @item What
5503 For file skips, this field contains the filename being skipped. For functions
5504 skips, this field contains the function name and its line number in the file
5505 where it is defined.
5506 @end table
5507
5508 @kindex skip delete
5509 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5510 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5511 skips.
5512
5513 @kindex skip enable
5514 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5515 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5516 skips.
5517
5518 @kindex skip disable
5519 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5520 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5521 skips.
5522
5523 @end table
5524
5525 @node Signals
5526 @section Signals
5527 @cindex signals
5528
5529 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5530 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5531 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5532 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5533 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5534 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5535 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5536 requested an alarm).
5537
5538 @cindex fatal signals
5539 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5540 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5541 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5542 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5543 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5544 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5545
5546 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5547 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5548 signal.
5549
5550 @cindex handling signals
5551 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5552 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5553 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5554 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5555 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5556
5557 @table @code
5558 @kindex info signals
5559 @kindex info handle
5560 @item info signals
5561 @itemx info handle
5562 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5563 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5564 the defined types of signals.
5565
5566 @item info signals @var{sig}
5567 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5568
5569 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5570
5571 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5572 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5573 for details about this command.
5574
5575 @kindex handle
5576 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5577 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5578 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5579 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5580 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5581 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5582 say what change to make.
5583 @end table
5584
5585 @c @group
5586 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5587 Their full names are:
5588
5589 @table @code
5590 @item nostop
5591 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5592 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5593
5594 @item stop
5595 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5596 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5597
5598 @item print
5599 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5600
5601 @item noprint
5602 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5603 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5604
5605 @item pass
5606 @itemx noignore
5607 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5608 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5609 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5610
5611 @item nopass
5612 @itemx ignore
5613 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5614 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5615 @end table
5616 @c @end group
5617
5618 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5619 program until you
5620 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5621 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5622 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5623 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5624 program sees that signal when you continue.
5625
5626 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5627 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5628 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5629 erroneous signals.
5630
5631 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5632 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5633 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5634 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5635 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5636 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5637 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5638 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5639 Program a Signal}.
5640
5641 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5642 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5643
5644 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5645 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5646 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5647 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5648 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5649 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5650 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5651 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5652 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5653 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5654 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5655 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5656 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5657
5658 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5659
5660 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5661 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5662 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5663 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5664
5665 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5666 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5667 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5668 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5669
5670 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5671 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5672
5673 @smallexample
5674 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5675 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5676 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5677 (@value{GDBP}) c
5678 Continuing.
5679
5680 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5681 main () sigusr1.c:28
5682 28 p = 0;
5683 (@value{GDBP}) si
5684 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5685 9 @{
5686 @end smallexample
5687
5688 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5689 program to receive the signal first:
5690
5691 @smallexample
5692 (@value{GDBP}) n
5693 28 p = 0;
5694 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5695 (@value{GDBP}) si
5696 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5697 9 @{
5698 (@value{GDBP})
5699 @end smallexample
5700
5701 @cindex extra signal information
5702 @anchor{extra signal information}
5703
5704 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5705 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5706 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5707 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5708 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5709 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5710 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5711 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5712 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5713 system header.
5714
5715 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5716 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5717
5718 @smallexample
5719 @group
5720 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5721 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5722 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5723 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5724 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5725 type = struct @{
5726 int si_signo;
5727 int si_errno;
5728 int si_code;
5729 union @{
5730 int _pad[28];
5731 struct @{...@} _kill;
5732 struct @{...@} _timer;
5733 struct @{...@} _rt;
5734 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5735 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5736 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5737 @} _sifields;
5738 @}
5739 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5740 type = struct @{
5741 void *si_addr;
5742 @}
5743 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5744 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5745 @end group
5746 @end smallexample
5747
5748 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5749
5750 @node Thread Stops
5751 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5752
5753 @cindex stopped threads
5754 @cindex threads, stopped
5755
5756 @cindex continuing threads
5757 @cindex threads, continuing
5758
5759 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5760 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5761 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5762 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5763 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5764 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5765 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5766 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5767 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5768
5769 @menu
5770 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5771 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5772 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5773 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5774 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5775 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5776 @end menu
5777
5778 @node All-Stop Mode
5779 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5780
5781 @cindex all-stop mode
5782
5783 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5784 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5785 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5786 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5787 underfoot.
5788
5789 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5790 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5791 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5792
5793 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5794 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5795 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5796 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5797 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5798 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5799 stops.
5800
5801 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5802 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5803 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5804 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5805
5806 @cindex automatic thread selection
5807 @cindex switching threads automatically
5808 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5809 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5810 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5811 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5812 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5813 thread.
5814
5815 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5816 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5817
5818 @table @code
5819 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5820 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5821 @cindex lock scheduler
5822 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
5823 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5824 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
5825 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
5826 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
5827 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
5828 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
5829 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
5830 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
5831 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
5832 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
5833 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
5834 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
5835 @code{on} in replay mode.
5836
5837 @item show scheduler-locking
5838 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5839 @end table
5840
5841 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5842 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5843 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5844 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5845 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5846 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5847 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5848 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5849 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5850 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5851 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5852 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5853 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5854 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5855
5856 @table @code
5857 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5858 @item set schedule-multiple
5859 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5860 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5861 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5862 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5863 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5864 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5865
5866 @item show schedule-multiple
5867 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5868 multiple processes.
5869 @end table
5870
5871 @node Non-Stop Mode
5872 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5873
5874 @cindex non-stop mode
5875
5876 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5877 @c with more details.
5878
5879 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5880 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5881 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5882 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5883 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5884 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5885
5886 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5887 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5888 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5889 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5890 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5891 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5892 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5893 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5894 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5895 independently and simultaneously.
5896
5897 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5898 or attach to your program:
5899
5900 @smallexample
5901 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5902 set pagination off
5903
5904 # Finally, turn it on!
5905 set non-stop on
5906 @end smallexample
5907
5908 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5909
5910 @table @code
5911 @kindex set non-stop
5912 @item set non-stop on
5913 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5914 @item set non-stop off
5915 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5916 @kindex show non-stop
5917 @item show non-stop
5918 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5919 @end table
5920
5921 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5922 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5923 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5924 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5925 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5926 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5927 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5928 default.
5929
5930 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5931 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5932 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5933
5934 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5935 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5936 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5937 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5938 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5939
5940 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5941 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5942 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5943 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5944 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5945
5946 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5947
5948 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5949 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5950 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5951 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5952 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5953 previously current thread.
5954
5955 @node Background Execution
5956 @subsection Background Execution
5957
5958 @cindex foreground execution
5959 @cindex background execution
5960 @cindex asynchronous execution
5961 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5962
5963 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5964 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5965 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5966 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5967 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5968 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5969
5970 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5971 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5972
5973 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5974 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5975 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5976 are:
5977
5978 @table @code
5979 @kindex run&
5980 @item run
5981 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5982
5983 @item attach
5984 @kindex attach&
5985 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5986
5987 @item step
5988 @kindex step&
5989 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
5990
5991 @item stepi
5992 @kindex stepi&
5993 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
5994
5995 @item next
5996 @kindex next&
5997 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
5998
5999 @item nexti
6000 @kindex nexti&
6001 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6002
6003 @item continue
6004 @kindex continue&
6005 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6006
6007 @item finish
6008 @kindex finish&
6009 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6010
6011 @item until
6012 @kindex until&
6013 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6014
6015 @end table
6016
6017 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6018 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6019 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6020 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6021 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6022 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6023
6024 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6025 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6026
6027 @table @code
6028 @kindex interrupt
6029 @item interrupt
6030 @itemx interrupt -a
6031
6032 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6033 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6034 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6035 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6036 @end table
6037
6038 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6039 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6040
6041 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6042 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6043 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6044
6045 @table @code
6046 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6047 @cindex thread breakpoints
6048 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
6049 @item break @var{location} thread @var{threadno}
6050 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
6051 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6052 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6053 specify some source line.
6054
6055 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
6056 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6057 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{threadno} specifier
6058 is one of the numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6059 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6060
6061 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
6062 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6063 program.
6064
6065 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6066 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
6067 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6068
6069 @smallexample
6070 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6071 @end smallexample
6072
6073 @end table
6074
6075 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6076 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6077 thread list. For example:
6078
6079 @smallexample
6080 (@value{GDBP}) c
6081 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6082 @end smallexample
6083
6084 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6085 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6086 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6087 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6088 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6089 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6090 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6091 command.
6092
6093 @node Interrupted System Calls
6094 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6095
6096 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6097 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6098 @cindex premature return from system calls
6099 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6100 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6101 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6102 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6103 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6104 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6105 stop execution.
6106
6107 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6108 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6109 style anyways.
6110
6111 For example, do not write code like this:
6112
6113 @smallexample
6114 sleep (10);
6115 @end smallexample
6116
6117 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6118 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6119
6120 Instead, write this:
6121
6122 @smallexample
6123 int unslept = 10;
6124 while (unslept > 0)
6125 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6126 @end smallexample
6127
6128 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6129 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6130 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6131 @value{GDBN}.
6132
6133 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6134 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6135 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6136 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6137
6138 @node Observer Mode
6139 @subsection Observer Mode
6140
6141 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6142 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6143 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6144 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6145 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6146
6147 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6148 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6149 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6150 mode.
6151
6152 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6153 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6154 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6155 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6156 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6157
6158 @table @code
6159
6160 @kindex observer
6161 @item set observer on
6162 @itemx set observer off
6163 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6164 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6165 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6166 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6167
6168 @item show observer
6169 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6170
6171 @kindex may-write-registers
6172 @item set may-write-registers on
6173 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6174 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6175 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6176 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6177
6178 @item show may-write-registers
6179 Show the current permission to write registers.
6180
6181 @kindex may-write-memory
6182 @item set may-write-memory on
6183 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6184 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6185 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6186 defaults to @code{on}.
6187
6188 @item show may-write-memory
6189 Show the current permission to write memory.
6190
6191 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6192 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6193 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6194 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6195 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6196 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6197
6198 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6199 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6200
6201 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6202 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6203 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6204 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6205 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6206 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6207 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6208
6209 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6210 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6211
6212 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6213 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6214 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6215 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6216 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6217 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6218 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6219
6220 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6221 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6222
6223 @kindex may-interrupt
6224 @item set may-interrupt on
6225 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6226 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6227 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6228 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6229 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6230
6231 @item show may-interrupt
6232 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6233
6234 @end table
6235
6236 @node Reverse Execution
6237 @chapter Running programs backward
6238 @cindex reverse execution
6239 @cindex running programs backward
6240
6241 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6242 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6243 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6244 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6245
6246 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6247 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6248 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6249 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6250 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6251 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6252
6253 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6254 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6255 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6256 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6257 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6258 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6259 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6260 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6261 prior values@footnote{
6262 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6263 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6264 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6265
6266 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6267 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6268 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6269 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6270 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6271 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6272 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6273 }.
6274
6275 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6276 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6277
6278 @table @code
6279 @kindex reverse-continue
6280 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6281 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6282 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6283 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6284 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6285 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6286 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6287
6288 @kindex reverse-step
6289 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6290 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6291 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6292 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6293
6294 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6295 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6296 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6297 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6298 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6299 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6300
6301 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6302 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6303
6304 @kindex reverse-stepi
6305 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6306 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6307 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6308 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6309 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6310 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6311 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6312
6313 @kindex reverse-next
6314 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6315 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6316 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6317 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6318 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6319 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6320 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6321 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6322 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6323 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6324
6325 @kindex reverse-nexti
6326 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6327 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6328 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6329 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6330 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6331 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6332 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6333 frame) is reached.
6334
6335 @kindex reverse-finish
6336 @item reverse-finish
6337 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6338 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6339 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6340 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6341
6342 @kindex set exec-direction
6343 @item set exec-direction
6344 Set the direction of target execution.
6345 @item set exec-direction reverse
6346 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6347 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6348 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6349 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6350 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6351 @item set exec-direction forward
6352 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6353 This is the default.
6354 @end table
6355
6356
6357 @node Process Record and Replay
6358 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6359 @cindex process record and replay
6360 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6361
6362 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6363 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6364 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6365
6366 @cindex replay mode
6367 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6368 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6369 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6370 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6371 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6372 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6373 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6374 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6375 execution log.
6376
6377 @cindex record mode
6378 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6379 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6380 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6381 for future replay.
6382
6383 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6384 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6385 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6386 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6387 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6388 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6389
6390 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6391 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6392 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6393 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6394
6395 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6396 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6397
6398 @table @code
6399 @kindex target record
6400 @kindex target record-full
6401 @kindex target record-btrace
6402 @kindex record
6403 @kindex record full
6404 @kindex record btrace
6405 @kindex record btrace bts
6406 @kindex record btrace pt
6407 @kindex record bts
6408 @kindex record pt
6409 @kindex rec
6410 @kindex rec full
6411 @kindex rec btrace
6412 @kindex rec btrace bts
6413 @kindex rec btrace pt
6414 @kindex rec bts
6415 @kindex rec pt
6416 @item record @var{method}
6417 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6418 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6419 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6420 recording methods are available:
6421
6422 @table @code
6423 @item full
6424 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6425 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6426 execution.
6427
6428 @item btrace @var{format}
6429 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6430 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6431 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6432 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6433 execution.
6434
6435 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6436 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6437 formats are available:
6438
6439 @table @code
6440 @item bts
6441 @cindex branch trace store
6442 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6443 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6444 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6445
6446 @item pt
6447 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6448 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6449 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6450 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6451
6452 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6453 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6454 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6455
6456 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6457 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6458 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6459 buffer-size with care.
6460 @end table
6461
6462 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6463 @end table
6464
6465 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6466 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6467 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6468 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6469
6470 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6471 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6472 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6473 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6474 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6475
6476 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6477 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6478 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6479 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6480 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6481 does not support these two modes.
6482
6483 @kindex record stop
6484 @kindex rec s
6485 @item record stop
6486 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6487 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6488 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6489
6490 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6491 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6492 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6493 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6494 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6495
6496 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6497 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6498 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6499 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6500 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6501
6502 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6503 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6504
6505 @kindex record goto
6506 @item record goto
6507 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6508 ways to specify the location to go to:
6509
6510 @table @code
6511 @item record goto begin
6512 @itemx record goto start
6513 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6514
6515 @item record goto end
6516 Go to the end of the execution log.
6517
6518 @item record goto @var{n}
6519 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6520 @end table
6521
6522 @kindex record save
6523 @item record save @var{filename}
6524 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6525 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6526 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6527
6528 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6529
6530 @kindex record restore
6531 @item record restore @var{filename}
6532 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6533 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6534
6535 @kindex set record full
6536 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6537 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6538 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6539 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6540
6541 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6542 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6543 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6544 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6545 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6546 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6547 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6548 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6549
6550 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6551 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6552 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6553
6554 @kindex show record full
6555 @item show record full insn-number-max
6556 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6557 recording method.
6558
6559 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6560 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6561 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6562 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6563 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6564 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6565 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6566 oldest one to be deleted.
6567
6568 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6569 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6570
6571 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6572 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6573
6574 @item set record full memory-query
6575 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6576 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6577 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6578 case.
6579
6580 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6581 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6582 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6583 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6584 results.
6585
6586 @item show record full memory-query
6587 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6588
6589 @kindex set record btrace
6590 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6591 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6592 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6593 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6594 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6595 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6596 You can use the following command for that:
6597
6598 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6599 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6600 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6601 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6602 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6603 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6604 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6605 position.
6606
6607 @kindex show record btrace
6608 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6609 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6610
6611 @kindex set record btrace bts
6612 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6613 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6614 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6615 format. Default is 64KB.
6616
6617 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6618 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6619 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6620 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6621 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6622 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6623 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6624
6625 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6626 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6627
6628 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6629 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6630
6631 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6632 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6633 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6634
6635 @kindex set record btrace pt
6636 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6637 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
6638 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
6639 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
6640
6641 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6642 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6643 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
6644 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
6645 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
6646 actual buffer size for each thread.
6647
6648 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6649 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6650
6651 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6652 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6653
6654 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6655 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6656 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
6657
6658 @kindex info record
6659 @item info record
6660 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6661 method:
6662
6663 @table @code
6664 @item full
6665 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6666 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6667
6668 @itemize @bullet
6669 @item
6670 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6671 @item
6672 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6673 @item
6674 Highest recorded instruction number.
6675 @item
6676 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6677 @item
6678 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6679 @item
6680 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6681 @end itemize
6682
6683 @item btrace
6684 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6685
6686 @itemize @bullet
6687 @item
6688 Recording format.
6689 @item
6690 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
6691 @item
6692 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
6693 instructions.
6694 @item
6695 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6696 @end itemize
6697
6698 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
6699 @itemize @bullet
6700 @item
6701 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6702 @end itemize
6703
6704 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
6705 @itemize @bullet
6706 @item
6707 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6708 @end itemize
6709 @end table
6710
6711 @kindex record delete
6712 @kindex rec del
6713 @item record delete
6714 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6715 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6716 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6717 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6718
6719 @kindex record instruction-history
6720 @kindex rec instruction-history
6721 @item record instruction-history
6722 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6723 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6724 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6725 are printed in execution order.
6726
6727 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
6728 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
6729 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
6730
6731 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
6732 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
6733 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
6734 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
6735 @code{/p} modifier.
6736
6737 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
6738 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
6739 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
6740
6741 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
6742 feature is not available for all recording formats.
6743
6744 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
6745 disassemble:
6746
6747 @table @code
6748 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6749 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6750 @var{insn}.
6751
6752 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6753 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6754 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6755 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6756 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6757 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6758
6759 @item record instruction-history
6760 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6761
6762 @item record instruction-history -
6763 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6764
6765 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
6766 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6767 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6768 number @var{end} is included.
6769 @end table
6770
6771 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6772
6773 @kindex set record
6774 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
6775 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
6776 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6777 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
6778 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
6779
6780 @kindex show record
6781 @item show record instruction-history-size
6782 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6783 instruction-history} command.
6784
6785 @kindex record function-call-history
6786 @kindex rec function-call-history
6787 @item record function-call-history
6788 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
6789 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
6790 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
6791 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
6792 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
6793 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
6794 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
6795 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
6796 given together.
6797
6798 @smallexample
6799 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
6800 1 void foo (void)
6801 2 @{
6802 3 @}
6803 4
6804 5 void bar (void)
6805 6 @{
6806 7 ...
6807 8 foo ();
6808 9 ...
6809 10 @}
6810 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
6811 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
6812 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
6813 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
6814 @end smallexample
6815
6816 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
6817 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
6818 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
6819 to print:
6820
6821 @table @code
6822 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
6823 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
6824
6825 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
6826 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
6827 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
6828 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
6829 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
6830
6831 @item record function-call-history
6832 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
6833
6834 @item record function-call-history -
6835 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
6836
6837 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
6838 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
6839 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
6840 @end table
6841
6842 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6843
6844 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
6845 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
6846 Define how many lines to print in the
6847 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
6848 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
6849
6850 @item show record function-call-history-size
6851 Show how many lines to print in the
6852 @code{record function-call-history} command.
6853 @end table
6854
6855
6856 @node Stack
6857 @chapter Examining the Stack
6858
6859 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
6860 stopped and how it got there.
6861
6862 @cindex call stack
6863 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
6864 is generated.
6865 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
6866 the arguments of the call,
6867 and the local variables of the function being called.
6868 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
6869 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
6870 stack}.
6871
6872 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
6873 stack allow you to see all of this information.
6874
6875 @cindex selected frame
6876 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
6877 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
6878 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
6879 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
6880 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
6881 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6882
6883 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
6884 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
6885 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
6886
6887 @menu
6888 * Frames:: Stack frames
6889 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
6890 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
6891 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
6892 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
6893
6894 @end menu
6895
6896 @node Frames
6897 @section Stack Frames
6898
6899 @cindex frame, definition
6900 @cindex stack frame
6901 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
6902 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
6903 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
6904 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
6905 which the function is executing.
6906
6907 @cindex initial frame
6908 @cindex outermost frame
6909 @cindex innermost frame
6910 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
6911 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
6912 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
6913 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
6914 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
6915 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
6916 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
6917 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
6918
6919 @cindex frame pointer
6920 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
6921 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
6922 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
6923 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
6924 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
6925 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
6926
6927 @cindex frame number
6928 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
6929 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
6930 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
6931 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
6932 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
6933
6934 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
6935 @c underflow problems.
6936 @cindex frameless execution
6937 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6938 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
6939 @smallexample
6940 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
6941 @end smallexample
6942 generates functions without a frame.)
6943 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
6944 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
6945 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
6946 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
6947 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
6948 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
6949 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
6950
6951 @node Backtrace
6952 @section Backtraces
6953
6954 @cindex traceback
6955 @cindex call stack traces
6956 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
6957 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
6958 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
6959 stack.
6960
6961 @anchor{backtrace-command}
6962 @table @code
6963 @kindex backtrace
6964 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
6965 @item backtrace
6966 @itemx bt
6967 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
6968 frames in the stack.
6969
6970 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
6971 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
6972
6973 @item backtrace @var{n}
6974 @itemx bt @var{n}
6975 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
6976
6977 @item backtrace -@var{n}
6978 @itemx bt -@var{n}
6979 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
6980
6981 @item backtrace full
6982 @itemx bt full
6983 @itemx bt full @var{n}
6984 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
6985 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
6986 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
6987
6988 @item backtrace no-filters
6989 @itemx bt no-filters
6990 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
6991 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
6992 @itemx bt no-filters full
6993 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
6994 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
6995 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
6996 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
6997 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
6998 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
6999 support.
7000 @end table
7001
7002 @kindex where
7003 @kindex info stack
7004 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7005 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7006
7007 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7008 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7009 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7010 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7011 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7012 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7013 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7014 multi-threaded program.
7015
7016 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7017 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7018 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7019 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7020 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7021 line number.
7022
7023 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7024 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7025
7026 @smallexample
7027 @group
7028 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7029 at builtin.c:993
7030 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7031 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7032 at macro.c:71
7033 (More stack frames follow...)
7034 @end group
7035 @end smallexample
7036
7037 @noindent
7038 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7039 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7040 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7041
7042 @noindent
7043 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7044 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7045 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7046 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7047 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7048
7049 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7050 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7051 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7052 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7053 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7054 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7055 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7056 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7057 such a backtrace might look like:
7058
7059 @smallexample
7060 @group
7061 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7062 at builtin.c:993
7063 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7064 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7065 at macro.c:71
7066 (More stack frames follow...)
7067 @end group
7068 @end smallexample
7069
7070 @noindent
7071 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7072 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7073
7074 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7075 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7076 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7077
7078 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7079 @cindex program entry point
7080 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7081 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7082 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7083 @code{main}@footnote{
7084 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7085 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7086 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7087 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7088 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7089 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7090
7091 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7092 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7093
7094 @table @code
7095 @item set backtrace past-main
7096 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7097 @kindex set backtrace
7098 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7099
7100 @item set backtrace past-main off
7101 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7102 default.
7103
7104 @item show backtrace past-main
7105 @kindex show backtrace
7106 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7107
7108 @item set backtrace past-entry
7109 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7110 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7111 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7112 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7113
7114 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7115 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7116 application. This is the default.
7117
7118 @item show backtrace past-entry
7119 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7120
7121 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7122 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7123 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7124 @cindex backtrace limit
7125 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7126 or zero means unlimited levels.
7127
7128 @item show backtrace limit
7129 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7130 @end table
7131
7132 You can control how file names are displayed.
7133
7134 @table @code
7135 @item set filename-display
7136 @itemx set filename-display relative
7137 @cindex filename-display
7138 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7139
7140 @item set filename-display basename
7141 Display only basename of a filename.
7142
7143 @item set filename-display absolute
7144 Display an absolute filename.
7145
7146 @item show filename-display
7147 Show the current way to display filenames.
7148 @end table
7149
7150 @node Selection
7151 @section Selecting a Frame
7152
7153 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7154 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7155 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7156 of the stack frame just selected.
7157
7158 @table @code
7159 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7160 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7161 @item frame @var{n}
7162 @itemx f @var{n}
7163 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7164 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7165 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7166 @code{main}.
7167
7168 @item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7169 @itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7170 Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7171 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7172 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7173 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7174 switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7175 specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7176
7177 @kindex up
7178 @item up @var{n}
7179 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7180 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7181 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7182
7183 @kindex down
7184 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7185 @item down @var{n}
7186 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7187 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7188 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7189 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7190 @end table
7191
7192 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7193 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7194 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7195 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7196
7197 @need 1000
7198 For example:
7199
7200 @smallexample
7201 @group
7202 (@value{GDBP}) up
7203 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7204 at env.c:10
7205 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7206 @end group
7207 @end smallexample
7208
7209 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7210 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7211 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7212 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7213 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7214 for details.
7215
7216 @table @code
7217 @kindex select-frame
7218 @item select-frame
7219 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7220 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7221 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7222 output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7223
7224 @kindex down-silently
7225 @kindex up-silently
7226 @item up-silently @var{n}
7227 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7228 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7229 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7230 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7231 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7232 distracting.
7233 @end table
7234
7235 @node Frame Info
7236 @section Information About a Frame
7237
7238 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7239 stack frame.
7240
7241 @table @code
7242 @item frame
7243 @itemx f
7244 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7245 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7246 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7247 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7248 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7249
7250 @kindex info frame
7251 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7252 @item info frame
7253 @itemx info f
7254 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7255 including:
7256
7257 @itemize @bullet
7258 @item
7259 the address of the frame
7260 @item
7261 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7262 @item
7263 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7264 @item
7265 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7266 @item
7267 the address of the frame's arguments
7268 @item
7269 the address of the frame's local variables
7270 @item
7271 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7272 @item
7273 which registers were saved in the frame
7274 @end itemize
7275
7276 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7277 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7278 the usual conventions.
7279
7280 @item info frame @var{addr}
7281 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7282 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7283 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7284 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7285 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7286 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7287
7288 @kindex info args
7289 @item info args
7290 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7291
7292 @item info locals
7293 @kindex info locals
7294 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7295 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7296 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7297
7298 @end table
7299
7300 @node Frame Filter Management
7301 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7302 @cindex managing frame filters
7303
7304 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7305 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7306
7307 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7308 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7309
7310 @table @code
7311 @kindex info frame-filter
7312 @item info frame-filter
7313 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7314 their name, priority and enabled status.
7315
7316 @kindex disable frame-filter
7317 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7318 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7319 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7320 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7321 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7322 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7323 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7324 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7325 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7326 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7327 may be enabled again later.
7328
7329 @kindex enable frame-filter
7330 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7331 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7332 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7333 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7334 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7335 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7336 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7337 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7338 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7339
7340 Example:
7341
7342 @smallexample
7343 (gdb) info frame-filter
7344
7345 global frame-filters:
7346 Priority Enabled Name
7347 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7348 100 Yes Reverse
7349
7350 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7351 Priority Enabled Name
7352 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7353
7354 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7355 Priority Enabled Name
7356 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7357
7358 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7359 (gdb) info frame-filter
7360
7361 global frame-filters:
7362 Priority Enabled Name
7363 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7364 100 Yes Reverse
7365
7366 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7367 Priority Enabled Name
7368 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7369
7370 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7371 Priority Enabled Name
7372 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7373
7374 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7375 (gdb) info frame-filter
7376
7377 global frame-filters:
7378 Priority Enabled Name
7379 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7380 100 Yes Reverse
7381
7382 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7383 Priority Enabled Name
7384 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7385
7386 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7387 Priority Enabled Name
7388 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7389 @end smallexample
7390
7391 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7392 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7393 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7394 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7395 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7396 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7397 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7398
7399 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7400 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7401 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7402 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7403 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7404 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7405 dictionary resides.
7406
7407 Example:
7408
7409 @smallexample
7410 (gdb) info frame-filter
7411
7412 global frame-filters:
7413 Priority Enabled Name
7414 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7415 100 Yes Reverse
7416
7417 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7418 Priority Enabled Name
7419 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7420
7421 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7422 Priority Enabled Name
7423 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7424
7425 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7426 (gdb) info frame-filter
7427
7428 global frame-filters:
7429 Priority Enabled Name
7430 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7431 50 Yes Reverse
7432
7433 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7434 Priority Enabled Name
7435 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7436
7437 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7438 Priority Enabled Name
7439 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7440 @end smallexample
7441 @end table
7442
7443 @node Source
7444 @chapter Examining Source Files
7445
7446 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7447 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7448 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7449 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7450 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7451 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7452 source files by explicit command.
7453
7454 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7455 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7456 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7457
7458 @menu
7459 * List:: Printing source lines
7460 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7461 * Edit:: Editing source files
7462 * Search:: Searching source files
7463 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7464 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7465 @end menu
7466
7467 @node List
7468 @section Printing Source Lines
7469
7470 @kindex list
7471 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7472 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7473 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7474 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7475 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7476
7477 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7478
7479 @table @code
7480 @item list @var{linenum}
7481 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7482 current source file.
7483
7484 @item list @var{function}
7485 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7486 @var{function}.
7487
7488 @item list
7489 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7490 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7491 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7492 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7493 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7494
7495 @item list -
7496 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7497 @end table
7498
7499 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7500 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7501 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7502
7503 @table @code
7504 @kindex set listsize
7505 @item set listsize @var{count}
7506 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7507 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7508 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7509 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7510
7511 @kindex show listsize
7512 @item show listsize
7513 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7514 @end table
7515
7516 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7517 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7518 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7519 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7520 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7521
7522 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7523 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
7524 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7525 to specify some source line.
7526
7527 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7528
7529 @table @code
7530 @item list @var{location}
7531 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
7532
7533 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7534 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7535 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
7536 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
7537 the same source file as the first location.
7538
7539 @item list ,@var{last}
7540 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7541
7542 @item list @var{first},
7543 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7544
7545 @item list +
7546 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7547
7548 @item list -
7549 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7550
7551 @item list
7552 As described in the preceding table.
7553 @end table
7554
7555 @node Specify Location
7556 @section Specifying a Location
7557 @cindex specifying location
7558 @cindex location
7559 @cindex source location
7560
7561 @menu
7562 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
7563 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
7564 * Address Locations:: Address locations
7565 @end menu
7566
7567 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7568 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7569 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
7570 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
7571 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
7572
7573 @node Linespec Locations
7574 @subsection Linespec Locations
7575 @cindex linespec locations
7576
7577 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
7578 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
7579 specifying a linespec:
7580
7581 @table @code
7582 @item @var{linenum}
7583 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7584
7585 @item -@var{offset}
7586 @itemx +@var{offset}
7587 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7588 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7589 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7590 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7591 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7592 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7593 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7594 linespec.
7595
7596 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7597 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7598 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7599 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7600 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7601 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7602 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7603
7604 @item @var{function}
7605 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7606 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7607
7608 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7609 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7610
7611 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7612 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7613 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7614 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7615 functions in different source files.
7616
7617 @item @var{label}
7618 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
7619 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
7620 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
7621 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7622
7623 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7624 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7625 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7626 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7627 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7628 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7629
7630 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7631 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7632 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7633 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7634 each one of those probes.
7635 @end table
7636
7637 @node Explicit Locations
7638 @subsection Explicit Locations
7639 @cindex explicit locations
7640
7641 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
7642 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
7643
7644 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
7645 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
7646 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
7647 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
7648 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
7649
7650 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
7651 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
7652 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
7653 the symbol table to know.
7654
7655 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
7656 following table:
7657
7658 @table @code
7659 @item -source @var{filename}
7660 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
7661 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
7662 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
7663 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
7664 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
7665
7666 @item -function @var{function}
7667 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
7668 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
7669 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
7670 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
7671
7672 @item -label @var{label}
7673 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
7674 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
7675 selected stack frame.
7676
7677 @item -line @var{number}
7678 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
7679 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
7680 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
7681 relative to the current line.
7682 @end table
7683
7684 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
7685 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @code{break -s main.c -li 3}.
7686
7687 @node Address Locations
7688 @subsection Address Locations
7689 @cindex address locations
7690
7691 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
7692 the generalized form *@var{address}.
7693
7694 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
7695 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
7696 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7697 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7698 source files.
7699
7700 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7701 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7702 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7703 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
7704 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
7705 of @var{address}:
7706
7707 @table @code
7708 @item @var{expression}
7709 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7710
7711 @item @var{funcaddr}
7712 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7713 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7714 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7715 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7716 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7717 (although the Pascal form also works).
7718
7719 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7720 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7721
7722 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
7723 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7724 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7725 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7726 functions with identical names in different source files.
7727 @end table
7728
7729 @node Edit
7730 @section Editing Source Files
7731 @cindex editing source files
7732
7733 @kindex edit
7734 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7735 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7736 The editing program of your choice
7737 is invoked with the current line set to
7738 the active line in the program.
7739 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7740 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7741
7742 @table @code
7743 @item edit @var{location}
7744 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7745 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7746 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7747 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7748 command most commonly used:
7749
7750 @table @code
7751 @item edit @var{number}
7752 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7753
7754 @item edit @var{function}
7755 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7756 @end table
7757
7758 @end table
7759
7760 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7761 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7762 @footnote{
7763 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7764 following command-line syntax:
7765 @smallexample
7766 ex +@var{number} file
7767 @end smallexample
7768 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
7769 the file where to start editing.}.
7770 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
7771 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
7772 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
7773 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
7774 @smallexample
7775 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
7776 export EDITOR
7777 gdb @dots{}
7778 @end smallexample
7779 or in the @code{csh} shell,
7780 @smallexample
7781 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
7782 gdb @dots{}
7783 @end smallexample
7784
7785 @node Search
7786 @section Searching Source Files
7787 @cindex searching source files
7788
7789 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
7790 regular expression.
7791
7792 @table @code
7793 @kindex search
7794 @kindex forward-search
7795 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
7796 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
7797 @itemx search @var{regexp}
7798 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
7799 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
7800 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
7801 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
7802 @code{fo}.
7803
7804 @kindex reverse-search
7805 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
7806 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
7807 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
7808 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
7809 this command as @code{rev}.
7810 @end table
7811
7812 @node Source Path
7813 @section Specifying Source Directories
7814
7815 @cindex source path
7816 @cindex directories for source files
7817 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
7818 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
7819 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
7820 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
7821 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
7822 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
7823 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
7824
7825 For example, suppose an executable references the file
7826 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
7827 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
7828 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
7829 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
7830 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
7831 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
7832 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
7833 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
7834 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
7835 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
7836
7837 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
7838 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
7839 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
7840 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
7841 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
7842 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
7843
7844 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
7845 source files.
7846
7847 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
7848 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
7849 each line is in the file.
7850
7851 @kindex directory
7852 @kindex dir
7853 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
7854 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
7855 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
7856
7857 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
7858 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
7859
7860 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
7861 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
7862 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
7863 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
7864 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
7865 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
7866 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
7867 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
7868 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
7869 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
7870 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
7871 name to look up the sources.
7872
7873 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
7874 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
7875 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
7876 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
7877 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
7878 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
7879 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
7880 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
7881
7882 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
7883 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
7884 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
7885 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
7886 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
7887 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
7888 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
7889
7890 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
7891 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
7892 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
7893 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
7894 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
7895 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
7896 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
7897 command.
7898
7899 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
7900 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
7901 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
7902 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
7903 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
7904 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
7905 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
7906
7907 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
7908 @cindex default source path substitution
7909 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
7910 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
7911 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
7912 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
7913 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
7914 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
7915 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
7916 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
7917 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
7918 together.
7919
7920 @table @code
7921 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
7922 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
7923 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
7924 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
7925 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
7926 part of absolute file names) or
7927 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
7928 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
7929
7930 @kindex cdir
7931 @kindex cwd
7932 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
7933 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
7934 @cindex compilation directory
7935 @cindex current directory
7936 @cindex working directory
7937 @cindex directory, current
7938 @cindex directory, compilation
7939 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
7940 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
7941 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
7942 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
7943 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
7944 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
7945
7946 @item directory
7947 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
7948
7949 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
7950 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
7951
7952 @item set directories @var{path-list}
7953 @kindex set directories
7954 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
7955 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
7956
7957 @item show directories
7958 @kindex show directories
7959 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
7960
7961 @anchor{set substitute-path}
7962 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
7963 @kindex set substitute-path
7964 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
7965 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
7966 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
7967
7968 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
7969 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
7970
7971 @smallexample
7972 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
7973 @end smallexample
7974
7975 @noindent
7976 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
7977 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
7978 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
7979
7980 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
7981 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
7982 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
7983 the substitution.
7984
7985 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
7986
7987 @smallexample
7988 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
7989 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
7990 @end smallexample
7991
7992 @noindent
7993 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
7994 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
7995 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
7996 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
7997
7998
7999 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8000 @kindex unset substitute-path
8001 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8002 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8003 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8004
8005 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8006
8007 @item show substitute-path [path]
8008 @kindex show substitute-path
8009 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8010 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8011
8012 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8013 rules.
8014
8015 @end table
8016
8017 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8018 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8019 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8020
8021 @enumerate
8022 @item
8023 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8024
8025 @item
8026 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8027 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8028 directories in one command.
8029 @end enumerate
8030
8031 @node Machine Code
8032 @section Source and Machine Code
8033 @cindex source line and its code address
8034
8035 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8036 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8037 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8038 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8039 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8040 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8041 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8042 well as hex.
8043
8044 @table @code
8045 @kindex info line
8046 @item info line @var{location}
8047 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8048 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8049 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
8050 @end table
8051
8052 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8053 the object code for the first line of function
8054 @code{m4_changequote}:
8055
8056 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
8057 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
8058 @smallexample
8059 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8060 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
8061 @end smallexample
8062
8063 @noindent
8064 @cindex code address and its source line
8065 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8066 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8067 @smallexample
8068 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8069 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
8070 @end smallexample
8071
8072 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8073 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8074 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8075 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8076 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8077 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8078 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8079 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8080 Variables}).
8081
8082 @table @code
8083 @kindex disassemble
8084 @cindex assembly instructions
8085 @cindex instructions, assembly
8086 @cindex machine instructions
8087 @cindex listing machine instructions
8088 @item disassemble
8089 @itemx disassemble /m
8090 @itemx disassemble /s
8091 @itemx disassemble /r
8092 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8093 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8094 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8095 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8096 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8097 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8098 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8099 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8100 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8101 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8102
8103 @table @code
8104 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8105 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8106 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8107 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8108 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8109 @end table
8110
8111 @noindent
8112 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8113 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8114
8115 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8116 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8117
8118 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8119 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8120 @end table
8121
8122 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8123 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8124
8125 @smallexample
8126 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8127 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8128 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8129 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8130 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8131 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8132 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8133 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8134 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8135 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8136 End of assembler dump.
8137 @end smallexample
8138
8139 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8140 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8141 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8142
8143 @smallexample
8144 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8145 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8146 5 @{
8147 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8148 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8149 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8150 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8151 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8152
8153 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8154 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8155 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8156
8157 7 return 0;
8158 8 @}
8159 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8160 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8161 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8162
8163 End of assembler dump.
8164 @end smallexample
8165
8166 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8167 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8168 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8169 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8170 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8171 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8172 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8173 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8174 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8175
8176 @file{foo.h}:
8177
8178 @smallexample
8179 int
8180 foo (int a)
8181 @{
8182 if (a < 0)
8183 return a * 2;
8184 if (a == 0)
8185 return 1;
8186 return a + 10;
8187 @}
8188 @end smallexample
8189
8190 @file{foo.c}:
8191
8192 @smallexample
8193 #include "foo.h"
8194 volatile int x, y;
8195 int
8196 main ()
8197 @{
8198 x = foo (y);
8199 return 0;
8200 @}
8201 @end smallexample
8202
8203 @smallexample
8204 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8205 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8206 5 @{
8207
8208 6 x = foo (y);
8209 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8210 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8211
8212 7 return 0;
8213 8 @}
8214 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8215 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8216 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8217 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8218
8219 End of assembler dump.
8220 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8221 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8222 foo.c:
8223 5 @{
8224 6 x = foo (y);
8225 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8226
8227 foo.h:
8228 4 if (a < 0)
8229 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8230 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8231
8232 6 if (a == 0)
8233 7 return 1;
8234 8 return a + 10;
8235 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8236 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8237 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8238 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8239
8240 foo.c:
8241 6 x = foo (y);
8242 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8243
8244 7 return 0;
8245 8 @}
8246 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8247 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8248
8249 foo.h:
8250 5 return a * 2;
8251 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8252 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8253 End of assembler dump.
8254 @end smallexample
8255
8256 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8257
8258 @smallexample
8259 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8260 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8261 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8262 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8263 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8264 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8265 End of assembler dump.
8266 @end smallexample
8267
8268 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8269 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8270 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8271 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8272
8273 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8274 mnemonics or other syntax.
8275
8276 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8277 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8278 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8279 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8280 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8281
8282 @table @code
8283 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8284 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8285 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8286 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8287 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8288 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8289
8290 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8291 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8292 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8293 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8294
8295 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8296 @item show disassembly-flavor
8297 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8298 @end table
8299
8300 @table @code
8301 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8302 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8303 @item set disassemble-next-line
8304 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8305 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8306 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8307 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8308 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8309 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8310 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8311 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8312 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8313 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8314 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8315 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8316 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8317 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8318 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8319 instruction.
8320 @end table
8321
8322
8323 @node Data
8324 @chapter Examining Data
8325
8326 @cindex printing data
8327 @cindex examining data
8328 @kindex print
8329 @kindex inspect
8330 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8331 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8332 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8333 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8334 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8335 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8336
8337 @table @code
8338 @item print @var{expr}
8339 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8340 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8341 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8342 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8343 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8344 Formats}.
8345
8346 @item print
8347 @itemx print /@var{f}
8348 @cindex reprint the last value
8349 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8350 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8351 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8352 @end table
8353
8354 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8355 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8356 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8357
8358 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8359 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8360 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8361 Table}.
8362
8363 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8364 @kindex explore
8365 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8366 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8367 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8368 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8369 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8370 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8371 embedded in the higher level data types.
8372
8373 @table @code
8374 @item explore @var{arg}
8375 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8376 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8377 @end table
8378
8379 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8380 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8381 C program as
8382
8383 @smallexample
8384 struct SimpleStruct
8385 @{
8386 int i;
8387 double d;
8388 @};
8389
8390 struct ComplexStruct
8391 @{
8392 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8393 int arr[10];
8394 @};
8395 @end smallexample
8396
8397 @noindent
8398 followed by variable declarations as
8399
8400 @smallexample
8401 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8402 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8403 @end smallexample
8404
8405 @noindent
8406 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8407 @code{explore} command as follows.
8408
8409 @smallexample
8410 (gdb) explore cs
8411 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8412 the following fields:
8413
8414 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8415 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8416
8417 Enter the field number of choice:
8418 @end smallexample
8419
8420 @noindent
8421 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8422 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8423 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8424 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8425 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8426 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8427 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8428 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8429
8430 @smallexample
8431 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8432 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8433 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8434 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8435
8436 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8437 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8438
8439 Press enter to return to parent value:
8440 @end smallexample
8441
8442 @noindent
8443 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8444 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8445 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8446 to explore.
8447
8448 @smallexample
8449 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8450 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8451
8452 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8453
8454 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8455
8456 Press enter to return to parent value:
8457 @end smallexample
8458
8459 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8460 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8461 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8462 level data structure).
8463
8464 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8465 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8466 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8467 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8468 same example as above, your can explore the type
8469 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8470 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8471
8472 @smallexample
8473 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8474 @end smallexample
8475
8476 @noindent
8477 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8478 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8479 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8480 example.
8481
8482 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8483 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8484 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8485 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8486 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8487
8488 @table @code
8489 @item explore value @var{expr}
8490 @cindex explore value
8491 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8492 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8493 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8494 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8495 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8496
8497 @item explore type @var{arg}
8498 @cindex explore type
8499 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8500 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8501 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8502 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8503 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8504 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8505 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8506 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8507 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8508 @end table
8509
8510 @menu
8511 * Expressions:: Expressions
8512 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8513 * Variables:: Program variables
8514 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8515 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8516 * Memory:: Examining memory
8517 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8518 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8519 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8520 * Value History:: Value history
8521 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8522 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8523 * Registers:: Registers
8524 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8525 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8526 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8527 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8528 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8529 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8530 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8531 character set than GDB does
8532 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8533 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8534 @end menu
8535
8536 @node Expressions
8537 @section Expressions
8538
8539 @cindex expressions
8540 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8541 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8542 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8543 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8544 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8545 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8546 @ref{Compilation}.
8547
8548 @cindex arrays in expressions
8549 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8550 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8551 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8552 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8553 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8554 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8555
8556 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8557 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8558 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8559 languages.
8560
8561 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8562 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8563
8564 @cindex casts, in expressions
8565 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8566 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8567 at that address in memory.
8568 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8569
8570 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8571 to programming languages:
8572
8573 @table @code
8574 @item @@
8575 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8576 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8577
8578 @item ::
8579 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8580 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8581
8582 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8583 @cindex type casting memory
8584 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8585 @cindex casts, to view memory
8586 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8587 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8588 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8589 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8590 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8591 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8592 @end table
8593
8594 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8595 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8596 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8597
8598 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8599 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8600 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8601 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8602 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8603 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8604 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8605
8606 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8607 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8608 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8609 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8610 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8611 as well.
8612
8613 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8614 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8615 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8616 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8617 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8618 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8619 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8620 choices.
8621
8622 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8623 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8624 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8625
8626 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8627 @smallexample
8628 @group
8629 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8630 [0] cancel
8631 [1] all
8632 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8633 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8634 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8635 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8636 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8637 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8638 > 2 4 6
8639 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8640 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8641 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8642 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8643 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8644 breakpoints.
8645 (@value{GDBP})
8646 @end group
8647 @end smallexample
8648
8649 @table @code
8650 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8651 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8652 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8653
8654 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8655 is ambiguous.
8656
8657 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8658 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8659 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8660 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8661 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8662 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8663 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8664 in the use of the menu.
8665
8666 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8667 when an ambiguity is detected.
8668
8669 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8670 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8671
8672 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8673 @item show multiple-symbols
8674 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8675 @end table
8676
8677 @node Variables
8678 @section Program Variables
8679
8680 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8681 in your program.
8682
8683 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8684 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8685
8686 @itemize @bullet
8687 @item
8688 global (or file-static)
8689 @end itemize
8690
8691 @noindent or
8692
8693 @itemize @bullet
8694 @item
8695 visible according to the scope rules of the
8696 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8697 @end itemize
8698
8699 @noindent This means that in the function
8700
8701 @smallexample
8702 foo (a)
8703 int a;
8704 @{
8705 bar (a);
8706 @{
8707 int b = test ();
8708 bar (b);
8709 @}
8710 @}
8711 @end smallexample
8712
8713 @noindent
8714 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8715 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8716 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8717 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8718
8719 @cindex variable name conflict
8720 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8721 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8722 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8723 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8724 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8725 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8726 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8727
8728 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8729 @ifnotinfo
8730 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8731 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8732 @end ifnotinfo
8733 @smallexample
8734 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8735 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8736 @end smallexample
8737
8738 @noindent
8739 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8740 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8741 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8742 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8743
8744 @smallexample
8745 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8746 @end smallexample
8747
8748 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8749 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8750 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8751 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8752 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8753
8754 @smallexample
8755 void
8756 foo (int a)
8757 @{
8758 if (a < 10)
8759 bar (a);
8760 else
8761 process (a); /* Stop here */
8762 @}
8763
8764 int
8765 bar (int a)
8766 @{
8767 foo (a + 5);
8768 @}
8769 @end smallexample
8770
8771 @noindent
8772 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
8773 here is what you might see
8774 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
8775
8776 @smallexample
8777 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8778 $1 = 10
8779 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8780 $2 = 5
8781 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
8782 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
8783 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8784 $3 = 5
8785 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8786 $4 = 0
8787 @end smallexample
8788
8789 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
8790 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
8791 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
8792 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
8793 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
8794
8795 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
8796 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
8797 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
8798 @code{some_global}.
8799
8800 @smallexample
8801 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
8802 $1 = 23
8803 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
8804 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
8805 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
8806 $2 = 27
8807 @end smallexample
8808
8809 @cindex wrong values
8810 @cindex variable values, wrong
8811 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
8812 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
8813 @quotation
8814 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
8815 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
8816 scope, and just before exit.
8817 @end quotation
8818 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
8819 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
8820 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
8821 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
8822 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
8823 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
8824 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
8825 variable definitions may be gone.
8826
8827 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
8828 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
8829 when compiling.
8830
8831 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
8832 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
8833 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
8834 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
8835 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
8836 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
8837 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
8838
8839 @smallexample
8840 No symbol "foo" in current context.
8841 @end smallexample
8842
8843 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
8844 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
8845 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
8846 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
8847 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
8848
8849 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
8850 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
8851 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
8852 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
8853
8854 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
8855 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
8856 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
8857 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
8858 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
8859
8860 @smallexample
8861 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
8862 29 i++;
8863 (gdb) next
8864 30 e (i);
8865 (gdb) print i
8866 $1 = 31
8867 (gdb) print i@@entry
8868 $2 = 30
8869 @end smallexample
8870
8871 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
8872 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
8873 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
8874 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
8875 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
8876 For program code
8877
8878 @smallexample
8879 char var0[] = "A";
8880 signed char var1[] = "A";
8881 @end smallexample
8882
8883 You get during debugging
8884 @smallexample
8885 (gdb) print var0
8886 $1 = "A"
8887 (gdb) print var1
8888 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
8889 @end smallexample
8890
8891 @node Arrays
8892 @section Artificial Arrays
8893
8894 @cindex artificial array
8895 @cindex arrays
8896 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
8897 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
8898 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
8899 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
8900 program.
8901
8902 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
8903 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
8904 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
8905 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
8906 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
8907 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
8908 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
8909 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
8910 example. If a program says
8911
8912 @smallexample
8913 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
8914 @end smallexample
8915
8916 @noindent
8917 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
8918
8919 @smallexample
8920 p *array@@len
8921 @end smallexample
8922
8923 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
8924 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
8925 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
8926 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
8927 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
8928
8929 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
8930 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
8931 The value need not be in memory:
8932 @smallexample
8933 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
8934 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8935 @end smallexample
8936
8937 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
8938 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
8939 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
8940 @smallexample
8941 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
8942 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8943 @end smallexample
8944
8945 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
8946 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
8947 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
8948 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
8949 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8950 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
8951 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
8952 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
8953 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
8954 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
8955
8956 @smallexample
8957 set $i = 0
8958 p dtab[$i++]->fv
8959 @key{RET}
8960 @key{RET}
8961 @dots{}
8962 @end smallexample
8963
8964 @node Output Formats
8965 @section Output Formats
8966
8967 @cindex formatted output
8968 @cindex output formats
8969 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
8970 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
8971 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
8972 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
8973 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
8974
8975 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
8976 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
8977 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
8978 letters supported are:
8979
8980 @table @code
8981 @item x
8982 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
8983 hexadecimal.
8984
8985 @item d
8986 Print as integer in signed decimal.
8987
8988 @item u
8989 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
8990
8991 @item o
8992 Print as integer in octal.
8993
8994 @item t
8995 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
8996 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
8997 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
8998 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
8999
9000 @item a
9001 @cindex unknown address, locating
9002 @cindex locate address
9003 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9004 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9005 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9006
9007 @smallexample
9008 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9009 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9010 @end smallexample
9011
9012 @noindent
9013 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9014 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9015
9016 @item c
9017 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9018 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9019 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9020 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9021
9022 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9023 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9024 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9025 data.
9026
9027 @item f
9028 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9029 using typical floating point syntax.
9030
9031 @item s
9032 @cindex printing strings
9033 @cindex printing byte arrays
9034 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9035 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9036 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9037 natural types.
9038
9039 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9040 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9041 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9042 array.
9043
9044 @item z
9045 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9046 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9047 to the size of the integer type.
9048
9049 @item r
9050 @cindex raw printing
9051 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9052 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9053 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9054 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9055 pretty-printer which might exist.
9056 @end table
9057
9058 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9059
9060 @smallexample
9061 p/x $pc
9062 @end smallexample
9063
9064 @noindent
9065 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9066 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9067
9068 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9069 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9070 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9071
9072 @node Memory
9073 @section Examining Memory
9074
9075 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9076 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9077
9078 @cindex examining memory
9079 @table @code
9080 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9081 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9082 @itemx x @var{addr}
9083 @itemx x
9084 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9085 @end table
9086
9087 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9088 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9089 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9090 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9091 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9092
9093 @table @r
9094 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9095 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9096 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
9097 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9098 @c 4.1.2.
9099
9100 @item @var{f}, the display format
9101 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9102 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9103 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9104 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9105 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9106
9107 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9108 The unit size is any of
9109
9110 @table @code
9111 @item b
9112 Bytes.
9113 @item h
9114 Halfwords (two bytes).
9115 @item w
9116 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9117 @item g
9118 Giant words (eight bytes).
9119 @end table
9120
9121 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9122 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9123 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9124 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9125 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9126 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9127 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9128 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9129 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9130 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9131 be altered.
9132
9133 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9134 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9135 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9136 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9137 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9138 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9139 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9140 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9141 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9142 a value from memory).
9143 @end table
9144
9145 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9146 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9147 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9148 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9149 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9150
9151 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9152 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9153 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9154 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9155 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9156
9157 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9158 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9159 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9160 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9161 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9162 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9163 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9164 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9165 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9166
9167 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9168 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9169 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9170 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9171 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9172 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9173 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9174
9175 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9176 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9177
9178 @smallexample
9179 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9180 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9181 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9182 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9183 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9184 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9185 @end smallexample
9186
9187 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9188 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9189 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9190 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9191 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9192 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9193 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9194 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9195 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9196
9197 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9198 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9199 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9200
9201 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9202 @cindex addressable memory unit
9203 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9204 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9205 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9206 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9207 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9208 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9209 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9210 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9211 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9212
9213 @cindex remote memory comparison
9214 @cindex target memory comparison
9215 @cindex verify remote memory image
9216 @cindex verify target memory image
9217 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9218 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9219 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9220 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9221 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9222 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9223
9224 @table @code
9225 @kindex compare-sections
9226 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9227 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9228 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9229 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9230 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9231 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9232
9233 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9234 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9235 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9236 @end table
9237
9238 @node Auto Display
9239 @section Automatic Display
9240 @cindex automatic display
9241 @cindex display of expressions
9242
9243 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9244 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9245 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9246 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9247 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9248 The automatic display looks like this:
9249
9250 @smallexample
9251 2: foo = 38
9252 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9253 @end smallexample
9254
9255 @noindent
9256 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9257 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9258 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9259 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9260 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9261 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9262
9263 @table @code
9264 @kindex display
9265 @item display @var{expr}
9266 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9267 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9268
9269 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9270
9271 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9272 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9273 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9274 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9275 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9276
9277 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9278 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9279 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9280 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9281 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9282 @end table
9283
9284 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9285 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9286 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9287
9288 @table @code
9289 @kindex delete display
9290 @kindex undisplay
9291 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9292 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9293 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9294 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9295 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9296 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9297 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9298
9299 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9300 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9301
9302 @kindex disable display
9303 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9304 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9305 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9306 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9307 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9308 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9309 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9310 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9311
9312 @kindex enable display
9313 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9314 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9315 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9316 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9317 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9318 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9319 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9320
9321 @item display
9322 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9323 done when your program stops.
9324
9325 @kindex info display
9326 @item info display
9327 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9328 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9329 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9330 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9331 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9332 @end table
9333
9334 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9335 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9336 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9337 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9338 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9339 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9340 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9341 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9342 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9343 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9344 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9345
9346 @node Print Settings
9347 @section Print Settings
9348
9349 @cindex format options
9350 @cindex print settings
9351 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9352 and symbols are printed.
9353
9354 @noindent
9355 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9356
9357 @table @code
9358 @kindex set print
9359 @item set print address
9360 @itemx set print address on
9361 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9362 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9363 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9364 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9365 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9366 @code{set print address on}:
9367
9368 @smallexample
9369 @group
9370 (@value{GDBP}) f
9371 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9372 at input.c:530
9373 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9374 @end group
9375 @end smallexample
9376
9377 @item set print address off
9378 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9379 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9380
9381 @smallexample
9382 @group
9383 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9384 (@value{GDBP}) f
9385 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9386 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9387 @end group
9388 @end smallexample
9389
9390 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9391 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9392 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9393 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9394
9395 @kindex show print
9396 @item show print address
9397 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9398 @end table
9399
9400 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9401 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9402 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9403 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9404 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9405 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9406 it prints a symbolic address:
9407
9408 @table @code
9409 @item set print symbol-filename on
9410 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9411 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9412 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9413 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9414
9415 @item set print symbol-filename off
9416 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9417 default.
9418
9419 @item show print symbol-filename
9420 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9421 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9422 @end table
9423
9424 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9425 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9426 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9427
9428 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9429 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9430
9431 @table @code
9432 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9433 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9434 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9435 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9436 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9437 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9438 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9439 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9440
9441 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9442 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9443 symbolic address.
9444 @end table
9445
9446 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9447 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9448 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9449 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9450 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9451 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9452 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9453 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9454
9455 @smallexample
9456 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9457 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9458 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9459 @end smallexample
9460
9461 @quotation
9462 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9463 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9464 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9465 @end quotation
9466
9467 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9468 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9469
9470 @table @code
9471 @item set print symbol on
9472 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9473 one exists.
9474
9475 @item set print symbol off
9476 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9477 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9478 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9479
9480 @item show print symbol
9481 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9482 address.
9483 @end table
9484
9485 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9486
9487 @table @code
9488 @item set print array
9489 @itemx set print array on
9490 @cindex pretty print arrays
9491 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9492 but uses more space. The default is off.
9493
9494 @item set print array off
9495 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9496
9497 @item show print array
9498 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9499 arrays.
9500
9501 @cindex print array indexes
9502 @item set print array-indexes
9503 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9504 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9505 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9506 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9507
9508 @item set print array-indexes off
9509 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9510
9511 @item show print array-indexes
9512 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9513 arrays.
9514
9515 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9516 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9517 @cindex number of array elements to print
9518 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9519 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9520 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9521 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9522 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9523 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9524 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9525 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9526
9527 @item show print elements
9528 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9529 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9530
9531 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9532 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9533 @cindex printing frame argument values
9534 @cindex print all frame argument values
9535 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9536 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9537 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9538 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9539 values are:
9540
9541 @table @code
9542 @item all
9543 The values of all arguments are printed.
9544
9545 @item scalars
9546 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9547 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9548 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9549 only scalar arguments are shown:
9550
9551 @smallexample
9552 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9553 at frame-args.c:23
9554 @end smallexample
9555
9556 @item none
9557 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9558 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9559
9560 @smallexample
9561 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9562 at frame-args.c:23
9563 @end smallexample
9564 @end table
9565
9566 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9567 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9568 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9569 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9570 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9571 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9572 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9573 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9574 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9575 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9576
9577 @item show print frame-arguments
9578 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9579
9580 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9581 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9582
9583 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9584 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9585 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9586 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9587 This is the default.
9588
9589 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9590 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9591
9592 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9593 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9594 @kindex set print entry-values
9595 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9596 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9597 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9598 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9599 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9600
9601 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9602 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9603 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9604 @code{no} setting.
9605
9606 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9607 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9608 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9609 this information.
9610
9611 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9612
9613 @table @code
9614 @item no
9615 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9616 point.
9617 @smallexample
9618 #0 equal (val=5)
9619 #0 different (val=6)
9620 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9621 #0 born (val=10)
9622 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9623 @end smallexample
9624
9625 @item only
9626 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9627 values are never printed.
9628 @smallexample
9629 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9630 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9631 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9632 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9633 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9634 @end smallexample
9635
9636 @item preferred
9637 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9638 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9639 value for such parameter.
9640 @smallexample
9641 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9642 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9643 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9644 #0 born (val=10)
9645 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9646 @end smallexample
9647
9648 @item if-needed
9649 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9650 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9651 parameter.
9652 @smallexample
9653 #0 equal (val=5)
9654 #0 different (val=6)
9655 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9656 #0 born (val=10)
9657 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9658 @end smallexample
9659
9660 @item both
9661 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9662 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9663 optimizations.
9664 @smallexample
9665 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9666 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9667 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9668 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9669 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9670 @end smallexample
9671
9672 @item compact
9673 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9674 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9675 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9676 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9677 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9678 @smallexample
9679 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9680 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9681 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9682 #0 born (val=10)
9683 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9684 @end smallexample
9685
9686 @item default
9687 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9688 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9689 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9690 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9691 @smallexample
9692 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9693 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9694 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9695 #0 born (val=10)
9696 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9697 @end smallexample
9698 @end table
9699
9700 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9701 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9702
9703 @item show print entry-values
9704 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9705 entry.
9706
9707 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9708 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9709 @cindex repeated array elements
9710 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9711 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9712 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9713 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9714 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9715 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9716 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9717 is 10.
9718
9719 @item show print repeats
9720 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9721 elements.
9722
9723 @item set print null-stop
9724 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9725 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9726 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9727 contain only short strings.
9728 The default is off.
9729
9730 @item show print null-stop
9731 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9732 @sc{null} character.
9733
9734 @item set print pretty on
9735 @cindex print structures in indented form
9736 @cindex indentation in structure display
9737 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9738 per line, like this:
9739
9740 @smallexample
9741 @group
9742 $1 = @{
9743 next = 0x0,
9744 flags = @{
9745 sweet = 1,
9746 sour = 1
9747 @},
9748 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9749 @}
9750 @end group
9751 @end smallexample
9752
9753 @item set print pretty off
9754 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9755
9756 @smallexample
9757 @group
9758 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
9759 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
9760 @end group
9761 @end smallexample
9762
9763 @noindent
9764 This is the default format.
9765
9766 @item show print pretty
9767 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
9768
9769 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
9770 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
9771 @cindex octal escapes in strings
9772 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
9773 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
9774 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
9775 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
9776 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
9777
9778 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
9779 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
9780 international character sets, and is the default.
9781
9782 @item show print sevenbit-strings
9783 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
9784
9785 @item set print union on
9786 @cindex unions in structures, printing
9787 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
9788 and other unions. This is the default setting.
9789
9790 @item set print union off
9791 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
9792 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
9793 instead.
9794
9795 @item show print union
9796 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
9797 structures and other unions.
9798
9799 For example, given the declarations
9800
9801 @smallexample
9802 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
9803 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
9804 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
9805 Bug_forms;
9806
9807 struct thing @{
9808 Species it;
9809 union @{
9810 Tree_forms tree;
9811 Bug_forms bug;
9812 @} form;
9813 @};
9814
9815 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
9816 @end smallexample
9817
9818 @noindent
9819 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
9820
9821 @smallexample
9822 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
9823 @end smallexample
9824
9825 @noindent
9826 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
9827
9828 @smallexample
9829 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
9830 @end smallexample
9831
9832 @noindent
9833 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
9834 and in Pascal.
9835 @end table
9836
9837 @need 1000
9838 @noindent
9839 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
9840
9841 @table @code
9842 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
9843 @item set print demangle
9844 @itemx set print demangle on
9845 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
9846 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
9847 linkage. The default is on.
9848
9849 @item show print demangle
9850 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
9851
9852 @item set print asm-demangle
9853 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
9854 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
9855 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
9856 The default is off.
9857
9858 @item show print asm-demangle
9859 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
9860 or demangled form.
9861
9862 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
9863 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
9864 @kindex set demangle-style
9865 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
9866 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
9867 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
9868
9869 @table @code
9870 @item auto
9871 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
9872 This is the default.
9873
9874 @item gnu
9875 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
9876
9877 @item hp
9878 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
9879
9880 @item lucid
9881 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
9882
9883 @item arm
9884 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
9885 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
9886 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
9887 require further enhancement to permit that.
9888
9889 @end table
9890 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
9891
9892 @item show demangle-style
9893 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
9894
9895 @item set print object
9896 @itemx set print object on
9897 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
9898 @cindex display derived types
9899 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
9900 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
9901 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
9902 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
9903 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
9904 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
9905 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
9906
9907 @item set print object off
9908 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
9909 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
9910
9911 @item show print object
9912 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
9913
9914 @item set print static-members
9915 @itemx set print static-members on
9916 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
9917 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
9918
9919 @item set print static-members off
9920 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
9921
9922 @item show print static-members
9923 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
9924
9925 @item set print pascal_static-members
9926 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
9927 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
9928 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
9929 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
9930
9931 @item set print pascal_static-members off
9932 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
9933
9934 @item show print pascal_static-members
9935 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
9936
9937 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
9938 @item set print vtbl
9939 @itemx set print vtbl on
9940 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
9941 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
9942 @cindex VTBL display
9943 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
9944 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9945 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9946
9947 @item set print vtbl off
9948 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
9949
9950 @item show print vtbl
9951 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
9952 @end table
9953
9954 @node Pretty Printing
9955 @section Pretty Printing
9956
9957 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
9958 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
9959 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
9960
9961 @menu
9962 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
9963 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
9964 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
9965 @end menu
9966
9967 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
9968 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
9969
9970 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
9971 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
9972 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
9973
9974 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
9975 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
9976 pretty-printers with their names.
9977 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
9978 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
9979 Each such subprinter has its own name.
9980 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
9981
9982 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
9983 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
9984 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
9985 do anything special.
9986
9987 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
9988
9989 @itemize @bullet
9990 @item
9991 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
9992 all inferiors.
9993
9994 @item
9995 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
9996 when debugging that program.
9997 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
9998
9999 @item
10000 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10001 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10002 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10003 @end itemize
10004
10005 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10006 pretty-printers are selected,
10007
10008 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10009 for new types.
10010
10011 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10012 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10013
10014 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10015
10016 @smallexample
10017 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10018 $1 = @{
10019 static npos = 4294967295,
10020 _M_dataplus = @{
10021 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10022 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10023 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10024 @},
10025 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10026 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10027 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10028 @}
10029 @}
10030 @end smallexample
10031
10032 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10033
10034 @smallexample
10035 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10036 $2 = "abcd"
10037 @end smallexample
10038
10039 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10040 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10041 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10042
10043 @table @code
10044 @kindex info pretty-printer
10045 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10046 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10047 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10048
10049 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10050 whose pretty-printers to list.
10051 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10052 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10053 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10054 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10055 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10056
10057 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10058 to list.
10059
10060 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10061 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10062 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10063 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10064
10065 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10066 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10067 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10068 @end table
10069
10070 Example:
10071
10072 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10073 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10074 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10075 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10076
10077 @smallexample
10078 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10079 library1.so:
10080 foo
10081 library2.so:
10082 bar
10083 bar1
10084 bar2
10085 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10086 library2.so:
10087 bar
10088 bar1
10089 bar2
10090 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10091 1 printer disabled
10092 2 of 3 printers enabled
10093 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10094 library1.so:
10095 foo [disabled]
10096 library2.so:
10097 bar
10098 bar1
10099 bar2
10100 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
10101 1 printer disabled
10102 1 of 3 printers enabled
10103 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10104 library1.so:
10105 foo [disabled]
10106 library2.so:
10107 bar
10108 bar1 [disabled]
10109 bar2
10110 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10111 1 printer disabled
10112 0 of 3 printers enabled
10113 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10114 library1.so:
10115 foo [disabled]
10116 library2.so:
10117 bar [disabled]
10118 bar1 [disabled]
10119 bar2
10120 @end smallexample
10121
10122 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10123 as can each individual subprinter.
10124
10125 @node Value History
10126 @section Value History
10127
10128 @cindex value history
10129 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10130 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10131 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10132 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10133 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10134 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10135 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10136 symbol table.
10137
10138 @cindex @code{$}
10139 @cindex @code{$$}
10140 @cindex history number
10141 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10142 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10143 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10144 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10145 history number.
10146
10147 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10148 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10149 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10150 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10151 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10152 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10153 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10154
10155 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10156 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10157
10158 @smallexample
10159 p *$
10160 @end smallexample
10161
10162 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10163 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10164
10165 @smallexample
10166 p *$.next
10167 @end smallexample
10168
10169 @noindent
10170 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10171 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10172
10173 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10174 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10175
10176 @smallexample
10177 print x
10178 set x=5
10179 @end smallexample
10180
10181 @noindent
10182 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10183 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10184
10185 @table @code
10186 @kindex show values
10187 @item show values
10188 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10189 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10190 values} does not change the history.
10191
10192 @item show values @var{n}
10193 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10194
10195 @item show values +
10196 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10197 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10198 @end table
10199
10200 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10201 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10202
10203 @node Convenience Vars
10204 @section Convenience Variables
10205
10206 @cindex convenience variables
10207 @cindex user-defined variables
10208 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10209 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10210 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10211 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10212 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10213
10214 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10215 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10216 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10217 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10218 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10219
10220 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10221 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10222 For example:
10223
10224 @smallexample
10225 set $foo = *object_ptr
10226 @end smallexample
10227
10228 @noindent
10229 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10230 @code{object_ptr}.
10231
10232 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10233 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10234 value with another assignment at any time.
10235
10236 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10237 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10238 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10239 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10240
10241 @table @code
10242 @kindex show convenience
10243 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10244 @item show convenience
10245 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10246 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10247 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10248
10249 @kindex init-if-undefined
10250 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10251 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10252 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10253 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10254 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10255 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10256 override default values used in a command script.
10257
10258 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10259 any side-effects do not occur.
10260 @end table
10261
10262 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10263 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10264 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10265
10266 @smallexample
10267 set $i = 0
10268 print bar[$i++]->contents
10269 @end smallexample
10270
10271 @noindent
10272 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10273
10274 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10275 values likely to be useful.
10276
10277 @table @code
10278 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10279 @item $_
10280 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10281 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10282 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10283 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10284 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10285 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10286 to the type of @code{$__}.
10287
10288 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10289 @item $__
10290 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10291 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10292 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10293
10294 @item $_exitcode
10295 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10296 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10297 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10298 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10299
10300 @item $_exitsignal
10301 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10302 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10303 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10304 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10305
10306 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10307 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10308 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10309 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10310 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10311
10312 @smallexample
10313 #include <signal.h>
10314
10315 int
10316 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10317 @{
10318 raise (SIGALRM);
10319 return 0;
10320 @}
10321 @end smallexample
10322
10323 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10324 or signalled would be:
10325
10326 @smallexample
10327 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10328 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10329 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10330 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10331 >echo The program has exited\n
10332 >else
10333 >echo The program has signalled\n
10334 >end
10335 >end
10336 (@value{GDBP}) run
10337 Starting program:
10338
10339 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10340 The program no longer exists.
10341 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10342 The program has signalled
10343 @end smallexample
10344
10345 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10346 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10347 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10348 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10349
10350 @smallexample
10351 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10352 The program has exited
10353 @end smallexample
10354
10355 @item $_exception
10356 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10357 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10358
10359 @item $_probe_argc
10360 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10361 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10362
10363 @item $_sdata
10364 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10365 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10366 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10367 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10368 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10369
10370 @item $_siginfo
10371 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10372 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10373 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10374 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10375 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10376
10377 @item $_tlb
10378 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10379 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10380 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10381 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10382 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10383 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10384
10385 @end table
10386
10387 @node Convenience Funs
10388 @section Convenience Functions
10389
10390 @cindex convenience functions
10391 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10392 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10393 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10394 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10395 @value{GDBN}.
10396
10397 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10398 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10399
10400 @table @code
10401
10402 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10403 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10404 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10405 returns zero.
10406
10407 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10408 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10409 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10410 it is @code{void}:
10411
10412 @smallexample
10413 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10414 $1 = void
10415 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10416 $2 = 1
10417 (@value{GDBP}) run
10418 Starting program: ./a.out
10419 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10420 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10421 $3 = 0
10422 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10423 $4 = 0
10424 @end smallexample
10425
10426 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10427 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10428 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10429 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10430 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10431 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10432 anymore.
10433
10434 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10435 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10436
10437 @smallexample
10438 void
10439 foo (void)
10440 @{
10441 @}
10442 @end smallexample
10443
10444 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10445
10446 @smallexample
10447 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10448 $1 = void
10449 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10450 $2 = 1
10451 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10452 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10453 $3 = void
10454 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10455 $4 = 1
10456 @end smallexample
10457
10458 @end table
10459
10460 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10461 @code{Python} support.
10462
10463 @table @code
10464
10465 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10466 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10467 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10468 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10469 Otherwise it returns zero.
10470
10471 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10472 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10473 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10474 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10475 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10476 regular expression support.
10477
10478 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10479 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10480 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10481 Otherwise it returns zero.
10482
10483 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10484 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10485 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10486
10487 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10488 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10489 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10490 Otherwise it returns zero.
10491
10492 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10493 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10494 The default is 1.
10495
10496 Example:
10497
10498 @smallexample
10499 (gdb) backtrace
10500 #0 bottom_func ()
10501 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10502 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10503 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10504 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10505 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10506 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10507 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10508 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10509 $1 = 1
10510 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10511 $1 = 1
10512 @end smallexample
10513
10514 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10515 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10516 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10517 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10518
10519 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10520 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10521 The default is 1.
10522
10523 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10524 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10525 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10526 Otherwise it returns zero.
10527
10528 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10529 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10530 The default is 1.
10531
10532 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10533 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10534 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10535 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10536
10537 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10538 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10539 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10540 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10541
10542 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10543 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10544 The default is 1.
10545
10546 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10547 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10548 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10549 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10550
10551 @end table
10552
10553 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10554 convenience functions.
10555
10556 @table @code
10557 @item help function
10558 @kindex help function
10559 @cindex show all convenience functions
10560 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10561 @end table
10562
10563 @node Registers
10564 @section Registers
10565
10566 @cindex registers
10567 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10568 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10569 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10570 your machine.
10571
10572 @table @code
10573 @kindex info registers
10574 @item info registers
10575 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10576 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10577
10578 @kindex info all-registers
10579 @cindex floating point registers
10580 @item info all-registers
10581 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10582 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10583
10584 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10585 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10586 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10587 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10588 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10589 @end table
10590
10591 @anchor{standard registers}
10592 @cindex stack pointer register
10593 @cindex program counter register
10594 @cindex process status register
10595 @cindex frame pointer register
10596 @cindex standard registers
10597 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10598 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10599 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10600 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10601 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10602 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10603 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10604 you could print the program counter in hex with
10605
10606 @smallexample
10607 p/x $pc
10608 @end smallexample
10609
10610 @noindent
10611 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10612
10613 @smallexample
10614 x/i $pc
10615 @end smallexample
10616
10617 @noindent
10618 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10619 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10620 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10621 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10622 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10623 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10624 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10625
10626 @smallexample
10627 set $sp += 4
10628 @end smallexample
10629
10630 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10631 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10632 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10633 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10634 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10635 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10636 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10637
10638 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10639 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10640 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10641 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10642 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10643 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10644 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10645
10646 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10647 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10648 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10649 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10650 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10651 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10652 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10653 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10654 prints the data in both formats.
10655
10656 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10657 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10658 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10659 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10660 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10661 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10662 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10663
10664 @smallexample
10665 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10666 $1 = @{
10667 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10668 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10669 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10670 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10671 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10672 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10673 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10674 @}
10675 @end smallexample
10676
10677 @noindent
10678 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10679 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10680 value to a @code{struct} member:
10681
10682 @smallexample
10683 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10684 @end smallexample
10685
10686 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10687 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10688 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10689 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10690 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10691 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10692
10693 @cindex caller-saved registers
10694 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10695 @cindex volatile registers
10696 @cindex <not saved> values
10697 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10698 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10699 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10700 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10701 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10702 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10703 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10704 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10705 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10706 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10707 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10708 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10709 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10710 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10711 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10712 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10713 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10714 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10715 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10716 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10717 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10718 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10719 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10720
10721 @node Floating Point Hardware
10722 @section Floating Point Hardware
10723 @cindex floating point
10724
10725 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10726 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10727
10728 @table @code
10729 @kindex info float
10730 @item info float
10731 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10732 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
10733 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
10734 the ARM and x86 machines.
10735 @end table
10736
10737 @node Vector Unit
10738 @section Vector Unit
10739 @cindex vector unit
10740
10741 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
10742 more information about the status of the vector unit.
10743
10744 @table @code
10745 @kindex info vector
10746 @item info vector
10747 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
10748 layout vary depending on the hardware.
10749 @end table
10750
10751 @node OS Information
10752 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
10753 @cindex OS information
10754
10755 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
10756 you debug your program.
10757
10758 @cindex auxiliary vector
10759 @cindex vector, auxiliary
10760 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
10761 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
10762 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
10763 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
10764 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
10765 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
10766 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
10767 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
10768 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
10769 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
10770 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
10771
10772 @table @code
10773 @kindex info auxv
10774 @item info auxv
10775 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
10776 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
10777 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
10778 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
10779 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
10780 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
10781 an unrecognized tag.
10782 @end table
10783
10784 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
10785 information and show it to you. The types of information available
10786 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
10787 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
10788 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
10789 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
10790 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
10791
10792 @table @code
10793 @kindex info os
10794 @item info os @var{infotype}
10795
10796 Display OS information of the requested type.
10797
10798 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
10799
10800 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
10801 @table @code
10802 @kindex info os cpus
10803 @item cpus
10804 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
10805 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
10806 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
10807 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
10808 kernel initialization.
10809
10810 @kindex info os files
10811 @item files
10812 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
10813 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
10814 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
10815 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
10816
10817 @kindex info os modules
10818 @item modules
10819 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
10820 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
10821 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
10822 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
10823 in memory.
10824
10825 @kindex info os msg
10826 @item msg
10827 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
10828 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
10829 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
10830 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
10831 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
10832 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
10833 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
10834 the message queue was last changed.
10835
10836 @kindex info os processes
10837 @item processes
10838 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
10839 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
10840 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
10841 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
10842 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
10843 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
10844
10845 @kindex info os procgroups
10846 @item procgroups
10847 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
10848 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
10849 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
10850 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
10851 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
10852 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
10853 and the process group leader is listed first.
10854
10855 @kindex info os semaphores
10856 @item semaphores
10857 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
10858 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
10859 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
10860 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
10861 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
10862
10863 @kindex info os shm
10864 @item shm
10865 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
10866 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
10867 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
10868 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
10869 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
10870 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
10871 attached to, detach from, and changed.
10872
10873 @kindex info os sockets
10874 @item sockets
10875 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
10876 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
10877 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
10878 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
10879 connection.
10880
10881 @kindex info os threads
10882 @item threads
10883 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
10884 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
10885 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
10886 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
10887 process is not listed.
10888 @end table
10889
10890 @item info os
10891 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
10892 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
10893 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
10894 types, this command will report an error.
10895 @end table
10896
10897 @node Memory Region Attributes
10898 @section Memory Region Attributes
10899 @cindex memory region attributes
10900
10901 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
10902 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
10903 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
10904 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
10905 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
10906 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
10907 user can override the fetched regions.
10908
10909 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
10910 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
10911 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
10912 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
10913 all memory.
10914
10915 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
10916 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
10917
10918 @table @code
10919 @kindex mem
10920 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
10921 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
10922 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
10923 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
10924 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
10925 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
10926
10927 @item mem auto
10928 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
10929 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
10930
10931 @kindex delete mem
10932 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10933 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
10934 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
10935
10936 @kindex disable mem
10937 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10938 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10939 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
10940 It may be enabled again later.
10941
10942 @kindex enable mem
10943 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10944 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10945
10946 @kindex info mem
10947 @item info mem
10948 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
10949 for each region:
10950
10951 @table @emph
10952 @item Memory Region Number
10953 @item Enabled or Disabled.
10954 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
10955 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
10956
10957 @item Lo Address
10958 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
10959
10960 @item Hi Address
10961 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
10962
10963 @item Attributes
10964 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
10965 @end table
10966 @end table
10967
10968
10969 @subsection Attributes
10970
10971 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
10972 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
10973 write accesses to a memory region.
10974
10975 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
10976 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
10977 etc.@: from accessing memory.
10978
10979 @table @code
10980 @item ro
10981 Memory is read only.
10982 @item wo
10983 Memory is write only.
10984 @item rw
10985 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
10986 @end table
10987
10988 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
10989 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
10990 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
10991 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
10992 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
10993
10994 @table @code
10995 @item 8
10996 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
10997 @item 16
10998 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
10999 @item 32
11000 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11001 @item 64
11002 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11003 @end table
11004
11005 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11006 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11007 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11008 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11009 @c
11010 @c @table @code
11011 @c @item hwbreak
11012 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11013 @c @item swbreak (default)
11014 @c @end table
11015
11016 @subsubsection Data Cache
11017 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11018 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11019 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11020 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11021 registers.
11022
11023 @table @code
11024 @item cache
11025 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11026 @item nocache
11027 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11028 @end table
11029
11030 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11031 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11032 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11033 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11034 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11035
11036 @table @code
11037 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11038 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11039 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11040 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11041 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11042 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11043 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11044 The default value is @code{on}.
11045 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11046 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11047 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11048 @end table
11049
11050
11051 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11052 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11053 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11054 @c
11055 @c @table @code
11056 @c @item verify
11057 @c @item noverify (default)
11058 @c @end table
11059
11060 @node Dump/Restore Files
11061 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11062 @cindex dump/restore files
11063 @cindex append data to a file
11064 @cindex dump data to a file
11065 @cindex restore data from a file
11066
11067 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11068 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11069 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11070 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11071 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11072 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11073 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11074
11075 @table @code
11076
11077 @kindex dump
11078 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11079 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11080 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11081 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11082
11083 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11084 @table @code
11085 @item binary
11086 Raw binary form.
11087 @item ihex
11088 Intel hex format.
11089 @item srec
11090 Motorola S-record format.
11091 @item tekhex
11092 Tektronix Hex format.
11093 @item verilog
11094 Verilog Hex format.
11095 @end table
11096
11097 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11098 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11099 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11100 form.
11101
11102 @kindex append
11103 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11104 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11105 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11106 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11107 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11108
11109 @kindex restore
11110 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11111 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11112 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11113 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11114 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11115
11116 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11117 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11118 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11119 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11120 from that location.
11121
11122 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11123 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11124 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11125 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11126
11127 @end table
11128
11129 @node Core File Generation
11130 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11131 @cindex dump core from inferior
11132
11133 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11134 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11135 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11136 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11137 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11138 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11139 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11140
11141 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11142 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11143 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11144
11145 @table @code
11146 @kindex gcore
11147 @kindex generate-core-file
11148 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11149 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11150 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11151 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11152 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11153 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11154
11155 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11156 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11157
11158 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11159 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11160 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}).
11161
11162 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11163 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11164 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11165 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11166 Enable or disable the use of the file
11167 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11168 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11169 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11170 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11171
11172 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11173 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11174 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11175 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11176 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11177 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11178 about the bits that can be set in the
11179 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11180 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11181
11182 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11183 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11184 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11185 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11186 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11187 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11188 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11189 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11190 @end table
11191
11192 @node Character Sets
11193 @section Character Sets
11194 @cindex character sets
11195 @cindex charset
11196 @cindex translating between character sets
11197 @cindex host character set
11198 @cindex target character set
11199
11200 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11201 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11202 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11203 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11204 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11205 @dfn{target character set}.
11206
11207 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11208 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11209 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11210 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11211 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11212 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11213 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11214 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11215 character and string literals in expressions.
11216
11217 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11218 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11219 target-charset} command, described below.
11220
11221 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11222 support:
11223
11224 @table @code
11225 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11226 @kindex set target-charset
11227 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11228 list of supported target character sets, type
11229 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11230
11231 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11232 @kindex set host-charset
11233 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11234
11235 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11236 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11237 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11238 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11239 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11240
11241 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11242 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11243 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11244
11245 @item set charset @var{charset}
11246 @kindex set charset
11247 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11248 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11249 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11250 for both host and target.
11251
11252 @item show charset
11253 @kindex show charset
11254 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11255
11256 @item show host-charset
11257 @kindex show host-charset
11258 Show the name of the current host character set.
11259
11260 @item show target-charset
11261 @kindex show target-charset
11262 Show the name of the current target character set.
11263
11264 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11265 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11266 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11267 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11268 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11269 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11270
11271 @item show target-wide-charset
11272 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11273 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11274 @end table
11275
11276 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11277 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11278 @file{charset-test.c}:
11279
11280 @smallexample
11281 #include <stdio.h>
11282
11283 char ascii_hello[]
11284 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11285 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11286 char ibm1047_hello[]
11287 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11288 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11289
11290 main ()
11291 @{
11292 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11293 @}
11294 @end smallexample
11295
11296 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11297 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11298 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11299
11300 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11301
11302 @smallexample
11303 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11304 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11305 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11306 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11307 @dots{}
11308 (@value{GDBP})
11309 @end smallexample
11310
11311 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11312 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11313 strings:
11314
11315 @smallexample
11316 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11317 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11318 (@value{GDBP})
11319 @end smallexample
11320
11321 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11322 initial character set:
11323 @smallexample
11324 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11325 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11326 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11327 (@value{GDBP})
11328 @end smallexample
11329
11330 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11331 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11332 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11333 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11334 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11335
11336 @smallexample
11337 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11338 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11339 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11340 $2 = 72 'H'
11341 (@value{GDBP})
11342 @end smallexample
11343
11344 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11345 literals you use in expressions:
11346
11347 @smallexample
11348 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11349 $3 = 43 '+'
11350 (@value{GDBP})
11351 @end smallexample
11352
11353 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11354 character.
11355
11356 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11357 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11358 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11359
11360 @smallexample
11361 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11362 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11363 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11364 $5 = 200 '\310'
11365 (@value{GDBP})
11366 @end smallexample
11367
11368 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11369 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11370
11371 @smallexample
11372 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11373 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11374 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11375 @end smallexample
11376
11377 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11378 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11379 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11380 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11381 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11382
11383 @smallexample
11384 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11385 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11386 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11387 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11388 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11389 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11390 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11391 $7 = 72 '\110'
11392 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11393 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11394 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11395 $9 = 200 'H'
11396 (@value{GDBP})
11397 @end smallexample
11398
11399 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11400 string literals you use in expressions:
11401
11402 @smallexample
11403 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11404 $10 = 78 '+'
11405 (@value{GDBP})
11406 @end smallexample
11407
11408 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11409 character.
11410
11411 @node Caching Target Data
11412 @section Caching Data of Targets
11413 @cindex caching data of targets
11414
11415 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11416 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11417 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11418 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11419 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11420 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11421 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11422 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11423 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11424 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11425 is executing.
11426 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11427 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11428 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11429 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11430 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11431 in the code segment.
11432 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11433 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11434
11435 @table @code
11436 @kindex set remotecache
11437 @item set remotecache on
11438 @itemx set remotecache off
11439 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11440 with old scripts.
11441
11442 @kindex show remotecache
11443 @item show remotecache
11444 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11445
11446 @kindex set stack-cache
11447 @item set stack-cache on
11448 @itemx set stack-cache off
11449 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11450 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11451
11452 @kindex show stack-cache
11453 @item show stack-cache
11454 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11455
11456 @kindex set code-cache
11457 @item set code-cache on
11458 @itemx set code-cache off
11459 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11460 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11461 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11462
11463 @kindex show code-cache
11464 @item show code-cache
11465 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11466 accesses.
11467
11468 @kindex info dcache
11469 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11470 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11471 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11472 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11473 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11474 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11475
11476 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11477 printed in hex.
11478
11479 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11480 @cindex dcache size
11481 @kindex set dcache size
11482 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11483
11484 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11485 @cindex dcache line-size
11486 @kindex set dcache line-size
11487 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11488 Must be a power of 2.
11489
11490 @item show dcache size
11491 @kindex show dcache size
11492 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11493
11494 @item show dcache line-size
11495 @kindex show dcache line-size
11496 Show default size of dcache lines.
11497
11498 @end table
11499
11500 @node Searching Memory
11501 @section Search Memory
11502 @cindex searching memory
11503
11504 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11505 @code{find} command.
11506
11507 @table @code
11508 @kindex find
11509 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11510 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11511 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11512 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11513 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11514 @end table
11515
11516 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11517 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11518
11519 @table @r
11520 @item @var{s}, search query size
11521 The size of each search query value.
11522
11523 @table @code
11524 @item b
11525 bytes
11526 @item h
11527 halfwords (two bytes)
11528 @item w
11529 words (four bytes)
11530 @item g
11531 giant words (eight bytes)
11532 @end table
11533
11534 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11535 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11536 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11537
11538 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11539 value's type in the current language.
11540 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11541 pattern as a mixture of types.
11542 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11543 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11544 which is typically four bytes.
11545
11546 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11547 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11548 @end table
11549
11550 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11551 (@code{"}).
11552 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11553 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11554
11555 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11556 number of matches found.
11557
11558 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11559 @samp{$_}.
11560 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11561
11562 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11563
11564 @smallexample
11565 void
11566 hello ()
11567 @{
11568 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11569 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11570 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11571 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11572 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11573 @}
11574 @end smallexample
11575
11576 @noindent
11577 you get during debugging:
11578
11579 @smallexample
11580 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11581 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11582 1 pattern found
11583 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11584 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11585 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11586 2 patterns found
11587 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11588 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11589 1 pattern found
11590 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11591 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11592 1 pattern found
11593 (gdb) print $numfound
11594 $1 = 1
11595 (gdb) print $_
11596 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11597 @end smallexample
11598
11599 @node Optimized Code
11600 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11601 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11602 @cindex debugging optimized code
11603
11604 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11605 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11606 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11607 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11608 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11609 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11610 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11611
11612 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11613 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11614 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11615 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11616
11617 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11618 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11619 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11620 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11621 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11622 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11623
11624 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11625 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11626 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11627 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11628 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11629
11630 @menu
11631 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11632 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11633 @end menu
11634
11635 @node Inline Functions
11636 @section Inline Functions
11637 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11638
11639 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11640 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11641 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11642 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11643 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11644 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11645 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11646 @code{info frame} command.
11647
11648 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11649 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11650 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11651 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11652 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11653 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11654 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11655 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11656 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11657 local variables in the caller.
11658
11659 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11660 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11661 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11662 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11663 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11664 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11665 instructions are executed.
11666
11667 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11668 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11669 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11670 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11671
11672 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11673 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11674
11675 @itemize @bullet
11676 @item
11677 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11678 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11679 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11680 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11681 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11682 or inside the inlined function instead.
11683
11684 @item
11685 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11686 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11687 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11688 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11689
11690 @end itemize
11691
11692 @node Tail Call Frames
11693 @section Tail Call Frames
11694 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
11695
11696 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
11697 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
11698 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
11699 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
11700 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
11701
11702 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
11703 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
11704 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
11705 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
11706 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
11707 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
11708 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
11709
11710 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
11711 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
11712 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
11713 this information.
11714
11715 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
11716 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
11717
11718 @smallexample
11719 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
11720 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
11721 (gdb) info frame
11722 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
11723 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
11724 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
11725 source language c++.
11726 Arglist at unknown address.
11727 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
11728 @end smallexample
11729
11730 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
11731 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
11732 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
11733 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
11734 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
11735 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
11736
11737 @table @code
11738 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
11739 @item set debug entry-values
11740 @kindex set debug entry-values
11741 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
11742 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
11743 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
11744 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
11745 result.
11746
11747 @item show debug entry-values
11748 @kindex show debug entry-values
11749 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
11750 values at function entry and tail calls.
11751 @end table
11752
11753 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
11754 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
11755 reference by variable @code{x}):
11756
11757 @smallexample
11758 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
11759 void (*x) (void) = c;
11760 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11761 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
11762 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
11763
11764 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
11765 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
11766 a () at t.c:3
11767 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11768 (gdb) bt
11769 #0 a () at t.c:3
11770 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
11771 @end smallexample
11772
11773 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
11774
11775 @smallexample
11776 int i;
11777 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
11778 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
11779 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
11780 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
11781 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
11782 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
11783 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
11784 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
11785
11786 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
11787 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
11788 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
11789 (gdb) bt
11790 #0 f () at t.c:2
11791 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
11792 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
11793 @end smallexample
11794
11795 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
11796 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
11797
11798 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
11799 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11800 @set ARROW @click{}
11801 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
11802 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
11803 @end ifset
11804 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11805 @set ARROW ->
11806 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
11807 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
11808 @end ifclear
11809
11810 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
11811 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
11812 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
11813
11814 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
11815 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
11816 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
11817 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
11818 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
11819 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
11820
11821 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
11822 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
11823 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
11824 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
11825 omitted.
11826
11827 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
11828 entry may fail:
11829
11830 @smallexample
11831 int v;
11832 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
11833 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
11834 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
11835 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
11836 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
11837 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
11838
11839 (gdb) bt
11840 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
11841 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
11842 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
11843 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
11844 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
11845 @end smallexample
11846
11847 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
11848 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
11849 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
11850 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
11851 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
11852
11853 @node Macros
11854 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
11855
11856 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
11857 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
11858 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
11859 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
11860 where it was defined.
11861
11862 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
11863 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
11864 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
11865 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
11866
11867 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
11868 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
11869 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
11870 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
11871 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
11872 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
11873 see @ref{List}.
11874
11875 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
11876 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
11877 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
11878
11879 @table @code
11880
11881 @kindex macro expand
11882 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
11883 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
11884 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
11885 @item macro expand @var{expression}
11886 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
11887 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
11888 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
11889 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
11890 it can be any string of tokens.
11891
11892 @kindex macro exp1
11893 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
11894 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
11895 @cindex expand macro once
11896 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
11897 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
11898 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
11899 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
11900 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
11901 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
11902 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
11903 can be any string of tokens.
11904
11905 @kindex info macro
11906 @cindex macro definition, showing
11907 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
11908 @cindex macros, from debug info
11909 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
11910 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
11911 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
11912 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
11913 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
11914 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
11915
11916 @kindex info macros
11917 @item info macros @var{location}
11918 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
11919 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
11920 command-line where those definitions were established.
11921
11922 @kindex macro define
11923 @cindex user-defined macros
11924 @cindex defining macros interactively
11925 @cindex macros, user-defined
11926 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
11927 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
11928 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
11929 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
11930 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
11931 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
11932 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
11933 @var{arglist}.
11934
11935 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
11936 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
11937 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
11938 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
11939 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
11940
11941 @kindex macro undef
11942 @item macro undef @var{macro}
11943 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
11944 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
11945 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
11946 in the program being debugged.
11947
11948 @kindex macro list
11949 @item macro list
11950 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
11951 @end table
11952
11953 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
11954 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
11955 show our source files:
11956
11957 @smallexample
11958 $ cat sample.c
11959 #include <stdio.h>
11960 #include "sample.h"
11961
11962 #define M 42
11963 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11964
11965 main ()
11966 @{
11967 #define N 28
11968 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11969 #undef N
11970 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11971 #define N 1729
11972 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11973 @}
11974 $ cat sample.h
11975 #define Q <
11976 $
11977 @end smallexample
11978
11979 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
11980 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
11981 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
11982 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
11983 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
11984 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
11985 information.
11986
11987 @smallexample
11988 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
11989 $
11990 @end smallexample
11991
11992 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
11993
11994 @smallexample
11995 $ gdb -nw sample
11996 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
11997 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11998 GDB is free software, @dots{}
11999 (@value{GDBP})
12000 @end smallexample
12001
12002 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12003 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12004 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12005
12006 @smallexample
12007 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12008 3
12009 4 #define M 42
12010 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12011 6
12012 7 main ()
12013 8 @{
12014 9 #define N 28
12015 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12016 11 #undef N
12017 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12018 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12019 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12020 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12021 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12022 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12023 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12024 #define Q <
12025 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12026 expands to: (42 + 1)
12027 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12028 expands to: once (M + 1)
12029 (@value{GDBP})
12030 @end smallexample
12031
12032 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12033 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12034 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12035 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12036
12037 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12038 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12039
12040 @smallexample
12041 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12042 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12043 (@value{GDBP}) run
12044 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12045
12046 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12047 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12048 (@value{GDBP})
12049 @end smallexample
12050
12051 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12052
12053 @smallexample
12054 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12055 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12056 #define N 28
12057 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12058 expands to: 28 < 42
12059 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12060 $1 = 1
12061 (@value{GDBP})
12062 @end smallexample
12063
12064 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12065 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12066 thereof) in force at each point:
12067
12068 @smallexample
12069 (@value{GDBP}) next
12070 Hello, world!
12071 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12072 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12073 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12074 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12075 (@value{GDBP}) next
12076 We're so creative.
12077 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12078 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12079 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12080 #define N 1729
12081 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12082 expands to: 1729 < 42
12083 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12084 $2 = 0
12085 (@value{GDBP})
12086 @end smallexample
12087
12088 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12089 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12090 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12091 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12092
12093 @smallexample
12094 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12095 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12096 -D__STDC__=1
12097 (@value{GDBP})
12098 @end smallexample
12099
12100
12101 @node Tracepoints
12102 @chapter Tracepoints
12103 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12104 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12105
12106 @cindex tracepoints
12107 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12108 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12109 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12110 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12111 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12112 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12113 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12114
12115 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12116 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12117 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12118 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12119 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12120 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12121 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12122 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12123 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12124 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12125 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12126
12127 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12128 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12129 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12130 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12131 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12132 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12133 Packets}.
12134
12135 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12136 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12137 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12138
12139 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12140
12141 @menu
12142 * Set Tracepoints::
12143 * Analyze Collected Data::
12144 * Tracepoint Variables::
12145 * Trace Files::
12146 @end menu
12147
12148 @node Set Tracepoints
12149 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12150
12151 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12152 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12153 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12154 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12155 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12156 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12157 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12158
12159 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12160 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12161 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12162 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12163 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12164 tracepoint was hit.
12165
12166 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12167 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12168 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12169 either.
12170
12171 @cindex fast tracepoints
12172 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12173 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12174 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12175
12176 @cindex static tracepoints
12177 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
12178 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12179 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12180 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12181 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12182 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12183 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12184 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12185 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12186 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12187 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12188 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12189 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12190 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12191 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12192 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12193 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12194 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12195 static tracepoint marker.
12196
12197 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12198 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12199
12200 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12201 conditions and actions.
12202
12203 @menu
12204 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12205 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12206 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12207 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12208 * Trace State Variables::
12209 * Tracepoint Actions::
12210 * Listing Tracepoints::
12211 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12212 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12213 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
12214 @end menu
12215
12216 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12217 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12218
12219 @table @code
12220 @cindex set tracepoint
12221 @kindex trace
12222 @item trace @var{location}
12223 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12224 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
12225 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
12226 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
12227 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
12228 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12229 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12230 in tracing}).
12231 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12232 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12233 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12234 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12235 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12236 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12237 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12238 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12239 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12240 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12241 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12242 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12243
12244 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12245
12246 @smallexample
12247 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12248
12249 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12250
12251 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12252
12253 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12254
12255 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12256 @end smallexample
12257
12258 @noindent
12259 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12260
12261 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12262 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12263 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12264 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12265 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12266 information on tracepoint conditions.
12267
12268 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12269 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12270 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12271 @kindex ftrace
12272 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12273 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12274 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12275 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12276 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12277 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12278 message.
12279
12280 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12281 @code{trace}.
12282
12283 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12284 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12285 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12286 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12287 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12288 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12289 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12290 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12291
12292 @example
12293 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12294 @end example
12295
12296 @noindent
12297 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12298 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12299
12300 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12301 @cindex set static tracepoint
12302 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12303 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12304 @kindex strace
12305 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12306 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12307 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12308 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12309 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12310
12311 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12312 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12313 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12314 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12315 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12316 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12317 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12318 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12319 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12320 tracing engine:
12321
12322 @smallexample
12323 main ()
12324 @{
12325 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12326 @}
12327 @end smallexample
12328
12329 @noindent
12330 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12331 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12332
12333 @smallexample
12334 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12335 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12336 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12337 Data: "str %s"
12338 [etc...]
12339 @end smallexample
12340
12341 @noindent
12342 so you may probe the marker above with:
12343
12344 @smallexample
12345 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12346 @end smallexample
12347
12348 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12349 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12350 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12351 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12352 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12353 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12354 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12355 the @samp{Data:} field.
12356
12357 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12358 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12359 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12360
12361 @vindex $tpnum
12362 @cindex last tracepoint number
12363 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12364 @cindex tracepoint number
12365 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12366 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12367
12368 @kindex delete tracepoint
12369 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12370 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12371 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12372 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12373 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12374
12375 Examples:
12376
12377 @smallexample
12378 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12379
12380 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12381 @end smallexample
12382
12383 @noindent
12384 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12385 @end table
12386
12387 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12388 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12389
12390 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12391
12392 @table @code
12393 @kindex disable tracepoint
12394 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12395 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12396 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12397 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12398 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12399 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12400 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12401 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12402 next trace experiment.
12403
12404 @kindex enable tracepoint
12405 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12406 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12407 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12408 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12409 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12410 next time a trace experiment is run.
12411 @end table
12412
12413 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12414 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12415
12416 @table @code
12417 @kindex passcount
12418 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12419 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12420 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12421 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12422 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12423 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12424 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12425 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12426 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12427 user.
12428
12429 Examples:
12430
12431 @smallexample
12432 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12433 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12434
12435 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12436 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12437 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12438 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12439 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12440 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12441 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12442 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12443 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12444 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12445 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12446 @end smallexample
12447 @end table
12448
12449 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12450 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12451 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12452 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12453
12454 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12455 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12456 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12457 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12458 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12459 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12460 is true.
12461
12462 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12463 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12464 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12465 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12466 just as with breakpoints.
12467
12468 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12469 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12470 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12471 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12472 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12473 accesses, and so forth.
12474
12475 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12476 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12477 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12478 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12479 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12480 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12481 search through.
12482
12483 @smallexample
12484 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12485 @end smallexample
12486
12487 @node Trace State Variables
12488 @subsection Trace State Variables
12489 @cindex trace state variables
12490
12491 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12492 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12493 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12494 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12495 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12496 integers.
12497
12498 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12499 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12500 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12501 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12502
12503 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12504 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12505 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12506 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12507 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12508 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12509 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12510 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12511 variable with the same name.
12512
12513 @table @code
12514
12515 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12516 @kindex tvariable
12517 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12518 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12519 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12520 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12521 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12522 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12523 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12524 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12525 value. The default initial value is 0.
12526
12527 @item info tvariables
12528 @kindex info tvariables
12529 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12530 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12531 currently running.
12532
12533 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12534 @kindex delete tvariable
12535 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12536 are specified.
12537
12538 @end table
12539
12540 @node Tracepoint Actions
12541 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12542
12543 @table @code
12544 @kindex actions
12545 @cindex tracepoint actions
12546 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12547 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12548 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12549 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12550 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12551 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12552 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12553 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12554 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12555 @code{while-stepping}.
12556
12557 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12558 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12559 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12560
12561 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12562 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12563 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12564
12565 @smallexample
12566 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12567
12568 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12569
12570 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12571 @end smallexample
12572
12573 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12574 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12575 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12576 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12577 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12578 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12579 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12580 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12581
12582 @smallexample
12583 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12584 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12585 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12586 > collect bar,baz
12587 > collect $regs
12588 > while-stepping 12
12589 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12590 > end
12591 end
12592 @end smallexample
12593
12594 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12595 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12596 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12597 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12598 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12599 special arguments are supported:
12600
12601 @table @code
12602 @item $regs
12603 Collect all registers.
12604
12605 @item $args
12606 Collect all function arguments.
12607
12608 @item $locals
12609 Collect all local variables.
12610
12611 @item $_ret
12612 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12613 of a backtrace.
12614
12615 @item $_probe_argc
12616 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12617 tracepoint is located.
12618 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12619
12620 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12621 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12622 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12623 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12624
12625 @item $_sdata
12626 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12627 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12628 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12629 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12630 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12631 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12632 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12633 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12634 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12635
12636 @smallexample
12637 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12638 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12639 @end smallexample
12640
12641 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12642 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12643 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12644 @value{GDBN}.
12645 @end table
12646
12647 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12648 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12649 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12650
12651 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12652 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12653 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12654 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12655 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12656 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12657 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12658 @samp{mystr}.
12659
12660 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12661 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12662
12663 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12664 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12665 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12666 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12667 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12668 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12669 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12670 action were used.
12671
12672 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12673 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12674 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12675 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
12676 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12677 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
12678
12679 @smallexample
12680 > while-stepping 12
12681 > collect $regs, myglobal
12682 > end
12683 >
12684 @end smallexample
12685
12686 @noindent
12687 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
12688 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
12689 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
12690 @code{stepping}.
12691
12692 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12693 @kindex set default-collect
12694 @cindex default collection action
12695 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
12696 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
12697 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
12698 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
12699 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
12700 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
12701
12702 @item show default-collect
12703 @kindex show default-collect
12704 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
12705 tracepoint hit.
12706
12707 @end table
12708
12709 @node Listing Tracepoints
12710 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
12711
12712 @table @code
12713 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12714 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12715 @cindex information about tracepoints
12716 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
12717 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
12718 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
12719 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
12720 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
12721 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
12722
12723 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
12724 tracing:
12725
12726 @itemize @bullet
12727 @item
12728 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
12729
12730 @item
12731 the state about installed on target of each location
12732 @end itemize
12733
12734 @smallexample
12735 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
12736 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
12737 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
12738 while-stepping 20
12739 collect globfoo, $regs
12740 end
12741 collect globfoo2
12742 end
12743 pass count 1200
12744 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
12745 collect $eip
12746 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12747 installed on target
12748 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12749 installed on target
12750 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
12751 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
12752 not installed on target
12753 (@value{GDBP})
12754 @end smallexample
12755
12756 @noindent
12757 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
12758 @end table
12759
12760 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12761 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12762
12763 @table @code
12764 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
12765 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
12766 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
12767 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
12768 program.
12769
12770 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
12771
12772 @table @emph
12773 @item Count
12774 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
12775 stable identifier.
12776 @item ID
12777 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
12778 @item Enabled or Disabled
12779 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
12780 that are not enabled.
12781 @item Address
12782 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
12783 @item What
12784 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
12785 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
12786 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
12787 will be left blank.
12788 @end table
12789
12790 @noindent
12791 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
12792
12793 @table @emph
12794 @item Data
12795 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
12796 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
12797 marker call.
12798 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
12799 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
12800 @end table
12801
12802 @smallexample
12803 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12804 Cnt ID Enb Address What
12805 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
12806 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
12807 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
12808 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
12809 Data: str %s
12810 (@value{GDBP})
12811 @end smallexample
12812 @end table
12813
12814 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12815 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12816
12817 @table @code
12818 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
12819 @cindex start a new trace experiment
12820 @cindex collected data discarded
12821 @item tstart
12822 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
12823 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
12824 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
12825 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
12826 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
12827 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
12828 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
12829 information, and so forth.
12830
12831 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
12832 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
12833 @item tstop
12834 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
12835 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
12836 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
12837 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
12838 needs to be stopped quickly.
12839
12840 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
12841 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
12842 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
12843
12844 @kindex tstatus
12845 @cindex status of trace data collection
12846 @cindex trace experiment, status of
12847 @item tstatus
12848 This command displays the status of the current trace data
12849 collection.
12850 @end table
12851
12852 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
12853
12854 @smallexample
12855 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
12856 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12857 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
12858 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
12859 > while-stepping 11
12860 > collect $regs
12861 > end
12862 > end
12863 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12864 [time passes @dots{}]
12865 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
12866 @end smallexample
12867
12868 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
12869 @cindex disconnected tracing
12870 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
12871 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
12872 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
12873 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
12874 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
12875 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
12876 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
12877 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
12878
12879 @table @code
12880 @item set disconnected-tracing on
12881 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
12882 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
12883 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
12884 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
12885 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
12886 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
12887 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
12888
12889 @item show disconnected-tracing
12890 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
12891 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
12892
12893 @end table
12894
12895 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
12896 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
12897 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
12898 it will continue after reconnection.
12899
12900 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
12901 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
12902 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
12903 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
12904 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
12905 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
12906 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
12907 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
12908 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
12909 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
12910
12911 @cindex circular trace buffer
12912 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
12913 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
12914 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
12915 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
12916 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
12917 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
12918 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
12919 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
12920 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
12921 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
12922 the next run.
12923
12924 @table @code
12925 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
12926 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
12927 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
12928 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
12929 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
12930 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
12931 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
12932
12933 @item show circular-trace-buffer
12934 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
12935 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
12936 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
12937 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
12938 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
12939
12940 @end table
12941
12942 @table @code
12943 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
12944 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
12945 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
12946 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
12947 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
12948 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
12949 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
12950 likes. This is also the default.
12951
12952 @item show trace-buffer-size
12953 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
12954 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
12955 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
12956 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
12957 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
12958 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
12959 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
12960 @end table
12961
12962 @table @code
12963 @item set trace-user @var{text}
12964 @kindex set trace-user
12965
12966 @item show trace-user
12967 @kindex show trace-user
12968
12969 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
12970 @kindex set trace-notes
12971 Set the trace run's notes.
12972
12973 @item show trace-notes
12974 @kindex show trace-notes
12975 Show the trace run's notes.
12976
12977 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
12978 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
12979 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
12980 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
12981 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
12982
12983 @item show trace-stop-notes
12984 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
12985 Show the trace run's stop notes.
12986
12987 @end table
12988
12989 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
12990 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
12991
12992 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
12993 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
12994 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
12995 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
12996 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
12997 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
12998 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
12999 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13000 mentioned here.
13001
13002 @itemize @bullet
13003
13004 @item
13005 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13006 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13007 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13008 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13009 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13010 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13011 cannot be collected either.
13012
13013 @item
13014 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13015 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13016 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13017 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13018 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13019 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13020 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13021 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13022 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13023 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13024
13025 @item
13026 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13027 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13028 in a misleading way.
13029
13030 @item
13031 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13032 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13033 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13034 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13035 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13036 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13037 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13038 by @code{ptr}.
13039
13040 @item
13041 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13042 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13043 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13044 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13045 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13046 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13047 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13048 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13049 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13050 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13051 invalid address.
13052
13053 @item
13054 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13055 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13056 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13057 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13058 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13059 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13060 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13061 it to zero.
13062
13063 @end itemize
13064
13065 @node Analyze Collected Data
13066 @section Using the Collected Data
13067
13068 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13069 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13070 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13071 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13072 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13073 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13074 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13075 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13076 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13077 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13078 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13079 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13080 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13081 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13082 the buffer will fail.
13083
13084 @menu
13085 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13086 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13087 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13088 @end menu
13089
13090 @node tfind
13091 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13092
13093 @kindex tfind
13094 @cindex select trace snapshot
13095 @cindex find trace snapshot
13096 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13097 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13098 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13099 snapshot is selected.
13100
13101 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13102
13103 @table @code
13104 @item tfind start
13105 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13106 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13107
13108 @item tfind none
13109 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13110
13111 @item tfind end
13112 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13113
13114 @item tfind
13115 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
13116
13117 @item tfind -
13118 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13119 retracing earlier steps.
13120
13121 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13122 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13123 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13124 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13125 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13126
13127 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13128 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13129 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13130 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13131 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13132
13133 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13134 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13135 addresses (exclusive).
13136
13137 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13138 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13139 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
13140
13141 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13142 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13143 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13144 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13145 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13146 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13147 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13148 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13149 @end table
13150
13151 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13152 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13153 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13154 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13155 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13156 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13157 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13158 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13159 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13160 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13161 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13162 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13163 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13164 tracepoint as the current one.
13165
13166 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13167 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13168 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13169 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13170 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13171
13172 @smallexample
13173 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13174 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13175 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13176 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13177 > tfind
13178 > end
13179
13180 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13181 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13182 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13183 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13184 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13185 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13186 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13187 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13188 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13189 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13190 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13191 @end smallexample
13192
13193 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13194 the buffer:
13195
13196 @smallexample
13197 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13198 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13199 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13200 > tfind line
13201 > end
13202
13203 Frame 0, X = 1
13204 Frame 7, X = 2
13205 Frame 13, X = 255
13206 @end smallexample
13207
13208 @node tdump
13209 @subsection @code{tdump}
13210 @kindex tdump
13211 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13212 @cindex tracepoint data, display
13213
13214 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13215 the current trace snapshot.
13216
13217 @smallexample
13218 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13219 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13220 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13221 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13222 > end
13223
13224 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13225
13226 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13227 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13228 at gdb_test.c:444
13229 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13230
13231 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13232 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13233 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13234 d1 0x18 24
13235 d2 0x80 128
13236 d3 0x33 51
13237 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13238 d5 0x22 34
13239 d6 0xe0 224
13240 d7 0x380035 3670069
13241 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13242 a1 0x3000668 50333288
13243 a2 0x100 256
13244 a3 0x322000 3284992
13245 a4 0x3000698 50333336
13246 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13247 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13248 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13249 ps 0x0 0
13250 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13251 fpcontrol 0x0 0
13252 fpstatus 0x0 0
13253 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13254 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13255 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13256 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13257 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13258 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13259 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13260 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13261 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13262
13263 (@value{GDBP})
13264 @end smallexample
13265
13266 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13267 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13268 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13269 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13270
13271 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13272 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13273 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13274 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13275 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13276 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13277 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13278 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13279 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13280 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13281
13282 @node save tracepoints
13283 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13284 @kindex save tracepoints
13285 @kindex save-tracepoints
13286 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13287
13288 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13289 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13290 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13291 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13292 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13293 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13294
13295 @node Tracepoint Variables
13296 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13297 @cindex tracepoint variables
13298 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13299
13300 @table @code
13301 @vindex $trace_frame
13302 @item (int) $trace_frame
13303 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13304 snapshot is selected.
13305
13306 @vindex $tracepoint
13307 @item (int) $tracepoint
13308 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13309
13310 @vindex $trace_line
13311 @item (int) $trace_line
13312 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13313
13314 @vindex $trace_file
13315 @item (char []) $trace_file
13316 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13317
13318 @vindex $trace_func
13319 @item (char []) $trace_func
13320 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13321 @end table
13322
13323 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13324 use @code{output} instead.
13325
13326 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13327 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13328 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13329 which are managed by the target.
13330
13331 @smallexample
13332 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13333
13334 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13335 > output $trace_file
13336 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13337 > tfind
13338 > end
13339 @end smallexample
13340
13341 @node Trace Files
13342 @section Using Trace Files
13343 @cindex trace files
13344
13345 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13346 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13347 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13348 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13349 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13350
13351 @table @code
13352
13353 @kindex tsave
13354 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13355 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13356 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13357 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13358 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13359 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13360 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13361 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13362 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13363 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13364 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13365 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF
13366 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13367 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13368 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13369
13370 @kindex target tfile
13371 @kindex tfile
13372 @kindex target ctf
13373 @kindex ctf
13374 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13375 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13376 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13377 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13378 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13379 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13380 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13381 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13382 the host.
13383
13384 @smallexample
13385 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13386 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13387 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13388 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13389 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13390 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13391 i = 0
13392 a = 0
13393 b = 1 '\001'
13394 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13395 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13396 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13397 $1 = 1
13398 @end smallexample
13399
13400 @end table
13401
13402 @node Overlays
13403 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13404 @cindex overlays
13405
13406 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13407 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13408 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13409 use overlays.
13410
13411 @menu
13412 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13413 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13414 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13415 mapped by asking the inferior.
13416 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13417 @end menu
13418
13419 @node How Overlays Work
13420 @section How Overlays Work
13421 @cindex mapped overlays
13422 @cindex unmapped overlays
13423 @cindex load address, overlay's
13424 @cindex mapped address
13425 @cindex overlay area
13426
13427 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13428 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13429 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13430 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13431 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13432
13433 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13434 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13435 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13436 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13437 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13438 largest overlay as well.
13439
13440 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13441 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13442 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13443 there.
13444
13445 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13446 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13447 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13448
13449 @smallexample
13450 @group
13451 Data Instruction Larger
13452 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13453 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13454 | | | | | |
13455 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13456 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13457 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13458 | and heap | | | | | |
13459 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13460 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13461 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13462 | | | | | |
13463 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13464 address | | | | | |
13465 | overlay | <-' | | |
13466 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13467 | | <---. | | load address
13468 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13469 | | | |
13470 +-----------+ | |
13471 +-----------+
13472 | |
13473 +-----------+
13474
13475 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13476 @end group
13477 @end smallexample
13478
13479 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13480 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13481 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13482 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13483 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13484 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13485 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13486 program and the overlay area.
13487
13488 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13489 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13490 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13491 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13492 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13493 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13494 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13495
13496 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13497 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13498 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13499
13500 @itemize @bullet
13501
13502 @item
13503 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13504 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13505 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13506 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13507
13508 @item
13509 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13510 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13511 your program's performance.
13512
13513 @item
13514 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13515 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13516 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13517 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13518 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13519 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13520 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13521
13522 @item
13523 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13524 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13525 instruction and data spaces.
13526
13527 @end itemize
13528
13529 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13530 improved in many ways:
13531
13532 @itemize @bullet
13533
13534 @item
13535 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13536 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13537 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13538 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13539 area in the usual way.
13540
13541 @item
13542 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13543 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13544
13545 @item
13546 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13547 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13548 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13549 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13550 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13551 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13552 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13553
13554 @end itemize
13555
13556
13557 @node Overlay Commands
13558 @section Overlay Commands
13559
13560 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13561 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13562 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13563 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13564 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13565 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13566
13567 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13568 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13569
13570 @table @code
13571 @item overlay off
13572 @kindex overlay
13573 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13574 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13575 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13576 overlay support is disabled.
13577
13578 @item overlay manual
13579 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13580 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13581 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13582 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13583 commands described below.
13584
13585 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13586 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13587 @cindex map an overlay
13588 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13589 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13590 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13591 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13592 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13593 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13594
13595 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13596 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13597 @cindex unmap an overlay
13598 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13599 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13600 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13601 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13602
13603 @item overlay auto
13604 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13605 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13606 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13607 Overlay Debugging}.
13608
13609 @item overlay load-target
13610 @itemx overlay load
13611 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13612 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13613 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13614 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13615 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13616 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13617
13618 @item overlay list-overlays
13619 @itemx overlay list
13620 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13621 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13622 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13623
13624 @end table
13625
13626 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13627 of the function the address falls in:
13628
13629 @smallexample
13630 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13631 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13632 @end smallexample
13633 @noindent
13634 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13635 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13636 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13637 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13638
13639 @smallexample
13640 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13641 No sections are mapped.
13642 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13643 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13644 @end smallexample
13645 @noindent
13646 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13647 name normally:
13648
13649 @smallexample
13650 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13651 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13652 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13653 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13654 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13655 @end smallexample
13656
13657 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13658 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13659 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13660 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13661 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13662
13663 @itemize @bullet
13664 @item
13665 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13666 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13667 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13668 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13669 @item
13670 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13671 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13672 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13673 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13674 breakpoints properly.
13675 @end itemize
13676
13677
13678 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13679 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13680 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
13681
13682 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13683 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
13684 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
13685 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
13686 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
13687 current state of the overlays.
13688
13689 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
13690 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
13691
13692 @table @asis
13693
13694 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
13695 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
13696
13697 @smallexample
13698 struct
13699 @{
13700 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
13701 unsigned long vma;
13702
13703 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
13704 unsigned long size;
13705
13706 /* The overlay's load address. */
13707 unsigned long lma;
13708
13709 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
13710 zero otherwise. */
13711 unsigned long mapped;
13712 @}
13713 @end smallexample
13714
13715 @item @code{_novlys}:
13716 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
13717 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
13718
13719 @end table
13720
13721 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
13722 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
13723 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
13724 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
13725 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
13726 currently mapped.
13727
13728 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
13729 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
13730 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
13731 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
13732 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
13733 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
13734 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
13735 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
13736 are not being executed.
13737
13738 @node Overlay Sample Program
13739 @section Overlay Sample Program
13740 @cindex overlay example program
13741
13742 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
13743 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
13744 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
13745 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
13746 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
13747 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
13748 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
13749
13750 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
13751 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
13752 suite. The program consists of the following files from
13753 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
13754
13755 @table @file
13756 @item overlays.c
13757 The main program file.
13758 @item ovlymgr.c
13759 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
13760 @item foo.c
13761 @itemx bar.c
13762 @itemx baz.c
13763 @itemx grbx.c
13764 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
13765 @item d10v.ld
13766 @itemx m32r.ld
13767 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
13768 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
13769 @end table
13770
13771 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
13772 cross-compiler like this:
13773
13774 @smallexample
13775 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
13776 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
13777 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
13778 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
13779 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
13780 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
13781 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
13782 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
13783 @end smallexample
13784
13785 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
13786 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
13787 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
13788
13789
13790 @node Languages
13791 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
13792 @cindex languages
13793
13794 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
13795 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
13796 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
13797 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
13798 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
13799 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
13800
13801 @cindex working language
13802 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
13803 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
13804 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
13805 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
13806 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
13807 language}.
13808
13809 @menu
13810 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
13811 * Show:: Displaying the language
13812 * Checks:: Type and range checks
13813 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
13814 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
13815 @end menu
13816
13817 @node Setting
13818 @section Switching Between Source Languages
13819
13820 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
13821 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
13822 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
13823 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
13824 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
13825 are printed, etc.
13826
13827 In addition to the working language, every source file that
13828 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
13829 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
13830 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
13831 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
13832 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
13833 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
13834 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
13835 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
13836 Displaying the Language}.
13837
13838 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
13839 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
13840 another language. In that case, make the
13841 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
13842 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
13843 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
13844
13845 @menu
13846 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
13847 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
13848 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
13849 @end menu
13850
13851 @node Filenames
13852 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
13853
13854 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
13855 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
13856
13857 @table @file
13858 @item .ada
13859 @itemx .ads
13860 @itemx .adb
13861 @itemx .a
13862 Ada source file.
13863
13864 @item .c
13865 C source file
13866
13867 @item .C
13868 @itemx .cc
13869 @itemx .cp
13870 @itemx .cpp
13871 @itemx .cxx
13872 @itemx .c++
13873 C@t{++} source file
13874
13875 @item .d
13876 D source file
13877
13878 @item .m
13879 Objective-C source file
13880
13881 @item .f
13882 @itemx .F
13883 Fortran source file
13884
13885 @item .mod
13886 Modula-2 source file
13887
13888 @item .s
13889 @itemx .S
13890 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
13891 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
13892 @end table
13893
13894 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
13895 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
13896
13897 @node Manually
13898 @subsection Setting the Working Language
13899
13900 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
13901 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
13902 your program.
13903
13904 @kindex set language
13905 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
13906 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
13907 a language, such as
13908 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
13909 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
13910
13911 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
13912 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
13913 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
13914 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
13915 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
13916 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
13917 command such as:
13918
13919 @smallexample
13920 print a = b + c
13921 @end smallexample
13922
13923 @noindent
13924 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
13925 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
13926 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
13927 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
13928
13929 @node Automatically
13930 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
13931
13932 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
13933 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
13934 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
13935 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
13936 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
13937 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
13938 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
13939 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
13940 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
13941
13942 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
13943 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
13944 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
13945 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
13946 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
13947
13948 @node Show
13949 @section Displaying the Language
13950
13951 The following commands help you find out which language is the
13952 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
13953
13954 @table @code
13955 @item show language
13956 @anchor{show language}
13957 @kindex show language
13958 Display the current working language. This is the
13959 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
13960 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
13961
13962 @item info frame
13963 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
13964 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
13965 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
13966 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
13967 information listed here.
13968
13969 @item info source
13970 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
13971 Display the source language of this source file.
13972 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
13973 information listed here.
13974 @end table
13975
13976 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
13977 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
13978 with a language explicitly:
13979
13980 @table @code
13981 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
13982 @kindex set extension-language
13983 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
13984 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
13985
13986 @item info extensions
13987 @kindex info extensions
13988 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
13989 @end table
13990
13991 @node Checks
13992 @section Type and Range Checking
13993
13994 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
13995 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
13996 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
13997 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
13998 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
13999 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14000 errors when your program is running.
14001
14002 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14003 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14004 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14005 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14006
14007 @menu
14008 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14009 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14010 @end menu
14011
14012 @cindex type checking
14013 @cindex checks, type
14014 @node Type Checking
14015 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14016
14017 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14018 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14019 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14020 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14021
14022 @smallexample
14023 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14024
14025 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14026 $1 = 2
14027 @exdent but
14028 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14029 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14030 @end smallexample
14031
14032 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14033 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14034
14035 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14036 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14037 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14038 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14039 expressions like the second example above.
14040
14041 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14042 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14043 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14044 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14045 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14046 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14047
14048 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14049
14050 @kindex set check type
14051 @kindex show check type
14052 @table @code
14053 @item set check type on
14054 @itemx set check type off
14055 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14056 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14057 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14058
14059 @item show check type
14060 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14061 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14062 @end table
14063
14064 @cindex range checking
14065 @cindex checks, range
14066 @node Range Checking
14067 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14068
14069 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14070 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14071 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14072 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14073 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14074
14075 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14076 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14077 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14078 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14079
14080 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14081 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14082 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14083 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14084 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14085 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14086
14087 @smallexample
14088 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14089 @end smallexample
14090
14091 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14092 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14093 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14094
14095 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14096
14097 @kindex set check range
14098 @kindex show check range
14099 @table @code
14100 @item set check range auto
14101 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14102 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14103 each language.
14104
14105 @item set check range on
14106 @itemx set check range off
14107 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14108 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14109 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14110 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14111
14112 @item set check range warn
14113 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14114 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14115 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14116 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14117 systems).
14118
14119 @item show range
14120 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14121 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14122 @end table
14123
14124 @node Supported Languages
14125 @section Supported Languages
14126
14127 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
14128 OpenCL C, Pascal, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14129 @c This is false ...
14130 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14131 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14132 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14133 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14134 language.
14135
14136 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14137 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14138 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14139 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14140 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14141 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14142 language reference or tutorial.
14143
14144 @menu
14145 * C:: C and C@t{++}
14146 * D:: D
14147 * Go:: Go
14148 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
14149 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14150 * Fortran:: Fortran
14151 * Pascal:: Pascal
14152 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
14153 * Ada:: Ada
14154 @end menu
14155
14156 @node C
14157 @subsection C and C@t{++}
14158
14159 @cindex C and C@t{++}
14160 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14161
14162 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14163 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14164 together.
14165
14166 @cindex C@t{++}
14167 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14168 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14169 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14170 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14171 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14172 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14173 compiler (@code{aCC}).
14174
14175 @menu
14176 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14177 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14178 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14179 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14180 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14181 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14182 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14183 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14184 @end menu
14185
14186 @node C Operators
14187 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14188
14189 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14190
14191 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14192 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14193 often defined on groups of types.
14194
14195 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14196
14197 @itemize @bullet
14198
14199 @item
14200 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14201 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14202
14203 @item
14204 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14205 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14206
14207 @item
14208 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14209
14210 @item
14211 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14212
14213 @end itemize
14214
14215 @noindent
14216 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14217 in order of increasing precedence:
14218
14219 @table @code
14220 @item ,
14221 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14222 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14223 expression being the last expression evaluated.
14224
14225 @item =
14226 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14227 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14228
14229 @item @var{op}=
14230 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14231 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14232 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14233 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14234 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14235
14236 @item ?:
14237 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14238 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14239 should be of an integral type.
14240
14241 @item ||
14242 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14243
14244 @item &&
14245 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14246
14247 @item |
14248 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14249
14250 @item ^
14251 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14252
14253 @item &
14254 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14255
14256 @item ==@r{, }!=
14257 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14258 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14259
14260 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14261 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14262 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14263 and non-zero for true.
14264
14265 @item <<@r{, }>>
14266 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14267
14268 @item @@
14269 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14270
14271 @item +@r{, }-
14272 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14273 pointer types.
14274
14275 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14276 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14277 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14278 integral types.
14279
14280 @item ++@r{, }--
14281 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14282 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14283 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14284 operation takes place.
14285
14286 @item *
14287 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14288 @code{++}.
14289
14290 @item &
14291 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14292
14293 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14294 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14295 to examine the address
14296 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14297 stored.
14298
14299 @item -
14300 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14301 precedence as @code{++}.
14302
14303 @item !
14304 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14305 @code{++}.
14306
14307 @item ~
14308 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14309 @code{++}.
14310
14311
14312 @item .@r{, }->
14313 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14314 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14315 pointer based on the stored type information.
14316 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14317
14318 @item .*@r{, }->*
14319 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14320
14321 @item []
14322 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14323 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14324
14325 @item ()
14326 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14327
14328 @item ::
14329 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14330 and @code{class} types.
14331
14332 @item ::
14333 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14334 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14335 above.
14336 @end table
14337
14338 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14339 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14340 predefined meaning.
14341
14342 @node C Constants
14343 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14344
14345 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14346
14347 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14348 following ways:
14349
14350 @itemize @bullet
14351 @item
14352 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14353 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14354 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14355 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14356 @code{long} value.
14357
14358 @item
14359 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14360 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14361 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14362 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14363 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14364 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14365 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14366 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14367 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14368 constant.
14369
14370 @item
14371 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14372 integral equivalents.
14373
14374 @item
14375 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14376 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14377 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14378 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14379 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14380 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14381 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14382 @samp{\n} for newline.
14383
14384 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14385 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14386 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14387 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14388
14389 @item
14390 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14391 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14392 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14393 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14394 characters.
14395
14396 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14397 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14398 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14399
14400 @item
14401 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14402 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14403
14404 @item
14405 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14406 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14407 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14408 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14409 @end itemize
14410
14411 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14412 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14413
14414 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14415 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14416
14417 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14418 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14419 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14420 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14421 @quotation
14422 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14423 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14424 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14425 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14426 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14427 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14428 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14429 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14430 @end quotation
14431
14432 @enumerate
14433
14434 @cindex member functions
14435 @item
14436 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14437
14438 @smallexample
14439 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14440 @end smallexample
14441
14442 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14443 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14444 @item
14445 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14446 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14447 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14448 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14449 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14450
14451 @cindex call overloaded functions
14452 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14453 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14454 @item
14455 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14456 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14457 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14458 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14459 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14460 default arguments.
14461
14462 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14463 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14464 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14465 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14466 number of function arguments.
14467
14468 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14469 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14470 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14471
14472 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14473 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14474 @smallexample
14475 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14476 @end smallexample
14477
14478 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14479 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14480
14481 @cindex reference declarations
14482 @item
14483 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
14484 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
14485 dereferenced.
14486
14487 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14488 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14489 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14490 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14491 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14492
14493 @item
14494 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14495 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14496 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14497 necessary, for example in an expression like
14498 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14499 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14500 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14501
14502 @item
14503 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14504 specification.
14505 @end enumerate
14506
14507 @node C Defaults
14508 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14509
14510 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14511
14512 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14513 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14514 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14515 selects the working language.
14516
14517 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14518 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14519 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14520 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14521 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14522 for further details.
14523
14524 @node C Checks
14525 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14526
14527 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14528
14529 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14530 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14531 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14532 constants to pointers.
14533
14534 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14535 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14536 that is not itself an array.
14537
14538 @node Debugging C
14539 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14540
14541 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14542 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14543 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14544 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14545
14546 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14547 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14548 ,Expressions}.
14549
14550 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14551 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14552
14553 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14554
14555 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14556 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14557
14558 @table @code
14559 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14560 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14561 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14562 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14563 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14564 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14565
14566 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14567 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14568 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14569 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14570 classes.
14571 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14572
14573 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14574 @item catch throw
14575 @itemx catch rethrow
14576 @itemx catch catch
14577 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14578 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14579
14580 @cindex inheritance
14581 @item ptype @var{typename}
14582 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14583 @var{typename}.
14584 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14585
14586 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14587 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14588 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14589 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14590 multiple inheritance is in use.
14591
14592 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
14593 @item demangle @var{name}
14594 Demangle @var{name}.
14595 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
14596
14597 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14598 @item set print demangle
14599 @itemx show print demangle
14600 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14601 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14602 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14603 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14604 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14605
14606 @item set print object
14607 @itemx show print object
14608 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14609 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14610
14611 @item set print vtbl
14612 @itemx show print vtbl
14613 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14614 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14615 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14616 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14617
14618 @kindex set overload-resolution
14619 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14620 @item set overload-resolution on
14621 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14622 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14623 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14624 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14625 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14626 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14627
14628 @item set overload-resolution off
14629 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14630 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14631 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14632 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14633 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14634 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14635 argument types.
14636
14637 @kindex show overload-resolution
14638 @item show overload-resolution
14639 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14640
14641 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14642 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14643 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14644 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14645 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14646 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14647 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14648 @end table
14649
14650 @node Decimal Floating Point
14651 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14652 @cindex decimal floating point format
14653
14654 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14655 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14656 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14657 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14658
14659 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14660 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14661 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14662 configured target.
14663
14664 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14665 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14666 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14667
14668 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14669 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14670 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14671
14672 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14673 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14674 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14675
14676 @node D
14677 @subsection D
14678
14679 @cindex D
14680 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14681 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14682 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
14683
14684 @node Go
14685 @subsection Go
14686
14687 @cindex Go (programming language)
14688 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
14689 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
14690
14691 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
14692
14693 @table @code
14694 @cindex current Go package
14695 @item The current Go package
14696 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
14697 specifying global variables and functions.
14698
14699 For example, given the program:
14700
14701 @example
14702 package main
14703 var myglob = "Shall we?"
14704 func main () @{
14705 // ...
14706 @}
14707 @end example
14708
14709 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
14710
14711 @example
14712 (gdb) p myglob
14713 (gdb) p main.myglob
14714 @end example
14715
14716 @cindex builtin Go types
14717 @item Builtin Go types
14718 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
14719 as a string.
14720
14721 @cindex builtin Go functions
14722 @item Builtin Go functions
14723 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
14724 function and handles it internally.
14725
14726 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
14727 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
14728 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
14729 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
14730 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
14731 @end table
14732
14733 @node Objective-C
14734 @subsection Objective-C
14735
14736 @cindex Objective-C
14737 This section provides information about some commands and command
14738 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
14739 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
14740 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
14741
14742 @menu
14743 * Method Names in Commands::
14744 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
14745 @end menu
14746
14747 @node Method Names in Commands
14748 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
14749
14750 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
14751 names as line specifications:
14752
14753 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
14754 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
14755 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
14756 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
14757 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
14758 @itemize
14759 @item @code{clear}
14760 @item @code{break}
14761 @item @code{info line}
14762 @item @code{jump}
14763 @item @code{list}
14764 @end itemize
14765
14766 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
14767
14768 @smallexample
14769 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
14770 @end smallexample
14771
14772 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
14773 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
14774 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
14775 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
14776 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
14777 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
14778 debugged, enter:
14779
14780 @smallexample
14781 break -[Fruit create]
14782 @end smallexample
14783
14784 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
14785 enter:
14786
14787 @smallexample
14788 list +[NSText initialize]
14789 @end smallexample
14790
14791 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
14792 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
14793 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
14794 is also possible to specify just a method name:
14795
14796 @smallexample
14797 break create
14798 @end smallexample
14799
14800 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
14801 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
14802 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
14803 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
14804 none apply.
14805
14806 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
14807 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
14808
14809 @smallexample
14810 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
14811 @end smallexample
14812
14813 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
14814 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
14815 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
14816 @kindex print-object
14817 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
14818
14819 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
14820
14821 @smallexample
14822 print -[@var{object} hash]
14823 @end smallexample
14824
14825 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
14826 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
14827 @noindent
14828 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
14829 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
14830 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
14831 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
14832 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
14833 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
14834
14835 @node OpenCL C
14836 @subsection OpenCL C
14837
14838 @cindex OpenCL C
14839 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
14840
14841 @menu
14842 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
14843 * OpenCL C Expressions::
14844 * OpenCL C Operators::
14845 @end menu
14846
14847 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
14848 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
14849
14850 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
14851 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
14852 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
14853 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
14854 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
14855
14856 @node OpenCL C Expressions
14857 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
14858
14859 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
14860 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
14861 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
14862 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
14863
14864 @node OpenCL C Operators
14865 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
14866
14867 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
14868 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
14869 vector data types.
14870
14871 @node Fortran
14872 @subsection Fortran
14873 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
14874
14875 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
14876 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
14877
14878 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
14879 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
14880 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
14881 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
14882 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
14883 underscore.
14884
14885 @menu
14886 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
14887 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
14888 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
14889 @end menu
14890
14891 @node Fortran Operators
14892 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
14893
14894 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
14895
14896 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14897 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
14898 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
14899
14900 @table @code
14901 @item **
14902 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
14903 of the second one.
14904
14905 @item :
14906 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
14907 represent a section of array.
14908
14909 @item %
14910 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
14911 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
14912 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
14913 union type.
14914 @end table
14915
14916 @node Fortran Defaults
14917 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
14918
14919 @cindex Fortran Defaults
14920
14921 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
14922 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
14923 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
14924 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
14925
14926 @node Special Fortran Commands
14927 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
14928
14929 @cindex Special Fortran commands
14930
14931 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
14932 such as displaying common blocks.
14933
14934 @table @code
14935 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
14936 @kindex info common
14937 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
14938 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
14939 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
14940 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
14941 printed.
14942 @end table
14943
14944 @node Pascal
14945 @subsection Pascal
14946
14947 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
14948 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
14949 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
14950 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
14951 syntax.
14952
14953 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
14954 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
14955 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
14956
14957 @node Modula-2
14958 @subsection Modula-2
14959
14960 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
14961
14962 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
14963 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
14964 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
14965 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
14966 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
14967 table.
14968
14969 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
14970 @menu
14971 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
14972 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
14973 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
14974 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
14975 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
14976 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
14977 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
14978 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
14979 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
14980 @end menu
14981
14982 @node M2 Operators
14983 @subsubsection Operators
14984 @cindex Modula-2 operators
14985
14986 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14987 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14988 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
14989 following definitions hold:
14990
14991 @itemize @bullet
14992
14993 @item
14994 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
14995 their subranges.
14996
14997 @item
14998 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
14999
15000 @item
15001 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15002
15003 @item
15004 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15005 @var{type}}.
15006
15007 @item
15008 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15009
15010 @item
15011 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15012
15013 @item
15014 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15015 @end itemize
15016
15017 @noindent
15018 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15019 increasing precedence:
15020
15021 @table @code
15022 @item ,
15023 Function argument or array index separator.
15024
15025 @item :=
15026 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15027 @var{value}.
15028
15029 @item <@r{, }>
15030 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15031 types.
15032
15033 @item <=@r{, }>=
15034 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15035 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15036 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
15037
15038 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15039 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15040 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15041 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15042 comment character.
15043
15044 @item IN
15045 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15046 Same precedence as @code{<}.
15047
15048 @item OR
15049 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15050
15051 @item AND@r{, }&
15052 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15053
15054 @item @@
15055 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15056
15057 @item +@r{, }-
15058 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15059 and difference on set types.
15060
15061 @item *
15062 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
15063 on set types.
15064
15065 @item /
15066 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
15067 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
15068
15069 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
15070 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
15071 precedence as @code{*}.
15072
15073 @item -
15074 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
15075
15076 @item ^
15077 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
15078
15079 @item NOT
15080 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
15081 @code{^}.
15082
15083 @item .
15084 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
15085 precedence as @code{^}.
15086
15087 @item []
15088 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
15089
15090 @item ()
15091 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
15092 as @code{^}.
15093
15094 @item ::@r{, }.
15095 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
15096 @end table
15097
15098 @quotation
15099 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
15100 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
15101 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
15102 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
15103 @end quotation
15104
15105
15106 @node Built-In Func/Proc
15107 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
15108 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
15109
15110 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
15111 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
15112
15113 @table @var
15114
15115 @item a
15116 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
15117
15118 @item c
15119 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
15120
15121 @item i
15122 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
15123
15124 @item m
15125 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
15126 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
15127 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
15128
15129 @item n
15130 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
15131
15132 @item r
15133 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
15134
15135 @item t
15136 represents a type.
15137
15138 @item v
15139 represents a variable.
15140
15141 @item x
15142 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
15143 explanation of the function for details.
15144 @end table
15145
15146 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
15147
15148 @table @code
15149 @item ABS(@var{n})
15150 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
15151
15152 @item CAP(@var{c})
15153 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
15154 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
15155
15156 @item CHR(@var{i})
15157 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15158
15159 @item DEC(@var{v})
15160 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15161
15162 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
15163 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15164 new value.
15165
15166 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15167 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
15168 set.
15169
15170 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
15171 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
15172
15173 @item HIGH(@var{a})
15174 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
15175
15176 @item INC(@var{v})
15177 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15178
15179 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
15180 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15181 new value.
15182
15183 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15184 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
15185 there. Returns the new set.
15186
15187 @item MAX(@var{t})
15188 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
15189
15190 @item MIN(@var{t})
15191 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
15192
15193 @item ODD(@var{i})
15194 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
15195
15196 @item ORD(@var{x})
15197 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
15198 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15199 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
15200 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15201
15202 @item SIZE(@var{x})
15203 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15204 variable or a type.
15205
15206 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
15207 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15208
15209 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
15210 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15211 variable or a type.
15212
15213 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15214 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15215 @end table
15216
15217 @quotation
15218 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15219 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15220 an error.
15221 @end quotation
15222
15223 @cindex Modula-2 constants
15224 @node M2 Constants
15225 @subsubsection Constants
15226
15227 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15228 ways:
15229
15230 @itemize @bullet
15231
15232 @item
15233 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15234 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15235 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15236 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15237
15238 @item
15239 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15240 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15241 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15242 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15243 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15244 digits.
15245
15246 @item
15247 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15248 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15249 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15250 followed by a @samp{C}.
15251
15252 @item
15253 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15254 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15255 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15256 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15257 sequences.
15258
15259 @item
15260 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15261
15262 @item
15263 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15264 @code{FALSE}.
15265
15266 @item
15267 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15268
15269 @item
15270 Set constants are not yet supported.
15271 @end itemize
15272
15273 @node M2 Types
15274 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15275 @cindex Modula-2 types
15276
15277 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15278 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15279 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15280 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15281 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15282 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15283
15284 The first example contains the following section of code:
15285
15286 @smallexample
15287 VAR
15288 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15289 r: [20..40] ;
15290 @end smallexample
15291
15292 @noindent
15293 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15294 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15295
15296 @smallexample
15297 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15298 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15299 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15300 SET OF CHAR
15301 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15302 21
15303 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15304 [20..40]
15305 @end smallexample
15306
15307 @noindent
15308 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15309
15310 @smallexample
15311 VAR
15312 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15313 @end smallexample
15314
15315 @noindent
15316 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15317
15318 @smallexample
15319 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15320 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15321 @end smallexample
15322
15323 @noindent
15324 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15325 expressions using the debugger.
15326
15327 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15328 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15329
15330 @smallexample
15331 VAR
15332 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15333 @end smallexample
15334
15335 @smallexample
15336 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15337 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15338 @end smallexample
15339
15340 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15341 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15342 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15343 above.
15344
15345 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15346
15347 @smallexample
15348 TYPE
15349 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15350 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15351 VAR
15352 s: t ;
15353 BEGIN
15354 s := blue ;
15355 @end smallexample
15356
15357 @noindent
15358 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15359 and value of a variable.
15360
15361 @smallexample
15362 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15363 $1 = blue
15364 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15365 type = [blue..yellow]
15366 @end smallexample
15367
15368 @noindent
15369 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15370 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15371 their @code{C} counterparts.
15372
15373 @smallexample
15374 VAR
15375 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15376 BEGIN
15377 s[1] := 1 ;
15378 @end smallexample
15379
15380 @smallexample
15381 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15382 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15383 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15384 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15385 @end smallexample
15386
15387 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15388 pointer types as shown in this example:
15389
15390 @smallexample
15391 VAR
15392 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15393 BEGIN
15394 NEW(s) ;
15395 s^[1] := 1 ;
15396 @end smallexample
15397
15398 @noindent
15399 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15400
15401 @smallexample
15402 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15403 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15404 @end smallexample
15405
15406 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15407 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15408 types:
15409
15410 @smallexample
15411 TYPE
15412 foo = RECORD
15413 f1: CARDINAL ;
15414 f2: CHAR ;
15415 f3: myarray ;
15416 END ;
15417
15418 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15419 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15420 VAR
15421 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15422 @end smallexample
15423
15424 @noindent
15425 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15426 below.
15427
15428 @smallexample
15429 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15430 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15431 f1 : CARDINAL;
15432 f2 : CHAR;
15433 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15434 END
15435 @end smallexample
15436
15437 @node M2 Defaults
15438 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15439 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
15440
15441 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15442 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15443 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15444 selected the working language.
15445
15446 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15447 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15448 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15449 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15450
15451 @node Deviations
15452 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15453 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15454
15455 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15456 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15457
15458 @itemize @bullet
15459 @item
15460 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15461 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15462 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15463 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15464 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15465 returned a pointer.)
15466
15467 @item
15468 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15469 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15470 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15471 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15472
15473 @item
15474 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15475 argument.
15476
15477 @item
15478 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15479 @end itemize
15480
15481 @node M2 Checks
15482 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15483 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15484
15485 @quotation
15486 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15487 range checking.
15488 @end quotation
15489 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15490
15491 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15492
15493 @itemize @bullet
15494 @item
15495 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15496 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15497
15498 @item
15499 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15500 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15501 @end itemize
15502
15503 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15504 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15505
15506 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15507 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15508
15509 @node M2 Scope
15510 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15511 @cindex scope
15512 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15513 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15514 @ifinfo
15515 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15516 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15517 @end ifinfo
15518 @ifnotinfo
15519 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15520 @end ifnotinfo
15521
15522 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15523 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
15524 similar syntax:
15525
15526 @smallexample
15527
15528 @var{module} . @var{id}
15529 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
15530 @end smallexample
15531
15532 @noindent
15533 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15534 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15535 identifier within your program, except another module.
15536
15537 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15538 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
15539 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15540 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15541
15542 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15543 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15544 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
15545 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15546 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15547 @var{module}.
15548
15549 @node GDB/M2
15550 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15551
15552 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15553 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15554 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15555 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
15556 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15557 analogue in Modula-2.
15558
15559 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
15560 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
15561 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
15562 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
15563 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15564 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15565
15566 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15567 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15568 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15569
15570 @node Ada
15571 @subsection Ada
15572 @cindex Ada
15573
15574 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15575 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15576 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15577 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15578 to be difficult.
15579
15580
15581 @cindex expressions in Ada
15582 @menu
15583 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
15584 and semantics supported by Ada mode
15585 in @value{GDBN}.
15586 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15587 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15588 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
15589 subprograms.
15590 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
15591 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
15592 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
15593 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15594 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
15595 Profile
15596 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
15597 @end menu
15598
15599 @node Ada Mode Intro
15600 @subsubsection Introduction
15601 @cindex Ada mode, general
15602
15603 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
15604 syntax, with some extensions.
15605 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
15606
15607 @itemize @bullet
15608 @item
15609 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
15610 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
15611 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
15612 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
15613
15614 @item
15615 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
15616 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15617
15618 @item
15619 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15620 @end itemize
15621
15622 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
15623 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
15624 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
15625 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
15626 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
15627
15628 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
15629 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
15630 was translated from an Ada source file.
15631
15632 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
15633 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
15634 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
15635 middle (to allow based literals).
15636
15637 @node Omissions from Ada
15638 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
15639 @cindex Ada, omissions from
15640
15641 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
15642
15643 @itemize @bullet
15644 @item
15645 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
15646
15647 @itemize @minus
15648 @item
15649 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
15650 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
15651
15652 @item
15653 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
15654
15655 @item
15656 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
15657
15658 @item
15659 @t{'Tag}.
15660
15661 @item
15662 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
15663 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
15664
15665 @item
15666 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
15667 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
15668
15669 @item
15670 @t{'Address}.
15671 @end itemize
15672
15673 @item
15674 The names in
15675 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
15676 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
15677 not currently available.
15678
15679 @item
15680 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
15681 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
15682 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
15683 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
15684 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
15685 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
15686 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
15687 indeterminate values.
15688
15689 @item
15690 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
15691 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
15692 are not implemented.
15693
15694 @item
15695 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
15696 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
15697 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
15698 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
15699 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
15700
15701 @smallexample
15702 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
15703 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
15704 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
15705 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
15706 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
15707 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
15708 @end smallexample
15709
15710 Changing a
15711 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
15712 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
15713 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
15714 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
15715 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
15716 declared to have a type such as:
15717
15718 @smallexample
15719 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
15720 Id : Integer;
15721 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
15722 end record;
15723 @end smallexample
15724
15725 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
15726 assignments:
15727
15728 @smallexample
15729 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
15730 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
15731 @end smallexample
15732
15733 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
15734 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
15735 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
15736 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
15737 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
15738 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
15739 redundant component associations, although which component values are
15740 assigned in such cases is not defined.
15741
15742 @item
15743 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
15744
15745 @item
15746 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
15747 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
15748 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
15749 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
15750 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
15751 the proper resolution.
15752
15753 @item
15754 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
15755
15756 @item
15757 Entry calls are not implemented.
15758
15759 @item
15760 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
15761 formats are not supported.
15762
15763 @item
15764 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
15765
15766 @item
15767 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
15768 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
15769 context.
15770 Should your program
15771 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
15772 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
15773 @end itemize
15774
15775 @node Additions to Ada
15776 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
15777 @cindex Ada, deviations from
15778
15779 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
15780 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
15781
15782 @itemize @bullet
15783 @item
15784 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
15785 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
15786 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
15787 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
15788 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
15789 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
15790 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
15791 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
15792
15793 @item
15794 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
15795 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
15796 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
15797
15798 @item
15799 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
15800 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
15801
15802 @item
15803 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
15804 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
15805 @end itemize
15806
15807 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
15808 additions specific to Ada:
15809
15810 @itemize @bullet
15811 @item
15812 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
15813 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
15814
15815 @smallexample
15816 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
15817 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
15818 @end smallexample
15819
15820 @item
15821 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
15822 the value of its right-hand operand.
15823 This allows, for example,
15824 complex conditional breaks:
15825
15826 @smallexample
15827 (@value{GDBP}) break f
15828 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
15829 @end smallexample
15830
15831 @item
15832 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
15833 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
15834 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
15835 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
15836 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
15837 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
15838 in strings. For example,
15839 @smallexample
15840 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
15841 @end smallexample
15842 @noindent
15843 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
15844 after each period.
15845
15846 @item
15847 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
15848 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
15849 to write
15850
15851 @smallexample
15852 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
15853 @end smallexample
15854
15855 @item
15856 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
15857 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
15858 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
15859 of 3 might print as
15860
15861 @smallexample
15862 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
15863 @end smallexample
15864
15865 @noindent
15866 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
15867 clause.
15868
15869 @item
15870 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
15871 multi-character subsequence of
15872 their names (an exact match gets preference).
15873 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
15874 in place of @t{a'length}.
15875
15876 @item
15877 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
15878 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
15879 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
15880 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
15881 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
15882 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
15883 For example,
15884 @smallexample
15885 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
15886 @end smallexample
15887
15888 @item
15889 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
15890 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
15891 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
15892 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
15893 object.
15894
15895 @end itemize
15896
15897 @node Overloading support for Ada
15898 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
15899 @cindex overloading, Ada
15900
15901 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
15902 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
15903 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
15904 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
15905 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
15906 functions to procedures elsewhere.
15907
15908 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
15909 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
15910 use, for instance:
15911
15912 @smallexample
15913 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
15914 Multiple matches for f
15915 [0] cancel
15916 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
15917 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
15918 >
15919 @end smallexample
15920
15921 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
15922 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
15923 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
15924
15925 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
15926 case:
15927
15928 @table @code
15929
15930 @kindex set ada print-signatures
15931 @item set ada print-signatures
15932 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
15933 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
15934 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
15935
15936 @kindex show ada print-signatures
15937 @item show ada print-signatures
15938 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
15939 overloads selection menu.
15940 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
15941
15942 @end table
15943
15944 @node Stopping Before Main Program
15945 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
15946
15947 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
15948 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
15949 before reaching the main procedure.
15950 As defined in the Ada Reference
15951 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
15952 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
15953 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
15954 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
15955
15956 @node Ada Exceptions
15957 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
15958
15959 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
15960
15961 @table @code
15962 @kindex info exceptions
15963 @item info exceptions
15964 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
15965 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
15966 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
15967 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
15968 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
15969 @end table
15970
15971 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
15972 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
15973 argument.
15974
15975 @smallexample
15976 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
15977 All defined Ada exceptions:
15978 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15979 program_error: 0x613d20
15980 storage_error: 0x613ce0
15981 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
15982 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15983 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
15984 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
15985 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15986 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15987 @end smallexample
15988
15989 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
15990 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
15991
15992 @node Ada Tasks
15993 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
15994 @cindex Ada, tasking
15995
15996 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
15997 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
15998
15999 @table @code
16000 @kindex info tasks
16001 @item info tasks
16002 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16003
16004
16005 @smallexample
16006 @iftex
16007 @leftskip=0.5cm
16008 @end iftex
16009 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16010 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16011 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16012 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
16013 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
16014 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
16015
16016 @end smallexample
16017
16018 @noindent
16019 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
16020 task currently being inspected.
16021
16022 @table @asis
16023 @item ID
16024 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16025
16026 @item TID
16027 The Ada task ID.
16028
16029 @item P-ID
16030 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16031
16032 @item Pri
16033 The base priority of the task.
16034
16035 @item State
16036 Current state of the task.
16037
16038 @table @code
16039 @item Unactivated
16040 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
16041 executing.
16042
16043 @item Runnable
16044 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
16045 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16046
16047 @item Terminated
16048 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
16049 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16050 terminated themselves.
16051
16052 @item Child Activation Wait
16053 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16054
16055 @item Accept Statement
16056 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16057
16058 @item Waiting on entry call
16059 The task is waiting on an entry call.
16060
16061 @item Async Select Wait
16062 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
16063 select statement.
16064
16065 @item Delay Sleep
16066 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
16067 alternative open.
16068
16069 @item Child Termination Wait
16070 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
16071 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
16072 waiting on a terminate Phase.
16073
16074 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
16075 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
16076 finish terminating.
16077
16078 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
16079 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
16080 @end table
16081
16082 @item Name
16083 Name of the task in the program.
16084
16085 @end table
16086
16087 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
16088 @item info task @var{taskno}
16089 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
16090 the following example:
16091 @smallexample
16092 @iftex
16093 @leftskip=0.5cm
16094 @end iftex
16095 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16096 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16097 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16098 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
16099 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
16100 Ada Task: 0x807c468
16101 Name: task_1
16102 Thread: 0x807f378
16103 Parent: 1 (main_task)
16104 Base Priority: 15
16105 State: Runnable
16106 @end smallexample
16107
16108 @item task
16109 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
16110 @cindex current Ada task ID
16111 This command prints the ID of the current task.
16112
16113 @smallexample
16114 @iftex
16115 @leftskip=0.5cm
16116 @end iftex
16117 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16118 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16119 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16120 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16121 (@value{GDBP}) task
16122 [Current task is 2]
16123 @end smallexample
16124
16125 @item task @var{taskno}
16126 @cindex Ada task switching
16127 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
16128 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
16129 from the current task to the given task.
16130
16131 @smallexample
16132 @iftex
16133 @leftskip=0.5cm
16134 @end iftex
16135 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16136 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16137 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16138 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16139 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
16140 [Switching to task 1]
16141 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16142 (@value{GDBP}) bt
16143 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16144 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
16145 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
16146 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
16147 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
16148 @end smallexample
16149
16150 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
16151 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
16152 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
16153 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
16154 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
16155 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
16156 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
16157 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
16158 in @ref{Specify Location}.
16159
16160 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
16161 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
16162 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
16163 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
16164 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
16165
16166 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
16167 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
16168 program.
16169
16170 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
16171 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
16172 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
16173
16174 For example,
16175
16176 @smallexample
16177 @iftex
16178 @leftskip=0.5cm
16179 @end iftex
16180 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16181 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16182 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16183 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
16184 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16185 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
16186 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
16187 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
16188 (@value{GDBP}) cont
16189 Continuing.
16190 task # 1 running
16191 task # 2 running
16192
16193 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
16194 15 flush;
16195 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16196 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16197 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16198 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
16199 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16200 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
16201 @end smallexample
16202 @end table
16203
16204 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
16205 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16206 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
16207
16208 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
16209 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
16210 the platform being used.
16211 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
16212 switching is not supported.
16213
16214 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
16215 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
16216 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
16217 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
16218 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
16219 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
16220
16221 @node Ravenscar Profile
16222 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
16223 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
16224
16225 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
16226 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
16227 requirements.
16228
16229 @table @code
16230 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
16231 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
16232 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
16233 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16234 Profile. This is the default.
16235
16236 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
16237 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
16238 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16239 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
16240 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16241 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16242 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16243
16244 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16245 @item show ravenscar task-switching
16246 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16247 using the Ravenscar Profile.
16248
16249 @end table
16250
16251 @node Ada Glitches
16252 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16253 @cindex Ada, problems
16254
16255 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16256 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16257 @value{GDBN},
16258 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16259 and the GNU Ada compiler.
16260
16261 @itemize @bullet
16262 @item
16263 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16264 storage are invisible to the debugger.
16265
16266 @item
16267 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16268 argument lists are treated as positional).
16269
16270 @item
16271 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16272
16273 @item
16274 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16275 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16276 the host machine.
16277
16278 @item
16279 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16280 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
16281 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16282 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16283 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
16284 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16285 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16286 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
16287 you can usually resolve the confusion
16288 by qualifying the problematic names with package
16289 @code{Standard} explicitly.
16290 @end itemize
16291
16292 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16293 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16294 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16295 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16296 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16297 enabled.
16298
16299 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16300 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16301 @table @code
16302
16303 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16304 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16305 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16306 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16307 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16308 This is the default.
16309
16310 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16311 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16312 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16313 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16314 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16315 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16316 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16317
16318 @end table
16319
16320 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
16321 @cindex GNAT encoding
16322 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16323 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16324 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16325 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16326 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16327 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16328
16329 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16330 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16331 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16332 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16333 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16334 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16335 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16336 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16337
16338 @table @code
16339
16340 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16341 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16342 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16343 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16344
16345 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16346 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16347 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16348
16349 @end table
16350
16351 @node Unsupported Languages
16352 @section Unsupported Languages
16353
16354 @cindex unsupported languages
16355 @cindex minimal language
16356 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16357 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16358 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16359 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16360 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16361 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16362
16363 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16364 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16365 language.
16366
16367 @node Symbols
16368 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16369
16370 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16371 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16372 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16373 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16374 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16375 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16376 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16377
16378 @cindex symbol names
16379 @cindex names of symbols
16380 @cindex quoting names
16381 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16382 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
16383 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16384 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
16385 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16386 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16387 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16388 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16389
16390 @smallexample
16391 p 'foo.c'::x
16392 @end smallexample
16393
16394 @noindent
16395 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16396
16397 @table @code
16398 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16399 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16400 @kindex set case-sensitive
16401 @item set case-sensitive on
16402 @itemx set case-sensitive off
16403 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
16404 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16405 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16406 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
16407 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16408 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
16409 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16410 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
16411 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16412 case-insensitive matches.
16413
16414 @kindex show case-sensitive
16415 @item show case-sensitive
16416 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16417 lookups.
16418
16419 @kindex set print type methods
16420 @item set print type methods
16421 @itemx set print type methods on
16422 @itemx set print type methods off
16423 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16424 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16425 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16426 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16427 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
16428 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16429
16430 @kindex show print type methods
16431 @item show print type methods
16432 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16433 classes.
16434
16435 @kindex set print type typedefs
16436 @item set print type typedefs
16437 @itemx set print type typedefs on
16438 @itemx set print type typedefs off
16439
16440 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16441 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16442 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16443 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16444 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
16445 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16446 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16447 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16448 types.
16449
16450 @kindex show print type typedefs
16451 @item show print type typedefs
16452 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16453 printing classes.
16454
16455 @kindex info address
16456 @cindex address of a symbol
16457 @item info address @var{symbol}
16458 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
16459 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
16460 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16461 is always stored.
16462
16463 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16464 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16465 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16466
16467 @kindex info symbol
16468 @cindex symbol from address
16469 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16470 @item info symbol @var{addr}
16471 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16472 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16473 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16474
16475 @smallexample
16476 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16477 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16478 @end smallexample
16479
16480 @noindent
16481 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
16482 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16483
16484 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16485 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16486
16487 @smallexample
16488 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16489 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16490 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16491 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16492 @end smallexample
16493
16494 @kindex demangle
16495 @cindex demangle
16496 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
16497 Demangle @var{name}.
16498 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
16499 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
16500
16501 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
16502 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
16503
16504 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
16505 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
16506
16507 @kindex whatis
16508 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16509 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16510 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
16511 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16512
16513 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16514 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16515 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16516
16517 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16518 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
16519 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16520 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
16521 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16522 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16523 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16524 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
16525 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16526
16527 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16528 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16529 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16530 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
16531 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16532 unroll it.
16533
16534 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
16535 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
16536 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
16537
16538 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
16539 Available flags are:
16540
16541 @table @code
16542 @item r
16543 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
16544 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
16545 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
16546
16547 @item m
16548 Do not print methods defined in the class.
16549
16550 @item M
16551 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16552 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16553
16554 @item t
16555 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
16556 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16557 names are substituted when printing other types.
16558
16559 @item T
16560 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16561 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
16562 @end table
16563
16564 @kindex ptype
16565 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16566 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
16567 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
16568 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
16569
16570 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
16571 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
16572 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
16573 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
16574 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
16575 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
16576 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
16577 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
16578
16579 For example, for this variable declaration:
16580
16581 @smallexample
16582 typedef double real_t;
16583 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
16584 typedef struct complex complex_t;
16585 complex_t var;
16586 real_t *real_pointer_var;
16587 @end smallexample
16588
16589 @noindent
16590 the two commands give this output:
16591
16592 @smallexample
16593 @group
16594 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
16595 type = complex_t
16596 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
16597 type = struct complex @{
16598 real_t real;
16599 double imag;
16600 @}
16601 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
16602 type = struct complex
16603 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
16604 type = struct complex
16605 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
16606 type = struct complex @{
16607 real_t real;
16608 double imag;
16609 @}
16610 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
16611 type = real_t *
16612 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
16613 type = double *
16614 @end group
16615 @end smallexample
16616
16617 @noindent
16618 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
16619 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16620
16621 @cindex incomplete type
16622 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
16623 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
16624 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
16625 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
16626 given these declarations:
16627
16628 @smallexample
16629 struct foo;
16630 struct foo *fooptr;
16631 @end smallexample
16632
16633 @noindent
16634 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
16635
16636 @smallexample
16637 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
16638 $1 = <incomplete type>
16639 @end smallexample
16640
16641 @noindent
16642 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
16643 completely specified.
16644
16645 @kindex info types
16646 @item info types @var{regexp}
16647 @itemx info types
16648 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
16649 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
16650 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
16651 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
16652 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
16653 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
16654 name is @code{value}.
16655
16656 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
16657 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
16658 lists all source files where a type is defined.
16659
16660 @kindex info type-printers
16661 @item info type-printers
16662 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
16663 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
16664 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
16665 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
16666 type printers.
16667
16668 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
16669
16670 @kindex enable type-printer
16671 @kindex disable type-printer
16672 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16673 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16674 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
16675
16676 @kindex info scope
16677 @cindex local variables
16678 @item info scope @var{location}
16679 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
16680 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
16681 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
16682 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
16683 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
16684
16685 @smallexample
16686 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
16687 Scope for command_line_handler:
16688 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
16689 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
16690 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
16691 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
16692 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
16693 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
16694 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
16695 @end smallexample
16696
16697 @noindent
16698 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
16699 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
16700 collect}.
16701
16702 @kindex info source
16703 @item info source
16704 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
16705 the function containing the current point of execution:
16706 @itemize @bullet
16707 @item
16708 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
16709 @item
16710 the directory it was compiled in,
16711 @item
16712 its length, in lines,
16713 @item
16714 which programming language it is written in,
16715 @item
16716 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
16717 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
16718 @item
16719 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
16720 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
16721 @item
16722 whether the debugging information includes information about
16723 preprocessor macros.
16724 @end itemize
16725
16726
16727 @kindex info sources
16728 @item info sources
16729 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
16730 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
16731 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
16732
16733 @kindex info functions
16734 @item info functions
16735 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
16736
16737 @item info functions @var{regexp}
16738 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
16739 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
16740 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
16741 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
16742 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
16743 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
16744 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
16745
16746 @kindex info variables
16747 @item info variables
16748 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
16749 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
16750
16751 @item info variables @var{regexp}
16752 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
16753 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
16754 @var{regexp}.
16755
16756 @kindex info classes
16757 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
16758 @item info classes
16759 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
16760 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
16761 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16762 expression.
16763
16764 @kindex info selectors
16765 @item info selectors
16766 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
16767 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
16768 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16769 expression.
16770
16771 @ignore
16772 This was never implemented.
16773 @kindex info methods
16774 @item info methods
16775 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
16776 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
16777 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
16778 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
16779 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
16780 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
16781 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
16782 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
16783 @end ignore
16784
16785 @cindex opaque data types
16786 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
16787 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
16788 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
16789 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
16790 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
16791 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
16792 another source file. The default is on.
16793
16794 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
16795 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
16796
16797 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
16798 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
16799 is printed as follows:
16800 @smallexample
16801 @{<no data fields>@}
16802 @end smallexample
16803
16804 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
16805 @item show opaque-type-resolution
16806 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
16807
16808 @kindex set print symbol-loading
16809 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
16810 @item set print symbol-loading
16811 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
16812 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
16813 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
16814 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
16815 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
16816 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
16817 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
16818 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
16819 can be annoying.
16820 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
16821 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
16822 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
16823 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
16824
16825 @kindex show print symbol-loading
16826 @item show print symbol-loading
16827 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
16828 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
16829
16830 @kindex maint print symbols
16831 @cindex symbol dump
16832 @kindex maint print psymbols
16833 @cindex partial symbol dump
16834 @kindex maint print msymbols
16835 @cindex minimal symbol dump
16836 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
16837 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
16838 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
16839 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
16840 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
16841 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
16842 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
16843 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
16844 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
16845 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
16846 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
16847 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
16848 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
16849 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
16850 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
16851 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
16852 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
16853
16854 @kindex maint info symtabs
16855 @kindex maint info psymtabs
16856 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
16857 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16858 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16859 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16860 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16861 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16862
16863 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
16864 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
16865 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
16866 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
16867 structure in more detail. For example:
16868
16869 @smallexample
16870 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
16871 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16872 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16873 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16874 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
16875 readin no
16876 fullname (null)
16877 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
16878 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
16879 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
16880 dependencies (none)
16881 @}
16882 @}
16883 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16884 (@value{GDBP})
16885 @end smallexample
16886 @noindent
16887 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
16888 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
16889 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
16890 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
16891 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
16892
16893 @smallexample
16894 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
16895 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
16896 line 1574.
16897 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16898 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16899 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16900 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16901 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
16902 dirname (null)
16903 fullname (null)
16904 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
16905 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
16906 debugformat DWARF 2
16907 @}
16908 @}
16909 (@value{GDBP})
16910 @end smallexample
16911
16912 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
16913 @cindex symbol cache size
16914 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
16915 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
16916 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
16917 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
16918 with different sizes.
16919
16920 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
16921 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
16922 Show the size of the symbol cache.
16923
16924 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
16925 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
16926 @item maint print symbol-cache
16927 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
16928 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
16929
16930 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
16931 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
16932 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
16933 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
16934 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
16935
16936 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
16937 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
16938 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
16939 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
16940 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
16941 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
16942
16943 @end table
16944
16945 @node Altering
16946 @chapter Altering Execution
16947
16948 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
16949 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
16950 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
16951 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
16952 program.
16953
16954 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
16955 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
16956 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
16957
16958 @menu
16959 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
16960 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
16961 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
16962 * Returning:: Returning from a function
16963 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
16964 * Patching:: Patching your program
16965 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
16966 @end menu
16967
16968 @node Assignment
16969 @section Assignment to Variables
16970
16971 @cindex assignment
16972 @cindex setting variables
16973 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
16974 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
16975
16976 @smallexample
16977 print x=4
16978 @end smallexample
16979
16980 @noindent
16981 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
16982 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
16983 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
16984 information on operators in supported languages.
16985
16986 @kindex set variable
16987 @cindex variables, setting
16988 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
16989 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
16990 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
16991 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
16992 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
16993
16994 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
16995 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
16996 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
16997 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
16998 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
16999 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
17000 command @code{set width}:
17001
17002 @smallexample
17003 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
17004 type = double
17005 (@value{GDBP}) p width
17006 $4 = 13
17007 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
17008 Invalid syntax in expression.
17009 @end smallexample
17010
17011 @noindent
17012 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
17013 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
17014
17015 @smallexample
17016 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
17017 @end smallexample
17018
17019 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
17020 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
17021 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
17022 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
17023 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
17024 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
17025
17026 @smallexample
17027 @group
17028 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
17029 type = double
17030 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17031 $1 = 1
17032 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
17033 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17034 $2 = 1
17035 (@value{GDBP}) r
17036 The program being debugged has been started already.
17037 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
17038 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
17039 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
17040 Invalid bfd target.
17041 (@value{GDBP}) show g
17042 The current BFD target is "=4".
17043 @end group
17044 @end smallexample
17045
17046 @noindent
17047 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
17048 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
17049 @code{g}, use
17050
17051 @smallexample
17052 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
17053 @end smallexample
17054
17055 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
17056 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
17057 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
17058 same length or shorter.
17059 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
17060 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
17061
17062 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
17063 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
17064 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
17065 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
17066 and representation in memory), and
17067
17068 @smallexample
17069 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
17070 @end smallexample
17071
17072 @noindent
17073 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
17074
17075 @node Jumping
17076 @section Continuing at a Different Address
17077
17078 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
17079 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
17080 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
17081
17082 @table @code
17083 @kindex jump
17084 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
17085 @item jump @var{location}
17086 @itemx j @var{location}
17087 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
17088 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
17089 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
17090 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
17091 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
17092
17093 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
17094 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
17095 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
17096 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
17097 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
17098 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
17099 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
17100 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
17101 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
17102 @end table
17103
17104 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
17105 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
17106 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
17107 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
17108 example,
17109
17110 @smallexample
17111 set $pc = 0x485
17112 @end smallexample
17113
17114 @noindent
17115 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
17116 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
17117 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
17118
17119 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
17120 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
17121 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
17122 detail.
17123
17124 @c @group
17125 @node Signaling
17126 @section Giving your Program a Signal
17127 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
17128
17129 @table @code
17130 @kindex signal
17131 @item signal @var{signal}
17132 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
17133 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
17134 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
17135 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17136
17137 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
17138 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
17139 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17140 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
17141 signal.
17142
17143 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
17144 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
17145 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
17146 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
17147 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
17148 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
17149 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
17150 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
17151
17152 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
17153 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
17154 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
17155 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
17156 passes the signal directly to your program.
17157
17158 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
17159 after executing the command.
17160
17161 @kindex queue-signal
17162 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
17163 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
17164 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
17165 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
17166 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17167 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
17168 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
17169 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
17170 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
17171
17172 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
17173 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
17174 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
17175 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17176 @code{continue} command.
17177
17178 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
17179 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
17180 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
17181 (@pxref{Signals}).
17182 @end table
17183 @c @end group
17184
17185 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
17186 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
17187
17188 @node Returning
17189 @section Returning from a Function
17190
17191 @table @code
17192 @cindex returning from a function
17193 @kindex return
17194 @item return
17195 @itemx return @var{expression}
17196 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
17197 command. If you give an
17198 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
17199 value.
17200 @end table
17201
17202 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
17203 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
17204 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
17205 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
17206
17207 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
17208 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
17209 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
17210 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
17211 of functions.
17212
17213 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
17214 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
17215 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
17216 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
17217 selected stack frame returns naturally.
17218
17219 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
17220 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
17221 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
17222 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
17223 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
17224 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
17225 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
17226 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
17227 assignment into the right register(s).
17228
17229 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
17230 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
17231 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
17232 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
17233 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
17234 into a @code{long long int}:
17235
17236 @smallexample
17237 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
17238 29 return 31;
17239 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17240 Make func return now? (y or n) y
17241 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
17242 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17243 (@value{GDBP})
17244 @end smallexample
17245
17246 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17247 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17248 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17249 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
17250 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17251 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17252 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17253 an appropriate cast explicitly:
17254
17255 @smallexample
17256 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17257 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17258 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17259 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17260 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17261 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17262 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
17263 (@value{GDBP})
17264 @end smallexample
17265
17266 @node Calling
17267 @section Calling Program Functions
17268
17269 @table @code
17270 @cindex calling functions
17271 @cindex inferior functions, calling
17272 @item print @var{expr}
17273 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17274 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17275 debugged.
17276
17277 @kindex call
17278 @item call @var{expr}
17279 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17280 returned values.
17281
17282 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17283 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17284 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17285 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17286 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17287 value history.
17288 @end table
17289
17290 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17291 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17292 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
17293 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17294
17295 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17296 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17297 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17298 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17299 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
17300 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17301 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
17302 in that case is controlled by the
17303 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17304
17305 @table @code
17306 @item set unwindonsignal
17307 @kindex set unwindonsignal
17308 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
17309 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17310 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17311 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
17312 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17313 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
17314 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17315 received.
17316
17317 @item show unwindonsignal
17318 @kindex show unwindonsignal
17319 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17320 @value{GDBN}.
17321
17322 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17323 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17324 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17325 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17326 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17327 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17328 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17329 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17330 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17331 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17332
17333 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17334 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17335 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17336 @value{GDBN}.
17337
17338 @end table
17339
17340 @cindex weak alias functions
17341 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
17342 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
17343 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
17344 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
17345 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
17346 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
17347 function instead.
17348
17349 @node Patching
17350 @section Patching Programs
17351
17352 @cindex patching binaries
17353 @cindex writing into executables
17354 @cindex writing into corefiles
17355
17356 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17357 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
17358 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17359 patching your program's binary.
17360
17361 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17362 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
17363 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17364 repairs.
17365
17366 @table @code
17367 @kindex set write
17368 @item set write on
17369 @itemx set write off
17370 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17371 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17372 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
17373
17374 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
17375 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
17376 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
17377
17378 @item show write
17379 @kindex show write
17380 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
17381 as well as reading.
17382 @end table
17383
17384 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
17385 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17386 @cindex injecting code
17387 @cindex writing into executables
17388 @cindex compiling code
17389
17390 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
17391 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
17392 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
17393 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
17394
17395 @table @code
17396 @kindex compile code
17397 @item compile code @var{source-code}
17398 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
17399 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
17400 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
17401 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
17402 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
17403 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
17404 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
17405 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
17406 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
17407 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
17408 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
17409
17410 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
17411 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
17412 E.g.:
17413
17414 @smallexample
17415 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
17416 @end smallexample
17417
17418 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
17419 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
17420 from actual source code. E.g.:
17421
17422 @smallexample
17423 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
17424 @end smallexample
17425
17426 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
17427 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
17428 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
17429 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
17430 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
17431 editor.
17432
17433 @smallexample
17434 compile code
17435 >printf ("hello\n");
17436 >printf ("world\n");
17437 >end
17438 @end smallexample
17439
17440 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
17441 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
17442 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
17443 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
17444 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
17445 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
17446 inferior symbols otherwise.
17447
17448 @kindex compile file
17449 @item compile file @var{filename}
17450 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
17451 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
17452
17453 @smallexample
17454 compile file /home/user/example.c
17455 @end smallexample
17456 @end table
17457
17458 @table @code
17459 @item compile print @var{expr}
17460 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
17461 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
17462 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
17463 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
17464 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
17465 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
17466 Formats}.
17467
17468 @item compile print
17469 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
17470 @cindex reprint the last value
17471 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
17472 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
17473 command without any text following the command. This will start the
17474 multiple-line editor.
17475 @end table
17476
17477 @noindent
17478 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
17479
17480 @table @code
17481 @anchor{set debug compile}
17482 @item set debug compile
17483 @cindex compile command debugging info
17484 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
17485 injecting the code. The default is off.
17486
17487 @item show debug compile
17488 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
17489 compiling and injecting the code.
17490 @end table
17491
17492 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
17493
17494 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
17495 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
17496 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
17497 injecting process.
17498
17499 @noindent
17500 The options used, in increasing precedence:
17501
17502 @table @asis
17503 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
17504 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
17505 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
17506 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
17507
17508 @item compilation options recorded in the target
17509 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
17510 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
17511 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
17512 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
17513 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
17514 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
17515 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
17516
17517 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
17518 @end table
17519
17520 @noindent
17521 You can override compilation options using the following command:
17522
17523 @table @code
17524 @item set compile-args
17525 @cindex compile command options override
17526 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
17527 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
17528 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
17529 compilation.
17530
17531 @item show compile-args
17532 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
17533 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
17534 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
17535 @end table
17536
17537 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
17538
17539 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
17540 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
17541 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
17542
17543 @table @asis
17544 @item C code examples and caveats
17545 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
17546 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
17547 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
17548 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
17549 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
17550
17551 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
17552 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
17553 much like any other normal debugging session.
17554
17555 @smallexample
17556 void function1 (void)
17557 @{
17558 int i = 42;
17559 printf ("function 1\n");
17560 @}
17561
17562 void function2 (void)
17563 @{
17564 int j = 12;
17565 function1 ();
17566 @}
17567
17568 int main(void)
17569 @{
17570 int k = 6;
17571 int *p;
17572 function2 ();
17573 return 0;
17574 @}
17575 @end smallexample
17576
17577 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
17578 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
17579 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
17580
17581 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
17582 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
17583 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
17584 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
17585 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
17586
17587 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
17588 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
17589 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
17590 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
17591 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
17592 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
17593 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
17594 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
17595 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
17596 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
17597
17598 @smallexample
17599 compile code k = 3;
17600 @end smallexample
17601
17602 @noindent
17603 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
17604 something else in the example program changes it, or another
17605 @code{compile} command changes it.
17606
17607 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
17608 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
17609 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
17610 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
17611 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
17612
17613 @smallexample
17614 compile code j = 3;
17615 @end smallexample
17616
17617 @noindent
17618 will result in a compilation error message.
17619
17620 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
17621 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
17622 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
17623
17624 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
17625 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
17626 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
17627 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
17628
17629 @smallexample
17630 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
17631 @end smallexample
17632
17633 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
17634 command has completed:
17635
17636 @smallexample
17637 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
17638 @end smallexample
17639
17640 @noindent
17641 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
17642 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
17643 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
17644 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
17645 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
17646
17647 @smallexample
17648 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
17649 @end smallexample
17650
17651 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
17652 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
17653 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
17654 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
17655 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
17656 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
17657 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
17658 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
17659
17660 @smallexample
17661 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
17662 @end smallexample
17663
17664 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
17665 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
17666 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
17667 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
17668 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
17669 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
17670 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
17671
17672 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
17673 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
17674 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
17675 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
17676 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
17677 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
17678
17679 @smallexample
17680 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
17681 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17682 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
17683 Compilation failed.
17684 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17685 42
17686 @end smallexample
17687
17688 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
17689 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
17690 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
17691 will print to the console.
17692 @end table
17693
17694 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
17695
17696 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged which
17697 may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture than where
17698 @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} (@code{PATH} from
17699 shell that executed @value{GDBN}, not the one set by @value{GDBN}
17700 command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}. @code{PATH} on
17701 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
17702 target architecture and operating system.
17703
17704 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
17705 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
17706 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
17707 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
17708 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
17709 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
17710 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
17711
17712 @node GDB Files
17713 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
17714
17715 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
17716 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
17717 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
17718 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
17719
17720 @menu
17721 * Files:: Commands to specify files
17722 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
17723 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
17724 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
17725 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
17726 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
17727 * Data Files:: GDB data files
17728 @end menu
17729
17730 @node Files
17731 @section Commands to Specify Files
17732
17733 @cindex symbol table
17734 @cindex core dump file
17735
17736 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
17737 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
17738 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
17739 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
17740
17741 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
17742 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
17743 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
17744 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
17745 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
17746 new files are useful.
17747
17748 @table @code
17749 @cindex executable file
17750 @kindex file
17751 @item file @var{filename}
17752 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
17753 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
17754 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
17755 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
17756 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
17757 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
17758 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
17759 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
17760
17761 @cindex unlinked object files
17762 @cindex patching object files
17763 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
17764 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
17765 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
17766 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
17767 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
17768 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
17769 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
17770 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
17771
17772 @item file
17773 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
17774 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
17775
17776 @kindex exec-file
17777 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
17778 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
17779 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
17780 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
17781 discard information on the executable file.
17782
17783 @kindex symbol-file
17784 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
17785 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
17786 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
17787 table and program to run from the same file.
17788
17789 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
17790 program's symbol table.
17791
17792 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
17793 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
17794 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
17795 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
17796 @value{GDBN}.
17797
17798 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
17799 executing it once.
17800
17801 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
17802 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
17803 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
17804 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
17805 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
17806 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
17807 optimized code.
17808
17809 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
17810 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
17811 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
17812 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
17813 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
17814
17815 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
17816 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
17817 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
17818 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
17819 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
17820 Warnings and Messages}.)
17821
17822 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
17823 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
17824 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
17825 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
17826 in stabs format.
17827
17828 @kindex readnow
17829 @cindex reading symbols immediately
17830 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
17831 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
17832 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
17833 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
17834 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
17835 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
17836 entire symbol table available.
17837
17838 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
17839 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
17840 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
17841 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
17842 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
17843 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
17844 @c files.
17845
17846 @kindex core-file
17847 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17848 @itemx core
17849 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
17850 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
17851 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
17852 executable file itself for other parts.
17853
17854 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
17855 to be used.
17856
17857 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
17858 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
17859 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
17860 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
17861 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
17862
17863 @kindex add-symbol-file
17864 @cindex dynamic linking
17865 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
17866 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
17867 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
17868 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
17869 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
17870 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
17871 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
17872 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
17873 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
17874 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
17875 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
17876 @var{address} as an expression.
17877
17878 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
17879 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
17880 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
17881 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
17882
17883 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
17884
17885 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
17886 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
17887 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
17888 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
17889 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
17890 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
17891 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
17892 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
17893 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
17894
17895 @itemize @bullet
17896 @item
17897 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
17898 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
17899 @item
17900 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
17901 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
17902 @item
17903 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
17904 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
17905 @end itemize
17906
17907 @noindent
17908 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
17909 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
17910 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
17911 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
17912 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
17913 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
17914 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
17915 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
17916 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
17917 way.
17918
17919 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17920
17921 @kindex remove-symbol-file
17922 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
17923 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
17924 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
17925 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
17926 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
17927
17928 @smallexample
17929 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
17930 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
17931 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
17932 (y or n) y
17933 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
17934 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
17935 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
17936 (gdb)
17937 @end smallexample
17938
17939
17940 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17941
17942 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
17943 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
17944 @cindex load symbols from memory
17945 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
17946 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
17947 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
17948 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
17949 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
17950 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
17951 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
17952 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
17953 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
17954
17955 @kindex section
17956 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
17957 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
17958 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
17959 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
17960 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
17961 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
17962 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
17963 their addresses.
17964
17965 @kindex info files
17966 @kindex info target
17967 @item info files
17968 @itemx info target
17969 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
17970 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
17971 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
17972 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
17973 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
17974 current ones.
17975
17976 @kindex maint info sections
17977 @item maint info sections
17978 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
17979 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
17980 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
17981 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
17982 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
17983 may be arbitrarily combined):
17984
17985 @table @code
17986 @item ALLOBJ
17987 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
17988 @item @var{sections}
17989 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
17990 @item @var{section-flags}
17991 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
17992 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
17993 @table @code
17994 @item ALLOC
17995 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
17996 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
17997 @item LOAD
17998 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
17999 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
18000 @item RELOC
18001 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
18002 @item READONLY
18003 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
18004 @item CODE
18005 Section contains executable code only.
18006 @item DATA
18007 Section contains data only (no executable code).
18008 @item ROM
18009 Section will reside in ROM.
18010 @item CONSTRUCTOR
18011 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
18012 @item HAS_CONTENTS
18013 Section is not empty.
18014 @item NEVER_LOAD
18015 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
18016 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
18017 A notification to the linker that the section contains
18018 COFF shared library information.
18019 @item IS_COMMON
18020 Section contains common symbols.
18021 @end table
18022 @end table
18023 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
18024 @cindex read-only sections
18025 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
18026 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
18027 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
18028 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
18029 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
18030 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
18031 enhancement to debugging performance.
18032
18033 The default is off.
18034
18035 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
18036 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
18037 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
18038 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
18039
18040 @item show trust-readonly-sections
18041 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
18042 @end table
18043
18044 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
18045 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
18046 name and remembers it that way.
18047
18048 @cindex shared libraries
18049 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
18050 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
18051 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
18052 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
18053
18054 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
18055 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
18056
18057 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
18058 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
18059 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
18060 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
18061 debugging a core file).
18062
18063 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
18064 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
18065 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
18066
18067 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
18068 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
18069 particularly large or there are many of them.
18070
18071 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
18072 commands:
18073
18074 @table @code
18075 @kindex set auto-solib-add
18076 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
18077 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
18078 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
18079 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
18080 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
18081 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
18082 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
18083
18084 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
18085 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
18086 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
18087 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
18088 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
18089 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
18090 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
18091 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
18092 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
18093
18094 @kindex show auto-solib-add
18095 @item show auto-solib-add
18096 Display the current autoloading mode.
18097 @end table
18098
18099 @cindex load shared library
18100 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
18101 command:
18102
18103 @table @code
18104 @kindex info sharedlibrary
18105 @kindex info share
18106 @item info share @var{regex}
18107 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18108 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
18109 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
18110 all shared libraries that are loaded.
18111
18112 @kindex info dll
18113 @item info dll @var{regex}
18114 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
18115
18116 @kindex sharedlibrary
18117 @kindex share
18118 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
18119 @itemx share @var{regex}
18120 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
18121 Unix regular expression.
18122 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
18123 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
18124 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
18125 loaded.
18126
18127 @item nosharedlibrary
18128 @kindex nosharedlibrary
18129 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
18130 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
18131 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
18132 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
18133 discarded.
18134 @end table
18135
18136 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
18137 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
18138 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
18139 Catchpoints}).
18140
18141 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
18142 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
18143 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
18144 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
18145
18146 @table @code
18147 @item set stop-on-solib-events
18148 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
18149 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
18150 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
18151 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
18152 shared library.
18153
18154 @item show stop-on-solib-events
18155 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
18156 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
18157 library events happen.
18158 @end table
18159
18160 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
18161 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
18162 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
18163 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
18164 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
18165 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
18166 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
18167 not.
18168
18169 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
18170 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
18171 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
18172 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
18173 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
18174
18175 @table @code
18176 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
18177 @cindex system root, alternate
18178 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
18179 @kindex set sysroot
18180 @item set sysroot @var{path}
18181 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
18182 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
18183 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
18184 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
18185 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
18186 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
18187 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
18188 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
18189 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
18190 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
18191 @var{path}.
18192
18193 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
18194 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
18195 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
18196 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
18197 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
18198 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
18199 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
18200 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
18201 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
18202 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
18203 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
18204 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
18205 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
18206 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
18207
18208 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
18209 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
18210 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
18211 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
18212 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
18213
18214 @smallexample
18215 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
18216 @end smallexample
18217
18218 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
18219 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
18220 system:
18221
18222 @smallexample
18223 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
18224 @end smallexample
18225
18226 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
18227 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
18228 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
18229 colons:
18230
18231 @smallexample
18232 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
18233 @end smallexample
18234
18235 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
18236 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
18237 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
18238 @samp{z}):
18239
18240 @smallexample
18241 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
18242 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18243 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
18244 @end smallexample
18245
18246 @noindent
18247 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
18248 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
18249 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
18250
18251 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
18252 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
18253
18254 @smallexample
18255 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
18256 @end smallexample
18257
18258 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
18259 if you don't want or need to.
18260
18261 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
18262 sysroot}.
18263
18264 @cindex default system root
18265 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
18266 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
18267 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
18268 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18269 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
18270 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18271 location.
18272
18273 @kindex show sysroot
18274 @item show sysroot
18275 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
18276
18277 @kindex set solib-search-path
18278 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
18279 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18280 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
18281 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
18282 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
18283 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
18284 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18285 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
18286 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
18287 of shared library symbols.
18288
18289 @kindex show solib-search-path
18290 @item show solib-search-path
18291 Display the current shared library search path.
18292
18293 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
18294 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
18295 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
18296 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
18297 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
18298
18299 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
18300 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
18301 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
18302 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
18303 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
18304 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
18305 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
18306 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
18307 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
18308 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
18309 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
18310 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
18311 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
18312 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
18313 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
18314 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
18315 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
18316 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
18317 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
18318 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
18319 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
18320 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
18321
18322 @table @code
18323 @item unix
18324 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
18325 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
18326 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
18327 the forward slash.
18328
18329 @item dos-based
18330 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
18331 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
18332 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
18333 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
18334 considered directory separators.
18335
18336 @item auto
18337 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
18338 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
18339 This is the default.
18340 @end table
18341 @end table
18342
18343 @cindex file name canonicalization
18344 @cindex base name differences
18345 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
18346 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
18347 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
18348 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
18349 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
18350 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
18351 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
18352 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
18353 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
18354 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
18355 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
18356 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
18357 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
18358 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
18359 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
18360
18361 @table @code
18362 @item set basenames-may-differ
18363 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
18364 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18365
18366 @item show basenames-may-differ
18367 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
18368 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18369 @end table
18370
18371 @node File Caching
18372 @section File Caching
18373 @cindex caching of opened files
18374 @cindex caching of bfd objects
18375
18376 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
18377 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
18378 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
18379 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
18380
18381 @table @code
18382 @kindex maint info bfds
18383 @item maint info bfds
18384 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
18385 @value{GDBN}.
18386
18387 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
18388 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
18389 @kindex bfd caching
18390 @item maint set bfd-sharing
18391 @item maint show bfd-sharing
18392 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
18393 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
18394 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
18395 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
18396 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
18397 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
18398 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
18399
18400 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18401 @kindex bfd caching
18402 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
18403 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
18404
18405 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
18406 @kindex bfd caching
18407 @item show debug bfd-cache
18408 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
18409 @end table
18410
18411 @node Separate Debug Files
18412 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
18413 @cindex separate debugging information files
18414 @cindex debugging information in separate files
18415 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
18416 @cindex debugging information directory, global
18417 @cindex global debugging information directories
18418 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
18419 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
18420
18421 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
18422 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
18423 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
18424 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
18425 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
18426 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
18427 install only when they need to debug a problem.
18428
18429 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
18430 file:
18431
18432 @itemize @bullet
18433 @item
18434 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
18435 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
18436 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
18437 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
18438 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
18439 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
18440 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
18441 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
18442
18443 @item
18444 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
18445 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
18446 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
18447 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
18448 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
18449 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
18450 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
18451 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
18452 below.
18453 @end itemize
18454
18455 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
18456 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
18457
18458 @itemize @bullet
18459 @item
18460 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
18461 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
18462 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
18463 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
18464 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
18465
18466 @item
18467 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
18468 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
18469 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
18470 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
18471 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
18472 hex characters, not 10.)
18473 @end itemize
18474
18475 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
18476 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
18477 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
18478 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
18479 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
18480 debug information files, in the indicated order:
18481
18482 @itemize @minus
18483 @item
18484 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
18485 @item
18486 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
18487 @item
18488 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
18489 @item
18490 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
18491 @end itemize
18492
18493 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
18494 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
18495 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
18496 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
18497 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
18498
18499 @table @code
18500
18501 @kindex set debug-file-directory
18502 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
18503 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18504 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
18505 concatenating them by a path separator.
18506
18507 @kindex show debug-file-directory
18508 @item show debug-file-directory
18509 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18510 information files.
18511
18512 @end table
18513
18514 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
18515 @cindex debug link sections
18516 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
18517 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
18518
18519 @itemize
18520 @item
18521 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
18522 a zero byte,
18523 @item
18524 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
18525 boundary within the section, and
18526 @item
18527 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
18528 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
18529 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
18530 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
18531 @end itemize
18532
18533 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
18534 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
18535 described above.
18536
18537 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
18538 @cindex build ID sections
18539 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
18540 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
18541 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
18542 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
18543 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
18544 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
18545 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
18546 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
18547 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
18548
18549 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
18550 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
18551 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
18552 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
18553 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
18554 in an ordinary executable.
18555
18556 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
18557 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
18558 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
18559 following commands:
18560
18561 @smallexample
18562 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
18563 @kbd{strip -g foo}
18564 @end smallexample
18565
18566 @noindent
18567 These commands remove the debugging
18568 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
18569 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
18570 two files:
18571
18572 @itemize @bullet
18573 @item
18574 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
18575 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
18576
18577 @smallexample
18578 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
18579 @end smallexample
18580
18581 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
18582 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
18583 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
18584 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
18585
18586 @item
18587 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
18588 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
18589 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
18590 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
18591 @end itemize
18592
18593 @noindent
18594
18595 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
18596 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
18597 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
18598
18599 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
18600 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
18601 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
18602 @c different ways!
18603 @ifhtml
18604 @display
18605 @html
18606 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
18607 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
18608 @end html
18609 @end display
18610 @end ifhtml
18611 @ifnothtml
18612 @display
18613 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
18614 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
18615 @end display
18616 @end ifnothtml
18617
18618 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
18619 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
18620 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
18621 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
18622 CRC.
18623
18624 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
18625 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
18626 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
18627 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
18628 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
18629
18630 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
18631 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
18632 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
18633 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
18634 @code{0xffffffff}.
18635
18636 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
18637 @smallexample
18638 unsigned long
18639 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
18640 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
18641 @{
18642 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
18643 @{
18644 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
18645 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
18646 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
18647 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
18648 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
18649 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
18650 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
18651 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
18652 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
18653 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
18654 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
18655 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
18656 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
18657 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
18658 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
18659 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
18660 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
18661 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
18662 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
18663 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
18664 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
18665 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
18666 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
18667 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
18668 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
18669 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
18670 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
18671 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
18672 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
18673 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
18674 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
18675 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
18676 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
18677 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
18678 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
18679 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
18680 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
18681 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
18682 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
18683 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
18684 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
18685 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
18686 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
18687 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
18688 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
18689 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
18690 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
18691 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
18692 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
18693 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
18694 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
18695 0x2d02ef8d
18696 @};
18697 unsigned char *end;
18698
18699 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18700 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
18701 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
18702 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18703 @}
18704 @end smallexample
18705
18706 @noindent
18707 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
18708
18709 @node MiniDebugInfo
18710 @section Debugging information in a special section
18711 @cindex separate debug sections
18712 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
18713
18714 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
18715 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
18716 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
18717 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
18718
18719 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
18720 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
18721 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
18722 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
18723 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
18724 debugging information might be included in the section.
18725
18726 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
18727 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
18728 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
18729
18730 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
18731 standard utilities:
18732
18733 @smallexample
18734 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
18735 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
18736 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
18737 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
18738
18739 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
18740 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
18741 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
18742 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
18743 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
18744 | sort > funcsyms
18745
18746 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
18747 # table.
18748 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
18749
18750 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
18751 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
18752
18753 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
18754 # removing some unnecessary sections.
18755 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
18756 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
18757
18758 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
18759 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
18760
18761 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
18762 # original binary.
18763 xz mini_debuginfo
18764 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
18765 @end smallexample
18766
18767 @node Index Files
18768 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
18769 @cindex index files
18770 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
18771
18772 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
18773 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
18774 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
18775 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
18776 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
18777 startup.
18778
18779 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
18780 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
18781 using @command{objcopy}.
18782
18783 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
18784
18785 @table @code
18786 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
18787 @kindex save gdb-index
18788 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
18789 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
18790 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
18791 @var{directory}.
18792 @end table
18793
18794 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
18795 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
18796
18797 @smallexample
18798 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
18799 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
18800 @end smallexample
18801
18802 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
18803 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
18804 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
18805 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
18806 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
18807 The default is @code{off}.
18808 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
18809 @xref{Index Section Format}.
18810
18811 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
18812 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
18813
18814 @smallexample
18815 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
18816 @end smallexample
18817
18818 Instead you must do, for example,
18819
18820 @smallexample
18821 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
18822 @end smallexample
18823
18824 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
18825 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
18826 currently work for programs using Ada.
18827
18828 @node Symbol Errors
18829 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
18830
18831 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
18832 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
18833 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
18834 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
18835 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
18836 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
18837 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
18838 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
18839 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
18840 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
18841 Messages}).
18842
18843 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
18844
18845 @table @code
18846 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
18847
18848 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
18849 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
18850 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
18851 in its outer scope blocks.
18852
18853 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
18854 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
18855 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
18856 function.
18857
18858 @item block at @var{address} out of order
18859
18860 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
18861 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
18862 do so.
18863
18864 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
18865 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
18866 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
18867 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
18868 Messages}.)
18869
18870 @item bad block start address patched
18871
18872 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
18873 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
18874 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
18875
18876 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
18877 starting on the previous source line.
18878
18879 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
18880
18881 @cindex foo
18882 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
18883 larger than the size of the string table.
18884
18885 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
18886 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
18887 with this name.
18888
18889 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
18890
18891 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
18892 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
18893 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
18894
18895 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
18896 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
18897 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
18898 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
18899 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
18900 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
18901
18902 @item stub type has NULL name
18903
18904 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
18905
18906 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
18907 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
18908 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
18909 it.
18910
18911 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
18912
18913 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
18914
18915 @end table
18916
18917 @node Data Files
18918 @section GDB Data Files
18919
18920 @cindex prefix for data files
18921 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
18922 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
18923
18924 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
18925 is currently using.
18926
18927 @table @code
18928 @kindex set data-directory
18929 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
18930 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
18931 to @var{directory}.
18932
18933 @kindex show data-directory
18934 @item show data-directory
18935 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
18936 @end table
18937
18938 @cindex default data directory
18939 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
18940 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
18941 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
18942 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18943 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
18944 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18945 location.
18946
18947 The data directory may also be specified with the
18948 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
18949 @xref{Mode Options}.
18950
18951 @node Targets
18952 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
18953
18954 @cindex debugging target
18955 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
18956
18957 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
18958 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
18959 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
18960 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
18961 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
18962 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
18963 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
18964 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
18965
18966 @cindex target architecture
18967 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
18968 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
18969 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
18970 command.
18971
18972 @table @code
18973 @kindex set architecture
18974 @kindex show architecture
18975 @item set architecture @var{arch}
18976 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
18977 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
18978 supported architectures.
18979
18980 @item show architecture
18981 Show the current target architecture.
18982
18983 @item set processor
18984 @itemx processor
18985 @kindex set processor
18986 @kindex show processor
18987 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
18988 and @code{show architecture}.
18989 @end table
18990
18991 @menu
18992 * Active Targets:: Active targets
18993 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
18994 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
18995 @end menu
18996
18997 @node Active Targets
18998 @section Active Targets
18999
19000 @cindex stacking targets
19001 @cindex active targets
19002 @cindex multiple targets
19003
19004 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
19005 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
19006 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
19007 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
19008 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
19009 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
19010 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
19011 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
19012 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
19013
19014 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
19015 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
19016 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
19017 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
19018
19019 @node Target Commands
19020 @section Commands for Managing Targets
19021
19022 @table @code
19023 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
19024 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
19025 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
19026 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
19027 protocol of the target machine.
19028
19029 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
19030 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
19031 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
19032
19033 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
19034 after executing the command.
19035
19036 @kindex help target
19037 @item help target
19038 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
19039 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
19040 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
19041
19042 @item help target @var{name}
19043 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
19044 select it.
19045
19046 @kindex set gnutarget
19047 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
19048 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
19049 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
19050 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
19051 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
19052 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
19053
19054 @quotation
19055 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
19056 you must know the actual BFD name.
19057 @end quotation
19058
19059 @noindent
19060 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
19061
19062 @kindex show gnutarget
19063 @item show gnutarget
19064 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
19065 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
19066 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
19067 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
19068 @end table
19069
19070 @cindex common targets
19071 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
19072 configuration):
19073
19074 @table @code
19075 @kindex target
19076 @item target exec @var{program}
19077 @cindex executable file target
19078 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
19079 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
19080
19081 @item target core @var{filename}
19082 @cindex core dump file target
19083 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
19084 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
19085
19086 @item target remote @var{medium}
19087 @cindex remote target
19088 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
19089 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
19090 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
19091
19092 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
19093 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
19094
19095 @smallexample
19096 target remote /dev/ttya
19097 @end smallexample
19098
19099 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
19100 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
19101 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
19102 clobbered by the download.
19103
19104 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
19105 @cindex built-in simulator target
19106 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
19107 In general,
19108 @smallexample
19109 target sim
19110 load
19111 run
19112 @end smallexample
19113 @noindent
19114 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
19115 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
19116 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
19117 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
19118 Processors}.
19119
19120 @item target native
19121 @cindex native target
19122 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
19123 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
19124 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
19125 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
19126
19127 @end table
19128
19129 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
19130 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
19131
19132 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
19133 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
19134 various aspects of this process.
19135
19136 @table @code
19137
19138 @item set hash
19139 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19140 @cindex hash mark while downloading
19141 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
19142 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
19143 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
19144 monitor.
19145
19146 @item show hash
19147 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
19148 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
19149
19150 @item set debug monitor
19151 @kindex set debug monitor
19152 @cindex display remote monitor communications
19153 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
19154 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19155
19156 @item show debug monitor
19157 @kindex show debug monitor
19158 Show the current status of displaying communications between
19159 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
19160 @end table
19161
19162 @table @code
19163
19164 @kindex load @var{filename}
19165 @item load @var{filename}
19166 @anchor{load}
19167 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
19168 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
19169 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
19170 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
19171 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
19172 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19173
19174 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
19175 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
19176 target is @dots{}}''
19177
19178 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
19179 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
19180 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
19181 specifies a fixed address.
19182 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
19183
19184 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
19185 load programs into flash memory.
19186
19187 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
19188 @end table
19189
19190 @node Byte Order
19191 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
19192
19193 @cindex choosing target byte order
19194 @cindex target byte order
19195
19196 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
19197 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
19198 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
19199 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
19200 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
19201 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
19202
19203 @table @code
19204 @kindex set endian
19205 @item set endian big
19206 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
19207
19208 @item set endian little
19209 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
19210
19211 @item set endian auto
19212 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
19213 executable.
19214
19215 @item show endian
19216 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
19217
19218 @end table
19219
19220 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
19221 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
19222 target system.
19223
19224
19225 @node Remote Debugging
19226 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
19227 @cindex remote debugging
19228
19229 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
19230 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
19231 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
19232 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
19233 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
19234
19235 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
19236 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
19237 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
19238 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
19239 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
19240 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
19241
19242 Other remote targets may be available in your
19243 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
19244
19245 @menu
19246 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
19247 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
19248 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
19249 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
19250 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
19251 @end menu
19252
19253 @node Connecting
19254 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
19255 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
19256 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
19257 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
19258 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
19259 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
19260 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
19261
19262 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
19263 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
19264 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
19265 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
19266
19267 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
19268
19269 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
19270 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
19271 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
19272 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
19273
19274 @table @asis
19275
19276 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
19277 @item Result of detach or program exit
19278 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
19279 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
19280 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
19281
19282 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
19283 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
19284 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
19285 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
19286
19287 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
19288 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
19289 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
19290 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
19291
19292 @item Specifying the program to debug
19293 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
19294 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
19295 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
19296 target.
19297
19298 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
19299 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
19300 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
19301
19302 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19303 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
19304 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
19305 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
19306
19307 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
19308 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19309 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
19310 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
19311 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
19312 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
19313 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
19314 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
19315 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19316
19317 @item The @code{run} command
19318 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
19319 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
19320 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
19321 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
19322 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
19323
19324 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
19325 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
19326 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
19327 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
19328 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19329
19330 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
19331 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
19332 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
19333 @code{target remote} mode.
19334
19335 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
19336 @item Attaching
19337 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
19338 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
19339 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19340
19341 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
19342 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
19343 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
19344 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
19345 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
19346
19347 @end table
19348
19349 @anchor{Host and target files}
19350 @subsection Host and Target Files
19351 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
19352 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
19353
19354 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
19355 information for your program running on the target. This requires
19356 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
19357 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
19358 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
19359
19360 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
19361 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
19362 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
19363 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
19364 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
19365
19366 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
19367 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
19368 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
19369 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
19370 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
19371 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
19372 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
19373 target libraries.
19374
19375 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
19376 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
19377 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
19378 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
19379 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
19380 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
19381 programs.
19382
19383 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
19384 @cindex remote connection commands
19385 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
19386 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
19387 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
19388 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
19389 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
19390 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
19391 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
19392
19393 @table @code
19394
19395 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
19396 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
19397 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
19398 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
19399 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
19400
19401 @smallexample
19402 target remote /dev/ttyb
19403 @end smallexample
19404
19405 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
19406 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
19407 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
19408 @code{target} command.
19409
19410 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19411 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19412 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
19413 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19414 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
19415 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
19416 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
19417 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
19418 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
19419 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
19420 target.
19421
19422 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
19423 @code{manyfarms}:
19424
19425 @smallexample
19426 target remote manyfarms:2828
19427 @end smallexample
19428
19429 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
19430 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
19431 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
19432 port 1234 on your local machine:
19433
19434 @smallexample
19435 target remote :1234
19436 @end smallexample
19437 @noindent
19438
19439 Note that the colon is still required here.
19440
19441 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19442 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19443 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
19444 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
19445 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
19446
19447 @smallexample
19448 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
19449 @end smallexample
19450
19451 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
19452 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
19453 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
19454 cause havoc with your debugging session.
19455
19456 @item target remote | @var{command}
19457 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
19458 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
19459 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
19460 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
19461 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
19462 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
19463 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
19464 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
19465 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
19466
19467 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
19468 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
19469 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
19470
19471 @end table
19472
19473 @cindex interrupting remote programs
19474 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
19475 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
19476 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
19477 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
19478 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
19479 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
19480
19481 @smallexample
19482 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
19483 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
19484 @end smallexample
19485
19486 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
19487 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
19488 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
19489 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
19490
19491 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
19492 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
19493
19494 @table @code
19495 @kindex detach (remote)
19496 @item detach
19497 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
19498 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
19499 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
19500 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
19501 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
19502 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
19503 still connected to the target.
19504
19505 @kindex disconnect
19506 @item disconnect
19507 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
19508 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
19509 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
19510 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
19511 another target.
19512
19513 @cindex send command to remote monitor
19514 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
19515 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
19516 @kindex monitor
19517 @item monitor @var{cmd}
19518 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
19519 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
19520 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
19521 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
19522 and implement.
19523 @end table
19524
19525 @node File Transfer
19526 @section Sending files to a remote system
19527 @cindex remote target, file transfer
19528 @cindex file transfer
19529 @cindex sending files to remote systems
19530
19531 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
19532 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
19533 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
19534 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
19535 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
19536 the only way to upload or download files.
19537
19538 Not all remote targets support these commands.
19539
19540 @table @code
19541 @kindex remote put
19542 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
19543 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
19544 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
19545
19546 @kindex remote get
19547 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
19548 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
19549 on the host system.
19550
19551 @kindex remote delete
19552 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
19553 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
19554
19555 @end table
19556
19557 @node Server
19558 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
19559
19560 @kindex gdbserver
19561 @cindex remote connection without stubs
19562 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
19563 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
19564 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
19565 linking in the usual debugging stub.
19566
19567 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
19568 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
19569 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
19570 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
19571 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
19572 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
19573 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
19574 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
19575 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
19576 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
19577 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
19578 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
19579 choice for debugging.
19580
19581 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
19582 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
19583 protocol.
19584
19585 @quotation
19586 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
19587 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
19588 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
19589 target system with the same privileges as the user running
19590 @code{gdbserver}.
19591 @end quotation
19592
19593 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
19594 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
19595 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
19596 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
19597
19598 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
19599 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
19600 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
19601 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
19602 system does all the symbol handling.
19603
19604 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
19605 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
19606 syntax is:
19607
19608 @smallexample
19609 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
19610 @end smallexample
19611
19612 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
19613 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
19614 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
19615 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
19616 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
19617 @file{/dev/com1}:
19618
19619 @smallexample
19620 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
19621 @end smallexample
19622
19623 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
19624 with it.
19625
19626 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
19627
19628 @smallexample
19629 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
19630 @end smallexample
19631
19632 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
19633 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
19634 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
19635 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
19636 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
19637 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
19638 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
19639 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
19640 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
19641 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
19642 @code{target remote} command.
19643
19644 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
19645 with ssh:
19646
19647 @smallexample
19648 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
19649 @end smallexample
19650
19651 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
19652 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
19653 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
19654 You could elide it if you want to.
19655
19656 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
19657 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
19658 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
19659 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
19660
19661 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
19662 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
19663 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
19664 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
19665
19666 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
19667 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
19668
19669 @smallexample
19670 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
19671 @end smallexample
19672
19673 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
19674 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
19675
19676 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
19677 @value{GDBN} attach command
19678 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
19679
19680 @pindex pidof
19681 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
19682 @code{pidof} utility:
19683
19684 @smallexample
19685 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
19686 @end smallexample
19687
19688 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
19689 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
19690 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
19691
19692 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
19693
19694 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
19695 port.
19696
19697 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
19698 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
19699 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
19700 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
19701 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
19702 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
19703 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
19704 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
19705
19706 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
19707 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
19708 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
19709
19710 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
19711 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
19712 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
19713 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
19714 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
19715 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
19716 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
19717 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
19718 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
19719 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
19720 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
19721 instance closes its port after the first connection.
19722
19723 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
19724 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
19725
19726 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
19727 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
19728 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
19729 program. For more information,
19730 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
19731
19732 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
19733 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
19734 status information about the debugging process.
19735 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
19736 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
19737 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
19738 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
19739
19740 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
19741 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
19742 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
19743 Possible options are:
19744
19745 @table @code
19746 @item none
19747 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
19748 @item all
19749 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
19750 @item timestamps
19751 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
19752 @end table
19753
19754 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
19755 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
19756
19757 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
19758 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
19759 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
19760 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
19761 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
19762
19763 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
19764 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
19765 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
19766 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
19767
19768 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
19769 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
19770 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
19771 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
19772
19773 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
19774 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
19775 environment:
19776
19777 @smallexample
19778 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
19779 @end smallexample
19780
19781 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
19782
19783 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
19784 @itemize
19785
19786 @item
19787 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
19788
19789 @item
19790 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
19791 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
19792 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
19793 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
19794 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
19795 @code{--with-sysroot}).
19796
19797 @item
19798 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
19799 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
19800 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
19801 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
19802 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
19803 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
19804 program is already on the target.
19805
19806 @end itemize
19807
19808 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
19809 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
19810 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
19811
19812 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
19813 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
19814 Here are the available commands.
19815
19816 @table @code
19817 @item monitor help
19818 List the available monitor commands.
19819
19820 @item monitor set debug 0
19821 @itemx monitor set debug 1
19822 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
19823
19824 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
19825 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
19826 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
19827 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
19828
19829 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
19830 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
19831 Possible options are:
19832
19833 @table @code
19834 @item none
19835 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
19836 @item all
19837 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
19838 @item timestamps
19839 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
19840 @end table
19841
19842 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
19843 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
19844
19845 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
19846 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
19847 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19848 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
19849 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
19850 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
19851
19852 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
19853 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
19854
19855 @item monitor exit
19856 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
19857 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
19858 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
19859 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
19860 of a multi-process mode debug session.
19861
19862 @end table
19863
19864 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
19865 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
19866
19867 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
19868 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
19869
19870 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
19871 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
19872 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
19873 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
19874 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
19875 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
19876 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
19877 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
19878 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
19879 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
19880 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
19881 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
19882
19883 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
19884
19885 @table @code
19886 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
19887
19888 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
19889 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
19890 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
19891
19892 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
19893
19894 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
19895 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
19896 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
19897 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
19898 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
19899 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
19900
19901 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
19902
19903 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
19904 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
19905 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
19906 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
19907 command for that. For example:
19908
19909 @smallexample
19910 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
19911 @end smallexample
19912
19913 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
19914 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
19915 @end table
19916
19917 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
19918 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
19919 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
19920 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
19921 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
19922 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
19923 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
19924 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
19925 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
19926 @code{gdbserver} like so:
19927
19928 @smallexample
19929 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
19930 @end smallexample
19931
19932 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
19933
19934 @smallexample
19935 $ gdb myprogram
19936 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
19937 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
19938 (@value{GDBP}) b main
19939 (@value{GDBP}) continue
19940 @end smallexample
19941
19942 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
19943 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
19944 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
19945 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
19946 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
19947 tracing.
19948
19949 @node Remote Configuration
19950 @section Remote Configuration
19951
19952 @kindex set remote
19953 @kindex show remote
19954 This section documents the configuration options available when
19955 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
19956 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
19957 system-call-allowed}.
19958
19959 @table @code
19960 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
19961 @cindex address size for remote targets
19962 @cindex bits in remote address
19963 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
19964 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
19965 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
19966 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
19967
19968 @item show remoteaddresssize
19969 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
19970
19971 @item set serial baud @var{n}
19972 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
19973 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
19974 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
19975 remote targets.
19976
19977 @item show serial baud
19978 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
19979
19980 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
19981 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
19982 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
19983
19984 @item show serial parity
19985 Show the current parity of the serial port.
19986
19987 @item set remotebreak
19988 @cindex interrupt remote programs
19989 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
19990 @anchor{set remotebreak}
19991 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
19992 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
19993 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
19994 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
19995 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
19996
19997 @item show remotebreak
19998 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
19999 interrupt the remote program.
20000
20001 @item set remoteflow on
20002 @itemx set remoteflow off
20003 @kindex set remoteflow
20004 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
20005 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
20006
20007 @item show remoteflow
20008 @kindex show remoteflow
20009 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
20010
20011 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
20012 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
20013 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
20014 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
20015 @code{ascii}.
20016
20017 @item show remotelogbase
20018 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
20019 protocol.
20020
20021 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
20022 @cindex record serial communications on file
20023 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
20024 default is not to record at all.
20025
20026 @item show remotelogfile.
20027 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
20028 serial communications.
20029
20030 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
20031 @cindex timeout for serial communications
20032 @cindex remote timeout
20033 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
20034 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
20035
20036 @item show remotetimeout
20037 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
20038 responses.
20039
20040 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
20041 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
20042 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
20043 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
20044 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
20045 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
20046 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
20047 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
20048
20049 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
20050 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
20051 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
20052 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
20053 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
20054 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
20055 as unlimited.
20056
20057 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
20058 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
20059 a remote hardware watchpoint.
20060
20061 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
20062 @itemx show remote exec-file
20063 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
20064 @cindex executable file, for remote target
20065 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
20066 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
20067 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
20068 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
20069
20070 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
20071 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20072 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
20073 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
20074 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
20075 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
20076 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
20077 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
20078 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
20079 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
20080
20081 @item show interrupt-sequence
20082 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
20083 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
20084 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
20085 also known as Magic SysRq g.
20086
20087 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
20088 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
20089 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
20090 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
20091 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
20092 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
20093
20094 @item show interrupt-on-connect
20095 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
20096 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
20097
20098 @kindex set tcp
20099 @kindex show tcp
20100 @item set tcp auto-retry on
20101 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
20102 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
20103 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
20104 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
20105 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
20106 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
20107 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
20108 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
20109
20110 @item set tcp auto-retry off
20111 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
20112
20113 @item show tcp auto-retry
20114 Show the current auto-retry setting.
20115
20116 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
20117 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
20118 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
20119 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
20120 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
20121 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
20122 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
20123 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
20124 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
20125 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
20126 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
20127
20128 @item show tcp connect-timeout
20129 Show the current connection timeout setting.
20130 @end table
20131
20132 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
20133 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
20134 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
20135 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
20136 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
20137 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
20138 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
20139 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
20140 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
20141
20142 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
20143 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
20144 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
20145 @value{GDBN} developers.
20146
20147 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
20148 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
20149 are:
20150
20151 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
20152 @item Command Name
20153 @tab Remote Packet
20154 @tab Related Features
20155
20156 @item @code{fetch-register}
20157 @tab @code{p}
20158 @tab @code{info registers}
20159
20160 @item @code{set-register}
20161 @tab @code{P}
20162 @tab @code{set}
20163
20164 @item @code{binary-download}
20165 @tab @code{X}
20166 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
20167
20168 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
20169 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
20170 @tab @code{info auxv}
20171
20172 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
20173 @tab @code{qSymbol}
20174 @tab Detecting multiple threads
20175
20176 @item @code{attach}
20177 @tab @code{vAttach}
20178 @tab @code{attach}
20179
20180 @item @code{verbose-resume}
20181 @tab @code{vCont}
20182 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
20183
20184 @item @code{run}
20185 @tab @code{vRun}
20186 @tab @code{run}
20187
20188 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
20189 @tab @code{Z0}
20190 @tab @code{break}
20191
20192 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
20193 @tab @code{Z1}
20194 @tab @code{hbreak}
20195
20196 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
20197 @tab @code{Z2}
20198 @tab @code{watch}
20199
20200 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
20201 @tab @code{Z3}
20202 @tab @code{rwatch}
20203
20204 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
20205 @tab @code{Z4}
20206 @tab @code{awatch}
20207
20208 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
20209 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
20210 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
20211
20212 @item @code{target-features}
20213 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
20214 @tab @code{set architecture}
20215
20216 @item @code{library-info}
20217 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
20218 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
20219
20220 @item @code{memory-map}
20221 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
20222 @tab @code{info mem}
20223
20224 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
20225 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
20226 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
20227
20228 @item @code{read-spu-object}
20229 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
20230 @tab @code{info spu}
20231
20232 @item @code{write-spu-object}
20233 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
20234 @tab @code{info spu}
20235
20236 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
20237 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
20238 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
20239
20240 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
20241 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
20242 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
20243
20244 @item @code{threads}
20245 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
20246 @tab @code{info threads}
20247
20248 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
20249 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
20250 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
20251
20252 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
20253 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
20254 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
20255
20256 @item @code{search-memory}
20257 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
20258 @tab @code{find}
20259
20260 @item @code{supported-packets}
20261 @tab @code{qSupported}
20262 @tab Remote communications parameters
20263
20264 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
20265 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
20266 @tab @code{catch syscall}
20267
20268 @item @code{pass-signals}
20269 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
20270 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20271
20272 @item @code{program-signals}
20273 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
20274 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
20275
20276 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
20277 @tab @code{vFile:close}
20278 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20279
20280 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
20281 @tab @code{vFile:open}
20282 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20283
20284 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
20285 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
20286 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20287
20288 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
20289 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
20290 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
20291
20292 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
20293 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
20294 @tab @code{remote delete}
20295
20296 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
20297 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
20298 @tab Host I/O
20299
20300 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
20301 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
20302 @tab Host I/O
20303
20304 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
20305 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
20306 @tab Host I/O
20307
20308 @item @code{noack-packet}
20309 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
20310 @tab Packet acknowledgment
20311
20312 @item @code{osdata}
20313 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
20314 @tab @code{info os}
20315
20316 @item @code{query-attached}
20317 @tab @code{qAttached}
20318 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
20319
20320 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
20321 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
20322 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
20323
20324 @item @code{trace-status}
20325 @tab @code{qTStatus}
20326 @tab @code{tstatus}
20327
20328 @item @code{traceframe-info}
20329 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
20330 @tab Traceframe info
20331
20332 @item @code{install-in-trace}
20333 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
20334 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
20335
20336 @item @code{disable-randomization}
20337 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
20338 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
20339
20340 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
20341 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
20342 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
20343
20344 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
20345 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
20346 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
20347
20348 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
20349 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
20350 @tab @code{break}
20351
20352 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
20353 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
20354 @tab @code{hbreak}
20355
20356 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
20357 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
20358 @tab @code{fork}
20359
20360 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
20361 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
20362 @tab @code{vfork}
20363
20364 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
20365 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
20366 @tab @code{exec}
20367
20368 @item @code{thread-events}
20369 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
20370 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20371
20372 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
20373 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
20374 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
20375
20376 @end multitable
20377
20378 @node Remote Stub
20379 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
20380
20381 @cindex debugging stub, example
20382 @cindex remote stub, example
20383 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
20384 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
20385 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
20386 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
20387 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
20388 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
20389 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
20390 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
20391
20392 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
20393 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
20394 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
20395 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
20396 program, you need:
20397
20398 @enumerate
20399 @item
20400 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
20401 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
20402 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
20403
20404 @item
20405 A C subroutine library to support your program's
20406 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
20407
20408 @item
20409 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
20410 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
20411 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
20412 documentation.
20413 @end enumerate
20414
20415 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
20416 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
20417 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
20418
20419 @table @emph
20420 @item On the host,
20421 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
20422 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
20423 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
20424
20425 @item On the target,
20426 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
20427 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
20428 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
20429
20430 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
20431 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
20432 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
20433 @end table
20434
20435 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
20436 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
20437 @sc{sparc} boards.
20438
20439 @cindex remote serial stub list
20440 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
20441
20442 @table @code
20443
20444 @item i386-stub.c
20445 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
20446 @cindex Intel
20447 @cindex i386
20448 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
20449
20450 @item m68k-stub.c
20451 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
20452 @cindex Motorola 680x0
20453 @cindex m680x0
20454 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
20455
20456 @item sh-stub.c
20457 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
20458 @cindex Renesas
20459 @cindex SH
20460 For Renesas SH architectures.
20461
20462 @item sparc-stub.c
20463 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
20464 @cindex Sparc
20465 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
20466
20467 @item sparcl-stub.c
20468 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
20469 @cindex Fujitsu
20470 @cindex SparcLite
20471 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
20472
20473 @end table
20474
20475 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
20476 recently added stubs.
20477
20478 @menu
20479 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
20480 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
20481 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
20482 @end menu
20483
20484 @node Stub Contents
20485 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
20486
20487 @cindex remote serial stub
20488 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
20489 subroutines:
20490
20491 @table @code
20492 @item set_debug_traps
20493 @findex set_debug_traps
20494 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
20495 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
20496 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
20497 program's startup code.
20498
20499 @item handle_exception
20500 @findex handle_exception
20501 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
20502 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
20503 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
20504 run when a trap is triggered.
20505
20506 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
20507 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
20508 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
20509 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
20510 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
20511 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
20512 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
20513 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
20514 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
20515 machine.
20516
20517 @item breakpoint
20518 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
20519 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
20520 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
20521 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
20522 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
20523 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
20524 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
20525 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
20526 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
20527 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
20528 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
20529
20530 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
20531 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
20532 start of your debugging session.
20533 @end table
20534
20535 @node Bootstrapping
20536 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
20537
20538 @cindex remote stub, support routines
20539 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
20540 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
20541 debugging target machine.
20542
20543 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
20544 serial port.
20545
20546 @table @code
20547 @item int getDebugChar()
20548 @findex getDebugChar
20549 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
20550 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
20551 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20552
20553 @item void putDebugChar(int)
20554 @findex putDebugChar
20555 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
20556 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
20557 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20558 @end table
20559
20560 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
20561 @cindex interrupting remote targets
20562 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
20563 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
20564 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
20565 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
20566 remote system to stop.
20567
20568 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
20569 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
20570 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
20571 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
20572
20573 Other routines you need to supply are:
20574
20575 @table @code
20576 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
20577 @findex exceptionHandler
20578 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
20579 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
20580 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
20581 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
20582 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
20583 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
20584 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
20585 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
20586 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
20587 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
20588 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
20589 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
20590 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
20591
20592 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
20593 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
20594 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
20595 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
20596 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
20597
20598 @item void flush_i_cache()
20599 @findex flush_i_cache
20600 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
20601 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
20602 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
20603
20604 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
20605 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
20606 @end table
20607
20608 @noindent
20609 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
20610
20611 @table @code
20612 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
20613 @findex memset
20614 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
20615 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
20616 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
20617 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
20618 @end table
20619
20620 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
20621 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
20622 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
20623 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
20624
20625
20626 @node Debug Session
20627 @subsection Putting it All Together
20628
20629 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
20630 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
20631 steps.
20632
20633 @enumerate
20634 @item
20635 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
20636 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
20637 @display
20638 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
20639 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
20640 @end display
20641
20642 @item
20643 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
20644 procedure is called:
20645
20646 @smallexample
20647 set_debug_traps();
20648 breakpoint();
20649 @end smallexample
20650
20651 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
20652 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
20653 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
20654 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
20655 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
20656 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
20657 progress.
20658
20659 @item
20660 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
20661 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
20662
20663 @smallexample
20664 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
20665 @end smallexample
20666
20667 @noindent
20668 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
20669 function in your program, that function is called when
20670 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
20671 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
20672 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
20673
20674 @item
20675 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
20676 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
20677
20678 @item
20679 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
20680 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
20681
20682 @item
20683 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
20684 @c document that. FIXME.
20685 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
20686 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
20687
20688 @item
20689 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
20690 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20691
20692 @end enumerate
20693
20694 @node Configurations
20695 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
20696
20697 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
20698 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
20699 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
20700
20701 There are three major categories of configurations: native
20702 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
20703 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
20704 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
20705 are quite different from each other.
20706
20707 @menu
20708 * Native::
20709 * Embedded OS::
20710 * Embedded Processors::
20711 * Architectures::
20712 @end menu
20713
20714 @node Native
20715 @section Native
20716
20717 This section describes details specific to particular native
20718 configurations.
20719
20720 @menu
20721 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
20722 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
20723 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
20724 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
20725 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
20726 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
20727 @end menu
20728
20729 @node BSD libkvm Interface
20730 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
20731
20732 @cindex libkvm
20733 @cindex kernel memory image
20734 @cindex kernel crash dump
20735
20736 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
20737 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
20738 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
20739 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
20740 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
20741 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
20742 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
20743 @code{kvm} target:
20744
20745 @smallexample
20746 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
20747 @end smallexample
20748
20749 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
20750 argument:
20751
20752 @smallexample
20753 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
20754 @end smallexample
20755
20756 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
20757 available:
20758
20759 @table @code
20760 @kindex kvm
20761 @item kvm pcb
20762 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
20763
20764 @item kvm proc
20765 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
20766 modern FreeBSD systems.
20767 @end table
20768
20769 @node SVR4 Process Information
20770 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
20771 @cindex /proc
20772 @cindex examine process image
20773 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
20774
20775 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
20776 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
20777 process using file-system subroutines.
20778
20779 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
20780 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
20781 information about the process running your program, or about any
20782 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
20783 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, for example.
20784
20785 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
20786 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
20787
20788 @table @code
20789 @kindex info proc
20790 @cindex process ID
20791 @item info proc
20792 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
20793 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
20794 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
20795 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
20796 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
20797 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
20798 executable file's absolute file name.
20799
20800 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
20801 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
20802 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
20803 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
20804 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
20805 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
20806
20807 @item info proc cmdline
20808 @cindex info proc cmdline
20809 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
20810 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20811
20812 @item info proc cwd
20813 @cindex info proc cwd
20814 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
20815 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20816
20817 @item info proc exe
20818 @cindex info proc exe
20819 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
20820 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20821
20822 @item info proc mappings
20823 @cindex memory address space mappings
20824 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
20825 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
20826 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
20827 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
20828 memory access rights to that range.
20829
20830 @item info proc stat
20831 @itemx info proc status
20832 @cindex process detailed status information
20833 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
20834 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
20835 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
20836 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
20837 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
20838 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
20839 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
20840
20841 @item info proc all
20842 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
20843 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
20844
20845 @ignore
20846 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
20847 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
20848 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
20849 @kindex info proc times
20850 @item info proc times
20851 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
20852 its children.
20853
20854 @kindex info proc id
20855 @item info proc id
20856 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
20857 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
20858 @end ignore
20859
20860 @item set procfs-trace
20861 @kindex set procfs-trace
20862 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
20863 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
20864
20865 @item show procfs-trace
20866 @kindex show procfs-trace
20867 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
20868
20869 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
20870 @kindex set procfs-file
20871 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
20872 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
20873 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
20874 standard output.
20875
20876 @item show procfs-file
20877 @kindex show procfs-file
20878 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
20879
20880 @item proc-trace-entry
20881 @itemx proc-trace-exit
20882 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
20883 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
20884 @kindex proc-trace-entry
20885 @kindex proc-trace-exit
20886 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
20887 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
20888 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
20889 from the @code{syscall} interface.
20890
20891 @item info pidlist
20892 @kindex info pidlist
20893 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
20894 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
20895 processes and all the threads within each process.
20896
20897 @item info meminfo
20898 @kindex info meminfo
20899 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
20900 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
20901 @end table
20902
20903 @node DJGPP Native
20904 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
20905 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
20906 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
20907 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
20908
20909 @cindex DPMI
20910 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
20911 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
20912 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
20913 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
20914
20915 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
20916 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
20917 subsection describes those commands.
20918
20919 @table @code
20920 @kindex info dos
20921 @item info dos
20922 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
20923 information about the target system and important OS structures.
20924
20925 @kindex sysinfo
20926 @cindex MS-DOS system info
20927 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
20928 @item info dos sysinfo
20929 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
20930 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
20931 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
20932
20933 @cindex GDT
20934 @cindex LDT
20935 @cindex IDT
20936 @cindex segment descriptor tables
20937 @cindex descriptor tables display
20938 @item info dos gdt
20939 @itemx info dos ldt
20940 @itemx info dos idt
20941 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
20942 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
20943 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
20944 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
20945 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
20946 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
20947 rights.
20948
20949 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
20950 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
20951 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
20952 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
20953 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
20954
20955 @cindex garbled pointers
20956 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
20957 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
20958 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
20959 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
20960 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
20961 debugged program's data segment:
20962
20963 @smallexample
20964 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
20965 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
20966 @end smallexample
20967
20968 @noindent
20969 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
20970 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
20971
20972 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
20973 @item info dos pde
20974 @itemx info dos pte
20975 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
20976 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
20977 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
20978 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
20979 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
20980 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
20981 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
20982 that is currently in use.
20983
20984 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
20985 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
20986 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
20987 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
20988 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
20989 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
20990 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
20991
20992 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
20993 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
20994 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
20995 controller.
20996
20997 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
20998
20999 @cindex physical address from linear address
21000 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
21001 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
21002 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
21003 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
21004 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
21005 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
21006 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
21007
21008 @smallexample
21009 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
21010 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
21011 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
21012 @end smallexample
21013
21014 @noindent
21015 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
21016 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
21017 attributes of that page.
21018
21019 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
21020 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
21021 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
21022 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
21023 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
21024 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
21025
21026 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
21027 transfer buffer:
21028
21029 @smallexample
21030 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
21031 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
21032 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
21033 @end smallexample
21034
21035 @noindent
21036 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
21037 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
21038 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
21039 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
21040 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
21041
21042 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
21043 @end table
21044
21045 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
21046 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
21047 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
21048 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
21049
21050 @table @code
21051 @kindex set com1base
21052 @kindex set com1irq
21053 @kindex set com2base
21054 @kindex set com2irq
21055 @kindex set com3base
21056 @kindex set com3irq
21057 @kindex set com4base
21058 @kindex set com4irq
21059 @item set com1base @var{addr}
21060 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
21061 port.
21062
21063 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
21064 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
21065 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
21066
21067 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
21068 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
21069 other 3 COM ports.
21070
21071 @kindex show com1base
21072 @kindex show com1irq
21073 @kindex show com2base
21074 @kindex show com2irq
21075 @kindex show com3base
21076 @kindex show com3irq
21077 @kindex show com4base
21078 @kindex show com4irq
21079 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
21080 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
21081 lines used by the COM ports.
21082
21083 @item info serial
21084 @kindex info serial
21085 @cindex DOS serial port status
21086 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
21087 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
21088 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
21089 counts of various errors encountered so far.
21090 @end table
21091
21092
21093 @node Cygwin Native
21094 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
21095 @cindex MS Windows debugging
21096 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
21097 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
21098
21099 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
21100 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
21101
21102 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
21103 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
21104 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
21105 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
21106 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
21107 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
21108 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
21109 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
21110
21111 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
21112 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
21113 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
21114
21115 @table @code
21116 @kindex info w32
21117 @item info w32
21118 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
21119 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21120
21121 @item info w32 selector
21122 This command displays information returned by
21123 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
21124 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
21125 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
21126 Without argument, this command displays information
21127 about the six segment registers.
21128
21129 @item info w32 thread-information-block
21130 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
21131 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
21132 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
21133
21134 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
21135 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
21136 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
21137 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
21138 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
21139 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
21140 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
21141 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
21142 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
21143 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
21144 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
21145
21146 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
21147 @item show cygwin-exceptions
21148 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
21149 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
21150
21151 @kindex set new-console
21152 @item set new-console @var{mode}
21153 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
21154 be started in a new console on next start.
21155 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
21156 be started in the same console as the debugger.
21157
21158 @kindex show new-console
21159 @item show new-console
21160 Displays whether a new console is used
21161 when the debuggee is started.
21162
21163 @kindex set new-group
21164 @item set new-group @var{mode}
21165 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
21166 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
21167 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
21168 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
21169
21170 @kindex show new-group
21171 @item show new-group
21172 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
21173
21174 @kindex set debugevents
21175 @item set debugevents
21176 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
21177 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
21178 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
21179 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
21180 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
21181
21182 @kindex set debugexec
21183 @item set debugexec
21184 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
21185 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
21186
21187 @kindex set debugexceptions
21188 @item set debugexceptions
21189 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
21190 debuggee seen by the debugger.
21191
21192 @kindex set debugmemory
21193 @item set debugmemory
21194 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
21195 and writes by the debugger.
21196
21197 @kindex set shell
21198 @item set shell
21199 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
21200 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
21201
21202 @kindex show shell
21203 @item show shell
21204 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
21205
21206 @end table
21207
21208 @menu
21209 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
21210 @end menu
21211
21212 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
21213 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
21214 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
21215 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
21216
21217 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
21218 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
21219 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
21220 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
21221 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
21222 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
21223 ``minimal symbols''.
21224
21225 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
21226 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
21227 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
21228 program run once to completion.
21229
21230 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
21231
21232 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
21233 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
21234 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
21235 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
21236 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
21237 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
21238 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
21239 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
21240 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
21241
21242 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
21243 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
21244 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
21245 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
21246 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
21247 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
21248
21249 @smallexample
21250 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
21251 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
21252
21253 Non-debugging symbols:
21254 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
21255 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
21256 @end smallexample
21257
21258 @smallexample
21259 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
21260 All functions matching regular expression "!":
21261
21262 Non-debugging symbols:
21263 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
21264 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
21265 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
21266 [etc...]
21267 @end smallexample
21268
21269 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
21270
21271 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
21272 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
21273 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
21274 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
21275 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
21276 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
21277 a function within a DLL without a running program.
21278
21279 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
21280 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
21281 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
21282 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
21283 problem:
21284
21285 @smallexample
21286 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
21287 $1 = 268572168
21288 @end smallexample
21289
21290 @smallexample
21291 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
21292 0x10021610: "\230y\""
21293 @end smallexample
21294
21295 And two possible solutions:
21296
21297 @smallexample
21298 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
21299 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21300 @end smallexample
21301
21302 @smallexample
21303 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
21304 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
21305 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
21306 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
21307 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
21308 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
21309 @end smallexample
21310
21311 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
21312 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
21313 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
21314 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
21315 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
21316
21317 @smallexample
21318 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
21319 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
21320 @end smallexample
21321
21322 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
21323 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
21324 safe.
21325
21326 @node Hurd Native
21327 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
21328 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
21329
21330 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
21331 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
21332
21333 @table @code
21334 @item set signals
21335 @itemx set sigs
21336 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
21337 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21338 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
21339 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
21340 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
21341 @code{signals}.
21342
21343 @item show signals
21344 @itemx show sigs
21345 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
21346 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
21347 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
21348
21349 @item set signal-thread
21350 @itemx set sigthread
21351 @kindex set signal-thread
21352 @kindex set sigthread
21353 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
21354 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
21355 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
21356 signal-thread}.
21357
21358 @item show signal-thread
21359 @itemx show sigthread
21360 @kindex show signal-thread
21361 @kindex show sigthread
21362 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
21363 delivered a signal.
21364
21365 @item set stopped
21366 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21367 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
21368 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
21369 continued by delivering a signal to it.
21370
21371 @item show stopped
21372 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
21373 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
21374 stopped.
21375
21376 @item set exceptions
21377 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21378 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
21379 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
21380 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
21381 trapping on.
21382
21383 @item show exceptions
21384 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
21385 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
21386
21387 @item set task pause
21388 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
21389 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21390 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21391 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
21392 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
21393 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
21394 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
21395 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
21396 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
21397
21398 @item show task pause
21399 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
21400 Show the current state of task suspension.
21401
21402 @item set task detach-suspend-count
21403 @cindex task suspend count
21404 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21405 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
21406 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
21407
21408 @item show task detach-suspend-count
21409 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
21410
21411 @item set task exception-port
21412 @itemx set task excp
21413 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21414 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
21415 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
21416 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
21417
21418 @item set noninvasive
21419 @cindex noninvasive task options
21420 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
21421 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
21422 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
21423 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
21424
21425 @item info send-rights
21426 @itemx info receive-rights
21427 @itemx info port-rights
21428 @itemx info port-sets
21429 @itemx info dead-names
21430 @itemx info ports
21431 @itemx info psets
21432 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21433 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21434 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21435 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21436 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21437 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
21438 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
21439 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
21440 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
21441
21442 @item set thread pause
21443 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
21444 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21445 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21446 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
21447 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
21448 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
21449 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
21450 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
21451 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
21452 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
21453 only the current thread.
21454
21455 @item show thread pause
21456 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
21457 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
21458
21459 @item set thread run
21460 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21461
21462 @item show thread run
21463 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21464
21465 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
21466 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21467 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21468 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
21469 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
21470 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
21471 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
21472
21473 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
21474 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
21475 detaching.
21476
21477 @item set thread exception-port
21478 @itemx set thread excp
21479 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
21480 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
21481 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
21482
21483 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
21484 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
21485 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
21486 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
21487
21488 @item set thread default
21489 @itemx show thread default
21490 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21491 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
21492 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
21493 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
21494 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
21495 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
21496 the non-default commands.
21497 @end table
21498
21499 @node Darwin
21500 @subsection Darwin
21501 @cindex Darwin
21502
21503 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
21504
21505 @table @code
21506 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
21507 @kindex set debug darwin
21508 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
21509 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
21510
21511 @item show debug darwin
21512 @kindex show debug darwin
21513 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
21514
21515 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
21516 @kindex set debug mach-o
21517 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
21518 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
21519 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
21520 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
21521 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
21522 usage.
21523
21524 @item show debug mach-o
21525 @kindex show debug mach-o
21526 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
21527
21528 @item set mach-exceptions on
21529 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
21530 @kindex set mach-exceptions
21531 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
21532 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
21533 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
21534 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
21535
21536 @item show mach-exceptions
21537 @kindex show mach-exceptions
21538 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
21539 @end table
21540
21541
21542 @node Embedded OS
21543 @section Embedded Operating Systems
21544
21545 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
21546 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
21547 architectures.
21548
21549 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
21550 various real-time operating systems.
21551
21552 @node Embedded Processors
21553 @section Embedded Processors
21554
21555 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
21556 configurations.
21557
21558 @cindex send command to simulator
21559 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
21560 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
21561
21562 @table @code
21563 @item sim @var{command}
21564 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
21565 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
21566 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
21567 acceptable commands.
21568 @end table
21569
21570
21571 @menu
21572 * ARM:: ARM
21573 * M32R/SDI:: Renesas M32R/SDI
21574 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
21575 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
21576 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
21577 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
21578 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
21579 * CRIS:: CRIS
21580 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
21581 @end menu
21582
21583 @node ARM
21584 @subsection ARM
21585
21586 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
21587
21588 @table @code
21589 @item set arm disassembler
21590 @kindex set arm
21591 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
21592 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
21593
21594 @item show arm disassembler
21595 @kindex show arm
21596 Show the current disassembly style.
21597
21598 @item set arm apcs32
21599 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
21600 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
21601
21602 @item show arm apcs32
21603 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
21604
21605 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
21606 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
21607 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
21608
21609 @table @code
21610 @item auto
21611 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
21612 @item softfpa
21613 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
21614 processors.
21615 @item fpa
21616 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
21617 @item softvfp
21618 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
21619 @item vfp
21620 VFP co-processor.
21621 @end table
21622
21623 @item show arm fpu
21624 Show the current type of the FPU.
21625
21626 @item set arm abi
21627 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
21628
21629 @item show arm abi
21630 Show the currently used ABI.
21631
21632 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21633 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
21634 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
21635 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
21636 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
21637 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
21638 register).
21639
21640 @item show arm fallback-mode
21641 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
21642
21643 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21644 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
21645 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
21646 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
21647 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
21648
21649 @item show arm force-mode
21650 Show the current forced instruction mode.
21651
21652 @item set debug arm
21653 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
21654 target support subsystem.
21655
21656 @item show debug arm
21657 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
21658 @end table
21659
21660 @table @code
21661 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
21662 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
21663
21664 @table @code
21665 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
21666 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
21667 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
21668 The default value is @code{all}.
21669
21670 @table @code
21671 @item none
21672 @item demon
21673 @item angel
21674 @item redboot
21675 @item all
21676 @end table
21677 @end table
21678 @end table
21679
21680 @node M32R/SDI
21681 @subsection Renesas M32R/SDI
21682
21683 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
21684
21685 @table @code
21686 @item sdireset
21687 @kindex sdireset
21688 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
21689 This command resets the SDI connection.
21690
21691 @item sdistatus
21692 @kindex sdistatus
21693 This command shows the SDI connection status.
21694
21695 @item debug_chaos
21696 @kindex debug_chaos
21697 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
21698 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
21699
21700 @item use_debug_dma
21701 @kindex use_debug_dma
21702 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
21703
21704 @item use_mon_code
21705 @kindex use_mon_code
21706 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
21707
21708 @item use_ib_break
21709 @kindex use_ib_break
21710 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
21711
21712 @item use_dbt_break
21713 @kindex use_dbt_break
21714 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
21715 @end table
21716
21717 @node M68K
21718 @subsection M68k
21719
21720 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
21721
21722 @node MicroBlaze
21723 @subsection MicroBlaze
21724 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
21725 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
21726
21727 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
21728 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
21729 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
21730 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
21731 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
21732 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
21733 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
21734 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
21735 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
21736 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
21737 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
21738
21739 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
21740
21741 @table @code
21742 @item target remote :1234
21743 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
21744 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
21745
21746 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
21747 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
21748 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
21749
21750 @item load
21751 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
21752
21753 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
21754 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
21755
21756 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
21757 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
21758 @end table
21759
21760 @node MIPS Embedded
21761 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
21762
21763 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} boards
21764 @value{GDBN} can use the @acronym{MIPS} remote debugging protocol to talk to a
21765 @acronym{MIPS} board attached to a serial line. This is available when
21766 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-elf}.
21767
21768 @need 1000
21769 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
21770
21771 @table @code
21772 @item target mips @var{port}
21773 @kindex target mips @var{port}
21774 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
21775 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
21776 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
21777 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
21778 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
21779 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
21780
21781 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
21782 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
21783 debugger:
21784
21785 @smallexample
21786 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
21787 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
21788 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
21789 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
21790 (@value{GDBP}) run
21791 @end smallexample
21792
21793 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
21794 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
21795 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
21796 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
21797 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
21798
21799 @item target pmon @var{port}
21800 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
21801 PMON ROM monitor.
21802
21803 @item target ddb @var{port}
21804 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
21805 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
21806
21807 @item target lsi @var{port}
21808 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
21809 LSI variant of PMON.
21810
21811 @end table
21812
21813
21814 @noindent
21815 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
21816
21817 @table @code
21818 @item set mipsfpu double
21819 @itemx set mipsfpu single
21820 @itemx set mipsfpu none
21821 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
21822 @itemx show mipsfpu
21823 @kindex set mipsfpu
21824 @kindex show mipsfpu
21825 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
21826 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
21827 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
21828 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
21829 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
21830 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
21831 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
21832 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
21833 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
21834 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
21835 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
21836 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
21837 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
21838
21839 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
21840 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
21841 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
21842
21843 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
21844 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
21845
21846 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
21847 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
21848 @itemx show timeout
21849 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
21850 @cindex @code{timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21851 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21852 @kindex set timeout
21853 @kindex show timeout
21854 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
21855 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
21856 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the @acronym{MIPS}
21857 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
21858 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
21859 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
21860 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
21861 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
21862 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
21863 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-elf}.)
21864
21865 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
21866 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
21867 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
21868 to run before stopping.
21869
21870 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
21871 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21872 @cindex synchronize with remote @acronym{MIPS} target
21873 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
21874 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
21875 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
21876
21877 @item show syn-garbage-limit
21878 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21879 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
21880 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
21881
21882 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
21883 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21884 @cindex remote monitor prompt
21885 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
21886 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
21887 @table @asis
21888 @item pmon target
21889 @samp{PMON}
21890 @item ddb target
21891 @samp{NEC010}
21892 @item lsi target
21893 @samp{PMON>}
21894 @end table
21895
21896 @item show monitor-prompt
21897 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21898 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
21899 remote monitor.
21900
21901 @item set monitor-warnings
21902 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21903 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
21904 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
21905 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
21906 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
21907
21908 @item show monitor-warnings
21909 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21910 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
21911
21912 @item pmon @var{command}
21913 @kindex pmon@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21914 @cindex send PMON command
21915 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
21916 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
21917 @end table
21918
21919 @node PowerPC Embedded
21920 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
21921
21922 @cindex DVC register
21923 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
21924 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
21925
21926 @smallexample
21927 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
21928 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
21929 @end smallexample
21930
21931 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
21932 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
21933 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
21934 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
21935 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
21936 or newer.
21937
21938 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
21939 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
21940 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
21941 watching variables of scalar types.
21942
21943 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
21944 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
21945
21946 @smallexample
21947 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
21948 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
21949 @end smallexample
21950
21951 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
21952 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
21953
21954 @cindex ranged breakpoint
21955 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
21956 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
21957 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
21958 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
21959 use the @code{break-range} command.
21960
21961 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
21962
21963 @table @code
21964 @kindex break-range
21965 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
21966 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
21967 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
21968 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
21969 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
21970 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
21971 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
21972 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
21973 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
21974
21975 @kindex set powerpc
21976 @item set powerpc soft-float
21977 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
21978 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
21979 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
21980 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21981
21982 @item set powerpc vector-abi
21983 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
21984 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
21985 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
21986 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
21987 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
21988 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
21989 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21990
21991 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
21992 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
21993 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
21994 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
21995 address of its first byte.
21996
21997 @end table
21998
21999 @node AVR
22000 @subsection Atmel AVR
22001 @cindex AVR
22002
22003 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
22004 following AVR-specific commands:
22005
22006 @table @code
22007 @item info io_registers
22008 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
22009 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
22010 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
22011 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
22012 @end table
22013
22014 @node CRIS
22015 @subsection CRIS
22016 @cindex CRIS
22017
22018 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
22019 following CRIS-specific commands:
22020
22021 @table @code
22022 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
22023 @cindex CRIS version
22024 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
22025 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
22026 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
22027
22028 @item show cris-version
22029 Show the current CRIS version.
22030
22031 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
22032 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
22033 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
22034 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
22035 @code{R59}.
22036
22037 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
22038 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
22039
22040 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
22041 @cindex CRIS mode
22042 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
22043 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
22044 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
22045
22046 @item show cris-mode
22047 Show the current CRIS mode.
22048 @end table
22049
22050 @node Super-H
22051 @subsection Renesas Super-H
22052 @cindex Super-H
22053
22054 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
22055 commands:
22056
22057 @table @code
22058 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
22059 @kindex set sh calling-convention
22060 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
22061 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
22062 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
22063 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
22064 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
22065 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
22066 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
22067 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
22068 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
22069 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
22070
22071 @item show sh calling-convention
22072 @kindex show sh calling-convention
22073 Show the current calling convention setting.
22074
22075 @end table
22076
22077
22078 @node Architectures
22079 @section Architectures
22080
22081 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
22082 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
22083
22084 @menu
22085 * AArch64::
22086 * i386::
22087 * Alpha::
22088 * MIPS::
22089 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
22090 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22091 * PowerPC::
22092 * Nios II::
22093 @end menu
22094
22095 @node AArch64
22096 @subsection AArch64
22097 @cindex AArch64 support
22098
22099 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
22100 following special commands:
22101
22102 @table @code
22103 @item set debug aarch64
22104 @kindex set debug aarch64
22105 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
22106 messages are to be displayed.
22107
22108 @item show debug aarch64
22109 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
22110
22111 @end table
22112
22113 @node i386
22114 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
22115
22116 @table @code
22117 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
22118 @kindex set struct-convention
22119 @cindex struct return convention
22120 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
22121 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22122 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
22123 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22124 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22125 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22126 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22127 be returned in a register.
22128
22129 @item show struct-convention
22130 @kindex show struct-convention
22131 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22132 from functions.
22133 @end table
22134
22135
22136 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22137 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22138
22139 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22140 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22141 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22142 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
22143 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22144 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22145 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22146
22147 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22148 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22149 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22150 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22151 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
22152 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22153
22154 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22155 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
22156 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22157
22158 @smallexample
22159 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22160 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22161 @end smallexample
22162
22163 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
22164 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22165 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22166 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22167 the pointer.
22168
22169 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
22170 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
22171 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
22172 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
22173 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
22174
22175 @table @code
22176 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
22177 @kindex show mpx bound
22178 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
22179
22180 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
22181 @kindex set mpx bound
22182 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
22183 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
22184 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
22185 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
22186 @end table
22187
22188 @node Alpha
22189 @subsection Alpha
22190
22191 See the following section.
22192
22193 @node MIPS
22194 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22195
22196 @cindex stack on Alpha
22197 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22198 @cindex Alpha stack
22199 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22200 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22201 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22202 find the beginning of a function.
22203
22204 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22205 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22206 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22207 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22208 commands:
22209
22210 @table @code
22211 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22212 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22213 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22214 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
22215 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
22216 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22217 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
22218 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22219
22220 @item show heuristic-fence-post
22221 Display the current limit.
22222 @end table
22223
22224 @noindent
22225 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22226 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22227
22228 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22229 programs:
22230
22231 @table @code
22232 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
22233 @kindex set mips abi
22234 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22235 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
22236 values of @var{arg} are:
22237
22238 @table @samp
22239 @item auto
22240 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22241 default).
22242 @item o32
22243 @item o64
22244 @item n32
22245 @item n64
22246 @item eabi32
22247 @item eabi64
22248 @end table
22249
22250 @item show mips abi
22251 @kindex show mips abi
22252 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22253
22254 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
22255 @kindex set mips compression
22256 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22257 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22258 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22259 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22260 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22261 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22262 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22263 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22264 provided by the executable.
22265
22266 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22267 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22268 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22269 identified as such.
22270
22271 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22272 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22273 implicitly from an executable.
22274
22275 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22276 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22277 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
22278 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22279 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22280
22281 @item show mips compression
22282 @kindex show mips compression
22283 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22284 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22285
22286 @item set mipsfpu
22287 @itemx show mipsfpu
22288 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22289
22290 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22291 @kindex set mips mask-address
22292 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22293 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22294 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
22295 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
22296 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22297
22298 @item show mips mask-address
22299 @kindex show mips mask-address
22300 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22301 not.
22302
22303 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22304 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22305 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22306 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22307 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22308 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22309
22310 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22311 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22312 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22313
22314 @item set debug mips
22315 @kindex set debug mips
22316 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22317 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22318
22319 @item show debug mips
22320 @kindex show debug mips
22321 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22322 @end table
22323
22324
22325 @node HPPA
22326 @subsection HPPA
22327 @cindex HPPA support
22328
22329 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22330 following special commands:
22331
22332 @table @code
22333 @item set debug hppa
22334 @kindex set debug hppa
22335 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22336 messages are to be displayed.
22337
22338 @item show debug hppa
22339 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22340
22341 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
22342 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22343 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22344 given @var{address}.
22345
22346 @end table
22347
22348
22349 @node SPU
22350 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22351 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22352 @cindex SPU
22353
22354 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22355 it provides the following special commands:
22356
22357 @table @code
22358 @item info spu event
22359 @kindex info spu
22360 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
22361 and pending event status.
22362
22363 @item info spu signal
22364 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
22365 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22366 notification channels.
22367
22368 @item info spu mailbox
22369 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
22370 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22371 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22372
22373 @item info spu dma
22374 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22375 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22376 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22377
22378 @item info spu proxydma
22379 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22380 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22381 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22382
22383 @end table
22384
22385 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
22386 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
22387 special commands:
22388
22389 @table @code
22390 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
22391 @kindex set spu
22392 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
22393 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
22394 function. The default is @code{off}.
22395
22396 @item show spu stop-on-load
22397 @kindex show spu
22398 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
22399
22400 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
22401 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
22402 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
22403 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
22404 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
22405 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
22406
22407 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
22408 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
22409
22410 @end table
22411
22412 @node PowerPC
22413 @subsection PowerPC
22414 @cindex PowerPC architecture
22415
22416 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
22417 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
22418 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
22419 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
22420 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
22421
22422 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
22423 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
22424 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
22425
22426 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
22427 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
22428
22429 @node Nios II
22430 @subsection Nios II
22431 @cindex Nios II architecture
22432
22433 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
22434 it provides the following special commands:
22435
22436 @table @code
22437
22438 @item set debug nios2
22439 @kindex set debug nios2
22440 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
22441 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22442
22443 @item show debug nios2
22444 @kindex show debug nios2
22445 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
22446 @end table
22447
22448 @node Controlling GDB
22449 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
22450
22451 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
22452 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
22453 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
22454 described here.
22455
22456 @menu
22457 * Prompt:: Prompt
22458 * Editing:: Command editing
22459 * Command History:: Command history
22460 * Screen Size:: Screen size
22461 * Numbers:: Numbers
22462 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
22463 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
22464 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
22465 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
22466 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
22467 @end menu
22468
22469 @node Prompt
22470 @section Prompt
22471
22472 @cindex prompt
22473
22474 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
22475 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
22476 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
22477 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
22478 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
22479 which one you are talking to.
22480
22481 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
22482 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
22483 or a prompt that does not.
22484
22485 @table @code
22486 @kindex set prompt
22487 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
22488 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
22489
22490 @kindex show prompt
22491 @item show prompt
22492 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
22493 @end table
22494
22495 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
22496 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
22497 are:
22498
22499 @table @code
22500 @kindex set extended-prompt
22501 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
22502 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
22503 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
22504 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
22505 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
22506 is displayed.
22507
22508 For example:
22509
22510 @smallexample
22511 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
22512 @end smallexample
22513
22514 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
22515 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
22516
22517 @kindex show extended-prompt
22518 @item show extended-prompt
22519 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
22520 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
22521 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
22522 @end table
22523
22524 @node Editing
22525 @section Command Editing
22526 @cindex readline
22527 @cindex command line editing
22528
22529 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
22530 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
22531 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
22532 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
22533 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
22534 debugging sessions.
22535
22536 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
22537 command @code{set}.
22538
22539 @table @code
22540 @kindex set editing
22541 @cindex editing
22542 @item set editing
22543 @itemx set editing on
22544 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
22545
22546 @item set editing off
22547 Disable command line editing.
22548
22549 @kindex show editing
22550 @item show editing
22551 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
22552 @end table
22553
22554 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22555 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
22556 @end ifset
22557 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22558 @xref{Command Line Editing},
22559 @end ifclear
22560 for more details about the Readline
22561 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
22562 encouraged to read that chapter.
22563
22564 @node Command History
22565 @section Command History
22566 @cindex command history
22567
22568 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
22569 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
22570 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
22571 history facility.
22572
22573 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
22574 package, to provide the history facility.
22575 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22576 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
22577 @end ifset
22578 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22579 @xref{Using History Interactively},
22580 @end ifclear
22581 for the detailed description of the History library.
22582
22583 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
22584 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
22585 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
22586 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
22587 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
22588 pressed on a line by itself.
22589
22590 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
22591 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22592 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22593 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22594
22595 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
22596 history.
22597
22598 @table @code
22599 @cindex history substitution
22600 @cindex history file
22601 @kindex set history filename
22602 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
22603 @item set history filename @var{fname}
22604 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
22605 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
22606 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
22607 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
22608 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
22609 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
22610 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
22611 is not set.
22612
22613 @cindex save command history
22614 @kindex set history save
22615 @item set history save
22616 @itemx set history save on
22617 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
22618 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
22619
22620 @item set history save off
22621 Stop recording command history in a file.
22622
22623 @cindex history size
22624 @kindex set history size
22625 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
22626 @item set history size @var{size}
22627 @itemx set history size unlimited
22628 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
22629 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
22630 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
22631 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
22632 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
22633 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
22634
22635 @cindex remove duplicate history
22636 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
22637 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
22638 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
22639 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
22640 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
22641 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
22642 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
22643 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
22644 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
22645
22646 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
22647 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
22648
22649 @end table
22650
22651 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
22652 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22653 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
22654 @end ifset
22655 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22656 @xref{Event Designators},
22657 @end ifclear
22658 for more details.
22659
22660 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
22661 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
22662 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
22663 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
22664 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
22665 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
22666 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
22667 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
22668
22669 The commands to control history expansion are:
22670
22671 @table @code
22672 @item set history expansion on
22673 @itemx set history expansion
22674 @kindex set history expansion
22675 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
22676
22677 @item set history expansion off
22678 Disable history expansion.
22679
22680 @c @group
22681 @kindex show history
22682 @item show history
22683 @itemx show history filename
22684 @itemx show history save
22685 @itemx show history size
22686 @itemx show history expansion
22687 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
22688 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
22689 @c @end group
22690 @end table
22691
22692 @table @code
22693 @kindex show commands
22694 @cindex show last commands
22695 @cindex display command history
22696 @item show commands
22697 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
22698
22699 @item show commands @var{n}
22700 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
22701
22702 @item show commands +
22703 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
22704 @end table
22705
22706 @node Screen Size
22707 @section Screen Size
22708 @cindex size of screen
22709 @cindex screen size
22710 @cindex pagination
22711 @cindex page size
22712 @cindex pauses in output
22713
22714 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
22715 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
22716 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
22717 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
22718 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
22719 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
22720 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
22721 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
22722
22723 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
22724 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
22725 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
22726 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
22727 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
22728 width} commands:
22729
22730 @table @code
22731 @kindex set height
22732 @kindex set width
22733 @kindex show width
22734 @kindex show height
22735 @item set height @var{lpp}
22736 @itemx set height unlimited
22737 @itemx show height
22738 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
22739 @itemx set width unlimited
22740 @itemx show width
22741 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
22742 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
22743 commands display the current settings.
22744
22745 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
22746 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
22747 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
22748 buffer.
22749
22750 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
22751 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
22752
22753 @item set pagination on
22754 @itemx set pagination off
22755 @kindex set pagination
22756 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
22757 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
22758 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
22759 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
22760
22761 @item show pagination
22762 @kindex show pagination
22763 Show the current pagination mode.
22764 @end table
22765
22766 @node Numbers
22767 @section Numbers
22768 @cindex number representation
22769 @cindex entering numbers
22770
22771 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
22772 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
22773 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
22774 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
22775 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
22776 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
22777 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
22778 both input and output with the commands described below.
22779
22780 @table @code
22781 @kindex set input-radix
22782 @item set input-radix @var{base}
22783 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
22784 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22785 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
22786 example, any of
22787
22788 @smallexample
22789 set input-radix 012
22790 set input-radix 10.
22791 set input-radix 0xa
22792 @end smallexample
22793
22794 @noindent
22795 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
22796 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
22797 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
22798 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
22799 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
22800 change the radix.
22801
22802 @kindex set output-radix
22803 @item set output-radix @var{base}
22804 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
22805 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22806 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
22807
22808 @kindex show input-radix
22809 @item show input-radix
22810 Display the current default base for numeric input.
22811
22812 @kindex show output-radix
22813 @item show output-radix
22814 Display the current default base for numeric display.
22815
22816 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
22817 @itemx show radix
22818 @kindex set radix
22819 @kindex show radix
22820 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
22821 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
22822 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
22823 default value of 10.
22824
22825 @end table
22826
22827 @node ABI
22828 @section Configuring the Current ABI
22829
22830 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
22831 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
22832 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
22833 current ABI.
22834
22835 @cindex OS ABI
22836 @kindex set osabi
22837 @kindex show osabi
22838 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
22839
22840 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
22841 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
22842 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
22843 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
22844 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
22845 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
22846 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
22847 platform provides.
22848
22849 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
22850 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
22851 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
22852 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
22853
22854 @table @code
22855 @item show osabi
22856 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
22857
22858 @item set osabi
22859 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
22860
22861 @item set osabi @var{abi}
22862 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
22863 @end table
22864
22865 @cindex float promotion
22866
22867 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
22868 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
22869 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
22870 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
22871 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
22872 @code{double} and then passed.
22873
22874 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
22875 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
22876 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
22877
22878 @table @code
22879 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
22880 @item set coerce-float-to-double
22881 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
22882 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
22883 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
22884
22885 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
22886 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
22887 functions.
22888
22889 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
22890 @item show coerce-float-to-double
22891 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
22892 @end table
22893
22894 @kindex set cp-abi
22895 @kindex show cp-abi
22896 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
22897 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
22898 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
22899 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
22900 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
22901 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
22902 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
22903 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
22904 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
22905 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
22906 ``auto''.
22907
22908 @table @code
22909 @item show cp-abi
22910 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
22911
22912 @item set cp-abi
22913 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
22914
22915 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
22916 @itemx set cp-abi auto
22917 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
22918 @end table
22919
22920 @node Auto-loading
22921 @section Automatically loading associated files
22922 @cindex auto-loading
22923
22924 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
22925 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
22926 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
22927 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
22928 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
22929 sources).
22930
22931 @menu
22932 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22933 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
22934
22935 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
22936 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
22937 @end menu
22938
22939 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
22940 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
22941 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
22942
22943 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
22944 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
22945 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22946
22947 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
22948 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
22949
22950 @table @code
22951 @anchor{set auto-load off}
22952 @kindex set auto-load off
22953 @item set auto-load off
22954 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
22955 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
22956 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
22957 @smallexample
22958 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
22959 @end smallexample
22960
22961 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
22962 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
22963 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
22964 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
22965 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
22966 @code{set auto-load no}.
22967
22968 @anchor{show auto-load}
22969 @kindex show auto-load
22970 @item show auto-load
22971 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
22972 or disabled.
22973
22974 @smallexample
22975 (gdb) show auto-load
22976 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
22977 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
22978 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
22979 is on.
22980 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
22981 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22982 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22983 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
22984 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22985 @end smallexample
22986
22987 @anchor{info auto-load}
22988 @kindex info auto-load
22989 @item info auto-load
22990 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
22991 not.
22992
22993 @smallexample
22994 (gdb) info auto-load
22995 gdb-scripts:
22996 Loaded Script
22997 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
22998 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
22999 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
23000 loaded.
23001 python-scripts:
23002 Loaded Script
23003 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
23004 @end smallexample
23005 @end table
23006
23007 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
23008
23009 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
23010 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
23011 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
23012 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
23013 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
23014 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
23015 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
23016 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23017 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23018 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23019 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23020 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
23021 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
23022 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
23023 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23024 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
23025 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23026 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
23027 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
23028 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
23029 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23030 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
23031 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23032 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
23033 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
23034 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23035 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23036 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
23037 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
23038 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
23039 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
23040 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23041 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
23042 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23043 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
23044 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
23045 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
23046 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
23047 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
23048 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
23049 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
23050 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
23051 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
23052 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
23053 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
23054 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
23055 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
23056 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
23057 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
23058 @end multitable
23059
23060 @node Init File in the Current Directory
23061 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
23062 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
23063
23064 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
23065 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
23066 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
23067
23068 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
23069 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23070
23071 @table @code
23072 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
23073 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
23074 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
23075 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
23076 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
23077
23078 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
23079 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
23080 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
23081 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23082 current directory is enabled or disabled.
23083
23084 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23085 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
23086 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
23087 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23088 current directory have been auto-loaded.
23089 @end table
23090
23091 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
23092 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
23093 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
23094
23095 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
23096
23097 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
23098 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
23099
23100 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
23101 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
23102 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
23103 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
23104 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
23105 library.
23106
23107 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
23108 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23109
23110 @table @code
23111 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
23112 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
23113 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
23114 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
23115
23116 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
23117 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
23118 @item show auto-load libthread-db
23119 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
23120 enabled or disabled.
23121
23122 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23123 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23124 @item info auto-load libthread-db
23125 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23126 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23127 @end table
23128
23129 @node Auto-loading safe path
23130 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23131 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
23132
23133 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23134 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23135 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23136 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23137 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23138
23139 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23140 get loaded:
23141
23142 @smallexample
23143 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23144 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23145 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23146 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23147 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23148 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23149 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23150 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23151 @end smallexample
23152
23153 @noindent
23154 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23155 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23156
23157 @smallexample
23158 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23159 @end smallexample
23160
23161 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23162
23163 @table @code
23164 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23165 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
23166 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23167 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23168 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23169 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23170 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23171 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23172 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23173 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23174
23175 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23176 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23177 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23178
23179 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23180 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
23181 @item show auto-load safe-path
23182 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23183 scripts.
23184
23185 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23186 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23187 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
23188 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23189 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
23190 by the host platform path separator in use.
23191 @end table
23192
23193 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
23194 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
23195 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23196 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
23197 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
23198
23199 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
23200 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
23201 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
23202 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
23203 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
23204 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
23205 init file in the current directory
23206 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
23207
23208 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
23209 example, you could use one of the following ways:
23210
23211 @table @asis
23212 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
23213 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
23214 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
23215 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
23216
23217 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
23218 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
23219 @value{GDBN} session.
23220
23221 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
23222 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23223 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
23224 from trusted sources.
23225
23226 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
23227 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
23228 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
23229 trusted sources.
23230 @end table
23231
23232 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
23233 also suppresses any such warning messages:
23234
23235 @table @asis
23236 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
23237 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23238
23239 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23240 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23241 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
23242 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23243 @end table
23244
23245 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
23246 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23247 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23248 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23249 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23250 recommended to be entered.
23251
23252 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
23253 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23254 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23255
23256 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23257 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23258 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23259 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
23260 be printed.
23261
23262 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23263 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
23264 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
23265
23266 @smallexample
23267 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
23268 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23269 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23270 for objfile "/tmp/true".
23271 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23272 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23273 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23274 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23275 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23276 @end smallexample
23277
23278 @table @code
23279 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
23280 @kindex set debug auto-load
23281 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23282 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23283
23284 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
23285 @kindex show debug auto-load
23286 @item show debug auto-load
23287 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23288 on or off.
23289 @end table
23290
23291 @node Messages/Warnings
23292 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
23293
23294 @cindex verbose operation
23295 @cindex optional warnings
23296 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
23297 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23298 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23299 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23300
23301 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23302 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23303 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23304
23305 @table @code
23306 @kindex set verbose
23307 @item set verbose on
23308 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23309
23310 @item set verbose off
23311 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23312
23313 @kindex show verbose
23314 @item show verbose
23315 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
23316 @end table
23317
23318 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
23319 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
23320 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
23321 Symbol Files}).
23322
23323 @table @code
23324
23325 @kindex set complaints
23326 @item set complaints @var{limit}
23327 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
23328 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
23329 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
23330 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
23331
23332 @kindex show complaints
23333 @item show complaints
23334 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
23335
23336 @end table
23337
23338 @anchor{confirmation requests}
23339 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
23340 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
23341 you try to run a program which is already running:
23342
23343 @smallexample
23344 (@value{GDBP}) run
23345 The program being debugged has been started already.
23346 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
23347 @end smallexample
23348
23349 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
23350 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
23351
23352 @table @code
23353
23354 @kindex set confirm
23355 @cindex flinching
23356 @cindex confirmation
23357 @cindex stupid questions
23358 @item set confirm off
23359 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
23360 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
23361 automatically disables confirmation requests.
23362
23363 @item set confirm on
23364 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
23365
23366 @kindex show confirm
23367 @item show confirm
23368 Displays state of confirmation requests.
23369
23370 @end table
23371
23372 @cindex command tracing
23373 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
23374 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
23375 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
23376 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
23377
23378 @table @code
23379 @kindex set trace-commands
23380 @cindex command scripts, debugging
23381 @item set trace-commands on
23382 Enable command tracing.
23383 @item set trace-commands off
23384 Disable command tracing.
23385 @item show trace-commands
23386 Display the current state of command tracing.
23387 @end table
23388
23389 @node Debugging Output
23390 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
23391 @cindex optional debugging messages
23392
23393 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
23394 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
23395 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
23396 section documents those commands.
23397
23398 @table @code
23399 @kindex set exec-done-display
23400 @item set exec-done-display
23401 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
23402 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
23403 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
23404 @kindex show exec-done-display
23405 @item show exec-done-display
23406 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
23407 notification.
23408 @kindex set debug
23409 @cindex ARM AArch64
23410 @item set debug aarch64
23411 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
23412 The default is off.
23413 @kindex show debug
23414 @item show debug aarch64
23415 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23416 ARM AArch64.
23417 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
23418 @cindex architecture debugging info
23419 @item set debug arch
23420 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
23421 @item show debug arch
23422 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
23423 @item set debug aix-solib
23424 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
23425 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
23426 support module. The default is off.
23427 @item show debug aix-thread
23428 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
23429 @item set debug aix-thread
23430 @cindex AIX threads
23431 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
23432 module.
23433 @item show debug aix-thread
23434 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
23435 @item set debug check-physname
23436 @cindex physname
23437 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
23438 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
23439 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
23440 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
23441 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
23442 both ways and display any discrepancies.
23443 @item show debug check-physname
23444 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
23445 @item set debug coff-pe-read
23446 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
23447 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
23448 exported symbols. The default is off.
23449 @item show debug coff-pe-read
23450 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23451 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23452 @item set debug dwarf-die
23453 @cindex DWARF DIEs
23454 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
23455 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
23456 A value of zero turns off the display.
23457 @item show debug dwarf-die
23458 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
23459 @item set debug dwarf-line
23460 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
23461 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23462 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
23463 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23464 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23465 @item show debug dwarf-line
23466 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
23467 @item set debug dwarf-read
23468 @cindex DWARF Reading
23469 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23470 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
23471 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23472 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23473 @item show debug dwarf-read
23474 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
23475 @item set debug displaced
23476 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
23477 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
23478 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
23479 @item show debug displaced
23480 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
23481 related to displaced stepping.
23482 @item set debug event
23483 @cindex event debugging info
23484 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
23485 default is off.
23486 @item show debug event
23487 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
23488 info.
23489 @item set debug expression
23490 @cindex expression debugging info
23491 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
23492 expression parsing. The default is off.
23493 @item show debug expression
23494 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
23495 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
23496 @item set debug frame
23497 @cindex frame debugging info
23498 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
23499 default is off.
23500 @item show debug frame
23501 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
23502 info.
23503 @item set debug gnu-nat
23504 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
23505 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
23506 @item show debug gnu-nat
23507 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
23508 @item set debug infrun
23509 @cindex inferior debugging info
23510 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
23511 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
23512 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
23513 @item show debug infrun
23514 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
23515 @item set debug jit
23516 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
23517 Turns on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
23518 @item show debug jit
23519 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
23520 @item set debug lin-lwp
23521 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
23522 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
23523 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
23524 @item show debug lin-lwp
23525 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
23526 @item set debug linux-namespaces
23527 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
23528 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
23529 @item show debug linux-namespaces
23530 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
23531 @item set debug mach-o
23532 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
23533 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
23534 processing. The default is off.
23535 @item show debug mach-o
23536 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23537 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23538 @item set debug notification
23539 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
23540 Turns on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
23541 The default is off.
23542 @item show debug notification
23543 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
23544 @item set debug observer
23545 @cindex observer debugging info
23546 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
23547 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
23548 @item show debug observer
23549 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
23550 @item set debug overload
23551 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
23552 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
23553 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
23554 is off.
23555 @item show debug overload
23556 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
23557 debugging info.
23558 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
23559 @cindex debug expression parser
23560 @item set debug parser
23561 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
23562 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
23563 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
23564 details. The default is off.
23565 @item show debug parser
23566 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
23567 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
23568 @cindex serial connections, debugging
23569 @cindex debug remote protocol
23570 @cindex remote protocol debugging
23571 @cindex display remote packets
23572 @item set debug remote
23573 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
23574 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
23575 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
23576 @item show debug remote
23577 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
23578 @item set debug serial
23579 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
23580 default is off.
23581 @item show debug serial
23582 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
23583 info.
23584 @item set debug solib-frv
23585 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
23586 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
23587 @item show debug solib-frv
23588 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
23589 messages.
23590 @item set debug symbol-lookup
23591 @cindex symbol lookup
23592 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
23593 The default is 0 (off).
23594 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23595 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23596 @item show debug symbol-lookup
23597 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
23598 @item set debug symfile
23599 @cindex symbol file functions
23600 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
23601 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
23602 @item show debug symfile
23603 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
23604 @item set debug symtab-create
23605 @cindex symbol table creation
23606 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
23607 The default is 0 (off).
23608 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23609 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23610 @item show debug symtab-create
23611 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
23612 @item set debug target
23613 @cindex target debugging info
23614 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
23615 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
23616 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
23617 value of large memory transfers.
23618 @item show debug target
23619 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
23620 info.
23621 @item set debug timestamp
23622 @cindex timestampping debugging info
23623 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
23624 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
23625 message.
23626 @item show debug timestamp
23627 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
23628 debugging info.
23629 @item set debug varobj
23630 @cindex variable object debugging info
23631 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
23632 info. The default is off.
23633 @item show debug varobj
23634 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
23635 debugging info.
23636 @item set debug xml
23637 @cindex XML parser debugging
23638 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
23639 @item show debug xml
23640 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
23641 @end table
23642
23643 @node Other Misc Settings
23644 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
23645 @cindex miscellaneous settings
23646
23647 @table @code
23648 @kindex set interactive-mode
23649 @item set interactive-mode
23650 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
23651 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
23652 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
23653 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
23654 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
23655 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
23656 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
23657 is, non-interactively otherwise.
23658
23659 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
23660 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
23661 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
23662 inside a cygwin window.
23663
23664 @kindex show interactive-mode
23665 @item show interactive-mode
23666 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
23667 @end table
23668
23669 @node Extending GDB
23670 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
23671 @cindex extending GDB
23672
23673 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
23674 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
23675 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
23676 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
23677 being debugged.
23678
23679 @menu
23680 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
23681 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
23682 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
23683 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
23684 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
23685 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
23686 @end menu
23687
23688 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
23689 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
23690 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
23691 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
23692 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23693 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
23694
23695 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
23696 setting:
23697
23698 @table @code
23699 @kindex set script-extension
23700 @kindex show script-extension
23701 @item set script-extension off
23702 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23703
23704 @item set script-extension soft
23705 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23706 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
23707 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
23708 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
23709
23710 @item set script-extension strict
23711 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23712 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
23713 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
23714
23715 @item show script-extension
23716 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
23717
23718 @end table
23719
23720 @node Sequences
23721 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
23722
23723 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
23724 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
23725 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
23726 files.
23727
23728 @menu
23729 * Define:: How to define your own commands
23730 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
23731 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
23732 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
23733 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
23734 @end menu
23735
23736 @node Define
23737 @subsection User-defined Commands
23738
23739 @cindex user-defined command
23740 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
23741 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
23742 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
23743 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
23744 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
23745 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
23746
23747 @smallexample
23748 define adder
23749 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23750 end
23751 @end smallexample
23752
23753 @noindent
23754 To execute the command use:
23755
23756 @smallexample
23757 adder 1 2 3
23758 @end smallexample
23759
23760 @noindent
23761 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
23762 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
23763 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
23764 functions calls.
23765
23766 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
23767 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
23768 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
23769 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
23770
23771 @smallexample
23772 define adder
23773 if $argc == 2
23774 print $arg0 + $arg1
23775 end
23776 if $argc == 3
23777 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23778 end
23779 end
23780 @end smallexample
23781
23782 @table @code
23783
23784 @kindex define
23785 @item define @var{commandname}
23786 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
23787 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
23788 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
23789 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
23790 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
23791 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
23792
23793 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
23794 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
23795 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23796
23797 @kindex document
23798 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
23799 @item document @var{commandname}
23800 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
23801 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
23802 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
23803 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
23804 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
23805 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
23806
23807 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
23808 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
23809 does not change the documentation.
23810
23811 @kindex dont-repeat
23812 @cindex don't repeat command
23813 @item dont-repeat
23814 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
23815 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
23816 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
23817
23818 @kindex help user-defined
23819 @item help user-defined
23820 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
23821 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
23822 included (if any).
23823
23824 @kindex show user
23825 @item show user
23826 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
23827 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
23828 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
23829 definitions for all user-defined commands.
23830 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
23831
23832 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
23833 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
23834 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
23835 @item show max-user-call-depth
23836 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
23837 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
23838 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
23839 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
23840 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
23841 @end table
23842
23843 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
23844 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
23845
23846 When user-defined commands are executed, the
23847 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
23848 stops execution of the user-defined command.
23849
23850 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
23851 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
23852 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
23853 messages when used in a user-defined command.
23854
23855 @node Hooks
23856 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
23857 @cindex command hooks
23858 @cindex hooks, for commands
23859 @cindex hooks, pre-command
23860
23861 @kindex hook
23862 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
23863 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
23864 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
23865 before that command.
23866
23867 @cindex hooks, post-command
23868 @kindex hookpost
23869 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
23870 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
23871 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
23872 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
23873 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
23874
23875 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
23876 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
23877
23878 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
23879 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
23880
23881 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
23882 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
23883 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
23884 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
23885 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
23886
23887 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
23888 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
23889 you could define:
23890
23891 @smallexample
23892 define hook-stop
23893 handle SIGALRM nopass
23894 end
23895
23896 define hook-run
23897 handle SIGALRM pass
23898 end
23899
23900 define hook-continue
23901 handle SIGALRM pass
23902 end
23903 @end smallexample
23904
23905 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
23906 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
23907 you could define:
23908
23909 @smallexample
23910 define hook-echo
23911 echo <<<---
23912 end
23913
23914 define hookpost-echo
23915 echo --->>>\n
23916 end
23917
23918 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
23919 <<<---Hello World--->>>
23920 (@value{GDBP})
23921
23922 @end smallexample
23923
23924 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
23925 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
23926 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
23927 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
23928 @c or not?
23929 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
23930 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
23931 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
23932
23933 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
23934 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
23935 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
23936
23937 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
23938 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
23939
23940 @node Command Files
23941 @subsection Command Files
23942
23943 @cindex command files
23944 @cindex scripting commands
23945 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
23946 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
23947 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
23948 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
23949 terminal.
23950
23951 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
23952 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
23953 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
23954 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
23955 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
23956
23957 @table @code
23958 @kindex source
23959 @cindex execute commands from a file
23960 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
23961 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
23962 @end table
23963
23964 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
23965 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
23966 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
23967 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
23968 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
23969
23970 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
23971 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
23972 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
23973 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
23974 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
23975 is not relevant to scripts.
23976
23977 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
23978 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
23979 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
23980 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
23981 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23982 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
23983 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
23984 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
23985 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23986 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
23987 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
23988 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
23989 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
23990 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
23991
23992 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
23993 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
23994 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
23995
23996 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
23997 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
23998 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
23999 when called from command files.
24000
24001 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
24002 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
24003 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
24004 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
24005 the next command.
24006
24007 @smallexample
24008 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
24009 @end smallexample
24010
24011 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
24012 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
24013 would be directed to @file{log}.
24014
24015 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
24016 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
24017 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
24018 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
24019 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
24020 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
24021 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
24022 conditionally, etc.
24023
24024 @table @code
24025 @kindex if
24026 @kindex else
24027 @item if
24028 @itemx else
24029 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
24030 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
24031 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
24032 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
24033 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
24034 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
24035 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24036
24037 @kindex while
24038 @item while
24039 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
24040 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
24041 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
24042 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
24043 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
24044 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
24045
24046 @kindex loop_break
24047 @item loop_break
24048 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
24049 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
24050 line.
24051
24052 @kindex loop_continue
24053 @item loop_continue
24054 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
24055 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
24056 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
24057 the controlling expression.
24058
24059 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
24060 @item end
24061 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
24062 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
24063 @end table
24064
24065
24066 @node Output
24067 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
24068
24069 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
24070 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
24071 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
24072 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
24073 want.
24074
24075 @table @code
24076 @kindex echo
24077 @item echo @var{text}
24078 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
24079 @c because it is not in ANSI.
24080 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
24081 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
24082 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
24083 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
24084 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
24085 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
24086 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
24087 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
24088 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
24089
24090 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
24091 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
24092
24093 @smallexample
24094 echo This is some text\n\
24095 which is continued\n\
24096 onto several lines.\n
24097 @end smallexample
24098
24099 produces the same output as
24100
24101 @smallexample
24102 echo This is some text\n
24103 echo which is continued\n
24104 echo onto several lines.\n
24105 @end smallexample
24106
24107 @kindex output
24108 @item output @var{expression}
24109 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
24110 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
24111 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
24112 on expressions.
24113
24114 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
24115 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
24116 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
24117 Formats}, for more information.
24118
24119 @kindex printf
24120 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24121 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24122 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
24123 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24124 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
24125 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24126 executing the code below:
24127
24128 @smallexample
24129 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24130 @end smallexample
24131
24132 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24133 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24134 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24135 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24136 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24137 printed.
24138
24139 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24140
24141 @smallexample
24142 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24143 @end smallexample
24144
24145 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24146 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24147 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24148
24149 @itemize @bullet
24150 @item
24151 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24152
24153 @item
24154 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24155 width.
24156
24157 @item
24158 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24159 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24160
24161 @item
24162 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24163 supported.
24164
24165 @item
24166 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
24167
24168 @item
24169 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
24170 @end itemize
24171
24172 @noindent
24173 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
24174 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
24175 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
24176 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
24177
24178 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
24179 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
24180 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
24181 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
24182 supported.
24183
24184 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
24185 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
24186 together with a floating point specifier.
24187 letters:
24188
24189 @itemize @bullet
24190 @item
24191 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
24192
24193 @item
24194 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
24195
24196 @item
24197 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
24198 @end itemize
24199
24200 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
24201 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
24202 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
24203
24204 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
24205 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
24206
24207 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
24208 @smallexample
24209 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
24210 @end smallexample
24211
24212 @kindex eval
24213 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24214 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24215 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
24216
24217 @end table
24218
24219 @node Auto-loading sequences
24220 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
24221 @cindex native script auto-loading
24222
24223 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24224 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24225 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
24226 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24227
24228 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24229 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24230
24231 @table @code
24232 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
24233 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
24234 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
24235 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
24236
24237 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
24238 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
24239 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
24240 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
24241 disabled.
24242
24243 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
24244 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
24245 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
24246 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24247 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
24248 auto-loaded.
24249 @end table
24250
24251 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
24252 matching names are printed.
24253
24254 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
24255 @include python.texi
24256
24257 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
24258 @include guile.texi
24259
24260 @node Auto-loading extensions
24261 @section Auto-loading extensions
24262 @cindex auto-loading extensions
24263
24264 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
24265 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24266 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
24267 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
24268 section of modern file formats like ELF.
24269
24270 @menu
24271 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24272 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24273 * Which flavor to choose?::
24274 @end menu
24275
24276 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24277 debugging commands and features.
24278
24279 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24280 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24281 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
24282 for more information.
24283 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
24284 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
24285
24286 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24287 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24288
24289 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
24290 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24291 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24292 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24293 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24294
24295 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
24296 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
24297 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
24298 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
24299
24300 @table @code
24301 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24302 GDB's own command language
24303 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24304 Python
24305 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24306 Guile
24307 @end table
24308
24309 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
24310 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
24311 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
24312 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
24313 script in the specified extension language.
24314
24315 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
24316 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
24317
24318 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
24319 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24320
24321 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
24322 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
24323 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
24324 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
24325 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
24326 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
24327
24328 @table @code
24329 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
24330 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
24331 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24332 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
24333 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
24334 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
24335
24336 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
24337 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
24338
24339 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
24340 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
24341 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
24342 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
24343
24344 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
24345 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
24346 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
24347 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
24348 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
24349 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
24350 platform.
24351
24352 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24353 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24354 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24355
24356 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
24357 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
24358 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
24359 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24360
24361 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
24362 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
24363 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
24364 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
24365 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
24366 @end table
24367
24368 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
24369 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
24370 @var{objfile} is opened.
24371 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
24372 is evaluated more than once.
24373
24374 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
24375 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24376 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24377
24378 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
24379 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
24380 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24381 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
24382 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
24383 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
24384 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24385
24386 The following entries are supported:
24387
24388 @table @code
24389 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
24390 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
24391 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
24392 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
24393 @end table
24394
24395 @subsubsection Script File Entries
24396
24397 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
24398 in the current directory and then along the source search path
24399 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
24400 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
24401 directory is not relevant to scripts.
24402
24403 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
24404 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
24405
24406 @example
24407 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
24408 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
24409 asm("\
24410 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
24411 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
24412 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
24413 .popsection \n\
24414 ");
24415 @end example
24416
24417 @noindent
24418 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
24419 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
24420
24421 @example
24422 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
24423 @end example
24424
24425 The script name may include directories if desired.
24426
24427 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24428 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24429
24430 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
24431 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
24432 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
24433 will remove duplicates.
24434
24435 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
24436
24437 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
24438 itself instead of loading it from a file.
24439 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
24440 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
24441 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
24442 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
24443 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
24444 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
24445 on its name.
24446
24447 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
24448 testsuite.
24449
24450 @example
24451 #include "symcat.h"
24452 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
24453 asm(
24454 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
24455 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
24456 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
24457 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
24458 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
24459 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
24460 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
24461 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
24462 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
24463 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
24464 ".byte 0\n"
24465 ".popsection\n"
24466 );
24467 @end example
24468
24469 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
24470 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24471 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
24472 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
24473
24474 @node Which flavor to choose?
24475 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
24476
24477 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
24478 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
24479
24480 @noindent
24481 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
24482
24483 @itemize @bullet
24484 @item
24485 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
24486
24487 @item
24488 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
24489
24490 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
24491 in the source search path.
24492 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
24493 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
24494
24495 @item
24496 Doesn't require source code additions.
24497 @end itemize
24498
24499 @noindent
24500 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
24501
24502 @itemize @bullet
24503 @item
24504 Works with static linking.
24505
24506 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
24507 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
24508 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
24509 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
24510 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
24511
24512 @item
24513 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
24514
24515 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
24516 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
24517
24518 @item
24519 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
24520
24521 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
24522 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
24523 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
24524 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
24525 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
24526 top of the source tree to the source search path.
24527 @end itemize
24528
24529 @node Multiple Extension Languages
24530 @section Multiple Extension Languages
24531
24532 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
24533 and generally do not interfere with each other.
24534 There are some things to be aware of, however.
24535
24536 @subsection Python comes first
24537
24538 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
24539 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
24540 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
24541 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
24542 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
24543 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
24544 pretty-printed form of a value).
24545 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
24546 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
24547 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
24548
24549 @node Aliases
24550 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
24551 @cindex aliases for commands
24552
24553 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
24554 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
24555 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
24556 that involves less typing.
24557
24558 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
24559 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
24560 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
24561
24562 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
24563 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
24564 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
24565
24566 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
24567
24568 @table @code
24569
24570 @kindex alias
24571 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
24572
24573 @end table
24574
24575 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
24576 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
24577 underscores.
24578
24579 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
24580 that is being aliased.
24581
24582 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
24583 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
24584 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
24585
24586 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
24587 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
24588
24589 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
24590 of a command so that there is less to type.
24591 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
24592 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
24593 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
24594 The following will accomplish this.
24595
24596 @smallexample
24597 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
24598 @end smallexample
24599
24600 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
24601 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
24602 for it with the @samp{document} command.
24603 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
24604
24605 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
24606 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
24607 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
24608 of a command.
24609
24610 @smallexample
24611 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
24612 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
24613 (gdb) set p elms 20
24614 (gdb) show p elms
24615 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
24616 @end smallexample
24617
24618 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
24619 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
24620 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
24621
24622 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
24623 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
24624
24625 @smallexample
24626 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
24627 @end smallexample
24628
24629 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
24630 alias for a more complex command.
24631 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
24632
24633 @smallexample
24634 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
24635 (gdb) spe 20
24636 @end smallexample
24637
24638 @node Interpreters
24639 @chapter Command Interpreters
24640 @cindex command interpreters
24641
24642 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
24643 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
24644 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
24645
24646 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
24647 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
24648 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
24649 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
24650
24651 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
24652 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
24653 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
24654 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
24655
24656 @table @code
24657 @item console
24658 @cindex console interpreter
24659 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
24660 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
24661 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
24662
24663 @item mi
24664 @cindex mi interpreter
24665 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
24666 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
24667 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
24668 Interface}.
24669
24670 @item mi2
24671 @cindex mi2 interpreter
24672 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
24673
24674 @item mi1
24675 @cindex mi1 interpreter
24676 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
24677
24678 @end table
24679
24680 @cindex invoke another interpreter
24681 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
24682 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
24683 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
24684 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
24685 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
24686 the IDE inoperable!
24687
24688 @kindex interpreter-exec
24689 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
24690 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
24691 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
24692 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
24693
24694 @smallexample
24695 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
24696 @end smallexample
24697
24698 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
24699 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
24700
24701 @node TUI
24702 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
24703 @cindex TUI
24704 @cindex Text User Interface
24705
24706 @menu
24707 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
24708 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
24709 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
24710 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
24711 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
24712 @end menu
24713
24714 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
24715 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
24716 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
24717 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
24718 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
24719 is available.
24720
24721 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
24722 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
24723 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
24724 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
24725 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
24726 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
24727
24728 @node TUI Overview
24729 @section TUI Overview
24730
24731 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
24732
24733 @table @emph
24734 @item command
24735 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
24736 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
24737 managed using readline.
24738
24739 @item source
24740 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
24741 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
24742
24743 @item assembly
24744 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
24745
24746 @item register
24747 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
24748 when their values change.
24749 @end table
24750
24751 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
24752 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
24753 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
24754 indicates the breakpoint type:
24755
24756 @table @code
24757 @item B
24758 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24759
24760 @item b
24761 Breakpoint which was never hit.
24762
24763 @item H
24764 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24765
24766 @item h
24767 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
24768 @end table
24769
24770 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
24771
24772 @table @code
24773 @item +
24774 Breakpoint is enabled.
24775
24776 @item -
24777 Breakpoint is disabled.
24778 @end table
24779
24780 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
24781 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
24782 changes.
24783
24784 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
24785 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
24786 layouts:
24787
24788 @itemize @bullet
24789 @item
24790 source only,
24791
24792 @item
24793 assembly only,
24794
24795 @item
24796 source and assembly,
24797
24798 @item
24799 source and registers, or
24800
24801 @item
24802 assembly and registers.
24803 @end itemize
24804
24805 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
24806
24807 @table @emph
24808 @item target
24809 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
24810 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
24811
24812 @item process
24813 Gives the current process or thread number.
24814 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
24815
24816 @item function
24817 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
24818 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
24819 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
24820 the string @code{??} is displayed.
24821
24822 @item line
24823 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
24824 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
24825
24826 @item pc
24827 Indicates the current program counter address.
24828 @end table
24829
24830 @node TUI Keys
24831 @section TUI Key Bindings
24832 @cindex TUI key bindings
24833
24834 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
24835 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24836 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
24837 @end ifset
24838 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24839 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
24840 @end ifclear
24841 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
24842 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
24843
24844 @table @kbd
24845 @kindex C-x C-a
24846 @item C-x C-a
24847 @kindex C-x a
24848 @itemx C-x a
24849 @kindex C-x A
24850 @itemx C-x A
24851 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
24852 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
24853 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
24854 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
24855 The screen is then refreshed.
24856
24857 @kindex C-x 1
24858 @item C-x 1
24859 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
24860 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
24861 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
24862
24863 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
24864
24865 @kindex C-x 2
24866 @item C-x 2
24867 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
24868 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
24869 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
24870 previous layout and the new one.
24871
24872 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
24873
24874 @kindex C-x o
24875 @item C-x o
24876 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
24877 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
24878 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
24879
24880 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
24881
24882 @kindex C-x s
24883 @item C-x s
24884 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
24885 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
24886 @end table
24887
24888 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
24889
24890 @table @asis
24891 @kindex PgUp
24892 @item @key{PgUp}
24893 Scroll the active window one page up.
24894
24895 @kindex PgDn
24896 @item @key{PgDn}
24897 Scroll the active window one page down.
24898
24899 @kindex Up
24900 @item @key{Up}
24901 Scroll the active window one line up.
24902
24903 @kindex Down
24904 @item @key{Down}
24905 Scroll the active window one line down.
24906
24907 @kindex Left
24908 @item @key{Left}
24909 Scroll the active window one column left.
24910
24911 @kindex Right
24912 @item @key{Right}
24913 Scroll the active window one column right.
24914
24915 @kindex C-L
24916 @item @kbd{C-L}
24917 Refresh the screen.
24918 @end table
24919
24920 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
24921 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
24922 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
24923 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
24924 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
24925
24926 @node TUI Single Key Mode
24927 @section TUI Single Key Mode
24928 @cindex TUI single key mode
24929
24930 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
24931 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
24932 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
24933
24934 @table @kbd
24935 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24936 @item c
24937 continue
24938
24939 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24940 @item d
24941 down
24942
24943 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24944 @item f
24945 finish
24946
24947 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24948 @item n
24949 next
24950
24951 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24952 @item q
24953 exit the SingleKey mode.
24954
24955 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24956 @item r
24957 run
24958
24959 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24960 @item s
24961 step
24962
24963 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24964 @item u
24965 up
24966
24967 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24968 @item v
24969 info locals
24970
24971 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24972 @item w
24973 where
24974 @end table
24975
24976 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
24977 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
24978 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
24979 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
24980 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
24981 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
24982
24983
24984 @node TUI Commands
24985 @section TUI-specific Commands
24986 @cindex TUI commands
24987
24988 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
24989 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
24990 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
24991 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
24992
24993 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
24994 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
24995 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
24996 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
24997 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
24998
24999 @table @code
25000 @item tui enable
25001 @kindex tui enable
25002 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
25003 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
25004 otherwise a default layout is used.
25005
25006 @item tui disable
25007 @kindex tui disable
25008 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
25009
25010 @item info win
25011 @kindex info win
25012 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
25013
25014 @item layout @var{name}
25015 @kindex layout
25016 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
25017 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
25018 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
25019
25020 @table @code
25021 @item next
25022 Display the next layout.
25023
25024 @item prev
25025 Display the previous layout.
25026
25027 @item src
25028 Display the source and command windows.
25029
25030 @item asm
25031 Display the assembly and command windows.
25032
25033 @item split
25034 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
25035
25036 @item regs
25037 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
25038 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
25039 register, assembler, and command windows.
25040 @end table
25041
25042 @item focus @var{name}
25043 @kindex focus
25044 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
25045 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
25046
25047 @table @code
25048 @item next
25049 Make the next window active for scrolling.
25050
25051 @item prev
25052 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
25053
25054 @item src
25055 Make the source window active for scrolling.
25056
25057 @item asm
25058 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
25059
25060 @item regs
25061 Make the register window active for scrolling.
25062
25063 @item cmd
25064 Make the command window active for scrolling.
25065 @end table
25066
25067 @item refresh
25068 @kindex refresh
25069 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
25070
25071 @item tui reg @var{group}
25072 @kindex tui reg
25073 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
25074 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
25075 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
25076 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
25077 following groups are available on most targets:
25078 @table @code
25079 @item next
25080 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25081 through all of the available register groups.
25082
25083 @item prev
25084 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
25085 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
25086 @var{next}.
25087
25088 @item general
25089 Display the general registers.
25090 @item float
25091 Display the floating point registers.
25092 @item system
25093 Display the system registers.
25094 @item vector
25095 Display the vector registers.
25096 @item all
25097 Display all registers.
25098 @end table
25099
25100 @item update
25101 @kindex update
25102 Update the source window and the current execution point.
25103
25104 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
25105 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
25106 @kindex winheight
25107 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
25108 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
25109 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
25110 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
25111 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
25112
25113 @item tabset @var{nchars}
25114 @kindex tabset
25115 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
25116 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
25117 assembly windows.
25118 @end table
25119
25120 @node TUI Configuration
25121 @section TUI Configuration Variables
25122 @cindex TUI configuration variables
25123
25124 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
25125
25126 @table @code
25127 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
25128 @kindex set tui border-kind
25129 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
25130 The possible values are the following:
25131 @table @code
25132 @item space
25133 Use a space character to draw the border.
25134
25135 @item ascii
25136 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25137
25138 @item acs
25139 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
25140 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25141 @end table
25142
25143 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25144 @kindex set tui border-mode
25145 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25146 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
25147 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25148 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25149 @table @code
25150 @item normal
25151 Use normal attributes to display the border.
25152
25153 @item standout
25154 Use standout mode.
25155
25156 @item reverse
25157 Use reverse video mode.
25158
25159 @item half
25160 Use half bright mode.
25161
25162 @item half-standout
25163 Use half bright and standout mode.
25164
25165 @item bold
25166 Use extra bright or bold mode.
25167
25168 @item bold-standout
25169 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25170 @end table
25171 @end table
25172
25173 @node Emacs
25174 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25175
25176 @cindex Emacs
25177 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25178 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25179 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25180 @value{GDBN}.
25181
25182 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
25183 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
25184 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25185 created Emacs buffer.
25186 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25187
25188 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25189 things:
25190
25191 @itemize @bullet
25192 @item
25193 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25194 the GUD buffer.
25195
25196 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25197 and output done by the program you are debugging.
25198
25199 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25200 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25201 in this way.
25202
25203 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25204 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
25205 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25206 stop.
25207
25208 @item
25209 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25210
25211 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25212 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25213 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25214 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25215 and the source.
25216
25217 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25218 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25219 @end itemize
25220
25221 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25222 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25223 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25224 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25225
25226 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25227 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25228 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25229 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25230 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25231 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25232 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
25233 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25234 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25235
25236 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
25237 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
25238 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
25239 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25240
25241 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
25242 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
25243 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
25244 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
25245 one you want.
25246
25247 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
25248 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
25249
25250 @table @kbd
25251 @item C-h m
25252 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
25253
25254 @item C-c C-s
25255 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
25256 update the display window to show the current file and location.
25257
25258 @item C-c C-n
25259 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
25260 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
25261 to show the current file and location.
25262
25263 @item C-c C-i
25264 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
25265 display window accordingly.
25266
25267 @item C-c C-f
25268 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
25269 @code{finish} command.
25270
25271 @item C-c C-r
25272 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
25273 command.
25274
25275 @item C-c <
25276 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
25277 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
25278 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
25279
25280 @item C-c >
25281 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
25282 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
25283 @end table
25284
25285 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
25286 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
25287
25288 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
25289 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
25290 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
25291 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
25292 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
25293 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
25294 speedbar displays watch expressions.
25295
25296 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
25297 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
25298 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
25299 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
25300 frame.
25301
25302 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
25303 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
25304 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
25305 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
25306 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
25307 to correspond properly with the code.
25308
25309 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
25310 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
25311 Emacs Manual}).
25312
25313 @node GDB/MI
25314 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
25315
25316 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
25317
25318 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
25319 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
25320 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
25321 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
25322 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
25323 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
25324
25325 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
25326 in the form of a reference manual.
25327
25328 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
25329 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
25330 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
25331
25332 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
25333
25334 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
25335 This chapter uses the following notation:
25336
25337 @itemize @bullet
25338 @item
25339 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
25340
25341 @item
25342 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
25343 it may or may not be given.
25344
25345 @item
25346 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25347 may repeat zero or more times.
25348
25349 @item
25350 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25351 may repeat one or more times.
25352
25353 @item
25354 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
25355 @end itemize
25356
25357 @ignore
25358 @heading Dependencies
25359 @end ignore
25360
25361 @menu
25362 * GDB/MI General Design::
25363 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
25364 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
25365 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
25366 * GDB/MI Output Records::
25367 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
25368 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
25369 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
25370 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
25371 * GDB/MI Program Context::
25372 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
25373 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
25374 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
25375 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
25376 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
25377 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
25378 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
25379 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
25380 * GDB/MI File Commands::
25381 @ignore
25382 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
25383 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
25384 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
25385 @end ignore
25386 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
25387 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
25388 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
25389 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
25390 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
25391 @end menu
25392
25393 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25394 @node GDB/MI General Design
25395 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
25396 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
25397
25398 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
25399 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
25400 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
25401 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
25402 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
25403 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
25404 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
25405 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
25406 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
25407 a command and reported as part of that command response.
25408
25409 The important examples of notifications are:
25410 @itemize @bullet
25411
25412 @item
25413 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
25414 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
25415 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
25416 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
25417 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
25418 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
25419 command itself was successfully executed.
25420
25421 @item
25422 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
25423 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
25424 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
25425 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
25426 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
25427 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
25428
25429 @item
25430 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
25431 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
25432 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
25433 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
25434 orthogonal frontend design.
25435
25436 @end itemize
25437
25438 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
25439 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
25440 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
25441 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
25442 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
25443 the user interface.
25444
25445
25446 @menu
25447 * Context management::
25448 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
25449 * Thread groups::
25450 @end menu
25451
25452 @node Context management
25453 @subsection Context management
25454
25455 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
25456
25457 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
25458 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
25459 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
25460 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
25461 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
25462 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
25463 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
25464 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
25465 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
25466
25467 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
25468 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
25469 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
25470 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
25471 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
25472 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
25473 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
25474 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
25475 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
25476 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
25477 for thread and frame to operate on.
25478
25479 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
25480 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
25481 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
25482 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
25483 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
25484 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
25485 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
25486 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
25487 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
25488 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
25489
25490 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
25491 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
25492 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
25493 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
25494 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
25495 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
25496 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
25497 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
25498 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
25499 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
25500 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
25501 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
25502 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
25503 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
25504 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
25505 @samp{--frame} options.
25506
25507 @subsubsection Language
25508
25509 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
25510 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
25511 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
25512 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
25513 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
25514 For instance:
25515
25516 @smallexample
25517 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
25518 ^done,value="4"
25519 (gdb)
25520 @end smallexample
25521
25522 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
25523 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
25524 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
25525
25526 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
25527 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
25528
25529 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
25530 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
25531 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
25532 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
25533 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
25534 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
25535 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
25536 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
25537 @code{-list-target-features} command.
25538
25539 @table @code
25540 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
25541 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
25542 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
25543
25544 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
25545 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
25546 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
25547
25548 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
25549 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
25550 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
25551 MI commands even while the target is running.
25552
25553 @item -gdb-show mi-async
25554 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
25555 @end table
25556
25557 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
25558 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
25559 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
25560 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
25561 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
25562 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
25563
25564 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
25565 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
25566 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
25567 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
25568 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
25569 are running.
25570
25571 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
25572 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
25573 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
25574 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
25575 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
25576 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
25577 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
25578 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
25579 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
25580 @samp{--thread} option).
25581
25582 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
25583 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
25584 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
25585 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
25586
25587 @node Thread groups
25588 @subsection Thread groups
25589 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
25590 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
25591 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
25592 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
25593 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
25594
25595 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
25596 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
25597 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
25598 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
25599 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
25600 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
25601 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
25602 into processes.
25603
25604 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
25605 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
25606 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
25607 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
25608 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
25609 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
25610 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
25611 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
25612 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
25613 the members of specific thread group.
25614
25615 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
25616 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
25617 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
25618 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
25619 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
25620 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
25621 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
25622 after attaching to that thread group.
25623
25624 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
25625 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
25626 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
25627 such thread groups.
25628
25629 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25630 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
25631 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
25632
25633 @menu
25634 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
25635 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
25636 @end menu
25637
25638 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
25639 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
25640
25641 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
25642 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
25643 @table @code
25644 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
25645 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
25646
25647 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
25648 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
25649 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
25650
25651 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
25652 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
25653 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
25654
25655 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25656 "any sequence of digits"
25657
25658 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
25659 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
25660
25661 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
25662 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
25663
25664 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
25665 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
25666
25667 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
25668 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
25669 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
25670
25671 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
25672 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
25673
25674 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25675 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25676 @end table
25677
25678 @noindent
25679 Notes:
25680
25681 @itemize @bullet
25682 @item
25683 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
25684 output is described below.
25685
25686 @item
25687 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
25688 finishes.
25689
25690 @item
25691 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
25692 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
25693 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
25694 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
25695 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
25696 @end itemize
25697
25698 Pragmatics:
25699
25700 @itemize @bullet
25701 @item
25702 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
25703
25704 @item
25705 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
25706 @end itemize
25707
25708 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
25709 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
25710
25711 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
25712 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
25713 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
25714 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
25715 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
25716 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
25717
25718 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
25719 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
25720 @var{token}.
25721
25722 @table @code
25723 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
25724 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
25725
25726 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
25727 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
25728
25729 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
25730 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
25731
25732 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
25733 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
25734
25735 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
25736 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
25737
25738 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
25739 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
25740
25741 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
25742 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
25743
25744 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
25745 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
25746
25747 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
25748 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
25749
25750 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
25751 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
25752 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
25753
25754 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
25755 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
25756
25757 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
25758 @code{ @var{string} }
25759
25760 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
25761 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
25762
25763 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
25764 @code{@var{c-string}}
25765
25766 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
25767 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
25768
25769 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
25770 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
25771 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
25772
25773 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
25774 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
25775
25776 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
25777 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
25778
25779 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
25780 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
25781
25782 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
25783 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
25784
25785 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25786 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25787
25788 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25789 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
25790 @end table
25791
25792 @noindent
25793 Notes:
25794
25795 @itemize @bullet
25796 @item
25797 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
25798
25799 @item
25800 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
25801 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
25802 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
25803 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
25804 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
25805 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
25806 prior command.
25807
25808 @item
25809 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25810 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
25811 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
25812 prefixed by @samp{+}.
25813
25814 @item
25815 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25816 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
25817 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
25818 @samp{*}.
25819
25820 @item
25821 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25822 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
25823 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
25824 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
25825
25826 @item
25827 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25828 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
25829 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
25830 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
25831
25832 @item
25833 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25834 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
25835 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
25836
25837 @item
25838 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25839 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
25840 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
25841 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
25842
25843 @item
25844 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25845 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
25846 @var{values}.
25847
25848
25849 @end itemize
25850
25851 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
25852 details about the various output records.
25853
25854 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25855 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
25856 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
25857
25858 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
25859 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
25860
25861 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
25862 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
25863 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
25864 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
25865 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
25866 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
25867
25868 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
25869 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
25870 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
25871
25872 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25873 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
25874 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
25875 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
25876
25877 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
25878 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
25879
25880 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
25881 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
25882 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
25883 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
25884 might change.
25885
25886 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
25887 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
25888 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
25889 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
25890
25891 @itemize @bullet
25892 @item
25893 New MI commands may be added.
25894
25895 @item
25896 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
25897
25898 @item
25899 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
25900 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
25901
25902 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
25903 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
25904
25905 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
25906 @c resolve inconsistencies.
25907 @end itemize
25908
25909 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
25910 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
25911 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
25912 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
25913 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
25914
25915 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
25916 @c version?
25917
25918 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
25919 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
25920 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
25921 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
25922 @cindex mailing lists
25923
25924 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25925 @node GDB/MI Output Records
25926 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
25927
25928 @menu
25929 * GDB/MI Result Records::
25930 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
25931 * GDB/MI Async Records::
25932 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
25933 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
25934 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
25935 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
25936 @end menu
25937
25938 @node GDB/MI Result Records
25939 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
25940
25941 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25942 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
25943 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
25944 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
25945
25946 @table @code
25947 @findex ^done
25948 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
25949 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
25950 values.
25951
25952 @item "^running"
25953 @findex ^running
25954 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
25955 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
25956 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
25957 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
25958 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
25959 which threads are resumed.
25960
25961 @item "^connected"
25962 @findex ^connected
25963 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
25964
25965 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
25966 @findex ^error
25967 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
25968 the corresponding error message.
25969
25970 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
25971 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
25972 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
25973
25974 @table @samp
25975 @item "undefined-command"
25976 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
25977 @end table
25978
25979 @item "^exit"
25980 @findex ^exit
25981 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
25982
25983 @end table
25984
25985 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
25986 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
25987
25988 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
25989 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25990 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
25991 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
25992 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
25993
25994 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
25995 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
25996 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
25997 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
25998 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
25999
26000 @table @code
26001 @item "~" @var{string-output}
26002 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
26003 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
26004
26005 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
26006 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
26007 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
26008 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
26009
26010 @item "&" @var{string-output}
26011 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
26012 internals.
26013 @end table
26014
26015 @node GDB/MI Async Records
26016 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
26017
26018 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
26019 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
26020 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
26021 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
26022 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
26023 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
26024
26025 The following is the list of possible async records:
26026
26027 @table @code
26028
26029 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
26030 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
26031 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
26032 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
26033 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
26034 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
26035 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
26036 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
26037 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
26038 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
26039
26040 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
26041 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
26042 following values:
26043
26044 @table @code
26045 @item breakpoint-hit
26046 A breakpoint was reached.
26047 @item watchpoint-trigger
26048 A watchpoint was triggered.
26049 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
26050 A read watchpoint was triggered.
26051 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
26052 An access watchpoint was triggered.
26053 @item function-finished
26054 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26055 @item location-reached
26056 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
26057 @item watchpoint-scope
26058 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
26059 @item end-stepping-range
26060 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
26061 similar CLI command was accomplished.
26062 @item exited-signalled
26063 The inferior exited because of a signal.
26064 @item exited
26065 The inferior exited.
26066 @item exited-normally
26067 The inferior exited normally.
26068 @item signal-received
26069 A signal was received by the inferior.
26070 @item solib-event
26071 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
26072 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
26073 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
26074 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
26075 @item fork
26076 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
26077 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26078 @item vfork
26079 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
26080 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26081 @item syscall-entry
26082 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
26083 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26084 @item syscall-return
26085 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
26086 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26087 @item exec
26088 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
26089 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
26090 @end table
26091
26092 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
26093 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
26094 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
26095 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
26096 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
26097 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
26098 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
26099 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
26100 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
26101 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
26102 if such information is not available.
26103
26104 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
26105 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
26106 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
26107 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
26108 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
26109 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
26110 cannot be used in any way.
26111
26112 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
26113 A thread group became associated with a running program,
26114 either because the program was just started or the thread group
26115 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
26116 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
26117 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
26118
26119 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
26120 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
26121 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
26122 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
26123 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
26124 only when the inferior exited with some code.
26125
26126 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26127 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
26128 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
26129 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
26130 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
26131
26132 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
26133 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
26134 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
26135 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
26136 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
26137 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
26138 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
26139
26140 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26141 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26142 that thread.
26143
26144 @item =library-loaded,...
26145 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
26146 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26147 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
26148 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
26149 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26150 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
26151 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
26152 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26153 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
26154 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26155 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
26156 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26157 thread groups.
26158
26159 @item =library-unloaded,...
26160 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
26161 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26162 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26163 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26164 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
26165 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26166 thread groups.
26167
26168 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
26169 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
26170 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
26171 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
26172 frame is @var{tpnum}.
26173
26174 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
26175 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
26176 initial value @var{initial}.
26177
26178 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
26179 @itemx =tsv-deleted
26180 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
26181 trace state variables are deleted.
26182
26183 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
26184 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
26185 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
26186 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
26187 value of trace state variable is known.
26188
26189 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26190 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26191 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
26192 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26193 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26194 user.
26195
26196 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26197 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
26198 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
26199
26200 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26201 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26202
26203 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}"
26204 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
26205 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
26206 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
26207 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
26208
26209 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
26210 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
26211 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
26212 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
26213 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
26214 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
26215
26216 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
26217 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
26218 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
26219 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
26220 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
26221 executable code.
26222 @end table
26223
26224 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
26225 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
26226
26227 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
26228 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
26229 following fields:
26230
26231 @table @code
26232 @item number
26233 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
26234 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
26235 @samp{1.2}.
26236
26237 @item type
26238 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
26239 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
26240
26241 @item catch-type
26242 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
26243 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
26244
26245 @item disp
26246 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
26247 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
26248 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
26249
26250 @item enabled
26251 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
26252 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
26253 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
26254
26255 @item addr
26256 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
26257 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
26258 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
26259 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
26260 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
26261
26262 @item func
26263 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
26264 If not known, this field is not present.
26265
26266 @item filename
26267 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
26268 If not known, this field is not present.
26269
26270 @item fullname
26271 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
26272 known. If not known, this field is not present.
26273
26274 @item line
26275 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
26276 If not known, this field is not present.
26277
26278 @item at
26279 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
26280 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
26281 by a symbol name.
26282
26283 @item pending
26284 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
26285 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
26286
26287 @item evaluated-by
26288 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
26289 @samp{target}.
26290
26291 @item thread
26292 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
26293 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
26294
26295 @item task
26296 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
26297 field will hold the task identifier.
26298
26299 @item cond
26300 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
26301
26302 @item ignore
26303 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
26304
26305 @item enable
26306 The enable count of the breakpoint.
26307
26308 @item traceframe-usage
26309 FIXME.
26310
26311 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
26312 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
26313
26314 @item mask
26315 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
26316
26317 @item pass
26318 A tracepoint's pass count.
26319
26320 @item original-location
26321 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
26322 This field is optional.
26323
26324 @item times
26325 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
26326
26327 @item installed
26328 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
26329 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
26330 is not.
26331
26332 @item what
26333 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
26334
26335 @end table
26336
26337 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
26338 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
26339
26340 @smallexample
26341 -> -break-insert main
26342 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26343 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26344 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26345 times="0"@}
26346 <- (gdb)
26347 @end smallexample
26348
26349 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
26350 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
26351
26352 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
26353 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
26354 fields:
26355
26356 @table @code
26357 @item level
26358 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
26359 zero. This field is always present.
26360
26361 @item func
26362 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
26363 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
26364
26365 @item addr
26366 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
26367
26368 @item file
26369 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
26370 address. This field may be absent.
26371
26372 @item line
26373 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
26374 may be absent.
26375
26376 @item from
26377 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
26378 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
26379
26380 @end table
26381
26382 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
26383 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
26384
26385 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
26386 uses a tuple with the following fields:
26387
26388 @table @code
26389 @item id
26390 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
26391 always present.
26392
26393 @item target-id
26394 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
26395
26396 @item details
26397 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
26398 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
26399 frontend. This field is optional.
26400
26401 @item state
26402 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
26403 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
26404
26405 @item core
26406 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
26407 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
26408 @end table
26409
26410 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
26411 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
26412
26413 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
26414 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
26415 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
26416 the @code{exception-name} field.
26417
26418 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26419 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
26420 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
26421 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
26422
26423 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
26424 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
26425 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
26426 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
26427
26428 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
26429 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
26430
26431 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
26432
26433 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
26434 information of the breakpoint.
26435
26436 @smallexample
26437 -> -break-insert main
26438 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26439 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26440 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26441 times="0"@}
26442 <- (gdb)
26443 @end smallexample
26444
26445 @subheading Program Execution
26446
26447 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
26448 reason that execution stopped.
26449
26450 @smallexample
26451 -> -exec-run
26452 <- ^running
26453 <- (gdb)
26454 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
26455 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
26456 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
26457 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
26458 <- (gdb)
26459 -> -exec-continue
26460 <- ^running
26461 <- (gdb)
26462 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26463 <- (gdb)
26464 @end smallexample
26465
26466 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
26467
26468 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
26469
26470 @smallexample
26471 -> (gdb)
26472 <- -gdb-exit
26473 <- ^exit
26474 @end smallexample
26475
26476 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
26477 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
26478 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
26479 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
26480 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
26481 fails to exit in reasonable time.
26482
26483 @subheading A Bad Command
26484
26485 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
26486
26487 @smallexample
26488 -> -rubbish
26489 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
26490 <- (gdb)
26491 @end smallexample
26492
26493
26494 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26495 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
26496 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
26497
26498 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
26499 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
26500
26501 @subheading Motivation
26502
26503 The motivation for this collection of commands.
26504
26505 @subheading Introduction
26506
26507 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
26508
26509 @subheading Commands
26510
26511 For each command in the block, the following is described:
26512
26513 @subsubheading Synopsis
26514
26515 @smallexample
26516 -command @var{args}@dots{}
26517 @end smallexample
26518
26519 @subsubheading Result
26520
26521 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26522
26523 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
26524
26525 @subsubheading Example
26526
26527 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
26528 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
26529
26530
26531 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26532 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
26533 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
26534
26535 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
26536 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
26537 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26538 breakpoints.
26539
26540 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
26541 @findex -break-after
26542
26543 @subsubheading Synopsis
26544
26545 @smallexample
26546 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
26547 @end smallexample
26548
26549 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
26550 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
26551 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
26552 @samp{-break-list} command below.
26553
26554 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26555
26556 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
26557
26558 @subsubheading Example
26559
26560 @smallexample
26561 (gdb)
26562 -break-insert main
26563 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26564 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26565 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26566 times="0"@}
26567 (gdb)
26568 -break-after 1 3
26569 ~
26570 ^done
26571 (gdb)
26572 -break-list
26573 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26574 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26575 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26576 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26577 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26578 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26579 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26580 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26581 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26582 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26583 (gdb)
26584 @end smallexample
26585
26586 @ignore
26587 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
26588 @findex -break-catch
26589 @end ignore
26590
26591 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
26592 @findex -break-commands
26593
26594 @subsubheading Synopsis
26595
26596 @smallexample
26597 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
26598 @end smallexample
26599
26600 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
26601 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
26602 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
26603 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
26604 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
26605 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
26606
26607 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26608
26609 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
26610
26611 @subsubheading Example
26612
26613 @smallexample
26614 (gdb)
26615 -break-insert main
26616 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26617 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26618 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26619 times="0"@}
26620 (gdb)
26621 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
26622 ^done
26623 (gdb)
26624 @end smallexample
26625
26626 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
26627 @findex -break-condition
26628
26629 @subsubheading Synopsis
26630
26631 @smallexample
26632 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
26633 @end smallexample
26634
26635 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
26636 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
26637 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
26638 command below).
26639
26640 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26641
26642 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
26643
26644 @subsubheading Example
26645
26646 @smallexample
26647 (gdb)
26648 -break-condition 1 1
26649 ^done
26650 (gdb)
26651 -break-list
26652 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26653 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26654 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26655 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26656 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26657 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26658 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26659 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26660 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26661 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26662 (gdb)
26663 @end smallexample
26664
26665 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
26666 @findex -break-delete
26667
26668 @subsubheading Synopsis
26669
26670 @smallexample
26671 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26672 @end smallexample
26673
26674 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
26675 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
26676
26677 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26678
26679 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
26680
26681 @subsubheading Example
26682
26683 @smallexample
26684 (gdb)
26685 -break-delete 1
26686 ^done
26687 (gdb)
26688 -break-list
26689 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26690 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26691 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26692 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26693 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26694 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26695 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26696 body=[]@}
26697 (gdb)
26698 @end smallexample
26699
26700 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
26701 @findex -break-disable
26702
26703 @subsubheading Synopsis
26704
26705 @smallexample
26706 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26707 @end smallexample
26708
26709 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
26710 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
26711
26712 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26713
26714 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
26715
26716 @subsubheading Example
26717
26718 @smallexample
26719 (gdb)
26720 -break-disable 2
26721 ^done
26722 (gdb)
26723 -break-list
26724 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26725 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26726 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26727 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26728 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26729 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26730 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26731 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26732 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26733 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26734 (gdb)
26735 @end smallexample
26736
26737 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
26738 @findex -break-enable
26739
26740 @subsubheading Synopsis
26741
26742 @smallexample
26743 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26744 @end smallexample
26745
26746 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
26747
26748 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26749
26750 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
26751
26752 @subsubheading Example
26753
26754 @smallexample
26755 (gdb)
26756 -break-enable 2
26757 ^done
26758 (gdb)
26759 -break-list
26760 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26761 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26762 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26763 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26764 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26765 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26766 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26767 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26768 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26769 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26770 (gdb)
26771 @end smallexample
26772
26773 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
26774 @findex -break-info
26775
26776 @subsubheading Synopsis
26777
26778 @smallexample
26779 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
26780 @end smallexample
26781
26782 @c REDUNDANT???
26783 Get information about a single breakpoint.
26784
26785 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
26786 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
26787 table.
26788
26789 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26790
26791 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
26792
26793 @subsubheading Example
26794 N.A.
26795
26796 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
26797 @findex -break-insert
26798 @anchor{-break-insert}
26799
26800 @subsubheading Synopsis
26801
26802 @smallexample
26803 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
26804 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26805 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
26806 @end smallexample
26807
26808 @noindent
26809 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26810
26811 @table @var
26812 @item linespec location
26813 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
26814
26815 @item explicit location
26816 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
26817 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
26818 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
26819
26820 @table @samp
26821 @item --source @var{filename}
26822 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
26823 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
26824
26825 @item --function @var{function}
26826 The name of a function or method.
26827
26828 @item --label @var{label}
26829 The name of a label.
26830
26831 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
26832 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
26833 @end table
26834
26835 @item address location
26836 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
26837 @end table
26838
26839 @noindent
26840 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26841
26842 @table @samp
26843 @item -t
26844 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26845 @item -h
26846 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
26847 @item -f
26848 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
26849 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26850 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26851 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26852 cannot be parsed.
26853 @item -d
26854 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26855 @item -a
26856 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
26857 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
26858 @item -c @var{condition}
26859 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26860 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26861 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
26862 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26863 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26864 @end table
26865
26866 @subsubheading Result
26867
26868 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26869 resulting breakpoint.
26870
26871 Note: this format is open to change.
26872 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26873
26874 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26875
26876 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
26877 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
26878
26879 @subsubheading Example
26880
26881 @smallexample
26882 (gdb)
26883 -break-insert main
26884 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
26885 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26886 times="0"@}
26887 (gdb)
26888 -break-insert -t foo
26889 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
26890 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26891 times="0"@}
26892 (gdb)
26893 -break-list
26894 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26895 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26896 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26897 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26898 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26899 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26900 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26901 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26902 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
26903 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26904 times="0"@},
26905 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26906 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
26907 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26908 times="0"@}]@}
26909 (gdb)
26910 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
26911 @c ~int foo(int, int);
26912 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
26913 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26914 @c times="0"@}
26915 @c (gdb)
26916 @end smallexample
26917
26918 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
26919 @findex -dprintf-insert
26920
26921 @subsubheading Synopsis
26922
26923 @smallexample
26924 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
26925 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26926 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
26927 [ @var{argument} ]
26928 @end smallexample
26929
26930 @noindent
26931 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
26932 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
26933
26934 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26935
26936 @table @samp
26937 @item -t
26938 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26939 @item -f
26940 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
26941 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26942 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26943 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26944 cannot be parsed.
26945 @item -d
26946 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26947 @item -c @var{condition}
26948 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26949 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26950 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
26951 to @var{ignore-count}.
26952 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26953 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26954 @end table
26955
26956 @subsubheading Result
26957
26958 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26959 resulting breakpoint.
26960
26961 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26962
26963 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26964
26965 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
26966
26967 @subsubheading Example
26968
26969 @smallexample
26970 (gdb)
26971 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
26972 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26973 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26974 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
26975 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
26976 original-location="foo"@}
26977 (gdb)
26978 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
26979 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26980 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26981 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
26982 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
26983 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
26984 (gdb)
26985 @end smallexample
26986
26987 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
26988 @findex -break-list
26989
26990 @subsubheading Synopsis
26991
26992 @smallexample
26993 -break-list
26994 @end smallexample
26995
26996 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
26997
26998 @table @samp
26999 @item Number
27000 number of the breakpoint
27001 @item Type
27002 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
27003 @item Disposition
27004 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
27005 or @samp{nokeep}
27006 @item Enabled
27007 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
27008 @item Address
27009 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
27010 @item What
27011 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
27012 name, line number
27013 @item Thread-groups
27014 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
27015 @item Times
27016 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
27017 @end table
27018
27019 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
27020 @code{body} field is an empty list.
27021
27022 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27023
27024 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
27025
27026 @subsubheading Example
27027
27028 @smallexample
27029 (gdb)
27030 -break-list
27031 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27032 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27033 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27034 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27035 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27036 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27037 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27038 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27039 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27040 times="0"@},
27041 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27042 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27043 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27044 (gdb)
27045 @end smallexample
27046
27047 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
27048
27049 @smallexample
27050 (gdb)
27051 -break-list
27052 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27053 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27054 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27055 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27056 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27057 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27058 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27059 body=[]@}
27060 (gdb)
27061 @end smallexample
27062
27063 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
27064 @findex -break-passcount
27065
27066 @subsubheading Synopsis
27067
27068 @smallexample
27069 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
27070 @end smallexample
27071
27072 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
27073 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
27074 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
27075 command @samp{passcount}.
27076
27077 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
27078 @findex -break-watch
27079
27080 @subsubheading Synopsis
27081
27082 @smallexample
27083 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
27084 @end smallexample
27085
27086 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
27087 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
27088 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
27089 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
27090 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
27091 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
27092 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
27093 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
27094
27095 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
27096 breakpoints inserted.
27097
27098 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27099
27100 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
27101 @samp{rwatch}.
27102
27103 @subsubheading Example
27104
27105 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
27106
27107 @smallexample
27108 (gdb)
27109 -break-watch x
27110 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
27111 (gdb)
27112 -exec-continue
27113 ^running
27114 (gdb)
27115 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
27116 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
27117 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
27118 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
27119 (gdb)
27120 @end smallexample
27121
27122 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
27123 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
27124 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
27125
27126 @smallexample
27127 (gdb)
27128 -break-watch C
27129 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
27130 (gdb)
27131 -exec-continue
27132 ^running
27133 (gdb)
27134 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
27135 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27136 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27137 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27138 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27139 (gdb)
27140 -exec-continue
27141 ^running
27142 (gdb)
27143 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
27144 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27145 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27146 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27147 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27148 (gdb)
27149 @end smallexample
27150
27151 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27152 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27153 deleted.
27154
27155 @smallexample
27156 (gdb)
27157 -break-watch C
27158 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27159 (gdb)
27160 -break-list
27161 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27162 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27163 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27164 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27165 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27166 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27167 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27168 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27169 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27170 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27171 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27172 times="1"@},
27173 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27174 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27175 (gdb)
27176 -exec-continue
27177 ^running
27178 (gdb)
27179 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
27180 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27181 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27182 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27183 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27184 (gdb)
27185 -break-list
27186 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27187 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27188 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27189 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27190 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27191 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27192 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27193 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27194 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27195 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27196 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27197 times="1"@},
27198 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27199 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
27200 (gdb)
27201 -exec-continue
27202 ^running
27203 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
27204 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27205 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27206 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27207 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27208 (gdb)
27209 -break-list
27210 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27211 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27212 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27213 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27214 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27215 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27216 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27217 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27218 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27219 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27220 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
27221 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
27222 (gdb)
27223 @end smallexample
27224
27225
27226 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27227 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27228 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
27229
27230 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27231 catchpoints.
27232
27233 @menu
27234 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27235 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27236 @end menu
27237
27238 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27239 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27240
27241 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
27242 @findex -catch-load
27243
27244 @subsubheading Synopsis
27245
27246 @smallexample
27247 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27248 @end smallexample
27249
27250 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
27251 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27252 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
27253 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27254 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
27255
27256
27257 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27258
27259 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
27260
27261 @subsubheading Example
27262
27263 @smallexample
27264 -catch-load -t foo.so
27265 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27266 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
27267 (gdb)
27268 @end smallexample
27269
27270
27271 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
27272 @findex -catch-unload
27273
27274 @subsubheading Synopsis
27275
27276 @smallexample
27277 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27278 @end smallexample
27279
27280 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
27281 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27282 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
27283 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27284 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
27285
27286 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27287
27288 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
27289
27290 @subsubheading Example
27291
27292 @smallexample
27293 -catch-unload -d bar.so
27294 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27295 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
27296 (gdb)
27297 @end smallexample
27298
27299 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27300 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27301
27302 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
27303 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
27304
27305 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
27306 @findex -catch-assert
27307
27308 @subsubheading Synopsis
27309
27310 @smallexample
27311 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
27312 @end smallexample
27313
27314 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
27315
27316 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27317
27318 @table @samp
27319 @item -c @var{condition}
27320 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27321 @item -d
27322 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27323 @item -t
27324 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27325 @end table
27326
27327 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27328
27329 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
27330
27331 @subsubheading Example
27332
27333 @smallexample
27334 -catch-assert
27335 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27336 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
27337 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
27338 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
27339 (gdb)
27340 @end smallexample
27341
27342 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
27343 @findex -catch-exception
27344
27345 @subsubheading Synopsis
27346
27347 @smallexample
27348 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
27349 [ -t ] [ -u ]
27350 @end smallexample
27351
27352 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
27353 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
27354 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
27355 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
27356 catchpoints.
27357
27358 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27359
27360 @table @samp
27361 @item -c @var{condition}
27362 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27363 @item -d
27364 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27365 @item -e @var{exception-name}
27366 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
27367 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
27368 @item -t
27369 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27370 @item -u
27371 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
27372 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
27373 @end table
27374
27375 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27376
27377 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
27378 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
27379
27380 @subsubheading Example
27381
27382 @smallexample
27383 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
27384 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27385 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
27386 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
27387 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
27388 (gdb)
27389 @end smallexample
27390
27391 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27392 @node GDB/MI Program Context
27393 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
27394
27395 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
27396 @findex -exec-arguments
27397
27398
27399 @subsubheading Synopsis
27400
27401 @smallexample
27402 -exec-arguments @var{args}
27403 @end smallexample
27404
27405 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
27406 @samp{-exec-run}.
27407
27408 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27409
27410 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
27411
27412 @subsubheading Example
27413
27414 @smallexample
27415 (gdb)
27416 -exec-arguments -v word
27417 ^done
27418 (gdb)
27419 @end smallexample
27420
27421
27422 @ignore
27423 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
27424 @findex -exec-show-arguments
27425
27426 @subsubheading Synopsis
27427
27428 @smallexample
27429 -exec-show-arguments
27430 @end smallexample
27431
27432 Print the arguments of the program.
27433
27434 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27435
27436 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
27437
27438 @subsubheading Example
27439 N.A.
27440 @end ignore
27441
27442
27443 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
27444 @findex -environment-cd
27445
27446 @subsubheading Synopsis
27447
27448 @smallexample
27449 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
27450 @end smallexample
27451
27452 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
27453
27454 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27455
27456 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
27457
27458 @subsubheading Example
27459
27460 @smallexample
27461 (gdb)
27462 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27463 ^done
27464 (gdb)
27465 @end smallexample
27466
27467
27468 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
27469 @findex -environment-directory
27470
27471 @subsubheading Synopsis
27472
27473 @smallexample
27474 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27475 @end smallexample
27476
27477 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
27478 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
27479 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
27480 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27481 occurs as normal.
27482 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27483 multiple directories in a single command
27484 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27485 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27486 If blanks are needed as
27487 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27488 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27489 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27490 character must not be used
27491 in any directory name.
27492 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
27493
27494 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27495
27496 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
27497
27498 @subsubheading Example
27499
27500 @smallexample
27501 (gdb)
27502 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27503 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27504 (gdb)
27505 -environment-directory ""
27506 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27507 (gdb)
27508 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
27509 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
27510 (gdb)
27511 -environment-directory -r
27512 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
27513 (gdb)
27514 @end smallexample
27515
27516
27517 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
27518 @findex -environment-path
27519
27520 @subsubheading Synopsis
27521
27522 @smallexample
27523 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27524 @end smallexample
27525
27526 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
27527 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
27528 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
27529 supplied in addition to the
27530 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27531 occurs as normal.
27532 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27533 multiple directories in a single command
27534 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27535 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27536 If blanks are needed as
27537 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27538 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27539 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27540 character must not be used
27541 in any directory name.
27542 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
27543
27544
27545 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27546
27547 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
27548
27549 @subsubheading Example
27550
27551 @smallexample
27552 (gdb)
27553 -environment-path
27554 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
27555 (gdb)
27556 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
27557 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
27558 (gdb)
27559 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
27560 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
27561 (gdb)
27562 @end smallexample
27563
27564
27565 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
27566 @findex -environment-pwd
27567
27568 @subsubheading Synopsis
27569
27570 @smallexample
27571 -environment-pwd
27572 @end smallexample
27573
27574 Show the current working directory.
27575
27576 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27577
27578 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
27579
27580 @subsubheading Example
27581
27582 @smallexample
27583 (gdb)
27584 -environment-pwd
27585 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
27586 (gdb)
27587 @end smallexample
27588
27589 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27590 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
27591 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
27592
27593
27594 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
27595 @findex -thread-info
27596
27597 @subsubheading Synopsis
27598
27599 @smallexample
27600 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
27601 @end smallexample
27602
27603 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
27604 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
27605 threads. When printing information about all threads,
27606 also reports the current thread.
27607
27608 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27609
27610 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
27611 about all threads.
27612
27613 @subsubheading Result
27614
27615 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
27616 defined for a given thread:
27617
27618 @table @samp
27619 @item current
27620 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27621
27622 @item id
27623 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
27624
27625 @item target-id
27626 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
27627
27628 @item details
27629 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
27630 field is optional.
27631
27632 @item name
27633 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27634 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27635 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27636 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27637 field is omitted.
27638
27639 @item frame
27640 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
27641
27642 @item state
27643 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
27644 values:
27645
27646 @table @code
27647 @item stopped
27648 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
27649 threads.
27650
27651 @item running
27652 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
27653 threads.
27654
27655 @end table
27656
27657 @item core
27658 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
27659 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
27660
27661 @end table
27662
27663 @subsubheading Example
27664
27665 @smallexample
27666 -thread-info
27667 ^done,threads=[
27668 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
27669 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
27670 args=[]@},state="running"@},
27671 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
27672 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
27673 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
27674 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
27675 state="running"@}],
27676 current-thread-id="1"
27677 (gdb)
27678 @end smallexample
27679
27680 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
27681 @findex -thread-list-ids
27682
27683 @subsubheading Synopsis
27684
27685 @smallexample
27686 -thread-list-ids
27687 @end smallexample
27688
27689 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
27690 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
27691
27692 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
27693 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
27694
27695 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27696
27697 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
27698
27699 @subsubheading Example
27700
27701 @smallexample
27702 (gdb)
27703 -thread-list-ids
27704 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27705 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
27706 (gdb)
27707 @end smallexample
27708
27709
27710 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
27711 @findex -thread-select
27712
27713 @subsubheading Synopsis
27714
27715 @smallexample
27716 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
27717 @end smallexample
27718
27719 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
27720 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
27721
27722 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
27723 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
27724
27725 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27726
27727 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
27728
27729 @subsubheading Example
27730
27731 @smallexample
27732 (gdb)
27733 -exec-next
27734 ^running
27735 (gdb)
27736 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
27737 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
27738 (gdb)
27739 -thread-list-ids
27740 ^done,
27741 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27742 number-of-threads="3"
27743 (gdb)
27744 -thread-select 3
27745 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
27746 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
27747 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
27748 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
27749 (gdb)
27750 @end smallexample
27751
27752 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27753 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
27754 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
27755
27756 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
27757 @findex -ada-task-info
27758
27759 @subsubheading Synopsis
27760
27761 @smallexample
27762 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
27763 @end smallexample
27764
27765 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
27766 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
27767
27768 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27769
27770 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
27771 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
27772
27773 @subsubheading Result
27774
27775 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
27776 defined for each Ada task:
27777
27778 @table @samp
27779 @item current
27780 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27781
27782 @item id
27783 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
27784
27785 @item task-id
27786 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
27787
27788 @item thread-id
27789 The identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada task.
27790
27791 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
27792 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
27793 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
27794
27795 @item parent-id
27796 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
27797 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
27798
27799 @item priority
27800 The base priority of the task.
27801
27802 @item state
27803 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
27804 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
27805
27806 @item name
27807 The name of the task.
27808
27809 @end table
27810
27811 @subsubheading Example
27812
27813 @smallexample
27814 -ada-task-info
27815 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
27816 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
27817 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
27818 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
27819 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
27820 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
27821 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
27822 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
27823 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
27824 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
27825 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
27826 (gdb)
27827 @end smallexample
27828
27829 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27830 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
27831 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
27832
27833 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
27834 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
27835 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
27836 other cases.
27837
27838 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
27839 @findex -exec-continue
27840
27841 @subsubheading Synopsis
27842
27843 @smallexample
27844 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
27845 @end smallexample
27846
27847 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
27848 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
27849 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
27850 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
27851 @itemize @bullet
27852 @item
27853 breakpoints or watchpoints
27854 @item
27855 signals or exceptions
27856 @item
27857 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
27858 @item
27859 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
27860 @end itemize
27861 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
27862 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
27863 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
27864 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
27865 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
27866 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
27867
27868 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27869
27870 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
27871
27872 @subsubheading Example
27873
27874 @smallexample
27875 -exec-continue
27876 ^running
27877 (gdb)
27878 @@Hello world
27879 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
27880 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
27881 line="13"@}
27882 (gdb)
27883 @end smallexample
27884
27885
27886 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
27887 @findex -exec-finish
27888
27889 @subsubheading Synopsis
27890
27891 @smallexample
27892 -exec-finish [--reverse]
27893 @end smallexample
27894
27895 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
27896 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
27897 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
27898 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
27899 function was called.
27900
27901 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27902
27903 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
27904
27905 @subsubheading Example
27906
27907 Function returning @code{void}.
27908
27909 @smallexample
27910 -exec-finish
27911 ^running
27912 (gdb)
27913 @@hello from foo
27914 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27915 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
27916 (gdb)
27917 @end smallexample
27918
27919 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
27920 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
27921 value itself.
27922
27923 @smallexample
27924 -exec-finish
27925 ^running
27926 (gdb)
27927 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
27928 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
27929 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27930 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
27931 (gdb)
27932 @end smallexample
27933
27934
27935 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
27936 @findex -exec-interrupt
27937
27938 @subsubheading Synopsis
27939
27940 @smallexample
27941 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
27942 @end smallexample
27943
27944 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
27945 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
27946 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
27947 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
27948 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
27949
27950 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
27951 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
27952 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
27953 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
27954
27955 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
27956 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
27957 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
27958 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
27959
27960 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27961
27962 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
27963
27964 @subsubheading Example
27965
27966 @smallexample
27967 (gdb)
27968 111-exec-continue
27969 111^running
27970
27971 (gdb)
27972 222-exec-interrupt
27973 222^done
27974 (gdb)
27975 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
27976 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27977 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
27978 (gdb)
27979
27980 (gdb)
27981 -exec-interrupt
27982 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
27983 (gdb)
27984 @end smallexample
27985
27986 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
27987 @findex -exec-jump
27988
27989 @subsubheading Synopsis
27990
27991 @smallexample
27992 -exec-jump @var{location}
27993 @end smallexample
27994
27995 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
27996 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
27997 different forms of @var{location}.
27998
27999 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28000
28001 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
28002
28003 @subsubheading Example
28004
28005 @smallexample
28006 -exec-jump foo.c:10
28007 *running,thread-id="all"
28008 ^running
28009 @end smallexample
28010
28011
28012 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
28013 @findex -exec-next
28014
28015 @subsubheading Synopsis
28016
28017 @smallexample
28018 -exec-next [--reverse]
28019 @end smallexample
28020
28021 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28022 of the next source line is reached.
28023
28024 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28025 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
28026 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
28027 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
28028 source line where the function was called.
28029
28030
28031 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28032
28033 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
28034
28035 @subsubheading Example
28036
28037 @smallexample
28038 -exec-next
28039 ^running
28040 (gdb)
28041 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
28042 (gdb)
28043 @end smallexample
28044
28045
28046 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
28047 @findex -exec-next-instruction
28048
28049 @subsubheading Synopsis
28050
28051 @smallexample
28052 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
28053 @end smallexample
28054
28055 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
28056 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
28057 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
28058 printed as well.
28059
28060 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
28061 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
28062 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
28063 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
28064 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
28065
28066 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28067
28068 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
28069
28070 @subsubheading Example
28071
28072 @smallexample
28073 (gdb)
28074 -exec-next-instruction
28075 ^running
28076
28077 (gdb)
28078 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28079 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
28080 (gdb)
28081 @end smallexample
28082
28083
28084 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
28085 @findex -exec-return
28086
28087 @subsubheading Synopsis
28088
28089 @smallexample
28090 -exec-return
28091 @end smallexample
28092
28093 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
28094 Displays the new current frame.
28095
28096 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28097
28098 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
28099
28100 @subsubheading Example
28101
28102 @smallexample
28103 (gdb)
28104 200-break-insert callee4
28105 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
28106 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28107 (gdb)
28108 000-exec-run
28109 000^running
28110 (gdb)
28111 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28112 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28113 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28114 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
28115 (gdb)
28116 205-break-delete
28117 205^done
28118 (gdb)
28119 111-exec-return
28120 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
28121 args=[@{name="strarg",
28122 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28123 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28124 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28125 (gdb)
28126 @end smallexample
28127
28128
28129 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
28130 @findex -exec-run
28131
28132 @subsubheading Synopsis
28133
28134 @smallexample
28135 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
28136 @end smallexample
28137
28138 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
28139 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
28140 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
28141 the program has exited exceptionally.
28142
28143 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
28144 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
28145 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
28146 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
28147 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
28148
28149 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
28150 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
28151 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
28152 (@pxref{Starting}).
28153
28154 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28155
28156 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
28157
28158 @subsubheading Examples
28159
28160 @smallexample
28161 (gdb)
28162 -break-insert main
28163 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28164 (gdb)
28165 -exec-run
28166 ^running
28167 (gdb)
28168 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28169 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28170 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28171 (gdb)
28172 @end smallexample
28173
28174 @noindent
28175 Program exited normally:
28176
28177 @smallexample
28178 (gdb)
28179 -exec-run
28180 ^running
28181 (gdb)
28182 x = 55
28183 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28184 (gdb)
28185 @end smallexample
28186
28187 @noindent
28188 Program exited exceptionally:
28189
28190 @smallexample
28191 (gdb)
28192 -exec-run
28193 ^running
28194 (gdb)
28195 x = 55
28196 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
28197 (gdb)
28198 @end smallexample
28199
28200 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
28201 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
28202
28203 @smallexample
28204 (gdb)
28205 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
28206 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
28207 @end smallexample
28208
28209
28210 @c @subheading -exec-signal
28211
28212
28213 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
28214 @findex -exec-step
28215
28216 @subsubheading Synopsis
28217
28218 @smallexample
28219 -exec-step [--reverse]
28220 @end smallexample
28221
28222 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28223 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
28224 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
28225 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
28226 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
28227 previously executed source line.
28228
28229 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28230
28231 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
28232
28233 @subsubheading Example
28234
28235 Stepping into a function:
28236
28237 @smallexample
28238 -exec-step
28239 ^running
28240 (gdb)
28241 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28242 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
28243 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
28244 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
28245 (gdb)
28246 @end smallexample
28247
28248 Regular stepping:
28249
28250 @smallexample
28251 -exec-step
28252 ^running
28253 (gdb)
28254 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
28255 (gdb)
28256 @end smallexample
28257
28258
28259 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
28260 @findex -exec-step-instruction
28261
28262 @subsubheading Synopsis
28263
28264 @smallexample
28265 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
28266 @end smallexample
28267
28268 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
28269 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
28270 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
28271 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
28272 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
28273 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
28274 as well.
28275
28276 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28277
28278 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
28279
28280 @subsubheading Example
28281
28282 @smallexample
28283 (gdb)
28284 -exec-step-instruction
28285 ^running
28286
28287 (gdb)
28288 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28289 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28290 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28291 (gdb)
28292 -exec-step-instruction
28293 ^running
28294
28295 (gdb)
28296 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28297 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28298 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28299 (gdb)
28300 @end smallexample
28301
28302
28303 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
28304 @findex -exec-until
28305
28306 @subsubheading Synopsis
28307
28308 @smallexample
28309 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
28310 @end smallexample
28311
28312 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
28313 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
28314 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
28315 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
28316
28317 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28318
28319 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
28320
28321 @subsubheading Example
28322
28323 @smallexample
28324 (gdb)
28325 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
28326 ^running
28327 (gdb)
28328 x = 55
28329 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28330 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
28331 (gdb)
28332 @end smallexample
28333
28334 @ignore
28335 @subheading -file-clear
28336 Is this going away????
28337 @end ignore
28338
28339 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28340 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
28341 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
28342
28343 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
28344 @findex -enable-frame-filters
28345
28346 @smallexample
28347 -enable-frame-filters
28348 @end smallexample
28349
28350 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
28351 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
28352 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28353 request that this functionality be enabled.
28354
28355 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28356
28357 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28358 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28359
28360 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
28361 @findex -stack-info-frame
28362
28363 @subsubheading Synopsis
28364
28365 @smallexample
28366 -stack-info-frame
28367 @end smallexample
28368
28369 Get info on the selected frame.
28370
28371 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28372
28373 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
28374 (without arguments).
28375
28376 @subsubheading Example
28377
28378 @smallexample
28379 (gdb)
28380 -stack-info-frame
28381 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28382 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28383 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
28384 (gdb)
28385 @end smallexample
28386
28387 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
28388 @findex -stack-info-depth
28389
28390 @subsubheading Synopsis
28391
28392 @smallexample
28393 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
28394 @end smallexample
28395
28396 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
28397 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
28398
28399 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28400
28401 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
28402
28403 @subsubheading Example
28404
28405 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
28406
28407 @smallexample
28408 (gdb)
28409 -stack-info-depth
28410 ^done,depth="12"
28411 (gdb)
28412 -stack-info-depth 4
28413 ^done,depth="4"
28414 (gdb)
28415 -stack-info-depth 12
28416 ^done,depth="12"
28417 (gdb)
28418 -stack-info-depth 11
28419 ^done,depth="11"
28420 (gdb)
28421 -stack-info-depth 13
28422 ^done,depth="12"
28423 (gdb)
28424 @end smallexample
28425
28426 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
28427 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
28428 @findex -stack-list-arguments
28429
28430 @subsubheading Synopsis
28431
28432 @smallexample
28433 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28434 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28435 @end smallexample
28436
28437 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
28438 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
28439 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
28440 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
28441 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
28442 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
28443 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
28444 which case only existing frames will be returned.
28445
28446 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28447 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28448 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28449 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28450 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28451 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28452
28453 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
28454 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
28455 are still displayed, however.
28456
28457 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
28458 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28459
28460 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28461
28462 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
28463 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
28464 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
28465
28466 @subsubheading Example
28467
28468 @smallexample
28469 (gdb)
28470 -stack-list-frames
28471 ^done,
28472 stack=[
28473 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28474 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28475 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
28476 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28477 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28478 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
28479 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
28480 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28481 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
28482 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
28483 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28484 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
28485 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
28486 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28487 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
28488 (gdb)
28489 -stack-list-arguments 0
28490 ^done,
28491 stack-args=[
28492 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28493 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
28494 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
28495 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
28496 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28497 (gdb)
28498 -stack-list-arguments 1
28499 ^done,
28500 stack-args=[
28501 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28502 frame=@{level="1",
28503 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28504 frame=@{level="2",args=[
28505 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28506 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28507 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
28508 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28509 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
28510 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
28511 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28512 (gdb)
28513 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
28514 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
28515 (gdb)
28516 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
28517 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
28518 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28519 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
28520 (gdb)
28521 @end smallexample
28522
28523 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
28524
28525
28526 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
28527 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
28528 @findex -stack-list-frames
28529
28530 @subsubheading Synopsis
28531
28532 @smallexample
28533 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28534 @end smallexample
28535
28536 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
28537 following info:
28538
28539 @table @samp
28540 @item @var{level}
28541 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
28542 @item @var{addr}
28543 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
28544 @item @var{func}
28545 Function name.
28546 @item @var{file}
28547 File name of the source file where the function lives.
28548 @item @var{fullname}
28549 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
28550 @item @var{line}
28551 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
28552 @item @var{from}
28553 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
28554 if the frame's function is not known.
28555 @end table
28556
28557 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
28558 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
28559 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
28560 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
28561 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
28562 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
28563 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
28564 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28565 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28566
28567 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28568
28569 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
28570
28571 @subsubheading Example
28572
28573 Full stack backtrace:
28574
28575 @smallexample
28576 (gdb)
28577 -stack-list-frames
28578 ^done,stack=
28579 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
28580 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
28581 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28582 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28583 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28584 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28585 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28586 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28587 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28588 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28589 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28590 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28591 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28592 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28593 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28594 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28595 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28596 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28597 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28598 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28599 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28600 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28601 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
28602 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
28603 (gdb)
28604 @end smallexample
28605
28606 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
28607
28608 @smallexample
28609 (gdb)
28610 -stack-list-frames 3 5
28611 ^done,stack=
28612 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28613 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28614 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28615 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28616 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28617 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28618 (gdb)
28619 @end smallexample
28620
28621 Show a single frame:
28622
28623 @smallexample
28624 (gdb)
28625 -stack-list-frames 3 3
28626 ^done,stack=
28627 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28628 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28629 (gdb)
28630 @end smallexample
28631
28632
28633 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
28634 @findex -stack-list-locals
28635 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
28636
28637 @subsubheading Synopsis
28638
28639 @smallexample
28640 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28641 @end smallexample
28642
28643 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
28644 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28645 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28646 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28647 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28648 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
28649 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
28650 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
28651 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28652 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28653
28654 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28655 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
28656 variables are still displayed, however.
28657
28658 This command is deprecated in favor of the
28659 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28660
28661 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28662
28663 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
28664
28665 @subsubheading Example
28666
28667 @smallexample
28668 (gdb)
28669 -stack-list-locals 0
28670 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
28671 (gdb)
28672 -stack-list-locals --all-values
28673 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
28674 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
28675 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
28676 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
28677 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
28678 (gdb)
28679 @end smallexample
28680
28681 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
28682 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
28683 @findex -stack-list-variables
28684
28685 @subsubheading Synopsis
28686
28687 @smallexample
28688 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28689 @end smallexample
28690
28691 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
28692 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28693 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28694 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28695 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28696 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28697 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28698
28699 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28700 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
28701 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
28702
28703 @subsubheading Example
28704
28705 @smallexample
28706 (gdb)
28707 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
28708 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
28709 (gdb)
28710 @end smallexample
28711
28712
28713 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
28714 @findex -stack-select-frame
28715
28716 @subsubheading Synopsis
28717
28718 @smallexample
28719 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
28720 @end smallexample
28721
28722 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
28723 the stack.
28724
28725 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
28726 option to every command.
28727
28728 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28729
28730 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
28731 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
28732
28733 @subsubheading Example
28734
28735 @smallexample
28736 (gdb)
28737 -stack-select-frame 2
28738 ^done
28739 (gdb)
28740 @end smallexample
28741
28742 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28743 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
28744 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
28745
28746 @ignore
28747
28748 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28749
28750 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
28751 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
28752 used by @code{Insight}.
28753
28754 The two main reasons for that are:
28755
28756 @enumerate 1
28757 @item
28758 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
28759
28760 @item
28761 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
28762 now).
28763 @end enumerate
28764
28765 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
28766 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
28767 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
28768 hints about their use.
28769
28770 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
28771 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
28772 least, the following operations:
28773
28774 @itemize @bullet
28775 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
28776 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
28777 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
28778 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
28779 @end itemize
28780
28781 @end ignore
28782
28783 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
28784
28785 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28786
28787 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
28788 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
28789 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
28790 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
28791 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
28792 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
28793 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
28794 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
28795 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
28796 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
28797 object, or to change display format.
28798
28799 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
28800 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
28801 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
28802 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
28803 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
28804 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
28805 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
28806 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
28807 child will be created.
28808
28809 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
28810 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
28811 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
28812 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
28813 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
28814
28815 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
28816 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
28817 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
28818 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
28819 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
28820 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
28821 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
28822 variables that frontend has created.
28823
28824 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
28825 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
28826 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
28827 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
28828 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
28829 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
28830 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
28831 implicitly updated.
28832
28833 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
28834 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
28835 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
28836 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
28837 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
28838 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
28839 frame. Consider this example:
28840
28841 @smallexample
28842 void do_work(...)
28843 @{
28844 struct work_state state;
28845
28846 if (...)
28847 do_work(...);
28848 @}
28849 @end smallexample
28850
28851 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
28852 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
28853 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
28854 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
28855 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
28856
28857 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
28858 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
28859 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
28860 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
28861 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
28862 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
28863
28864 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
28865 access this functionality:
28866
28867 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
28868 @item @strong{Operation}
28869 @tab @strong{Description}
28870
28871 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
28872 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
28873 @item @code{-var-create}
28874 @tab create a variable object
28875 @item @code{-var-delete}
28876 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
28877 @item @code{-var-set-format}
28878 @tab set the display format of this variable
28879 @item @code{-var-show-format}
28880 @tab show the display format of this variable
28881 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
28882 @tab tells how many children this object has
28883 @item @code{-var-list-children}
28884 @tab return a list of the object's children
28885 @item @code{-var-info-type}
28886 @tab show the type of this variable object
28887 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
28888 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
28889 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
28890 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
28891 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
28892 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
28893 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
28894 @tab get the value of this variable
28895 @item @code{-var-assign}
28896 @tab set the value of this variable
28897 @item @code{-var-update}
28898 @tab update the variable and its children
28899 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
28900 @tab set frozeness attribute
28901 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
28902 @tab set range of children to display on update
28903 @end multitable
28904
28905 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
28906 how it can be used.
28907
28908 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
28909
28910 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
28911 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
28912
28913 @smallexample
28914 -enable-pretty-printing
28915 @end smallexample
28916
28917 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
28918 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
28919 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28920 request that this functionality be enabled.
28921
28922 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28923
28924 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28925 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28926
28927 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
28928 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
28929
28930 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
28931 @findex -var-create
28932
28933 @subsubheading Synopsis
28934
28935 @smallexample
28936 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
28937 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
28938 @end smallexample
28939
28940 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
28941 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
28942 register.
28943
28944 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
28945 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
28946 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
28947 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
28948 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
28949
28950 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
28951 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
28952 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
28953 object must be created.
28954
28955 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
28956 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
28957
28958 @itemize @bullet
28959 @item
28960 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
28961
28962 @item
28963 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
28964
28965 @item
28966 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
28967 @end itemize
28968
28969 @cindex dynamic varobj
28970 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
28971 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
28972 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
28973 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
28974 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
28975 compatibility for existing clients.
28976
28977 @subsubheading Result
28978
28979 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
28980 are:
28981
28982 @table @samp
28983 @item name
28984 The name of the varobj.
28985
28986 @item numchild
28987 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
28988 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
28989 @samp{has_more} attribute.
28990
28991 @item value
28992 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
28993 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
28994 will not be interesting.
28995
28996 @item type
28997 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
28998 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
28999 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29000 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29001 @emph{declared} one.
29002
29003 @item thread-id
29004 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
29005 thread's identifier.
29006
29007 @item has_more
29008 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
29009 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
29010
29011 @item dynamic
29012 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29013 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29014 then this attribute will not be present.
29015
29016 @item displayhint
29017 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29018 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29019 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29020 @end table
29021
29022 Typical output will look like this:
29023
29024 @smallexample
29025 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
29026 has_more="@var{has_more}"
29027 @end smallexample
29028
29029
29030 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
29031 @findex -var-delete
29032
29033 @subsubheading Synopsis
29034
29035 @smallexample
29036 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
29037 @end smallexample
29038
29039 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
29040 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
29041
29042 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
29043
29044
29045 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
29046 @findex -var-set-format
29047
29048 @subsubheading Synopsis
29049
29050 @smallexample
29051 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
29052 @end smallexample
29053
29054 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
29055 @var{format-spec}.
29056
29057 @anchor{-var-set-format}
29058 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
29059
29060 @smallexample
29061 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
29062 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
29063 @end smallexample
29064
29065 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
29066 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
29067 for pointers, etc.).
29068
29069 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
29070 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
29071 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
29072 zero-hexadecimal format.
29073
29074 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
29075 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
29076
29077 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
29078 @findex -var-show-format
29079
29080 @subsubheading Synopsis
29081
29082 @smallexample
29083 -var-show-format @var{name}
29084 @end smallexample
29085
29086 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
29087
29088 @smallexample
29089 @var{format} @expansion{}
29090 @var{format-spec}
29091 @end smallexample
29092
29093
29094 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
29095 @findex -var-info-num-children
29096
29097 @subsubheading Synopsis
29098
29099 @smallexample
29100 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
29101 @end smallexample
29102
29103 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
29104
29105 @smallexample
29106 numchild=@var{n}
29107 @end smallexample
29108
29109 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
29110 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
29111 be available.
29112
29113
29114 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
29115 @findex -var-list-children
29116
29117 @subsubheading Synopsis
29118
29119 @smallexample
29120 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
29121 @end smallexample
29122 @anchor{-var-list-children}
29123
29124 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
29125 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
29126 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
29127 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
29128 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
29129 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
29130 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
29131 and unions.
29132
29133 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
29134 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
29135 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
29136 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
29137 reported.
29138
29139 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
29140 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
29141 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
29142 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
29143 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
29144 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
29145 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
29146 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
29147 the visible items.
29148
29149 For each child the following results are returned:
29150
29151 @table @var
29152
29153 @item name
29154 Name of the variable object created for this child.
29155
29156 @item exp
29157 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
29158 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
29159
29160 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
29161 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
29162
29163 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
29164 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
29165 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
29166 type and value are not present.
29167
29168 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
29169 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
29170 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
29171
29172 @item numchild
29173 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
29174 0.
29175
29176 @item type
29177 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
29178 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29179 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29180 @emph{declared} one.
29181
29182 @item value
29183 If values were requested, this is the value.
29184
29185 @item thread-id
29186 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
29187 Otherwise this result is not present.
29188
29189 @item frozen
29190 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
29191
29192 @item displayhint
29193 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29194 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29195 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29196
29197 @item dynamic
29198 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29199 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29200 then this attribute will not be present.
29201
29202 @end table
29203
29204 The result may have its own attributes:
29205
29206 @table @samp
29207 @item displayhint
29208 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29209 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29210 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29211
29212 @item has_more
29213 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
29214 remaining after the end of the selected range.
29215 @end table
29216
29217 @subsubheading Example
29218
29219 @smallexample
29220 (gdb)
29221 -var-list-children n
29222 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29223 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29224 (gdb)
29225 -var-list-children --all-values n
29226 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29227 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29228 @end smallexample
29229
29230
29231 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
29232 @findex -var-info-type
29233
29234 @subsubheading Synopsis
29235
29236 @smallexample
29237 -var-info-type @var{name}
29238 @end smallexample
29239
29240 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
29241 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
29242 @value{GDBN} CLI:
29243
29244 @smallexample
29245 type=@var{typename}
29246 @end smallexample
29247
29248
29249 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
29250 @findex -var-info-expression
29251
29252 @subsubheading Synopsis
29253
29254 @smallexample
29255 -var-info-expression @var{name}
29256 @end smallexample
29257
29258 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
29259 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
29260 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
29261
29262 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
29263 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
29264
29265 @smallexample
29266 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
29267 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
29268 @end smallexample
29269
29270 @noindent
29271 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
29272 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
29273
29274 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
29275 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
29276 is of limited use.
29277
29278 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
29279 @findex -var-info-path-expression
29280
29281 @subsubheading Synopsis
29282
29283 @smallexample
29284 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
29285 @end smallexample
29286
29287 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
29288 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
29289 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
29290 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
29291 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
29292 watchpoint from a variable object.
29293
29294 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
29295 and will give an error when invoked on one.
29296
29297 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
29298 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
29299 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
29300 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
29301 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
29302 @smallexample
29303 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
29304 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
29305 @end smallexample
29306
29307 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
29308 @findex -var-show-attributes
29309
29310 @subsubheading Synopsis
29311
29312 @smallexample
29313 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
29314 @end smallexample
29315
29316 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
29317
29318 @smallexample
29319 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
29320 @end smallexample
29321
29322 @noindent
29323 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
29324
29325 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
29326 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
29327
29328 @subsubheading Synopsis
29329
29330 @smallexample
29331 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
29332 @end smallexample
29333
29334 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
29335 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
29336 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
29337 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
29338 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
29339 the current display format will be used. The current display format
29340 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
29341
29342 @smallexample
29343 value=@var{value}
29344 @end smallexample
29345
29346 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
29347 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
29348
29349 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
29350 @findex -var-assign
29351
29352 @subsubheading Synopsis
29353
29354 @smallexample
29355 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
29356 @end smallexample
29357
29358 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
29359 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
29360 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
29361 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
29362
29363 @subsubheading Example
29364
29365 @smallexample
29366 (gdb)
29367 -var-assign var1 3
29368 ^done,value="3"
29369 (gdb)
29370 -var-update *
29371 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
29372 (gdb)
29373 @end smallexample
29374
29375 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
29376 @findex -var-update
29377
29378 @subsubheading Synopsis
29379
29380 @smallexample
29381 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
29382 @end smallexample
29383
29384 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
29385 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
29386 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
29387 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
29388 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
29389 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
29390 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
29391 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
29392 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
29393 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
29394 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
29395 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
29396 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
29397
29398 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
29399 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
29400 diagnostic.
29401
29402 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
29403 only the selected range of children will be reported.
29404
29405 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
29406 @samp{changelist}.
29407
29408 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
29409
29410 @table @samp
29411 @item name
29412 The name of the varobj.
29413
29414 @item value
29415 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
29416 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
29417
29418 @item in_scope
29419 @anchor{-var-update}
29420 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
29421
29422 @table @code
29423 @item "true"
29424 The variable object's current value is valid.
29425
29426 @item "false"
29427 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
29428 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
29429 scope.
29430
29431 @item "invalid"
29432 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
29433 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
29434 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
29435 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
29436 objects.
29437 @end table
29438
29439 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
29440 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
29441
29442 @item type_changed
29443 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
29444 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
29445 be @samp{false}.
29446
29447 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
29448 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
29449 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
29450 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
29451 unset.
29452
29453 @item new_type
29454 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
29455 hold the new type.
29456
29457 @item new_num_children
29458 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
29459 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
29460
29461 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
29462 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
29463 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
29464 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
29465 children which may be available.
29466
29467 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
29468 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
29469 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
29470 only happen at the end of the update range).
29471
29472 @item displayhint
29473 The display hint, if any.
29474
29475 @item has_more
29476 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
29477 available outside the varobj's update range.
29478
29479 @item dynamic
29480 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29481 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29482 then this attribute will not be present.
29483
29484 @item new_children
29485 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
29486 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
29487 be listed in this attribute.
29488 @end table
29489
29490 @subsubheading Example
29491
29492 @smallexample
29493 (gdb)
29494 -var-assign var1 3
29495 ^done,value="3"
29496 (gdb)
29497 -var-update --all-values var1
29498 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
29499 type_changed="false"@}]
29500 (gdb)
29501 @end smallexample
29502
29503 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
29504 @findex -var-set-frozen
29505 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
29506
29507 @subsubheading Synopsis
29508
29509 @smallexample
29510 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
29511 @end smallexample
29512
29513 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
29514 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
29515 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
29516 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
29517 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
29518 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
29519 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
29520 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
29521 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
29522 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
29523 @code{-var-update} does.
29524
29525 @subsubheading Example
29526
29527 @smallexample
29528 (gdb)
29529 -var-set-frozen V 1
29530 ^done
29531 (gdb)
29532 @end smallexample
29533
29534 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
29535 @findex -var-set-update-range
29536 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
29537
29538 @subsubheading Synopsis
29539
29540 @smallexample
29541 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
29542 @end smallexample
29543
29544 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
29545 @code{-var-update}.
29546
29547 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
29548 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
29549 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
29550 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
29551
29552 @subsubheading Example
29553
29554 @smallexample
29555 (gdb)
29556 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
29557 ^done
29558 @end smallexample
29559
29560 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
29561 @findex -var-set-visualizer
29562 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
29563
29564 @subsubheading Synopsis
29565
29566 @smallexample
29567 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
29568 @end smallexample
29569
29570 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
29571
29572 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
29573 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
29574
29575 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
29576 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
29577 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
29578 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
29579 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
29580 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
29581 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
29582
29583 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
29584 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
29585 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
29586 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
29587
29588 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
29589 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
29590 can be used to check this.
29591
29592 @subsubheading Example
29593
29594 Resetting the visualizer:
29595
29596 @smallexample
29597 (gdb)
29598 -var-set-visualizer V None
29599 ^done
29600 @end smallexample
29601
29602 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
29603
29604 @smallexample
29605 (gdb)
29606 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
29607 ^done
29608 @end smallexample
29609
29610 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
29611 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
29612
29613 @smallexample
29614 (gdb)
29615 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
29616 ^done
29617 @end smallexample
29618
29619 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29620 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
29621 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
29622
29623 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
29624 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
29625 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
29626 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
29627
29628 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
29629 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
29630
29631 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
29632 @c @subheading -data-assign
29633 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
29634 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
29635 @c set variable
29636 @c @subsubheading Example
29637 @c N.A.
29638
29639 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
29640 @findex -data-disassemble
29641
29642 @subsubheading Synopsis
29643
29644 @smallexample
29645 -data-disassemble
29646 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
29647 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
29648 -- @var{mode}
29649 @end smallexample
29650
29651 @noindent
29652 Where:
29653
29654 @table @samp
29655 @item @var{start-addr}
29656 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
29657 @item @var{end-addr}
29658 is the end address
29659 @item @var{filename}
29660 is the name of the file to disassemble
29661 @item @var{linenum}
29662 is the line number to disassemble around
29663 @item @var{lines}
29664 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
29665 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
29666 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
29667 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
29668 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
29669 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
29670 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
29671 are displayed.
29672 @item @var{mode}
29673 is one of:
29674 @itemize @bullet
29675 @item 0 disassembly only
29676 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
29677 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
29678 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
29679 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
29680 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
29681 @end itemize
29682
29683 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
29684 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
29685 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
29686 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
29687 @end table
29688
29689 @subsubheading Result
29690
29691 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
29692 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
29693 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
29694
29695 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
29696 following fields:
29697
29698 @table @code
29699 @item address
29700 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
29701
29702 @item func-name
29703 The name of the function this instruction is within.
29704
29705 @item offset
29706 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
29707
29708 @item inst
29709 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
29710
29711 @item opcodes
29712 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
29713 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
29714
29715 @end table
29716
29717 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
29718 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
29719
29720 @table @code
29721 @item line
29722 The line number within @samp{file}.
29723
29724 @item file
29725 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
29726 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
29727 used.
29728
29729 @item fullname
29730 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
29731 using the source file search path
29732 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
29733 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
29734
29735 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
29736 present in the debug information.
29737
29738 @item line_asm_insn
29739 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
29740 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
29741 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
29742 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
29743 @samp{opcodes}.
29744
29745 @end table
29746
29747 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
29748 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
29749 adjust its format.
29750
29751 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29752
29753 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
29754
29755 @subsubheading Example
29756
29757 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
29758
29759 @smallexample
29760 (gdb)
29761 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
29762 ^done,
29763 asm_insns=[
29764 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29765 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29766 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29767 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29768 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
29769 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
29770 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
29771 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29772 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
29773 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
29774 (gdb)
29775 @end smallexample
29776
29777 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
29778 @code{main}.
29779
29780 @smallexample
29781 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
29782 ^done,asm_insns=[
29783 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29784 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29785 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29786 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29787 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29788 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29789 [@dots{}]
29790 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
29791 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
29792 (gdb)
29793 @end smallexample
29794
29795 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
29796
29797 @smallexample
29798 (gdb)
29799 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
29800 ^done,asm_insns=[
29801 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29802 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29803 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29804 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29805 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29806 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
29807 (gdb)
29808 @end smallexample
29809
29810 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
29811
29812 @smallexample
29813 (gdb)
29814 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
29815 ^done,asm_insns=[
29816 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
29817 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29818 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29819 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
29820 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
29821 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
29822 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29823 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29824 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
29825 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29826 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29827 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
29828 (gdb)
29829 @end smallexample
29830
29831
29832 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
29833 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
29834
29835 @subsubheading Synopsis
29836
29837 @smallexample
29838 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
29839 @end smallexample
29840
29841 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
29842 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
29843 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
29844
29845 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29846
29847 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
29848 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
29849 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
29850
29851 @subsubheading Example
29852
29853 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
29854 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
29855 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
29856 output.
29857
29858 @smallexample
29859 211-data-evaluate-expression A
29860 211^done,value="1"
29861 (gdb)
29862 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
29863 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
29864 (gdb)
29865 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
29866 411^done,value="4"
29867 (gdb)
29868 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
29869 511^done,value="4"
29870 (gdb)
29871 @end smallexample
29872
29873
29874 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
29875 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
29876
29877 @subsubheading Synopsis
29878
29879 @smallexample
29880 -data-list-changed-registers
29881 @end smallexample
29882
29883 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
29884
29885 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29886
29887 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
29888 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
29889
29890 @subsubheading Example
29891
29892 On a PPC MBX board:
29893
29894 @smallexample
29895 (gdb)
29896 -exec-continue
29897 ^running
29898
29899 (gdb)
29900 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
29901 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
29902 line="5"@}
29903 (gdb)
29904 -data-list-changed-registers
29905 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
29906 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
29907 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
29908 (gdb)
29909 @end smallexample
29910
29911
29912 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
29913 @findex -data-list-register-names
29914
29915 @subsubheading Synopsis
29916
29917 @smallexample
29918 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
29919 @end smallexample
29920
29921 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
29922 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
29923 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
29924 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
29925 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
29926 include empty register names.
29927
29928 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29929
29930 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
29931 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
29932 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
29933
29934 @subsubheading Example
29935
29936 For the PPC MBX board:
29937 @smallexample
29938 (gdb)
29939 -data-list-register-names
29940 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
29941 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
29942 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
29943 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
29944 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
29945 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
29946 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
29947 (gdb)
29948 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
29949 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
29950 (gdb)
29951 @end smallexample
29952
29953 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
29954 @findex -data-list-register-values
29955
29956 @subsubheading Synopsis
29957
29958 @smallexample
29959 -data-list-register-values
29960 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
29961 @end smallexample
29962
29963 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
29964 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
29965 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
29966 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
29967 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
29968 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
29969
29970 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
29971
29972 @table @code
29973 @item x
29974 Hexadecimal
29975 @item o
29976 Octal
29977 @item t
29978 Binary
29979 @item d
29980 Decimal
29981 @item r
29982 Raw
29983 @item N
29984 Natural
29985 @end table
29986
29987 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29988
29989 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
29990 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
29991
29992 @subsubheading Example
29993
29994 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
29995 don't appear in the actual output):
29996
29997 @smallexample
29998 (gdb)
29999 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
30000 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30001 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
30002 (gdb)
30003 -data-list-register-values x
30004 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
30005 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30006 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
30007 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
30008 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
30009 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
30010 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
30011 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
30012 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
30013 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
30014 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
30015 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
30016 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
30017 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
30018 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
30019 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
30020 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
30021 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
30022 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
30023 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
30024 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
30025 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
30026 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
30027 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
30028 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
30029 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
30030 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
30031 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
30032 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
30033 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
30034 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
30035 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
30036 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
30037 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
30038 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
30039 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
30040 (gdb)
30041 @end smallexample
30042
30043
30044 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
30045 @findex -data-read-memory
30046
30047 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
30048
30049 @subsubheading Synopsis
30050
30051 @smallexample
30052 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
30053 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
30054 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
30055 @end smallexample
30056
30057 @noindent
30058 where:
30059
30060 @table @samp
30061 @item @var{address}
30062 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30063 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30064 quoted using the C convention.
30065
30066 @item @var{word-format}
30067 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
30068 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
30069 ,Output Formats}).
30070
30071 @item @var{word-size}
30072 The size of each memory word in bytes.
30073
30074 @item @var{nr-rows}
30075 The number of rows in the output table.
30076
30077 @item @var{nr-cols}
30078 The number of columns in the output table.
30079
30080 @item @var{aschar}
30081 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
30082 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
30083 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
30084 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
30085
30086 @item @var{byte-offset}
30087 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
30088 @end table
30089
30090 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
30091 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
30092 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
30093 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
30094 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
30095 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
30096 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
30097 @samp{addr}.
30098
30099 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
30100 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
30101 @samp{prev-page}.
30102
30103 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30104
30105 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
30106 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
30107
30108 @subsubheading Example
30109
30110 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
30111 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
30112 word. Display each word in hex.
30113
30114 @smallexample
30115 (gdb)
30116 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
30117 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
30118 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
30119 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
30120 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
30121 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
30122 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
30123 (gdb)
30124 @end smallexample
30125
30126 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
30127 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
30128
30129 @smallexample
30130 (gdb)
30131 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
30132 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
30133 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
30134 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
30135 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
30136 (gdb)
30137 @end smallexample
30138
30139 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
30140 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
30141 used as the non-printable character.
30142
30143 @smallexample
30144 (gdb)
30145 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
30146 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
30147 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
30148 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
30149 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30150 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30151 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30152 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
30153 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
30154 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
30155 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
30156 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
30157 (gdb)
30158 @end smallexample
30159
30160 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
30161 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
30162
30163 @subsubheading Synopsis
30164
30165 @smallexample
30166 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
30167 @var{address} @var{count}
30168 @end smallexample
30169
30170 @noindent
30171 where:
30172
30173 @table @samp
30174 @item @var{address}
30175 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30176 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30177 quoted using the C convention.
30178
30179 @item @var{count}
30180 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
30181 literal.
30182
30183 @item @var{offset}
30184 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
30185 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
30186 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
30187 arithmetics itself.
30188
30189 @end table
30190
30191 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
30192 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
30193 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
30194 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
30195 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
30196 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
30197
30198 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
30199 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
30200 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
30201 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
30202 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
30203 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
30204 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
30205 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
30206
30207 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
30208 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
30209 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
30210 and has the following fields:
30211
30212 @table @code
30213 @item begin
30214 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30215
30216 @item end
30217 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30218
30219 @item offset
30220 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
30221 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
30222
30223 @item contents
30224 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
30225
30226 @end table
30227
30228
30229
30230 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30231
30232 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
30233
30234 @subsubheading Example
30235
30236 @smallexample
30237 (gdb)
30238 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
30239 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
30240 end="0xbffff15e",
30241 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
30242 (gdb)
30243 @end smallexample
30244
30245
30246 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
30247 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
30248
30249 @subsubheading Synopsis
30250
30251 @smallexample
30252 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
30253 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
30254 @end smallexample
30255
30256 @noindent
30257 where:
30258
30259 @table @samp
30260 @item @var{address}
30261 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
30262 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
30263 be quoted using the C convention.
30264
30265 @item @var{contents}
30266 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
30267 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
30268
30269 @item @var{count}
30270 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
30271 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
30272 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
30273 @var{count} memory units.
30274
30275 @end table
30276
30277 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30278
30279 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30280
30281 @subsubheading Example
30282
30283 @smallexample
30284 (gdb)
30285 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
30286 ^done
30287 (gdb)
30288 @end smallexample
30289
30290 @smallexample
30291 (gdb)
30292 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
30293 ^done
30294 (gdb)
30295 @end smallexample
30296
30297 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30298 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
30299 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
30300
30301 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
30302 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
30303
30304 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
30305 @findex -trace-find
30306
30307 @subsubheading Synopsis
30308
30309 @smallexample
30310 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
30311 @end smallexample
30312
30313 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
30314 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
30315 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
30316
30317 @table @samp
30318
30319 @item none
30320 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
30321
30322 @item frame-number
30323 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
30324 that index.
30325
30326 @item tracepoint-number
30327 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
30328 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
30329
30330 @item pc
30331 An address is required as parameter. Finds
30332 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
30333 address.
30334
30335 @item pc-inside-range
30336 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
30337 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
30338 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30339
30340 @item pc-outside-range
30341 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
30342 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
30343 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30344
30345 @item line
30346 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
30347 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
30348 the specified location.
30349
30350 @end table
30351
30352 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
30353 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
30354
30355 @table @samp
30356 @item found
30357 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
30358 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
30359
30360 @item traceframe
30361 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
30362 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30363
30364 @item tracepoint
30365 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
30366 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30367
30368 @item frame
30369 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
30370 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
30371 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
30372
30373 @end table
30374
30375 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30376
30377 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
30378
30379 @subheading -trace-define-variable
30380 @findex -trace-define-variable
30381
30382 @subsubheading Synopsis
30383
30384 @smallexample
30385 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
30386 @end smallexample
30387
30388 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
30389 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
30390 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
30391 with the @samp{$} character.
30392
30393 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30394
30395 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
30396
30397 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
30398 @findex -trace-frame-collected
30399
30400 @subsubheading Synopsis
30401
30402 @smallexample
30403 -trace-frame-collected
30404 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
30405 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
30406 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
30407 [--memory-contents]
30408 @end smallexample
30409
30410 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
30411 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
30412 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
30413 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
30414 See the output description table below for more details.
30415
30416 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
30417 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
30418 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
30419 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
30420 memory range and which is a computed expression.
30421
30422 For instance, if the actions were
30423 @smallexample
30424 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
30425 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
30426 @end smallexample
30427
30428 @noindent
30429 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
30430 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
30431 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
30432 objects would be computed expressions.
30433
30434 An example output would be:
30435
30436 @smallexample
30437 (gdb)
30438 -trace-frame-collected
30439 ^done,
30440 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
30441 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
30442 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
30443 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
30444 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
30445 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
30446 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
30447 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
30448 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
30449 ...
30450 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
30451 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
30452 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
30453 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
30454 (gdb)
30455 @end smallexample
30456
30457 Where:
30458
30459 @table @code
30460 @item explicit-variables
30461 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
30462 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
30463 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
30464 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
30465 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
30466 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
30467 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
30468 arrays, structures and unions.
30469
30470 @item computed-expressions
30471 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
30472 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
30473 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
30474 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
30475
30476 @item registers
30477 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
30478 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
30479 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
30480 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
30481 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
30482
30483 @item tvars
30484 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
30485 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
30486 current value are returned.
30487
30488 @item memory
30489 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
30490 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
30491 collected memory range and has the following fields:
30492
30493 @table @code
30494 @item address
30495 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
30496
30497 @item length
30498 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
30499
30500 @item contents
30501 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
30502 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
30503
30504 @end table
30505
30506 @end table
30507
30508 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30509
30510 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30511
30512 @subsubheading Example
30513
30514 @subheading -trace-list-variables
30515 @findex -trace-list-variables
30516
30517 @subsubheading Synopsis
30518
30519 @smallexample
30520 -trace-list-variables
30521 @end smallexample
30522
30523 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
30524 table has the following fields:
30525
30526 @table @samp
30527 @item name
30528 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
30529
30530 @item initial
30531 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
30532 field is always present.
30533
30534 @item current
30535 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
30536 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
30537 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
30538 presently running.
30539
30540 @end table
30541
30542 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30543
30544 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
30545
30546 @subsubheading Example
30547
30548 @smallexample
30549 (gdb)
30550 -trace-list-variables
30551 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
30552 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30553 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
30554 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
30555 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
30556 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
30557 (gdb)
30558 @end smallexample
30559
30560 @subheading -trace-save
30561 @findex -trace-save
30562
30563 @subsubheading Synopsis
30564
30565 @smallexample
30566 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
30567 @end smallexample
30568
30569 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
30570 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
30571 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
30572 to perform the save.
30573
30574 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30575
30576 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
30577
30578
30579 @subheading -trace-start
30580 @findex -trace-start
30581
30582 @subsubheading Synopsis
30583
30584 @smallexample
30585 -trace-start
30586 @end smallexample
30587
30588 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
30589 have any fields.
30590
30591 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30592
30593 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
30594
30595 @subheading -trace-status
30596 @findex -trace-status
30597
30598 @subsubheading Synopsis
30599
30600 @smallexample
30601 -trace-status
30602 @end smallexample
30603
30604 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
30605 the following fields:
30606
30607 @table @samp
30608
30609 @item supported
30610 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
30611 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
30612 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
30613 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
30614 started. This field is always present.
30615
30616 @item running
30617 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
30618 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
30619 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30620
30621 @item stop-reason
30622 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
30623 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
30624 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
30625 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
30626 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
30627 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
30628 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
30629 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
30630 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30631
30632 @item stopping-tracepoint
30633 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
30634 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
30635 @samp{passcount}.
30636
30637 @item frames
30638 @itemx frames-created
30639 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
30640 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
30641 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
30642 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
30643
30644 @item buffer-size
30645 @itemx buffer-free
30646 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
30647 remaining space. These fields are optional.
30648
30649 @item circular
30650 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
30651 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
30652 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
30653 and may fill up.
30654
30655 @item disconnected
30656 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
30657 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
30658 that the trace run will stop.
30659
30660 @item trace-file
30661 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
30662 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
30663
30664 @end table
30665
30666 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30667
30668 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
30669
30670 @subheading -trace-stop
30671 @findex -trace-stop
30672
30673 @subsubheading Synopsis
30674
30675 @smallexample
30676 -trace-stop
30677 @end smallexample
30678
30679 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
30680 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
30681 @samp{running} fields are not output.
30682
30683 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30684
30685 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
30686
30687
30688 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30689 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
30690 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
30691
30692
30693 @ignore
30694 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
30695 @findex -symbol-info-address
30696
30697 @subsubheading Synopsis
30698
30699 @smallexample
30700 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
30701 @end smallexample
30702
30703 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
30704
30705 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30706
30707 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
30708
30709 @subsubheading Example
30710 N.A.
30711
30712
30713 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
30714 @findex -symbol-info-file
30715
30716 @subsubheading Synopsis
30717
30718 @smallexample
30719 -symbol-info-file
30720 @end smallexample
30721
30722 Show the file for the symbol.
30723
30724 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30725
30726 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
30727 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
30728
30729 @subsubheading Example
30730 N.A.
30731
30732
30733 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
30734 @findex -symbol-info-function
30735
30736 @subsubheading Synopsis
30737
30738 @smallexample
30739 -symbol-info-function
30740 @end smallexample
30741
30742 Show which function the symbol lives in.
30743
30744 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30745
30746 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
30747
30748 @subsubheading Example
30749 N.A.
30750
30751
30752 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
30753 @findex -symbol-info-line
30754
30755 @subsubheading Synopsis
30756
30757 @smallexample
30758 -symbol-info-line
30759 @end smallexample
30760
30761 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
30762
30763 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30764
30765 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
30766 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
30767
30768 @subsubheading Example
30769 N.A.
30770
30771
30772 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
30773 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
30774
30775 @subsubheading Synopsis
30776
30777 @smallexample
30778 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
30779 @end smallexample
30780
30781 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
30782
30783 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30784
30785 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
30786
30787 @subsubheading Example
30788 N.A.
30789
30790
30791 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
30792 @findex -symbol-list-functions
30793
30794 @subsubheading Synopsis
30795
30796 @smallexample
30797 -symbol-list-functions
30798 @end smallexample
30799
30800 List the functions in the executable.
30801
30802 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30803
30804 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
30805 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30806
30807 @subsubheading Example
30808 N.A.
30809 @end ignore
30810
30811
30812 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
30813 @findex -symbol-list-lines
30814
30815 @subsubheading Synopsis
30816
30817 @smallexample
30818 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
30819 @end smallexample
30820
30821 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
30822 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
30823 ascending PC order.
30824
30825 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30826
30827 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30828
30829 @subsubheading Example
30830 @smallexample
30831 (gdb)
30832 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
30833 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
30834 (gdb)
30835 @end smallexample
30836
30837
30838 @ignore
30839 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
30840 @findex -symbol-list-types
30841
30842 @subsubheading Synopsis
30843
30844 @smallexample
30845 -symbol-list-types
30846 @end smallexample
30847
30848 List all the type names.
30849
30850 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30851
30852 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
30853 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30854
30855 @subsubheading Example
30856 N.A.
30857
30858
30859 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
30860 @findex -symbol-list-variables
30861
30862 @subsubheading Synopsis
30863
30864 @smallexample
30865 -symbol-list-variables
30866 @end smallexample
30867
30868 List all the global and static variable names.
30869
30870 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30871
30872 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30873
30874 @subsubheading Example
30875 N.A.
30876
30877
30878 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
30879 @findex -symbol-locate
30880
30881 @subsubheading Synopsis
30882
30883 @smallexample
30884 -symbol-locate
30885 @end smallexample
30886
30887 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30888
30889 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
30890
30891 @subsubheading Example
30892 N.A.
30893
30894
30895 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
30896 @findex -symbol-type
30897
30898 @subsubheading Synopsis
30899
30900 @smallexample
30901 -symbol-type @var{variable}
30902 @end smallexample
30903
30904 Show type of @var{variable}.
30905
30906 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30907
30908 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
30909 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
30910
30911 @subsubheading Example
30912 N.A.
30913 @end ignore
30914
30915
30916 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30917 @node GDB/MI File Commands
30918 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
30919
30920 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
30921 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
30922
30923 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
30924 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
30925
30926 @subsubheading Synopsis
30927
30928 @smallexample
30929 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
30930 @end smallexample
30931
30932 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
30933 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
30934 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
30935 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
30936 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
30937 notification.
30938
30939 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30940
30941 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
30942
30943 @subsubheading Example
30944
30945 @smallexample
30946 (gdb)
30947 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30948 ^done
30949 (gdb)
30950 @end smallexample
30951
30952
30953 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
30954 @findex -file-exec-file
30955
30956 @subsubheading Synopsis
30957
30958 @smallexample
30959 -file-exec-file @var{file}
30960 @end smallexample
30961
30962 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
30963 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
30964 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
30965 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
30966 notification.
30967
30968 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30969
30970 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
30971
30972 @subsubheading Example
30973
30974 @smallexample
30975 (gdb)
30976 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30977 ^done
30978 (gdb)
30979 @end smallexample
30980
30981
30982 @ignore
30983 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
30984 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
30985
30986 @subsubheading Synopsis
30987
30988 @smallexample
30989 -file-list-exec-sections
30990 @end smallexample
30991
30992 List the sections of the current executable file.
30993
30994 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30995
30996 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
30997 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
30998 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
30999
31000 @subsubheading Example
31001 N.A.
31002 @end ignore
31003
31004
31005 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
31006 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
31007
31008 @subsubheading Synopsis
31009
31010 @smallexample
31011 -file-list-exec-source-file
31012 @end smallexample
31013
31014 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
31015 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
31016 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
31017 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
31018
31019 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31020
31021 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
31022
31023 @subsubheading Example
31024
31025 @smallexample
31026 (gdb)
31027 123-file-list-exec-source-file
31028 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
31029 (gdb)
31030 @end smallexample
31031
31032
31033 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
31034 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
31035
31036 @subsubheading Synopsis
31037
31038 @smallexample
31039 -file-list-exec-source-files
31040 @end smallexample
31041
31042 List the source files for the current executable.
31043
31044 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
31045 name) of a source file.
31046
31047 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31048
31049 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
31050 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
31051
31052 @subsubheading Example
31053 @smallexample
31054 (gdb)
31055 -file-list-exec-source-files
31056 ^done,files=[
31057 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
31058 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
31059 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
31060 (gdb)
31061 @end smallexample
31062
31063 @ignore
31064 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
31065 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
31066
31067 @subsubheading Synopsis
31068
31069 @smallexample
31070 -file-list-shared-libraries
31071 @end smallexample
31072
31073 List the shared libraries in the program.
31074
31075 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31076
31077 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
31078
31079 @subsubheading Example
31080 N.A.
31081
31082
31083 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
31084 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
31085
31086 @subsubheading Synopsis
31087
31088 @smallexample
31089 -file-list-symbol-files
31090 @end smallexample
31091
31092 List symbol files.
31093
31094 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31095
31096 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
31097
31098 @subsubheading Example
31099 N.A.
31100 @end ignore
31101
31102
31103 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
31104 @findex -file-symbol-file
31105
31106 @subsubheading Synopsis
31107
31108 @smallexample
31109 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
31110 @end smallexample
31111
31112 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
31113 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
31114 produced, except for a completion notification.
31115
31116 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31117
31118 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
31119
31120 @subsubheading Example
31121
31122 @smallexample
31123 (gdb)
31124 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
31125 ^done
31126 (gdb)
31127 @end smallexample
31128
31129 @ignore
31130 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31131 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
31132 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
31133
31134 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
31135
31136 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
31137
31138 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
31139
31140 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
31141
31142 @c @subheading -overlay-map
31143
31144 @c @subheading -overlay-off
31145
31146 @c @subheading -overlay-on
31147
31148 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
31149
31150 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31151 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
31152 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
31153
31154 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
31155
31156 @c @subheading -signal-handle
31157
31158 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
31159
31160 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
31161 @end ignore
31162
31163
31164 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31165 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
31166 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
31167
31168
31169 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
31170 @findex -target-attach
31171
31172 @subsubheading Synopsis
31173
31174 @smallexample
31175 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
31176 @end smallexample
31177
31178 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
31179 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
31180 group, the id previously returned by
31181 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
31182
31183 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31184
31185 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
31186
31187 @subsubheading Example
31188 @smallexample
31189 (gdb)
31190 -target-attach 34
31191 =thread-created,id="1"
31192 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
31193 ^done
31194 (gdb)
31195 @end smallexample
31196
31197 @ignore
31198 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
31199 @findex -target-compare-sections
31200
31201 @subsubheading Synopsis
31202
31203 @smallexample
31204 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
31205 @end smallexample
31206
31207 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
31208 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
31209
31210 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31211
31212 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
31213
31214 @subsubheading Example
31215 N.A.
31216 @end ignore
31217
31218
31219 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
31220 @findex -target-detach
31221
31222 @subsubheading Synopsis
31223
31224 @smallexample
31225 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
31226 @end smallexample
31227
31228 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
31229 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
31230 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
31231
31232 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31233
31234 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
31235
31236 @subsubheading Example
31237
31238 @smallexample
31239 (gdb)
31240 -target-detach
31241 ^done
31242 (gdb)
31243 @end smallexample
31244
31245
31246 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
31247 @findex -target-disconnect
31248
31249 @subsubheading Synopsis
31250
31251 @smallexample
31252 -target-disconnect
31253 @end smallexample
31254
31255 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
31256 generally not resumed.
31257
31258 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31259
31260 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
31261
31262 @subsubheading Example
31263
31264 @smallexample
31265 (gdb)
31266 -target-disconnect
31267 ^done
31268 (gdb)
31269 @end smallexample
31270
31271
31272 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
31273 @findex -target-download
31274
31275 @subsubheading Synopsis
31276
31277 @smallexample
31278 -target-download
31279 @end smallexample
31280
31281 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
31282 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
31283
31284 @table @samp
31285 @item section
31286 The name of the section.
31287 @item section-sent
31288 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
31289 @item section-size
31290 The size of the section.
31291 @item total-sent
31292 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
31293 @item total-size
31294 The size of the overall executable to download.
31295 @end table
31296
31297 @noindent
31298 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
31299 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
31300
31301 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
31302 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
31303
31304 @table @samp
31305 @item section
31306 The name of the section.
31307 @item section-size
31308 The size of the section.
31309 @item total-size
31310 The size of the overall executable to download.
31311 @end table
31312
31313 @noindent
31314 At the end, a summary is printed.
31315
31316 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31317
31318 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
31319
31320 @subsubheading Example
31321
31322 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
31323 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
31324
31325 @smallexample
31326 (gdb)
31327 -target-download
31328 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
31329 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
31330 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
31331 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
31332 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
31333 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
31334 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
31335 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
31336 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
31337 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
31338 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
31339 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
31340 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
31341 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
31342 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
31343 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
31344 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
31345 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
31346 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
31347 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
31348 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
31349 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
31350 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
31351 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
31352 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
31353 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
31354 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
31355 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31356 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31357 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
31358 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
31359 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
31360 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
31361 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
31362 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
31363 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
31364 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
31365 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
31366 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
31367 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
31368 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
31369 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
31370 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
31371 write-rate="429"
31372 (gdb)
31373 @end smallexample
31374
31375
31376 @ignore
31377 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
31378 @findex -target-exec-status
31379
31380 @subsubheading Synopsis
31381
31382 @smallexample
31383 -target-exec-status
31384 @end smallexample
31385
31386 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
31387 not, for instance).
31388
31389 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31390
31391 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31392
31393 @subsubheading Example
31394 N.A.
31395
31396
31397 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
31398 @findex -target-list-available-targets
31399
31400 @subsubheading Synopsis
31401
31402 @smallexample
31403 -target-list-available-targets
31404 @end smallexample
31405
31406 List the possible targets to connect to.
31407
31408 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31409
31410 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
31411
31412 @subsubheading Example
31413 N.A.
31414
31415
31416 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
31417 @findex -target-list-current-targets
31418
31419 @subsubheading Synopsis
31420
31421 @smallexample
31422 -target-list-current-targets
31423 @end smallexample
31424
31425 Describe the current target.
31426
31427 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31428
31429 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
31430 other things).
31431
31432 @subsubheading Example
31433 N.A.
31434
31435
31436 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
31437 @findex -target-list-parameters
31438
31439 @subsubheading Synopsis
31440
31441 @smallexample
31442 -target-list-parameters
31443 @end smallexample
31444
31445 @c ????
31446 @end ignore
31447
31448 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31449
31450 No equivalent.
31451
31452 @subsubheading Example
31453 N.A.
31454
31455
31456 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
31457 @findex -target-select
31458
31459 @subsubheading Synopsis
31460
31461 @smallexample
31462 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
31463 @end smallexample
31464
31465 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
31466
31467 @table @samp
31468 @item @var{type}
31469 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
31470 @item @var{parameters}
31471 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
31472 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
31473 @end table
31474
31475 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
31476 which the target program is, in the following form:
31477
31478 @smallexample
31479 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
31480 args=[@var{arg list}]
31481 @end smallexample
31482
31483 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31484
31485 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
31486
31487 @subsubheading Example
31488
31489 @smallexample
31490 (gdb)
31491 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
31492 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
31493 (gdb)
31494 @end smallexample
31495
31496 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31497 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
31498 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
31499
31500
31501 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
31502 @findex -target-file-put
31503
31504 @subsubheading Synopsis
31505
31506 @smallexample
31507 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
31508 @end smallexample
31509
31510 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
31511 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
31512
31513 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31514
31515 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
31516
31517 @subsubheading Example
31518
31519 @smallexample
31520 (gdb)
31521 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
31522 ^done
31523 (gdb)
31524 @end smallexample
31525
31526
31527 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
31528 @findex -target-file-get
31529
31530 @subsubheading Synopsis
31531
31532 @smallexample
31533 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
31534 @end smallexample
31535
31536 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
31537 on the host system.
31538
31539 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31540
31541 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
31542
31543 @subsubheading Example
31544
31545 @smallexample
31546 (gdb)
31547 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
31548 ^done
31549 (gdb)
31550 @end smallexample
31551
31552
31553 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
31554 @findex -target-file-delete
31555
31556 @subsubheading Synopsis
31557
31558 @smallexample
31559 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
31560 @end smallexample
31561
31562 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
31563
31564 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31565
31566 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
31567
31568 @subsubheading Example
31569
31570 @smallexample
31571 (gdb)
31572 -target-file-delete remotefile
31573 ^done
31574 (gdb)
31575 @end smallexample
31576
31577
31578 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31579 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
31580 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31581
31582 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
31583 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
31584
31585 @subsubheading Synopsis
31586
31587 @smallexample
31588 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
31589 @end smallexample
31590
31591 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
31592 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
31593 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31594
31595 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31596
31597 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
31598
31599 @subsubheading Result
31600
31601 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
31602 defined for each exception:
31603
31604 @table @samp
31605 @item name
31606 The name of the exception.
31607
31608 @item address
31609 The address of the exception.
31610
31611 @end table
31612
31613 @subsubheading Example
31614
31615 @smallexample
31616 -info-ada-exceptions aint
31617 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
31618 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31619 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
31620 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
31621 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
31622 @end smallexample
31623
31624 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
31625
31626 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
31627 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
31628 Catchpoint Commands}.
31629
31630
31631 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31632 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
31633 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
31634
31635 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
31636 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
31637 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
31638 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
31639
31640 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
31641 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
31642 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
31643
31644 @subsubheading Synopsis
31645
31646 @smallexample
31647 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
31648 @end smallexample
31649
31650 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
31651
31652 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
31653 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
31654 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
31655 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
31656 dash.
31657
31658 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31659
31660 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31661
31662 @subsubheading Result
31663
31664 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
31665
31666 @table @samp
31667 @item exists
31668 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
31669 @code{"false"} otherwise.
31670
31671 @end table
31672
31673 @subsubheading Example
31674
31675 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
31676
31677 @smallexample
31678 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
31679 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
31680 @end smallexample
31681
31682 @noindent
31683 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
31684 to the debugger:
31685
31686 @smallexample
31687 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
31688 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
31689 @end smallexample
31690
31691 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
31692 @findex -list-features
31693 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
31694
31695 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
31696 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
31697 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
31698 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
31699 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
31700 startup.
31701
31702 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
31703 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
31704 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
31705 is given below.
31706
31707 Example output:
31708
31709 @smallexample
31710 (gdb) -list-features
31711 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
31712 @end smallexample
31713
31714 The current list of features is:
31715
31716 @ftable @samp
31717 @item frozen-varobjs
31718 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
31719 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
31720 of @code{-varobj-create}.
31721 @item pending-breakpoints
31722 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
31723 command.
31724 @item python
31725 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
31726 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
31727 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
31728 @item thread-info
31729 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
31730 @item data-read-memory-bytes
31731 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
31732 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
31733 @item breakpoint-notifications
31734 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
31735 CLI will be announced via async records.
31736 @item ada-task-info
31737 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
31738 @item language-option
31739 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
31740 option (@pxref{Context management}).
31741 @item info-gdb-mi-command
31742 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
31743 @item undefined-command-error-code
31744 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
31745 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
31746 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
31747 @item exec-run-start-option
31748 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
31749 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
31750 @end ftable
31751
31752 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
31753 @findex -list-target-features
31754
31755 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
31756 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
31757 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
31758 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
31759 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
31760 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
31761 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
31762 Example output:
31763
31764 @smallexample
31765 (gdb) -list-target-features
31766 ^done,result=["async"]
31767 @end smallexample
31768
31769 The current list of features is:
31770
31771 @table @samp
31772 @item async
31773 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
31774 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
31775 while the target is running.
31776
31777 @item reverse
31778 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
31779 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
31780
31781 @end table
31782
31783 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31784 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
31785 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31786
31787 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
31788
31789 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
31790 @findex -gdb-exit
31791
31792 @subsubheading Synopsis
31793
31794 @smallexample
31795 -gdb-exit
31796 @end smallexample
31797
31798 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
31799
31800 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31801
31802 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
31803
31804 @subsubheading Example
31805
31806 @smallexample
31807 (gdb)
31808 -gdb-exit
31809 ^exit
31810 @end smallexample
31811
31812
31813 @ignore
31814 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
31815 @findex -exec-abort
31816
31817 @subsubheading Synopsis
31818
31819 @smallexample
31820 -exec-abort
31821 @end smallexample
31822
31823 Kill the inferior running program.
31824
31825 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31826
31827 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
31828
31829 @subsubheading Example
31830 N.A.
31831 @end ignore
31832
31833
31834 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
31835 @findex -gdb-set
31836
31837 @subsubheading Synopsis
31838
31839 @smallexample
31840 -gdb-set
31841 @end smallexample
31842
31843 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
31844 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
31845
31846 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31847
31848 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
31849
31850 @subsubheading Example
31851
31852 @smallexample
31853 (gdb)
31854 -gdb-set $foo=3
31855 ^done
31856 (gdb)
31857 @end smallexample
31858
31859
31860 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
31861 @findex -gdb-show
31862
31863 @subsubheading Synopsis
31864
31865 @smallexample
31866 -gdb-show
31867 @end smallexample
31868
31869 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
31870
31871 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31872
31873 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
31874
31875 @subsubheading Example
31876
31877 @smallexample
31878 (gdb)
31879 -gdb-show annotate
31880 ^done,value="0"
31881 (gdb)
31882 @end smallexample
31883
31884 @c @subheading -gdb-source
31885
31886
31887 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
31888 @findex -gdb-version
31889
31890 @subsubheading Synopsis
31891
31892 @smallexample
31893 -gdb-version
31894 @end smallexample
31895
31896 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
31897
31898 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31899
31900 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
31901 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
31902
31903 @subsubheading Example
31904
31905 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
31906 @c box in TeX.
31907 @smallexample
31908 (gdb)
31909 -gdb-version
31910 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
31911 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31912 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
31913 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
31914 ~ certain conditions.
31915 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31916 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
31917 ~ details.
31918 ~This GDB was configured as
31919 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
31920 ^done
31921 (gdb)
31922 @end smallexample
31923
31924 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
31925 @findex -list-thread-groups
31926
31927 @subheading Synopsis
31928
31929 @smallexample
31930 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
31931 @end smallexample
31932
31933 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
31934 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
31935 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
31936 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
31937 top-level thread groups.
31938
31939 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
31940 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
31941 available on the target.
31942
31943 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
31944 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
31945 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
31946 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
31947 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
31948 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
31949 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
31950 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
31951
31952 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
31953 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
31954 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
31955 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
31956 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
31957 @samp{threads} field.
31958
31959 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
31960 the following caveats:
31961
31962 @itemize @bullet
31963 @item
31964 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
31965 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
31966 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
31967
31968 @item
31969 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
31970 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
31971 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
31972 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
31973 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
31974 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
31975
31976 @end itemize
31977
31978 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
31979 have the following fields:
31980
31981 @table @code
31982 @item id
31983 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
31984 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
31985 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
31986
31987 @item type
31988 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
31989 valid type.
31990
31991 @item pid
31992 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
31993 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
31994
31995 @item exit-code
31996 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
31997 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
31998 only if the process is not running.
31999
32000 @item num_children
32001 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
32002 absent for an available thread group.
32003
32004 @item threads
32005 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
32006 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
32007 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
32008
32009 @item cores
32010 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
32011 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
32012 such information is not available.
32013
32014 @item executable
32015 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
32016 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
32017 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
32018
32019 @end table
32020
32021 @subheading Example
32022
32023 @smallexample
32024 @value{GDBP}
32025 -list-thread-groups
32026 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
32027 -list-thread-groups 17
32028 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
32029 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
32030 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
32031 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
32032 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
32033 -list-thread-groups --available
32034 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
32035 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
32036 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32037 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32038 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
32039 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
32040 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
32041 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
32042 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
32043 @end smallexample
32044
32045 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
32046 @findex -info-os
32047
32048 @subsubheading Synopsis
32049
32050 @smallexample
32051 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
32052 @end smallexample
32053
32054 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
32055 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
32056 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
32057 of data of that type.
32058
32059 The types of information available depend on the target operating
32060 system.
32061
32062 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32063
32064 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
32065
32066 @subsubheading Example
32067
32068 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
32069 like this:
32070
32071 @smallexample
32072 @value{GDBP}
32073 -info-os
32074 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
32075 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
32076 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
32077 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
32078 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
32079 col2="CPUs"@},
32080 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
32081 col2="File descriptors"@},
32082 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
32083 col2="Kernel modules"@},
32084 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
32085 col2="Message queues"@},
32086 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
32087 col2="Processes"@},
32088 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
32089 col2="Process groups"@},
32090 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
32091 col2="Semaphores"@},
32092 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
32093 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
32094 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
32095 col2="Sockets"@},
32096 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
32097 col2="Threads"@}]
32098 @value{GDBP}
32099 -info-os processes
32100 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
32101 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
32102 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
32103 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
32104 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
32105 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
32106 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
32107 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
32108 ...
32109 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
32110 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
32111 (gdb)
32112 @end smallexample
32113
32114 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
32115 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
32116 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
32117 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
32118 @code{info os} omits it.)
32119
32120 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
32121 @findex -add-inferior
32122
32123 @subheading Synopsis
32124
32125 @smallexample
32126 -add-inferior
32127 @end smallexample
32128
32129 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
32130 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
32131 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
32132 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
32133 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
32134 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
32135
32136 @subheading Example
32137
32138 @smallexample
32139 @value{GDBP}
32140 -add-inferior
32141 ^done,inferior="i3"
32142 @end smallexample
32143
32144 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
32145 @findex -interpreter-exec
32146
32147 @subheading Synopsis
32148
32149 @smallexample
32150 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
32151 @end smallexample
32152 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
32153
32154 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
32155
32156 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32157
32158 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
32159
32160 @subheading Example
32161
32162 @smallexample
32163 (gdb)
32164 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
32165 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
32166 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
32167 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
32168 ^done
32169 (gdb)
32170 @end smallexample
32171
32172 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
32173 @findex -inferior-tty-set
32174
32175 @subheading Synopsis
32176
32177 @smallexample
32178 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32179 @end smallexample
32180
32181 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
32182
32183 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32184
32185 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
32186
32187 @subheading Example
32188
32189 @smallexample
32190 (gdb)
32191 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32192 ^done
32193 (gdb)
32194 @end smallexample
32195
32196 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
32197 @findex -inferior-tty-show
32198
32199 @subheading Synopsis
32200
32201 @smallexample
32202 -inferior-tty-show
32203 @end smallexample
32204
32205 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
32206
32207 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32208
32209 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
32210
32211 @subheading Example
32212
32213 @smallexample
32214 (gdb)
32215 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32216 ^done
32217 (gdb)
32218 -inferior-tty-show
32219 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
32220 (gdb)
32221 @end smallexample
32222
32223 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
32224 @findex -enable-timings
32225
32226 @subheading Synopsis
32227
32228 @smallexample
32229 -enable-timings [yes | no]
32230 @end smallexample
32231
32232 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
32233 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
32234 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
32235 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
32236
32237 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32238
32239 No equivalent.
32240
32241 @subheading Example
32242
32243 @smallexample
32244 (gdb)
32245 -enable-timings
32246 ^done
32247 (gdb)
32248 -break-insert main
32249 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32250 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
32251 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
32252 times="0"@},
32253 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
32254 (gdb)
32255 -enable-timings no
32256 ^done
32257 (gdb)
32258 -exec-run
32259 ^running
32260 (gdb)
32261 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
32262 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
32263 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
32264 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
32265 (gdb)
32266 @end smallexample
32267
32268 @node Annotations
32269 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
32270
32271 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
32272 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
32273 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
32274 relatively high level.
32275
32276 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
32277 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
32278
32279 @ignore
32280 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
32281 @end ignore
32282
32283 @menu
32284 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
32285 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
32286 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
32287 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
32288 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
32289 * Annotations for Running::
32290 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
32291 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
32292 @end menu
32293
32294 @node Annotations Overview
32295 @section What is an Annotation?
32296 @cindex annotations
32297
32298 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
32299 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
32300 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
32301 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
32302 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
32303 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
32304 cannot contain newline characters.
32305
32306 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
32307 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
32308 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
32309 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
32310 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
32311 means those three characters as output.
32312
32313 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
32314 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
32315 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
32316 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
32317 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
32318 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
32319 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
32320 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
32321 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
32322
32323 @table @code
32324 @kindex set annotate
32325 @item set annotate @var{level}
32326 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
32327 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
32328
32329 @item show annotate
32330 @kindex show annotate
32331 Show the current annotation level.
32332 @end table
32333
32334 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
32335
32336 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
32337
32338 @smallexample
32339 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
32340 GNU gdb 6.0
32341 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32342 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
32343 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
32344 under certain conditions.
32345 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32346 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
32347 for details.
32348 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
32349
32350 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32351 (@value{GDBP})
32352 ^Z^Zprompt
32353 @kbd{quit}
32354
32355 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32356 $
32357 @end smallexample
32358
32359 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
32360 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
32361 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
32362 output from @value{GDBN}.
32363
32364 @node Server Prefix
32365 @section The Server Prefix
32366 @cindex server prefix
32367
32368 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
32369 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
32370 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
32371 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
32372 a transparent manner.
32373
32374 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
32375 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
32376 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
32377 @code{print} command.
32378
32379 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
32380 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
32381
32382 @node Prompting
32383 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
32384
32385 @cindex annotations for prompts
32386 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
32387 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
32388 over, etc.
32389
32390 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
32391 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
32392 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
32393 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
32394 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
32395 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
32396 features the following annotations:
32397
32398 @smallexample
32399 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32400 ^Z^Zprompt
32401 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32402 @end smallexample
32403
32404 The input types are
32405
32406 @table @code
32407 @findex pre-prompt annotation
32408 @findex prompt annotation
32409 @findex post-prompt annotation
32410 @item prompt
32411 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
32412
32413 @findex pre-commands annotation
32414 @findex commands annotation
32415 @findex post-commands annotation
32416 @item commands
32417 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
32418 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
32419
32420 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
32421 @findex overload-choice annotation
32422 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
32423 @item overload-choice
32424 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
32425
32426 @findex pre-query annotation
32427 @findex query annotation
32428 @findex post-query annotation
32429 @item query
32430 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
32431
32432 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
32433 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
32434 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
32435 @item prompt-for-continue
32436 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
32437 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
32438 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
32439 presence of annotations.
32440 @end table
32441
32442 @node Errors
32443 @section Errors
32444 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
32445
32446 @findex quit annotation
32447 @smallexample
32448 ^Z^Zquit
32449 @end smallexample
32450
32451 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
32452
32453 @findex error annotation
32454 @smallexample
32455 ^Z^Zerror
32456 @end smallexample
32457
32458 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
32459
32460 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
32461 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
32462 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
32463 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
32464 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
32465 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
32466 to the top level.
32467
32468 @findex error-begin annotation
32469 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
32470
32471 @smallexample
32472 ^Z^Zerror-begin
32473 @end smallexample
32474
32475 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
32476 message.
32477
32478 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
32479 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
32480 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
32481
32482 @node Invalidation
32483 @section Invalidation Notices
32484
32485 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
32486 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
32487 changed.
32488
32489 @table @code
32490 @findex frames-invalid annotation
32491 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
32492
32493 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
32494 have changed.
32495
32496 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
32497 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
32498
32499 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
32500 deleted a breakpoint.
32501 @end table
32502
32503 @node Annotations for Running
32504 @section Running the Program
32505 @cindex annotations for running programs
32506
32507 @findex starting annotation
32508 @findex stopping annotation
32509 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
32510 @code{step} or @code{continue},
32511
32512 @smallexample
32513 ^Z^Zstarting
32514 @end smallexample
32515
32516 is output. When the program stops,
32517
32518 @smallexample
32519 ^Z^Zstopped
32520 @end smallexample
32521
32522 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
32523 annotations describe how the program stopped.
32524
32525 @table @code
32526 @findex exited annotation
32527 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
32528 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
32529 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
32530
32531 @findex signalled annotation
32532 @findex signal-name annotation
32533 @findex signal-name-end annotation
32534 @findex signal-string annotation
32535 @findex signal-string-end annotation
32536 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
32537 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
32538 annotation continues:
32539
32540 @smallexample
32541 @var{intro-text}
32542 ^Z^Zsignal-name
32543 @var{name}
32544 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
32545 @var{middle-text}
32546 ^Z^Zsignal-string
32547 @var{string}
32548 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
32549 @var{end-text}
32550 @end smallexample
32551
32552 @noindent
32553 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
32554 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
32555 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
32556 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
32557 user's benefit and have no particular format.
32558
32559 @findex signal annotation
32560 @item ^Z^Zsignal
32561 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
32562 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
32563 terminated with it.
32564
32565 @findex breakpoint annotation
32566 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
32567 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
32568
32569 @findex watchpoint annotation
32570 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
32571 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
32572 @end table
32573
32574 @node Source Annotations
32575 @section Displaying Source
32576 @cindex annotations for source display
32577
32578 @findex source annotation
32579 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
32580
32581 @smallexample
32582 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
32583 @end smallexample
32584
32585 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
32586 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
32587 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
32588 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
32589 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
32590 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
32591 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
32592 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
32593 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
32594 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
32595 depend on the language).
32596
32597 @node JIT Interface
32598 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
32599 @cindex just-in-time compilation
32600 @cindex JIT compilation interface
32601
32602 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
32603 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
32604 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
32605 performance while maintaining platform independence.
32606
32607 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
32608 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
32609 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
32610 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
32611 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
32612 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
32613
32614 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
32615 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
32616 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
32617 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
32618 LLVM JIT.
32619
32620 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
32621 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
32622 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
32623 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
32624 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
32625 out about additional code.
32626
32627 @menu
32628 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
32629 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
32630 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
32631 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
32632 @end menu
32633
32634 @node Declarations
32635 @section JIT Declarations
32636
32637 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
32638 implement the interface:
32639
32640 @smallexample
32641 typedef enum
32642 @{
32643 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
32644 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
32645 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
32646 @} jit_actions_t;
32647
32648 struct jit_code_entry
32649 @{
32650 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
32651 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
32652 const char *symfile_addr;
32653 uint64_t symfile_size;
32654 @};
32655
32656 struct jit_descriptor
32657 @{
32658 uint32_t version;
32659 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
32660 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
32661 uint32_t action_flag;
32662 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
32663 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
32664 @};
32665
32666 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
32667 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
32668
32669 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
32670 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
32671 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
32672 @end smallexample
32673
32674 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
32675 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
32676 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
32677
32678 @node Registering Code
32679 @section Registering Code
32680
32681 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
32682
32683 @itemize @bullet
32684 @item
32685 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
32686 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
32687
32688 @item
32689 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
32690 file.
32691
32692 @item
32693 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
32694
32695 @item
32696 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
32697
32698 @item
32699 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
32700 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32701 @end itemize
32702
32703 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
32704 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
32705 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
32706 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
32707
32708 @node Unregistering Code
32709 @section Unregistering Code
32710
32711 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
32712
32713 @itemize @bullet
32714 @item
32715 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
32716
32717 @item
32718 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
32719
32720 @item
32721 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
32722 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32723 @end itemize
32724
32725 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
32726 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
32727
32728 @node Custom Debug Info
32729 @section Custom Debug Info
32730 @cindex custom JIT debug info
32731 @cindex JIT debug info reader
32732
32733 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
32734 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
32735 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
32736 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
32737 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
32738 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
32739 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
32740 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
32741 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
32742
32743 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
32744 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
32745 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
32746 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
32747 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
32748 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
32749 compiler.
32750
32751 @menu
32752 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
32753 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
32754 @end menu
32755
32756 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32757 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32758 @kindex jit-reader-load
32759 @kindex jit-reader-unload
32760
32761 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
32762 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
32763
32764 @table @code
32765 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
32766 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
32767 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
32768 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
32769 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
32770 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
32771 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
32772
32773 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
32774 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
32775 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
32776 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
32777 @code{jit-reader-load}.
32778
32779 @item jit-reader-unload
32780 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
32781
32782 @end table
32783
32784 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32785 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32786 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
32787
32788 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
32789 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
32790
32791 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
32792 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
32793 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
32794 the system include directory.
32795
32796 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
32797 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
32798 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
32799
32800 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
32801 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
32802
32803 @findex gdb_init_reader
32804 @smallexample
32805 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
32806 @end smallexample
32807
32808 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
32809
32810 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
32811 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
32812 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
32813 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
32814 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
32815 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
32816
32817 @smallexample
32818 struct gdb_reader_funcs
32819 @{
32820 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
32821 int reader_version;
32822
32823 /* For use by the reader. */
32824 void *priv_data;
32825
32826 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
32827 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
32828 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
32829 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
32830 @};
32831 @end smallexample
32832
32833 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
32834 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
32835
32836 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
32837 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
32838 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
32839 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
32840 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
32841 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
32842 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
32843 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
32844 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
32845 target's address space.
32846
32847 @node In-Process Agent
32848 @chapter In-Process Agent
32849 @cindex debugging agent
32850 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
32851 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
32852 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
32853 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
32854 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
32855 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
32856 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
32857 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
32858 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
32859 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
32860 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
32861 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
32862 behavior without interrupting it.
32863
32864 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
32865 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
32866 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
32867 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
32868 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
32869 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
32870 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
32871 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
32872 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
32873
32874 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
32875 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
32876 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
32877 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
32878
32879 @anchor{Control Agent}
32880 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
32881 debugging with the following commands:
32882
32883 @table @code
32884 @kindex set agent on
32885 @item set agent on
32886 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
32887 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
32888 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
32889 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
32890 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
32891 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
32892
32893 @kindex set agent off
32894 @item set agent off
32895 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
32896 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
32897
32898 @kindex show agent
32899 @item show agent
32900 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
32901 the in-process agent.
32902 @end table
32903
32904 @menu
32905 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
32906 @end menu
32907
32908 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
32909 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
32910 @cindex in-process agent protocol
32911
32912 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
32913 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
32914 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
32915 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
32916 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
32917 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
32918 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
32919 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
32920 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
32921
32922 @menu
32923 * IPA Protocol Objects::
32924 * IPA Protocol Commands::
32925 @end menu
32926
32927 @node IPA Protocol Objects
32928 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
32929 @cindex ipa protocol objects
32930
32931 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
32932 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
32933
32934 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
32935 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
32936 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
32937 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
32938
32939 @enumerate
32940 @item
32941 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
32942 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
32943 @item
32944 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
32945 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
32946 the other one.
32947 @end enumerate
32948
32949 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
32950
32951 @enumerate
32952 @item
32953 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
32954 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
32955 @anchor{agent expression object}
32956 @item
32957 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
32958 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
32959 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
32960 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
32961 @item
32962 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
32963 @anchor{tracepoint object}
32964
32965 @end enumerate
32966
32967 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
32968 object:
32969
32970 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
32971 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
32972 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
32973 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
32974 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
32975 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
32976 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32977 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
32978 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
32979 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
32980 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
32981 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
32982 memory address for collecting.
32983 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
32984 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32985 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
32986 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32987 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
32988 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32989 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
32990 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
32991 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
32992 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
32993 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
32994 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
32995 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
32996 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
32997 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
32998 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
32999 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
33000 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
33001 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
33002 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
33003 @ref{agent expression object}
33004 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
33005 @ref{agent expression object}
33006 @item actions @tab variable
33007 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
33008 @end multitable
33009
33010 @node IPA Protocol Commands
33011 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
33012 @cindex ipa protocol commands
33013
33014 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
33015 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
33016
33017 @table @samp
33018
33019 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
33020 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
33021 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
33022 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
33023 in IPA finally.
33024
33025 Replies:
33026 @table @samp
33027 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
33028 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
33029 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
33030 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
33031 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
33032 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
33033 @item E @var{NN}
33034 for an error
33035
33036 @end table
33037
33038 @item close
33039 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
33040 is about to kill inferiors.
33041
33042 @item qTfSTM
33043 @xref{qTfSTM}.
33044 @item qTsSTM
33045 @xref{qTsSTM}.
33046 @item qTSTMat
33047 @xref{qTSTMat}.
33048 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
33049 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
33050
33051 Replies:
33052 @table @samp
33053 @item E @var{NN}
33054 for an error
33055 @end table
33056 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
33057 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
33058 @end table
33059
33060 @node GDB Bugs
33061 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
33062 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
33063 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
33064
33065 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
33066
33067 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
33068 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
33069 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
33070 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
33071
33072 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
33073 information that enables us to fix the bug.
33074
33075 @menu
33076 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
33077 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
33078 @end menu
33079
33080 @node Bug Criteria
33081 @section Have You Found a Bug?
33082 @cindex bug criteria
33083
33084 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
33085
33086 @itemize @bullet
33087 @cindex fatal signal
33088 @cindex debugger crash
33089 @cindex crash of debugger
33090 @item
33091 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
33092 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
33093
33094 @cindex error on valid input
33095 @item
33096 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
33097 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
33098 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
33099
33100 @cindex invalid input
33101 @item
33102 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
33103 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
33104 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
33105 for traditional practice''.
33106
33107 @item
33108 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
33109 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
33110 @end itemize
33111
33112 @node Bug Reporting
33113 @section How to Report Bugs
33114 @cindex bug reports
33115 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
33116
33117 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
33118 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
33119 contact that organization first.
33120
33121 You can find contact information for many support companies and
33122 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
33123 distribution.
33124 @c should add a web page ref...
33125
33126 @ifset BUGURL
33127 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
33128 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33129 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
33130 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
33131 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
33132 be used.
33133
33134 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
33135 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
33136 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
33137 @samp{bug-gdb}.
33138
33139 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
33140 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
33141 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
33142 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
33143 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
33144 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
33145 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
33146 bug reports to the mailing list.
33147 @end ifset
33148 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
33149 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
33150 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
33151 @end ifclear
33152 @end ifset
33153
33154 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
33155 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
33156 fact or leave it out, state it!
33157
33158 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
33159 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
33160 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
33161 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
33162 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
33163 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
33164 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
33165 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
33166 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
33167
33168 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
33169 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
33170 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
33171 self-contained.
33172
33173 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
33174 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
33175 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
33176 bugs properly.
33177
33178 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
33179
33180 @itemize @bullet
33181 @item
33182 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
33183 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
33184 version}.
33185
33186 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
33187 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
33188
33189 @item
33190 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
33191 version number.
33192
33193 @item
33194 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
33195 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
33196 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
33197 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
33198
33199 @item
33200 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
33201 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
33202
33203 @item
33204 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
33205 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
33206 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
33207 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
33208 those compilers.
33209
33210 @item
33211 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
33212 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
33213 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
33214 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
33215
33216 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
33217 and then we might not encounter the bug.
33218
33219 @item
33220 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
33221 reproduce the bug.
33222
33223 @item
33224 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
33225 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
33226
33227 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
33228 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
33229 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
33230 a chance to make a mistake.
33231
33232 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
33233 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
33234 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
33235 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
33236 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
33237 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
33238 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
33239 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
33240
33241 @pindex script
33242 @cindex recording a session script
33243 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
33244 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
33245 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
33246 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
33247
33248 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
33249 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
33250
33251 @item
33252 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
33253 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
33254 it by context, not by line number.
33255
33256 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
33257 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
33258
33259 @end itemize
33260
33261 Here are some things that are not necessary:
33262
33263 @itemize @bullet
33264 @item
33265 A description of the envelope of the bug.
33266
33267 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
33268 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
33269 changes will not affect it.
33270
33271 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
33272 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
33273 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
33274 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
33275
33276 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
33277 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
33278 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
33279 less time, and so on.
33280
33281 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
33282 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
33283
33284 @item
33285 A patch for the bug.
33286
33287 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
33288 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
33289 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
33290 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
33291
33292 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
33293 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
33294 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
33295 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
33296
33297 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
33298 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
33299 help us to understand.
33300
33301 @item
33302 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
33303
33304 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
33305 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
33306 @end itemize
33307
33308 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
33309 @c and consists of the two following files:
33310 @c rluser.texi
33311 @c hsuser.texi
33312 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
33313 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
33314 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
33315 @include rluser.texi
33316 @include hsuser.texi
33317 @end ifclear
33318
33319 @node In Memoriam
33320 @appendix In Memoriam
33321
33322 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
33323 contributors:
33324
33325 @table @code
33326 @item Fred Fish
33327 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
33328 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
33329 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
33330
33331 @item Michael Snyder
33332 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
33333 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
33334 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
33335 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
33336 @end table
33337
33338 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
33339 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
33340
33341 @node Formatting Documentation
33342 @appendix Formatting Documentation
33343
33344 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
33345 @cindex reference card
33346 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
33347 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
33348 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
33349 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
33350 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
33351 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
33352
33353 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
33354 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
33355
33356 @smallexample
33357 make refcard.dvi
33358 @end smallexample
33359
33360 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
33361 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
33362 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
33363 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
33364 your @sc{dvi} output program.
33365
33366 @cindex documentation
33367
33368 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
33369 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
33370 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
33371 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
33372 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
33373 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
33374
33375 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
33376 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
33377 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
33378 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
33379 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
33380 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
33381 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
33382 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
33383
33384 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
33385 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
33386 @code{makeinfo}.
33387
33388 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
33389 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
33390 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
33391
33392 @smallexample
33393 cd gdb
33394 make gdb.info
33395 @end smallexample
33396
33397 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
33398 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
33399 Texinfo definitions file.
33400
33401 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
33402 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
33403 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
33404 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
33405 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
33406 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
33407 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
33408
33409 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
33410 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
33411 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
33412 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
33413 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
33414 directory.
33415
33416 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
33417 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
33418 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
33419 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
33420
33421 @smallexample
33422 make gdb.dvi
33423 @end smallexample
33424
33425 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
33426
33427 @node Installing GDB
33428 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
33429 @cindex installation
33430
33431 @menu
33432 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
33433 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
33434 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
33435 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
33436 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
33437 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
33438 @end menu
33439
33440 @node Requirements
33441 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
33442 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
33443
33444 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
33445 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
33446
33447 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
33448 @table @asis
33449 @item ISO C90 compiler
33450 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
33451 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
33452
33453 @end table
33454
33455 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
33456 @table @asis
33457 @item Expat
33458 @anchor{Expat}
33459 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
33460 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
33461 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
33462 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
33463 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
33464 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
33465
33466 Expat is used for:
33467
33468 @itemize @bullet
33469 @item
33470 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
33471 @item
33472 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
33473 @item
33474 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
33475 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
33476 @item
33477 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
33478 @item
33479 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
33480 @item
33481 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
33482 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
33483 @end itemize
33484
33485 @item zlib
33486 @cindex compressed debug sections
33487 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
33488 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
33489 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
33490 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
33491 information in such binaries.
33492
33493 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
33494 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
33495 @url{http://zlib.net}.
33496
33497 @item iconv
33498 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
33499 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
33500 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
33501 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
33502
33503 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
33504 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
33505 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
33506 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
33507
33508 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
33509 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
33510 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
33511
33512 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
33513 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
33514 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
33515 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
33516 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
33517 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
33518 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
33519 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
33520 @end table
33521
33522 @node Running Configure
33523 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
33524 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
33525 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
33526 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
33527 build the @code{gdb} program.
33528 @iftex
33529 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
33530 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
33531 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
33532 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
33533 @end iftex
33534
33535 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
33536 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
33537 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
33538
33539 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
33540 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
33541
33542 @table @code
33543 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
33544 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
33545
33546 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
33547 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
33548
33549 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
33550 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
33551
33552 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
33553 @sc{gnu} include files
33554
33555 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
33556 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
33557
33558 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
33559 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
33560
33561 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
33562 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
33563
33564 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
33565 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
33566
33567 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
33568 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
33569 @end table
33570
33571 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
33572 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
33573 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
33574
33575 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
33576 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
33577 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
33578 argument.
33579
33580 For example:
33581
33582 @smallexample
33583 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33584 ./configure @var{host}
33585 make
33586 @end smallexample
33587
33588 @noindent
33589 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
33590 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
33591 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
33592 correct value by examining your system.)
33593
33594 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
33595 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
33596 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
33597 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
33598
33599 @need 750
33600 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
33601 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
33602 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
33603
33604 @smallexample
33605 sh configure @var{host}
33606 @end smallexample
33607
33608 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
33609 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
33610 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
33611 @file{configure}
33612 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
33613 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
33614
33615 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
33616 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
33617 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
33618 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
33619 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
33620 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
33621 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
33622 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
33623 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33624
33625 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
33626 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
33627 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
33628 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
33629 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
33630
33631 @node Separate Objdir
33632 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
33633
33634 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
33635 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
33636 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
33637 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
33638 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
33639 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
33640 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
33641 program specified there.
33642
33643 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
33644 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
33645 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
33646 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
33647 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
33648 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
33649
33650 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
33651 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
33652
33653 @smallexample
33654 @group
33655 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33656 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
33657 cd ../gdb-sun4
33658 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
33659 make
33660 @end group
33661 @end smallexample
33662
33663 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
33664 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
33665 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
33666 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
33667 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
33668 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
33669
33670 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
33671 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
33672 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
33673 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
33674 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33675
33676 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
33677 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
33678 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
33679 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
33680 You specify a cross-debugging target by
33681 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
33682
33683 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
33684 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
33685 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
33686
33687 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
33688 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
33689 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
33690 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
33691 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
33692
33693 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
33694 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
33695 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
33696 with each other.
33697
33698 @node Config Names
33699 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
33700
33701 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
33702 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
33703 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
33704 of information in the following pattern:
33705
33706 @smallexample
33707 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
33708 @end smallexample
33709
33710 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
33711 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
33712 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
33713
33714 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
33715 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
33716 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
33717 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
33718 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
33719 abbreviations---for example:
33720
33721 @smallexample
33722 % sh config.sub i386-linux
33723 i386-pc-linux-gnu
33724 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
33725 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
33726 % sh config.sub hp9k700
33727 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
33728 % sh config.sub sun4
33729 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
33730 % sh config.sub sun3
33731 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
33732 % sh config.sub i986v
33733 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
33734 @end smallexample
33735
33736 @noindent
33737 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
33738 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
33739
33740 @node Configure Options
33741 @section @file{configure} Options
33742
33743 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
33744 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
33745 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
33746 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
33747
33748 @smallexample
33749 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
33750 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33751 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33752 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
33753 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
33754 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
33755 @var{host}
33756 @end smallexample
33757
33758 @noindent
33759 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
33760 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
33761 @samp{--}.
33762
33763 @table @code
33764 @item --help
33765 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
33766
33767 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
33768 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
33769 @file{@var{dir}}.
33770
33771 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
33772 Configure the source to install programs under directory
33773 @file{@var{dir}}.
33774
33775 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
33776 @need 2000
33777 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
33778 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
33779 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
33780 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
33781 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
33782 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
33783 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
33784 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
33785 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
33786 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
33787 @var{dirname}.
33788
33789 @item --norecursion
33790 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
33791 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
33792
33793 @item --target=@var{target}
33794 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
33795 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
33796 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
33797
33798 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
33799
33800 @item @var{host} @dots{}
33801 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
33802
33803 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
33804 @end table
33805
33806 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
33807 needed for special purposes only.
33808
33809 @node System-wide configuration
33810 @section System-wide configuration and settings
33811 @cindex system-wide init file
33812
33813 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
33814 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
33815 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
33816
33817 Here is the corresponding configure option:
33818
33819 @table @code
33820 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
33821 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
33822 @var{file}.
33823 @end table
33824
33825 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
33826 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
33827
33828 @itemize @bullet
33829 @item
33830 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
33831 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
33832 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
33833 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
33834 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
33835 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
33836
33837 @item
33838 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
33839 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
33840 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33841 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33842 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
33843 @end itemize
33844
33845 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
33846 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
33847 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
33848 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
33849 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
33850 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
33851 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
33852 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
33853 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
33854 reread.
33855
33856 @menu
33857 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33858 @end menu
33859
33860 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
33861 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33862 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
33863
33864 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
33865 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
33866 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
33867 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
33868 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
33869 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
33870
33871 The following scripts are currently available:
33872 @itemize @bullet
33873
33874 @item @file{elinos.py}
33875 @pindex elinos.py
33876 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
33877 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
33878 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
33879 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
33880 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
33881 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
33882
33883 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
33884 @pindex wrs-linux.py
33885 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
33886 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
33887 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
33888 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
33889
33890 @end itemize
33891
33892 @node Maintenance Commands
33893 @appendix Maintenance Commands
33894 @cindex maintenance commands
33895 @cindex internal commands
33896
33897 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
33898 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
33899 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
33900 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
33901 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
33902
33903 @table @code
33904 @kindex maint agent
33905 @kindex maint agent-eval
33906 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33907 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33908 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
33909 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
33910 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
33911 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
33912 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
33913 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
33914 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
33915 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
33916 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
33917 addition and return the sum.
33918 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
33919 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
33920
33921 @kindex maint agent-printf
33922 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
33923 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
33924 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
33925 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
33926 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
33927
33928 @kindex maint info breakpoints
33929 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
33930 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
33931 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
33932 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
33933 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
33934 is shown:
33935
33936 @table @code
33937 @item breakpoint
33938 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
33939
33940 @item watchpoint
33941 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
33942
33943 @item longjmp
33944 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
33945 @code{longjmp} calls.
33946
33947 @item longjmp resume
33948 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
33949
33950 @item until
33951 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
33952
33953 @item finish
33954 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
33955
33956 @item shlib events
33957 Shared library events.
33958
33959 @end table
33960
33961 @kindex maint info btrace
33962 @item maint info btrace
33963 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
33964
33965 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
33966 @item maint btrace packet-history
33967 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
33968 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
33969 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
33970 recording format.
33971
33972 @table @code
33973 @item bts
33974 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
33975 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
33976
33977 @table @asis
33978 @item Block number
33979 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
33980 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
33981 @item Highest @samp{PC}
33982 @end table
33983
33984 @item pt
33985 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
33986 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
33987 information is printed:
33988
33989 @table @asis
33990 @item Packet number
33991 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
33992 @item Trace offset
33993 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
33994 @item Packet opcode and payload
33995 @end table
33996 @end table
33997
33998 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
33999 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
34000 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
34001 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
34002 needed.
34003
34004 @kindex maint btrace clear
34005 @item maint btrace clear
34006 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
34007 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
34008
34009 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
34010 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
34011 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
34012 buffer.
34013
34014 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34015 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
34016 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34017 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
34018 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
34019 packet history.
34020
34021 @kindex set displaced-stepping
34022 @kindex show displaced-stepping
34023 @cindex displaced stepping support
34024 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
34025 @item set displaced-stepping
34026 @itemx show displaced-stepping
34027 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
34028 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
34029 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
34030 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
34031 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
34032
34033 @table @code
34034 @item set displaced-stepping on
34035 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
34036 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
34037
34038 @item set displaced-stepping off
34039 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
34040 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
34041
34042 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
34043 @item set displaced-stepping auto
34044 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
34045 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
34046 architecture supports displaced stepping.
34047 @end table
34048
34049 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
34050 @item maint check-psymtabs
34051 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
34052 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
34053
34054 @kindex maint check-symtabs
34055 @item maint check-symtabs
34056 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
34057
34058 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
34059 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
34060 Expand symbol tables.
34061 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
34062 names matching @var{regexp}.
34063
34064 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
34065 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34066 @cindex demangler crashes
34067 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
34068 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
34069 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
34070 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
34071 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
34072 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
34073 option to terminate the current session.
34074
34075 @kindex maint cplus first_component
34076 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
34077 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
34078
34079 @kindex maint cplus namespace
34080 @item maint cplus namespace
34081 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
34082
34083 @kindex maint deprecate
34084 @kindex maint undeprecate
34085 @cindex deprecated commands
34086 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
34087 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
34088 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
34089 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
34090 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
34091 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
34092 the replacement as part of the warning.
34093
34094 @kindex maint dump-me
34095 @item maint dump-me
34096 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
34097 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
34098 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
34099 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
34100
34101 @kindex maint internal-error
34102 @kindex maint internal-warning
34103 @kindex maint demangler-warning
34104 @cindex demangler crashes
34105 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34106 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34107 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
34108
34109 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
34110 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
34111 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
34112 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
34113 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
34114 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
34115 @value{GDBN} session.
34116
34117 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
34118 used as the text of the error or warning message.
34119
34120 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
34121
34122 @smallexample
34123 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
34124 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
34125 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
34126 debugging may prove unreliable.
34127 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34128 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
34129 (@value{GDBP})
34130 @end smallexample
34131
34132 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
34133 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
34134 @cindex demangler crashes
34135
34136 @kindex maint set internal-error
34137 @kindex maint show internal-error
34138 @kindex maint set internal-warning
34139 @kindex maint show internal-warning
34140 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
34141 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
34142 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34143 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
34144 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34145 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
34146 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
34147 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
34148 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
34149 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
34150 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
34151 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
34152 described in the table below.
34153
34154 @table @samp
34155 @item quit
34156 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34157 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
34158
34159 @item corefile
34160 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
34161 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
34162 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
34163 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
34164 disabled.
34165 @end table
34166
34167 @kindex maint packet
34168 @item maint packet @var{text}
34169 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
34170 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
34171 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
34172 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
34173 checksum.
34174
34175 @kindex maint print architecture
34176 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34177 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
34178 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
34179
34180 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
34181 @item maint print c-tdesc
34182 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
34183 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
34184 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
34185
34186 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
34187 @item maint print dummy-frames
34188 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
34189
34190 @smallexample
34191 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
34192 @dots{}
34193 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
34194 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
34195 58 return (a + b);
34196 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
34197 @dots{}
34198 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
34199 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
34200 (@value{GDBP})
34201 @end smallexample
34202
34203 Takes an optional file parameter.
34204
34205 @kindex maint print registers
34206 @kindex maint print raw-registers
34207 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
34208 @kindex maint print register-groups
34209 @kindex maint print remote-registers
34210 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34211 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34212 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34213 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34214 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34215 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
34216
34217 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
34218 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
34219 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
34220 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
34221 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
34222 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
34223 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
34224 and offsets in the `G' packets.
34225
34226 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
34227 write the information.
34228
34229 @kindex maint print reggroups
34230 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34231 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
34232 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
34233 information.
34234
34235 The register groups info looks like this:
34236
34237 @smallexample
34238 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
34239 Group Type
34240 general user
34241 float user
34242 all user
34243 vector user
34244 system user
34245 save internal
34246 restore internal
34247 @end smallexample
34248
34249 @kindex flushregs
34250 @item flushregs
34251 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
34252
34253 @kindex maint print objfiles
34254 @cindex info for known object files
34255 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
34256 Print a dump of all known object files.
34257 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
34258 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
34259 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
34260
34261 @kindex maint print user-registers
34262 @cindex user registers
34263 @item maint print user-registers
34264 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
34265 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
34266 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
34267 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
34268 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
34269 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
34270 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
34271
34272 @kindex maint print section-scripts
34273 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
34274 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
34275 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
34276 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
34277 matching @var{regexp}.
34278 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
34279 and the full path if known.
34280 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
34281
34282 @kindex maint print statistics
34283 @cindex bcache statistics
34284 @item maint print statistics
34285 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
34286 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
34287 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
34288 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
34289 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
34290 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
34291 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
34292 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
34293 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
34294 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
34295 lengths.
34296
34297 @kindex maint print target-stack
34298 @cindex target stack description
34299 @item maint print target-stack
34300 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
34301 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
34302 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
34303 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
34304 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
34305 address.
34306
34307 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
34308 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
34309
34310 @kindex maint print type
34311 @cindex type chain of a data type
34312 @item maint print type @var{expr}
34313 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
34314 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
34315 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
34316 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
34317 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
34318
34319 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34320 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34321 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
34322 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
34323 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
34324 information.
34325
34326 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
34327 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
34328 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
34329 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
34330 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
34331 always see the disassembly form.
34332
34333 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
34334
34335 @smallexample
34336 (gdb) info addr argc
34337 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
34338 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
34339 @end smallexample
34340
34341 For more information on these expressions, see
34342 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
34343
34344 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34345 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34346 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
34347 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
34348 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
34349
34350 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
34351 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
34352 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
34353 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
34354 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
34355 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
34356 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
34357 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
34358 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
34359
34360 @kindex maint set profile
34361 @kindex maint show profile
34362 @cindex profiling GDB
34363 @item maint set profile
34364 @itemx maint show profile
34365 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
34366
34367 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
34368 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
34369 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
34370 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
34371 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
34372 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
34373 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
34374
34375 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
34376 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
34377
34378 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
34379 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
34380 @cindex hardware debug registers
34381 @item maint set show-debug-regs
34382 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
34383 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
34384 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
34385 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
34386 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
34387 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
34388
34389 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
34390 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
34391 @item maint set show-all-tib
34392 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
34393 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
34394 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
34395 command.
34396
34397 @kindex maint set target-async
34398 @kindex maint show target-async
34399 @item maint set target-async
34400 @itemx maint show target-async
34401 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
34402 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
34403 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
34404 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
34405
34406 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
34407 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
34408 @item maint set target-non-stop
34409 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
34410
34411 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
34412 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
34413 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
34414 if supported by the target.
34415
34416 @table @code
34417 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
34418 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
34419 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
34420
34421 @item maint set target-non-stop on
34422 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
34423 does not indicate support.
34424
34425 @item maint set target-non-stop off
34426 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
34427 target supports it.
34428 @end table
34429
34430 @kindex maint set per-command
34431 @kindex maint show per-command
34432 @item maint set per-command
34433 @itemx maint show per-command
34434 @cindex resources used by commands
34435
34436 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
34437 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
34438
34439 @table @code
34440 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
34441 @itemx maint show per-command space
34442 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
34443 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
34444 took, following the command's own output.
34445 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34446 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34447
34448 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
34449 @itemx maint show per-command time
34450 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
34451 for each command.
34452 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
34453 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
34454 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
34455 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
34456 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
34457 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
34458 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
34459 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
34460 spent by the program been debugged.
34461 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34462 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34463
34464 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
34465 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
34466 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
34467 for each command.
34468 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
34469
34470 @enumerate a
34471 @item
34472 number of symbol tables
34473 @item
34474 number of primary symbol tables
34475 @item
34476 number of blocks in the blockvector
34477 @end enumerate
34478 @end table
34479
34480 @kindex maint space
34481 @cindex memory used by commands
34482 @item maint space @var{value}
34483 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
34484 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34485
34486 @kindex maint time
34487 @cindex time of command execution
34488 @item maint time @var{value}
34489 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
34490 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34491
34492 @kindex maint translate-address
34493 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
34494 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
34495 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
34496 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
34497 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
34498 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
34499 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
34500
34501 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
34502 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
34503 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
34504
34505 @end table
34506
34507 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
34508 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
34509
34510 @table @code
34511 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
34512 @kindex set watchdog
34513 @cindex watchdog timer
34514 @cindex timeout for commands
34515 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
34516 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
34517 reports and error and the command is aborted.
34518
34519 @item show watchdog
34520 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
34521 @end table
34522
34523 @node Remote Protocol
34524 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
34525
34526 @menu
34527 * Overview::
34528 * Packets::
34529 * Stop Reply Packets::
34530 * General Query Packets::
34531 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
34532 * Tracepoint Packets::
34533 * Host I/O Packets::
34534 * Interrupts::
34535 * Notification Packets::
34536 * Remote Non-Stop::
34537 * Packet Acknowledgment::
34538 * Examples::
34539 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
34540 * Library List Format::
34541 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
34542 * Memory Map Format::
34543 * Thread List Format::
34544 * Traceframe Info Format::
34545 * Branch Trace Format::
34546 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
34547 @end menu
34548
34549 @node Overview
34550 @section Overview
34551
34552 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
34553 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
34554 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
34555 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
34556
34557 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
34558 transmitted and received data, respectively.
34559
34560 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
34561 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
34562 @cindex remote serial protocol
34563 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
34564 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
34565 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
34566 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
34567 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
34568
34569 @smallexample
34570 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34571 @end smallexample
34572 @noindent
34573
34574 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
34575 @noindent
34576 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
34577 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
34578 eight bit unsigned checksum).
34579
34580 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
34581 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
34582
34583 @smallexample
34584 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34585 @end smallexample
34586
34587 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
34588 @noindent
34589 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
34590 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
34591 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
34592
34593 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
34594 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
34595 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
34596 retransmission):
34597
34598 @smallexample
34599 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34600 <- @code{+}
34601 @end smallexample
34602 @noindent
34603
34604 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
34605 once a connection is established.
34606 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
34607
34608 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
34609 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
34610 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
34611 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
34612 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
34613 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
34614 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
34615
34616 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
34617 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
34618 exceptions).
34619
34620 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
34621 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
34622 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
34623 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
34624
34625 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
34626 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
34627 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
34628
34629 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
34630 @anchor{Binary Data}
34631 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
34632 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
34633 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
34634 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
34635 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
34636 binary data.
34637
34638 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
34639 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
34640 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
34641 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
34642 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
34643 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
34644 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
34645 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
34646 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
34647 (described next).
34648
34649 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
34650 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
34651 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
34652 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
34653 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
34654 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
34655 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
34656 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
34657 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
34658 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
34659 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
34660 3}} more times.
34661
34662 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
34663 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
34664 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
34665 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
34666 @samp{0*"00}.
34667
34668 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
34669 error number. That number is not well defined.
34670
34671 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
34672 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
34673 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
34674 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
34675 on that response.
34676
34677 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
34678 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
34679 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
34680 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
34681 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
34682 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
34683
34684 @node Packets
34685 @section Packets
34686
34687 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
34688 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
34689 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
34690 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
34691
34692 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
34693 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
34694 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
34695 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
34696 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
34697 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
34698 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
34699 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
34700 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
34701 @var{baz}.
34702
34703 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
34704 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
34705 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
34706 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
34707 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
34708 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
34709 pick any thread.
34710
34711 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
34712 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
34713 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
34714 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
34715 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
34716 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
34717 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
34718 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
34719 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
34720 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
34721 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
34722 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
34723 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
34724
34725 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
34726 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
34727 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
34728 more information.
34729
34730 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
34731 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
34732
34733 Here are the packet descriptions.
34734
34735 @table @samp
34736
34737 @item !
34738 @cindex @samp{!} packet
34739 @anchor{extended mode}
34740 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
34741 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
34742 debugged.
34743
34744 Reply:
34745 @table @samp
34746 @item OK
34747 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
34748 @end table
34749
34750 @item ?
34751 @cindex @samp{?} packet
34752 @anchor{? packet}
34753 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
34754 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
34755 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
34756
34757 Reply:
34758 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34759
34760 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
34761 @cindex @samp{A} packet
34762 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
34763 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
34764 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
34765
34766 Reply:
34767 @table @samp
34768 @item OK
34769 The arguments were set.
34770 @item E @var{NN}
34771 An error occurred.
34772 @end table
34773
34774 @item b @var{baud}
34775 @cindex @samp{b} packet
34776 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
34777 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
34778
34779 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
34780 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
34781 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
34782
34783 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
34784 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
34785 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
34786 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
34787 of view, nothing actually happened.}
34788
34789 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
34790 @cindex @samp{B} packet
34791 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
34792 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
34793
34794 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
34795 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
34796
34797 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
34798 @anchor{bc}
34799 @item bc
34800 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
34801 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34802
34803 Reply:
34804 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34805
34806 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
34807 @anchor{bs}
34808 @item bs
34809 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
34810 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34811
34812 Reply:
34813 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34814
34815 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
34816 @cindex @samp{c} packet
34817 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
34818 is omitted, resume at current address.
34819
34820 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34821 packet}.
34822
34823 Reply:
34824 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34825
34826 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
34827 @cindex @samp{C} packet
34828 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
34829 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
34830
34831 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34832 packet}.
34833
34834 Reply:
34835 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34836
34837 @item d
34838 @cindex @samp{d} packet
34839 Toggle debug flag.
34840
34841 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
34842 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
34843
34844 @item D
34845 @itemx D;@var{pid}
34846 @cindex @samp{D} packet
34847 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
34848 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
34849 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
34850
34851 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
34852 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
34853 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
34854 big-endian hex string.
34855
34856 Reply:
34857 @table @samp
34858 @item OK
34859 for success
34860 @item E @var{NN}
34861 for an error
34862 @end table
34863
34864 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
34865 @cindex @samp{F} packet
34866 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
34867 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
34868 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
34869
34870 @item g
34871 @anchor{read registers packet}
34872 @cindex @samp{g} packet
34873 Read general registers.
34874
34875 Reply:
34876 @table @samp
34877 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34878 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
34879 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
34880 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
34881 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
34882 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
34883 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
34884
34885 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
34886 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
34887 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
34888 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
34889 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
34890 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
34891 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
34892 have been collected, and both have zero value:
34893
34894 @smallexample
34895 -> @code{g}
34896 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
34897 @end smallexample
34898
34899 @item E @var{NN}
34900 for an error.
34901 @end table
34902
34903 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
34904 @cindex @samp{G} packet
34905 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
34906 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
34907
34908 Reply:
34909 @table @samp
34910 @item OK
34911 for success
34912 @item E @var{NN}
34913 for an error
34914 @end table
34915
34916 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
34917 @cindex @samp{H} packet
34918 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
34919 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
34920 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
34921 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
34922 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
34923 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
34924 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34925
34926 Reply:
34927 @table @samp
34928 @item OK
34929 for success
34930 @item E @var{NN}
34931 for an error
34932 @end table
34933
34934 @c FIXME: JTC:
34935 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
34936 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
34937 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
34938 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
34939 @c described. For example:
34940 @c
34941 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34942 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
34943 @c otherwise returns current registers.
34944 @c
34945 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34946 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
34947 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
34948
34949 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
34950 @anchor{cycle step packet}
34951 @cindex @samp{i} packet
34952 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
34953 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
34954 step starting at that address.
34955
34956 @item I
34957 @cindex @samp{I} packet
34958 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
34959 step packet}.
34960
34961 @item k
34962 @cindex @samp{k} packet
34963 Kill request.
34964
34965 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
34966
34967 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
34968 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
34969
34970 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
34971
34972 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
34973 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
34974 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
34975
34976 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
34977 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
34978 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
34979
34980 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
34981 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
34982 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
34983 (@pxref{? packet}).
34984
34985 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
34986 @cindex @samp{m} packet
34987 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
34988 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
34989 any particular boundary.
34990
34991 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
34992 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
34993 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
34994 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
34995 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
34996 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
34997 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
34998 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
34999
35000 Reply:
35001 @table @samp
35002 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35003 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35004 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
35005 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
35006 @item E @var{NN}
35007 @var{NN} is errno
35008 @end table
35009
35010 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35011 @cindex @samp{M} packet
35012 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
35013 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
35014 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
35015
35016 Reply:
35017 @table @samp
35018 @item OK
35019 for success
35020 @item E @var{NN}
35021 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
35022 written).
35023 @end table
35024
35025 @item p @var{n}
35026 @cindex @samp{p} packet
35027 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
35028 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
35029 register value is encoded.
35030
35031 Reply:
35032 @table @samp
35033 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
35034 the register's value
35035 @item E @var{NN}
35036 for an error
35037 @item @w{}
35038 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
35039 @end table
35040
35041 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
35042 @anchor{write register packet}
35043 @cindex @samp{P} packet
35044 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
35045 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
35046 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
35047
35048 Reply:
35049 @table @samp
35050 @item OK
35051 for success
35052 @item E @var{NN}
35053 for an error
35054 @end table
35055
35056 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35057 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
35058 @cindex @samp{q} packet
35059 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
35060 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
35061 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
35062
35063 @item r
35064 @cindex @samp{r} packet
35065 Reset the entire system.
35066
35067 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
35068
35069 @item R @var{XX}
35070 @cindex @samp{R} packet
35071 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
35072 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35073
35074 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
35075
35076 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
35077 @cindex @samp{s} packet
35078 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
35079 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
35080
35081 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35082 packet}.
35083
35084 Reply:
35085 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35086
35087 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
35088 @anchor{step with signal packet}
35089 @cindex @samp{S} packet
35090 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
35091 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
35092
35093 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
35094 packet}.
35095
35096 Reply:
35097 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35098
35099 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
35100 @cindex @samp{t} packet
35101 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
35102 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
35103 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
35104
35105 @item T @var{thread-id}
35106 @cindex @samp{T} packet
35107 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35108
35109 Reply:
35110 @table @samp
35111 @item OK
35112 thread is still alive
35113 @item E @var{NN}
35114 thread is dead
35115 @end table
35116
35117 @item v
35118 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
35119 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
35120
35121 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
35122 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
35123 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
35124 The process ID is a
35125 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
35126 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
35127 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
35128
35129 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
35130 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
35131 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
35132 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
35133 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
35134 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
35135 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
35136 @c stopping or restarting threads.
35137
35138 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35139
35140 Reply:
35141 @table @samp
35142 @item E @var{nn}
35143 for an error
35144 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35145 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35146 @item OK
35147 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
35148 @end table
35149
35150 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
35151 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
35152 @anchor{vCont packet}
35153 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
35154 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
35155 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
35156 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
35157 in their current state in non-stop mode.
35158 Specifying multiple
35159 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
35160 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35161
35162 Currently supported actions are:
35163
35164 @table @samp
35165 @item c
35166 Continue.
35167 @item C @var{sig}
35168 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35169 @item s
35170 Step.
35171 @item S @var{sig}
35172 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
35173 @item t
35174 Stop.
35175 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
35176 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
35177 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
35178 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
35179 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
35180 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
35181
35182 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
35183 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
35184 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
35185 jumps to @var{start}).
35186
35187 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
35188 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
35189 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
35190
35191 @end table
35192
35193 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
35194 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
35195 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
35196
35197 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
35198 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
35199 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
35200 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
35201 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
35202 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
35203 as an implementation detail.
35204
35205 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
35206 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
35207 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
35208 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
35209 @var{thread-id}.
35210
35211 Reply:
35212 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
35213
35214 @item vCont?
35215 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
35216 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
35217
35218 Reply:
35219 @table @samp
35220 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
35221 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
35222 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
35223 @item @w{}
35224 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
35225 @end table
35226
35227 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
35228 @item vCtrlC
35229 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
35230 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
35231 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
35232 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
35233 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
35234 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
35235 variant.
35236
35237 Reply:
35238 @table @samp
35239 @item E @var{nn}
35240 for an error
35241 @item OK
35242 for success
35243 @end table
35244
35245 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
35246 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
35247 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
35248 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
35249
35250 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
35251 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
35252 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
35253 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
35254 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
35255 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
35256 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
35257 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
35258 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35259 packet is received.
35260
35261 Reply:
35262 @table @samp
35263 @item OK
35264 for success
35265 @item E @var{NN}
35266 for an error
35267 @end table
35268
35269 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35270 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
35271 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
35272 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
35273 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
35274 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
35275 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
35276 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
35277 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
35278 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
35279 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
35280 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
35281
35282
35283 Reply:
35284 @table @samp
35285 @item OK
35286 for success
35287 @item E.memtype
35288 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
35289 @item E @var{NN}
35290 for an error
35291 @end table
35292
35293 @item vFlashDone
35294 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
35295 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
35296 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
35297 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
35298 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
35299 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35300 request is completed.
35301
35302 @item vKill;@var{pid}
35303 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
35304 @anchor{vKill packet}
35305 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
35306 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
35307 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
35308 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35309
35310 Reply:
35311 @table @samp
35312 @item E @var{nn}
35313 for an error
35314 @item OK
35315 for success
35316 @end table
35317
35318 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
35319 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
35320 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
35321 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
35322 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
35323 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
35324 state.
35325
35326 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
35327
35328 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35329
35330 Reply:
35331 @table @samp
35332 @item E @var{nn}
35333 for an error
35334 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35335 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35336 @end table
35337
35338 @item vStopped
35339 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
35340 @xref{Notification Packets}.
35341
35342 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35343 @anchor{X packet}
35344 @cindex @samp{X} packet
35345 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
35346 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
35347 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
35348 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
35349
35350 Reply:
35351 @table @samp
35352 @item OK
35353 for success
35354 @item E @var{NN}
35355 for an error
35356 @end table
35357
35358 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35359 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35360 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
35361 @cindex @samp{z} packet
35362 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
35363 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
35364 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
35365
35366 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
35367 separately.
35368
35369 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
35370 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
35371 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
35372 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
35373 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
35374 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
35375
35376 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35377 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35378 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
35379 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
35380 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
35381 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
35382
35383 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
35384 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
35385 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
35386 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
35387 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
35388 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
35389 @var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
35390 form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the
35391 conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
35392 the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
35393
35394 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
35395 for how to best report a memory breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
35396
35397 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
35398 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
35399
35400 @table @samp
35401
35402 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35403 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35404 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35405
35406 @end table
35407
35408 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
35409 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
35410 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
35411 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
35412 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
35413 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
35414 separators. Each expression has the following form:
35415
35416 @table @samp
35417
35418 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35419 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35420 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35421
35422 @end table
35423
35424 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
35425
35426 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
35427 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
35428 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
35429 target, is not defined.}
35430
35431 Reply:
35432 @table @samp
35433 @item OK
35434 success
35435 @item @w{}
35436 not supported
35437 @item E @var{NN}
35438 for an error
35439 @end table
35440
35441 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35442 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35443 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
35444 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
35445 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
35446 address @var{addr}.
35447
35448 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
35449 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. The @var{kind}
35450 and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
35451
35452 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
35453 movement.}
35454
35455 Reply:
35456 @table @samp
35457 @item OK
35458 success
35459 @item @w{}
35460 not supported
35461 @item E @var{NN}
35462 for an error
35463 @end table
35464
35465 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35466 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35467 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
35468 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
35469 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35470 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35471
35472 Reply:
35473 @table @samp
35474 @item OK
35475 success
35476 @item @w{}
35477 not supported
35478 @item E @var{NN}
35479 for an error
35480 @end table
35481
35482 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35483 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35484 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
35485 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
35486 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35487 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35488
35489 Reply:
35490 @table @samp
35491 @item OK
35492 success
35493 @item @w{}
35494 not supported
35495 @item E @var{NN}
35496 for an error
35497 @end table
35498
35499 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35500 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35501 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
35502 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
35503 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35504 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35505
35506 Reply:
35507 @table @samp
35508 @item OK
35509 success
35510 @item @w{}
35511 not supported
35512 @item E @var{NN}
35513 for an error
35514 @end table
35515
35516 @end table
35517
35518 @node Stop Reply Packets
35519 @section Stop Reply Packets
35520 @cindex stop reply packets
35521
35522 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
35523 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
35524 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
35525 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
35526 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
35527 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
35528 @value{GDBN} source code.
35529
35530 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
35531 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
35532 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
35533 components.
35534
35535 @table @samp
35536
35537 @item S @var{AA}
35538 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35539 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
35540 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
35541
35542 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
35543 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
35544 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35545 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
35546 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
35547 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
35548 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
35549 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
35550
35551 @itemize @bullet
35552 @item
35553 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
35554 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
35555 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
35556 two-digit hex number.
35557
35558 @item
35559 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
35560 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35561
35562 @item
35563 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
35564 the core on which the stop event was detected.
35565
35566 @item
35567 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
35568 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
35569 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
35570 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
35571
35572 @item
35573 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
35574 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
35575 future.
35576 @end itemize
35577
35578 The currently defined stop reasons are:
35579
35580 @table @samp
35581 @item watch
35582 @itemx rwatch
35583 @itemx awatch
35584 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
35585 hex.
35586
35587 @item syscall_entry
35588 @itemx syscall_return
35589 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
35590 syscall number, in hex.
35591
35592 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
35593 @item library
35594 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
35595 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
35596 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
35597
35598 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
35599 @item replaylog
35600 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
35601 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
35602 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
35603 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
35604 for more information.
35605
35606 @item swbreak
35607 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
35608 The packet indicates a memory breakpoint instruction was executed,
35609 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
35610 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
35611 part must be left empty.
35612
35613 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
35614 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
35615 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
35616 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
35617 address.
35618
35619 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35620 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35621 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35622 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35623 indicating support.
35624
35625 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
35626
35627 @item hwbreak
35628 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
35629 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
35630
35631 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
35632 apply.
35633
35634 @cindex fork events, remote reply
35635 @item fork
35636 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
35637 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
35638 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35639 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
35640 fork events.
35641
35642 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35643 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35644 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35645 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35646 indicating support.
35647
35648 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
35649 @item vfork
35650 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
35651 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
35652 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35653 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
35654 vfork events.
35655
35656 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35657 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35658 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35659 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35660 indicating support.
35661
35662 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
35663 @item vforkdone
35664 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
35665 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
35666 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
35667 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
35668 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
35669
35670 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35671 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35672 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35673 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35674 indicating support.
35675
35676 @cindex exec events, remote reply
35677 @item exec
35678 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
35679 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
35680 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
35681
35682 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35683 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35684 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35685 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35686 indicating support.
35687
35688 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
35689 @anchor{thread create event}
35690 @item create
35691 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
35692 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
35693 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
35694 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
35695 also the @samp{w} (@ref{thread exit event}) remote reply below.
35696
35697 @end table
35698
35699 @item W @var{AA}
35700 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35701 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
35702 applicable to certain targets.
35703
35704 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
35705 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
35706 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35707 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35708
35709 @item X @var{AA}
35710 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35711 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
35712
35713 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
35714 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
35715 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
35716 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35717
35718 @anchor{thread exit event}
35719 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
35720 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
35721
35722 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
35723 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
35724 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
35725
35726 @item N
35727 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
35728 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
35729 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
35730 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
35731 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
35732 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
35733 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
35734 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
35735 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
35736 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
35737 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
35738 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
35739 support.
35740
35741 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
35742 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
35743 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
35744 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
35745 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
35746
35747 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
35748 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
35749 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
35750 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
35751 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
35752 system calls.
35753
35754 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
35755 this very system call.
35756
35757 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
35758 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
35759 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
35760 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
35761 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
35762 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
35763
35764 @end table
35765
35766 @node General Query Packets
35767 @section General Query Packets
35768 @cindex remote query requests
35769
35770 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
35771 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
35772 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
35773 sending information to and from the stub.
35774
35775 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
35776 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
35777 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
35778 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
35779 conventions:
35780
35781 @itemize @bullet
35782 @item
35783 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
35784 @item
35785 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
35786 letter.
35787 @item
35788 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
35789 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
35790 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
35791 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
35792 @end itemize
35793
35794 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
35795 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
35796 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
35797 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
35798 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
35799 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
35800 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
35801 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
35802 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
35803 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
35804 packet.}.
35805
35806 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
35807 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
35808 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
35809 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
35810 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
35811
35812 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
35813
35814 @table @samp
35815
35816 @item QAgent:1
35817 @itemx QAgent:0
35818 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
35819 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
35820
35821 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
35822 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
35823 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
35824 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
35825 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
35826 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
35827 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
35828 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
35829 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
35830 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
35831 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
35832
35833 @item qC
35834 @cindex current thread, remote request
35835 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
35836 Return the current thread ID.
35837
35838 Reply:
35839 @table @samp
35840 @item QC @var{thread-id}
35841 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
35842 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35843 @item @r{(anything else)}
35844 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
35845 @end table
35846
35847 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
35848 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
35849 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
35850 @anchor{qCRC packet}
35851 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
35852 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
35853 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
35854 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
35855
35856 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
35857 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
35858 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
35859 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
35860 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
35861 detect trailing zeros.
35862
35863 Reply:
35864 @table @samp
35865 @item E @var{NN}
35866 An error (such as memory fault)
35867 @item C @var{crc32}
35868 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
35869 @end table
35870
35871 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
35872 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
35873 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
35874 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
35875 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
35876 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
35877 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
35878 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
35879 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
35880 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
35881 randomization.
35882
35883 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35884
35885 Reply:
35886 @table @samp
35887 @item OK
35888 The request succeeded.
35889
35890 @item E @var{nn}
35891 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35892
35893 @item @w{}
35894 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
35895 by the stub.
35896 @end table
35897
35898 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35899 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35900 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
35901 address space randomization.
35902
35903 @item qfThreadInfo
35904 @itemx qsThreadInfo
35905 @cindex list active threads, remote request
35906 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
35907 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
35908 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
35909 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
35910 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
35911 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
35912 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
35913 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
35914
35915 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
35916
35917 Reply:
35918 @table @samp
35919 @item m @var{thread-id}
35920 A single thread ID
35921 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
35922 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
35923 @item l
35924 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
35925 @end table
35926
35927 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
35928 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
35929 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
35930 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
35931 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
35932 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35933 fields.
35934
35935 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
35936 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
35937 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
35938 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
35939 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
35940
35941 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
35942 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
35943 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
35944 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
35945 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
35946
35947 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
35948 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35949
35950 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
35951 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
35952 information associated with the variable.)
35953
35954 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
35955 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
35956 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
35957 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
35958 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
35959 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
35960
35961 Reply:
35962 @table @samp
35963 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35964 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
35965 local storage requested.
35966
35967 @item E @var{nn}
35968 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35969
35970 @item @w{}
35971 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
35972 @end table
35973
35974 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
35975 @cindex get thread information block address
35976 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
35977 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
35978
35979 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
35980
35981 Reply:
35982 @table @samp
35983 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35984 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
35985 thread information block.
35986
35987 @item E @var{nn}
35988 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
35989 address could not be retrieved.
35990
35991 @item @w{}
35992 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
35993 @end table
35994
35995 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
35996 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
35997 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
35998 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
35999 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
36000 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
36001 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
36002
36003 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
36004
36005 Reply:
36006 @table @samp
36007 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
36008 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
36009 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
36010 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
36011 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
36012 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
36013 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
36014 @end table
36015
36016 @item qOffsets
36017 @cindex section offsets, remote request
36018 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
36019 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
36020 image.
36021
36022 Reply:
36023 @table @samp
36024 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
36025 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
36026 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
36027 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
36028 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
36029 segments by the supplied offsets.
36030
36031 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
36032 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
36033 to the @code{Bss} section.}
36034
36035 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
36036 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
36037 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
36038 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
36039 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
36040 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
36041 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
36042 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
36043 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
36044 @end table
36045
36046 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
36047 @cindex thread information, remote request
36048 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
36049 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
36050 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
36051 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
36052
36053 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
36054 (see below).
36055
36056 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
36057
36058 @item QNonStop:1
36059 @itemx QNonStop:0
36060 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
36061 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
36062 @anchor{QNonStop}
36063 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
36064 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
36065
36066 Reply:
36067 @table @samp
36068 @item OK
36069 The request succeeded.
36070
36071 @item E @var{nn}
36072 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36073
36074 @item @w{}
36075 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
36076 the stub.
36077 @end table
36078
36079 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36080 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36081 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
36082 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
36083
36084 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
36085 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
36086 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
36087 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
36088 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
36089 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
36090 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
36091
36092 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
36093 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
36094 is listed, every system call should be reported.
36095
36096 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
36097 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
36098 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
36099 report the requested syscalls.
36100
36101 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
36102 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36103
36104 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
36105 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
36106 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
36107 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
36108
36109 Reply:
36110 @table @samp
36111 @item OK
36112 The request succeeded.
36113
36114 @item E @var{nn}
36115 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
36116
36117 @item @w{}
36118 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
36119 the stub.
36120 @end table
36121
36122 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
36123 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
36124 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36125 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36126
36127 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36128 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
36129 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36130 @anchor{QPassSignals}
36131 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
36132 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36133 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36134 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
36135 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
36136 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
36137 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
36138 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
36139 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
36140
36141 Reply:
36142 @table @samp
36143 @item OK
36144 The request succeeded.
36145
36146 @item E @var{nn}
36147 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36148
36149 @item @w{}
36150 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
36151 the stub.
36152 @end table
36153
36154 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
36155 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
36156 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36157 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36158
36159 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
36160 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
36161 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
36162 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
36163 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
36164 Others should be silently discarded.
36165
36166 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
36167 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
36168 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
36169 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
36170 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
36171 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
36172 signals.
36173
36174 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
36175 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
36176
36177 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
36178 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
36179 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
36180 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
36181 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
36182
36183 Reply:
36184 @table @samp
36185 @item OK
36186 The request succeeded.
36187
36188 @item E @var{nn}
36189 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36190
36191 @item @w{}
36192 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
36193 by the stub.
36194 @end table
36195
36196 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
36197 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
36198 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36199 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36200
36201 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
36202 @item QThreadEvents:1
36203 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
36204 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
36205 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
36206
36207 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
36208 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
36209 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
36210 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
36211 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
36212 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
36213 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
36214 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
36215 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
36216 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36217
36218 Reply:
36219 @table @samp
36220 @item OK
36221 The request succeeded.
36222
36223 @item E @var{nn}
36224 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
36225
36226 @item @w{}
36227 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
36228 the stub.
36229 @end table
36230
36231 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
36232 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
36233
36234 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
36235 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
36236 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
36237 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
36238 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
36239 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
36240 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
36241 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
36242 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
36243
36244 Reply:
36245 @table @samp
36246 @item OK
36247 A command response with no output.
36248 @item @var{OUTPUT}
36249 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
36250 @item E @var{NN}
36251 Indicate a badly formed request.
36252 @item @w{}
36253 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
36254 @end table
36255
36256 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
36257 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
36258 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
36259 packets.)
36260
36261 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
36262 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
36263 @ifnotinfo
36264 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
36265 @end ifnotinfo
36266 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
36267 @anchor{qSearch memory}
36268 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
36269 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
36270 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
36271
36272 Reply:
36273 @table @samp
36274 @item 0
36275 The pattern was not found.
36276 @item 1,address
36277 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
36278 @item E @var{NN}
36279 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
36280 @item @w{}
36281 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
36282 @end table
36283
36284 @item QStartNoAckMode
36285 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
36286 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
36287 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
36288 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
36289
36290 Reply:
36291 @table @samp
36292 @item OK
36293 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
36294 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
36295 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
36296 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
36297 @item @w{}
36298 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
36299 @end table
36300
36301 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
36302 @cindex supported packets, remote query
36303 @cindex features of the remote protocol
36304 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
36305 @anchor{qSupported}
36306 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
36307 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
36308 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
36309 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
36310 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
36311 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
36312 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
36313 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
36314 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
36315 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
36316 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
36317 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
36318 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
36319 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
36320
36321 Reply:
36322 @table @samp
36323 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
36324 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
36325 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
36326 possible forms).
36327 @item @w{}
36328 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
36329 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
36330 @end table
36331
36332 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
36333 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
36334 are:
36335
36336 @table @samp
36337 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
36338 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
36339 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
36340 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
36341 @item @var{name}+
36342 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
36343 need an associated value.
36344 @item @var{name}-
36345 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
36346 @item @var{name}?
36347 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
36348 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
36349 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
36350 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
36351 @end table
36352
36353 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
36354 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
36355 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
36356 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
36357 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
36358
36359 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
36360 are defined:
36361
36362 @table @samp
36363 @item multiprocess
36364 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
36365 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36366 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36367 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36368 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
36369
36370 @item xmlRegisters
36371 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
36372 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
36373 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
36374 description.
36375
36376 @item qRelocInsn
36377 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
36378 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
36379 instruction reply packet}).
36380
36381 @item swbreak
36382 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
36383 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36384
36385 @item hwbreak
36386 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
36387 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
36388
36389 @item fork-events
36390 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
36391 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36392 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36393 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36394
36395 @item vfork-events
36396 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
36397 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36398 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36399 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36400
36401 @item exec-events
36402 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
36403 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
36404 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
36405 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
36406
36407 @item vContSupported
36408 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
36409 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
36410 @end table
36411
36412 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
36413 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
36414 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
36415 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
36416 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
36417 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
36418 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
36419 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
36420 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
36421 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
36422 all the features it supports.
36423
36424 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
36425 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
36426
36427 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
36428 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
36429 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
36430 form response.
36431
36432 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
36433 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
36434 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
36435 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
36436
36437 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
36438 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
36439 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
36440 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
36441 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
36442
36443 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
36444
36445 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
36446 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
36447 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
36448 @item Feature Name
36449 @tab Value Required
36450 @tab Default
36451 @tab Probe Allowed
36452
36453 @item @samp{PacketSize}
36454 @tab Yes
36455 @tab @samp{-}
36456 @tab No
36457
36458 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
36459 @tab No
36460 @tab @samp{-}
36461 @tab Yes
36462
36463 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36464 @tab No
36465 @tab @samp{-}
36466 @tab Yes
36467
36468 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36469 @tab No
36470 @tab @samp{-}
36471 @tab Yes
36472
36473 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
36474 @tab No
36475 @tab @samp{-}
36476 @tab Yes
36477
36478 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
36479 @tab No
36480 @tab @samp{-}
36481 @tab Yes
36482
36483 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
36484 @tab No
36485 @tab @samp{-}
36486 @tab Yes
36487
36488 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
36489 @tab No
36490 @tab @samp{-}
36491 @tab Yes
36492
36493 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
36494 @tab No
36495 @tab @samp{-}
36496 @tab No
36497
36498 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
36499 @tab No
36500 @tab @samp{-}
36501 @tab Yes
36502
36503 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
36504 @tab No
36505 @tab @samp{-}
36506 @tab Yes
36507
36508 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
36509 @tab No
36510 @tab @samp{-}
36511 @tab Yes
36512
36513 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
36514 @tab No
36515 @tab @samp{-}
36516 @tab Yes
36517
36518 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
36519 @tab No
36520 @tab @samp{-}
36521 @tab Yes
36522
36523 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
36524 @tab No
36525 @tab @samp{-}
36526 @tab Yes
36527
36528 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
36529 @tab No
36530 @tab @samp{-}
36531 @tab Yes
36532
36533 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36534 @tab No
36535 @tab @samp{-}
36536 @tab Yes
36537
36538 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36539 @tab No
36540 @tab @samp{-}
36541 @tab Yes
36542
36543 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36544 @tab No
36545 @tab @samp{-}
36546 @tab Yes
36547
36548 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
36549 @tab Yes
36550 @tab @samp{-}
36551 @tab Yes
36552
36553 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
36554 @tab Yes
36555 @tab @samp{-}
36556 @tab Yes
36557
36558 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
36559 @tab Yes
36560 @tab @samp{-}
36561 @tab Yes
36562
36563 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
36564 @tab Yes
36565 @tab @samp{-}
36566 @tab Yes
36567
36568 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
36569 @tab Yes
36570 @tab @samp{-}
36571 @tab Yes
36572
36573 @item @samp{QNonStop}
36574 @tab No
36575 @tab @samp{-}
36576 @tab Yes
36577
36578 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
36579 @tab No
36580 @tab @samp{-}
36581 @tab Yes
36582
36583 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
36584 @tab No
36585 @tab @samp{-}
36586 @tab Yes
36587
36588 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
36589 @tab No
36590 @tab @samp{-}
36591 @tab Yes
36592
36593 @item @samp{multiprocess}
36594 @tab No
36595 @tab @samp{-}
36596 @tab No
36597
36598 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
36599 @tab No
36600 @tab @samp{-}
36601 @tab No
36602
36603 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
36604 @tab No
36605 @tab @samp{-}
36606 @tab No
36607
36608 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
36609 @tab No
36610 @tab @samp{-}
36611 @tab No
36612
36613 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
36614 @tab No
36615 @tab @samp{-}
36616 @tab No
36617
36618 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
36619 @tab No
36620 @tab @samp{-}
36621 @tab No
36622
36623 @item @samp{QAgent}
36624 @tab No
36625 @tab @samp{-}
36626 @tab No
36627
36628 @item @samp{QAllow}
36629 @tab No
36630 @tab @samp{-}
36631 @tab No
36632
36633 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
36634 @tab No
36635 @tab @samp{-}
36636 @tab No
36637
36638 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
36639 @tab No
36640 @tab @samp{-}
36641 @tab No
36642
36643 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
36644 @tab No
36645 @tab @samp{-}
36646 @tab No
36647
36648 @item @samp{tracenz}
36649 @tab No
36650 @tab @samp{-}
36651 @tab No
36652
36653 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
36654 @tab No
36655 @tab @samp{-}
36656 @tab No
36657
36658 @item @samp{swbreak}
36659 @tab No
36660 @tab @samp{-}
36661 @tab No
36662
36663 @item @samp{hwbreak}
36664 @tab No
36665 @tab @samp{-}
36666 @tab No
36667
36668 @item @samp{fork-events}
36669 @tab No
36670 @tab @samp{-}
36671 @tab No
36672
36673 @item @samp{vfork-events}
36674 @tab No
36675 @tab @samp{-}
36676 @tab No
36677
36678 @item @samp{exec-events}
36679 @tab No
36680 @tab @samp{-}
36681 @tab No
36682
36683 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
36684 @tab No
36685 @tab @samp{-}
36686 @tab No
36687
36688 @item @samp{no-resumed}
36689 @tab No
36690 @tab @samp{-}
36691 @tab No
36692
36693 @end multitable
36694
36695 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
36696
36697 @table @samp
36698 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
36699 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
36700 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
36701 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
36702 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
36703 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
36704 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
36705 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
36706 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
36707 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
36708
36709 @item qXfer:auxv:read
36710 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
36711 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
36712
36713 @item qXfer:btrace:read
36714 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36715 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
36716
36717 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
36718 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36719 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
36720
36721 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
36722 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
36723 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
36724
36725 @item qXfer:features:read
36726 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
36727 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
36728
36729 @item qXfer:libraries:read
36730 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
36731 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
36732
36733 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
36734 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
36735 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
36736
36737 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
36738 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
36739 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
36740 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
36741
36742 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
36743 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
36744 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
36745
36746 @item qXfer:sdata:read
36747 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
36748 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
36749
36750 @item qXfer:spu:read
36751 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
36752 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
36753
36754 @item qXfer:spu:write
36755 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
36756 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
36757
36758 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
36759 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
36760 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
36761
36762 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
36763 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
36764 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
36765
36766 @item qXfer:threads:read
36767 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
36768 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
36769
36770 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
36771 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36772 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
36773
36774 @item qXfer:uib:read
36775 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36776 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
36777
36778 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
36779 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36780 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
36781
36782 @item QNonStop
36783 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
36784 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
36785
36786 @item QCatchSyscalls
36787 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
36788 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
36789
36790 @item QPassSignals
36791 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36792 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
36793
36794 @item QStartNoAckMode
36795 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
36796 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
36797
36798 @item multiprocess
36799 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
36800 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
36801 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
36802 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
36803 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
36804 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
36805 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
36806 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
36807 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
36808 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
36809 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
36810
36811 @item qXfer:osdata:read
36812 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
36813 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
36814
36815 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
36816 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
36817 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
36818 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
36819
36820 @item ConditionalTracepoints
36821 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
36822 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
36823
36824 @item ReverseContinue
36825 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
36826 (@pxref{bc}).
36827
36828 @item ReverseStep
36829 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
36830 (@pxref{bs}).
36831
36832 @item TracepointSource
36833 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
36834 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
36835
36836 @item QAgent
36837 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
36838
36839 @item QAllow
36840 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
36841
36842 @item QDisableRandomization
36843 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
36844
36845 @item StaticTracepoint
36846 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
36847 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
36848
36849 @item InstallInTrace
36850 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
36851 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
36852
36853 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
36854 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
36855 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
36856 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
36857
36858 @item QTBuffer:size
36859 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
36860 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
36861
36862 @item tracenz
36863 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
36864 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
36865 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
36866
36867 @item BreakpointCommands
36868 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
36869 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
36870 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
36871
36872 @item Qbtrace:off
36873 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
36874
36875 @item Qbtrace:bts
36876 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
36877
36878 @item Qbtrace:pt
36879 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
36880
36881 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
36882 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
36883
36884 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
36885 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
36886
36887 @item swbreak
36888 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
36889 breakpoints.
36890
36891 @item hwbreak
36892 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
36893 breakpoints.
36894
36895 @item fork-events
36896 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
36897
36898 @item vfork-events
36899 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
36900 and vforkdone events.
36901
36902 @item exec-events
36903 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
36904
36905 @item vContSupported
36906 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
36907 @samp{vCont?} packet.
36908
36909 @item QThreadEvents
36910 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
36911
36912 @item no-resumed
36913 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
36914
36915 @end table
36916
36917 @item qSymbol::
36918 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
36919 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
36920 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
36921 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
36922
36923 Reply:
36924 @table @samp
36925 @item OK
36926 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
36927 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
36928 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
36929 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
36930 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
36931 below.
36932 @end table
36933
36934 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
36935 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
36936
36937 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
36938 target has previously requested.
36939
36940 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
36941 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
36942 will be empty.
36943
36944 Reply:
36945 @table @samp
36946 @item OK
36947 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
36948 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
36949 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
36950 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
36951 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
36952 @end table
36953
36954 @item qTBuffer
36955 @itemx QTBuffer
36956 @itemx QTDisconnected
36957 @itemx QTDP
36958 @itemx QTDPsrc
36959 @itemx QTDV
36960 @itemx qTfP
36961 @itemx qTfV
36962 @itemx QTFrame
36963 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
36964
36965 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
36966
36967 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
36968 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
36969 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
36970 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
36971 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
36972 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
36973 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
36974 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
36975 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
36976 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
36977 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
36978
36979 Reply:
36980 @table @samp
36981 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36982 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
36983 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
36984 the thread's attributes.
36985 @end table
36986
36987 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
36988 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
36989 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
36990 packets.)
36991
36992 @item QTNotes
36993 @itemx qTP
36994 @itemx QTSave
36995 @itemx qTsP
36996 @itemx qTsV
36997 @itemx QTStart
36998 @itemx QTStop
36999 @itemx QTEnable
37000 @itemx QTDisable
37001 @itemx QTinit
37002 @itemx QTro
37003 @itemx qTStatus
37004 @itemx qTV
37005 @itemx qTfSTM
37006 @itemx qTsSTM
37007 @itemx qTSTMat
37008 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
37009
37010 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37011 @cindex read special object, remote request
37012 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
37013 @anchor{qXfer read}
37014 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
37015 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
37016 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
37017 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
37018 additional details about what data to access.
37019
37020 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
37021 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37022 formats, listed below.
37023
37024 @table @samp
37025 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37026 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
37027 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
37028 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
37029
37030 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37031 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37032
37033 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37034 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
37035
37036 Return a description of the current branch trace.
37037 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
37038 packet may have one of the following values:
37039
37040 @table @code
37041 @item all
37042 Returns all available branch trace.
37043
37044 @item new
37045 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
37046 the last read request.
37047
37048 @item delta
37049 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
37050 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
37051 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
37052 used to stitch traces together.
37053
37054 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
37055 @end table
37056
37057 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37058 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37059
37060 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37061 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
37062
37063 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
37064 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
37065
37066 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
37067 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37068
37069 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37070 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
37071 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
37072 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
37073 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
37074 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
37075 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
37076
37077 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37078 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37079
37080 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37081 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
37082 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
37083 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
37084 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
37085
37086 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37087 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37088
37089 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37090 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
37091 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
37092 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37093 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37094
37095 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
37096 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
37097 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
37098
37099 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37100 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37101
37102 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37103 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
37104 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
37105 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
37106 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
37107 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
37108 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37109 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
37110
37111 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
37112 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
37113
37114 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37115 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37116
37117 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
37118 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
37119 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
37120 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
37121
37122 @table @code
37123 @item start=@var{address}
37124 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37125 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
37126 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
37127 chosen as the starting point.
37128
37129 @item prev=@var{address}
37130 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
37131 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
37132 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
37133 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
37134 exists prior to the starting point.
37135
37136 @end table
37137
37138 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
37139 ignored.
37140
37141 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37142 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
37143 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
37144 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37145 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37146
37147 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37148 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37149
37150 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37151 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
37152
37153 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
37154 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
37155 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
37156 Action Lists}.
37157
37158 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37159 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37160 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37161
37162 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37163 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
37164 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
37165 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37166 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37167
37168 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37169 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37170 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37171
37172 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37173 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
37174 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37175 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
37176 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37177 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37178 in that context to be accessed.
37179
37180 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37181 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37182 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37183
37184 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37185 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
37186 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
37187 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
37188 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37189
37190 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37191 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37192
37193 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37194 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
37195
37196 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
37197 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
37198 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
37199
37200 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37201 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37202
37203 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37204 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
37205
37206 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
37207 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
37208
37209 This packet is not probed by default.
37210
37211 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
37212 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
37213 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
37214 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
37215 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
37216
37217 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37218 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37219
37220 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
37221 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
37222 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
37223 @xref{Operating System Information}.
37224
37225 @end table
37226
37227 Reply:
37228 @table @samp
37229 @item m @var{data}
37230 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
37231 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
37232 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
37233 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
37234 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
37235 request.
37236
37237 @item l @var{data}
37238 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
37239 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
37240 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
37241
37242 @item l
37243 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
37244 There is no more data to be read.
37245
37246 @item E00
37247 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37248
37249 @item E @var{nn}
37250 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
37251 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37252
37253 @item @w{}
37254 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
37255 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
37256 @end table
37257
37258 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37259 @cindex write data into object, remote request
37260 @anchor{qXfer write}
37261 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
37262 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
37263 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
37264 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
37265 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
37266 to access.
37267
37268 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
37269 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
37270 formats, listed below.
37271
37272 @table @samp
37273 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37274 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
37275 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
37276 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
37277 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
37278
37279 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37280 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37281 (@pxref{qSupported}).
37282
37283 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
37284 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
37285 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
37286 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
37287 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
37288 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
37289 in that context to be accessed.
37290
37291 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37292 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37293 @end table
37294
37295 Reply:
37296 @table @samp
37297 @item @var{nn}
37298 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
37299 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
37300
37301 @item E00
37302 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
37303
37304 @item E @var{nn}
37305 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
37306 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
37307
37308 @item @w{}
37309 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
37310 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
37311 @end table
37312
37313 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
37314 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
37315 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
37316 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
37317 must respond with an empty packet.
37318
37319 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
37320 @cindex query attached, remote request
37321 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
37322 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
37323 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
37324 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
37325 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
37326 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
37327 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
37328
37329 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
37330 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
37331 the @code{quit} command.
37332
37333 Reply:
37334 @table @samp
37335 @item 1
37336 The remote server attached to an existing process.
37337 @item 0
37338 The remote server created a new process.
37339 @item E @var{NN}
37340 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37341 @end table
37342
37343 @item Qbtrace:bts
37344 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
37345
37346 Reply:
37347 @table @samp
37348 @item OK
37349 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37350 @item E.errtext
37351 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37352 @end table
37353
37354 @item Qbtrace:pt
37355 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
37356
37357 Reply:
37358 @table @samp
37359 @item OK
37360 Branch tracing has been enabled.
37361 @item E.errtext
37362 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37363 @end table
37364
37365 @item Qbtrace:off
37366 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
37367
37368 Reply:
37369 @table @samp
37370 @item OK
37371 Branch tracing has been disabled.
37372 @item E.errtext
37373 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37374 @end table
37375
37376 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
37377 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37378 btrace recording method in bts format.
37379
37380 Reply:
37381 @table @samp
37382 @item OK
37383 The ring buffer size has been set.
37384 @item E.errtext
37385 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37386 @end table
37387
37388 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
37389 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
37390 btrace recording method in pt format.
37391
37392 Reply:
37393 @table @samp
37394 @item OK
37395 The ring buffer size has been set.
37396 @item E.errtext
37397 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
37398 @end table
37399
37400 @end table
37401
37402 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37403 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
37404
37405 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
37406 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
37407 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
37408
37409 @menu
37410 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
37411 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
37412 @end menu
37413
37414 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
37415 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
37416
37417 @menu
37418 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
37419 @end menu
37420
37421 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
37422 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
37423 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
37424
37425 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37426
37427 @table @r
37428
37429 @item 2
37430 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
37431
37432 @item 3
37433 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
37434
37435 @item 4
37436 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
37437
37438 @end table
37439
37440 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
37441 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
37442
37443 @menu
37444 * MIPS Register packet Format::
37445 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
37446 @end menu
37447
37448 @node MIPS Register packet Format
37449 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
37450 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
37451
37452 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
37453 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
37454 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
37455 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
37456 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
37457 most-significant -- least-significant.
37458
37459 @table @r
37460
37461 @item MIPS32
37462 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
37463 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
37464 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
37465
37466 @item MIPS64
37467 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
37468 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
37469 as @code{MIPS32}.
37470
37471 @end table
37472
37473 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
37474 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
37475 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
37476
37477 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
37478
37479 @table @r
37480
37481 @item 2
37482 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
37483
37484 @item 3
37485 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37486
37487 @item 4
37488 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
37489
37490 @item 5
37491 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
37492
37493 @end table
37494
37495 @node Tracepoint Packets
37496 @section Tracepoint Packets
37497 @cindex tracepoint packets
37498 @cindex packets, tracepoint
37499
37500 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
37501 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
37502
37503 @table @samp
37504
37505 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
37506 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
37507 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
37508 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
37509 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
37510 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
37511 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
37512 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
37513 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
37514 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
37515 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
37516 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
37517 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
37518 actions.
37519
37520 Replies:
37521 @table @samp
37522 @item OK
37523 The packet was understood and carried out.
37524 @item qRelocInsn
37525 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37526 @item @w{}
37527 The packet was not recognized.
37528 @end table
37529
37530 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
37531 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
37532 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
37533 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
37534 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
37535 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
37536 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
37537
37538 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
37539 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
37540 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
37541 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
37542 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
37543 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
37544 tracepoint actions.
37545
37546 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
37547 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
37548 following forms:
37549
37550 @table @samp
37551
37552 @item R @var{mask}
37553 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
37554 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
37555 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
37556 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
37557 not fit in a 32-bit word.
37558
37559 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
37560 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
37561 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
37562 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
37563 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
37564 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
37565 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
37566
37567 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37568 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
37569 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
37570 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
37571 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
37572 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
37573 packet).
37574
37575 @end table
37576
37577 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
37578 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
37579 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
37580 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
37581 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
37582 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
37583 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
37584 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
37585
37586 Replies:
37587 @table @samp
37588 @item OK
37589 The packet was understood and carried out.
37590 @item qRelocInsn
37591 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37592 @item @w{}
37593 The packet was not recognized.
37594 @end table
37595
37596 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
37597 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
37598 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
37599 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
37600 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
37601 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
37602 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
37603 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
37604
37605 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
37606 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
37607 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
37608 fit in a single packet.
37609 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
37610 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
37611
37612 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
37613 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
37614 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
37615 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
37616
37617 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
37618 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
37619 query packets.
37620
37621 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
37622 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
37623 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
37624 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
37625 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
37626 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
37627 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
37628 be found.
37629
37630 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
37631 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
37632 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
37633 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
37634 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
37635 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
37636 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
37637 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
37638 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
37639 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
37640 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
37641 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
37642 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
37643 variable.
37644
37645 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
37646 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
37647 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
37648 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
37649 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
37650
37651 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
37652 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
37653 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
37654 one of the following forms:
37655
37656 @table @samp
37657 @item F @var{f}
37658 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
37659 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
37660 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
37661
37662 @item T @var{t}
37663 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
37664 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
37665
37666 @end table
37667
37668 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
37669 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37670 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
37671 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
37672
37673 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
37674 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37675 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
37676 is a hexadecimal number.
37677
37678 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
37679 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37680 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
37681 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
37682 numbers.
37683
37684 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
37685 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
37686 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
37687
37688 @item qTMinFTPILen
37689 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
37690 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
37691 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
37692 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
37693 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
37694 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
37695 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
37696 arrange for that.
37697
37698 Replies:
37699
37700 @table @samp
37701 @item 0
37702 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
37703 @item @var{length}
37704 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
37705 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
37706 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
37707 regardless of size.
37708 @item E
37709 An error has occurred.
37710 @item @w{}
37711 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
37712 @end table
37713
37714 @item QTStart
37715 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
37716 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
37717 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
37718 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
37719 instruction reply packet}).
37720
37721 @item QTStop
37722 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
37723 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
37724
37725 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
37726 @anchor{QTEnable}
37727 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
37728 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
37729 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
37730 of data from it will resume.
37731
37732 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
37733 @anchor{QTDisable}
37734 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
37735 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
37736 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
37737 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
37738
37739 @item QTinit
37740 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
37741 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
37742
37743 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
37744 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
37745 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
37746 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
37747 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
37748
37749 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
37750 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
37751 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
37752 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
37753
37754 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
37755 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
37756 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
37757 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
37758 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
37759 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
37760
37761 @item qTStatus
37762 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
37763 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
37764
37765 The reply has the form:
37766
37767 @table @samp
37768
37769 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
37770 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
37771 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
37772 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
37773
37774 @end table
37775
37776 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
37777 explanations as one of the optional fields:
37778
37779 @table @samp
37780
37781 @item tnotrun:0
37782 No trace has been run yet.
37783
37784 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
37785 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
37786 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
37787 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
37788 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
37789
37790 @item tfull:0
37791 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
37792
37793 @item tdisconnected:0
37794 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
37795
37796 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
37797 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
37798
37799 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
37800 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
37801 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
37802 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
37803 is hex encoded.
37804
37805 @item tunknown:0
37806 The trace stopped for some other reason.
37807
37808 @end table
37809
37810 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
37811 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
37812 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
37813 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
37814 trace.
37815
37816 @table @samp
37817
37818 @item tframes:@var{n}
37819 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
37820
37821 @item tcreated:@var{n}
37822 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
37823 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
37824
37825 @item tsize:@var{n}
37826 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
37827
37828 @item tfree:@var{n}
37829 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
37830
37831 @item circular:@var{n}
37832 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
37833 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
37834 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
37835 and may fill up.
37836
37837 @item disconn:@var{n}
37838 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
37839 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
37840 that the trace run will stop.
37841
37842 @end table
37843
37844 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
37845 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
37846 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
37847 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
37848 address @var{addr}.
37849
37850 Replies:
37851 @table @samp
37852 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
37853 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
37854 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
37855 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
37856 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
37857
37858 @end table
37859
37860 @item qTV:@var{var}
37861 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
37862 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
37863 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
37864
37865 Replies:
37866 @table @samp
37867 @item V@var{value}
37868 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
37869 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
37870 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
37871 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
37872 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
37873 program is running.
37874
37875 @item U
37876 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
37877 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
37878 was not collected.
37879 @end table
37880
37881 @item qTfP
37882 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
37883 @itemx qTsP
37884 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
37885 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
37886 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
37887 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
37888 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
37889 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
37890
37891 @item qTfV
37892 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
37893 @itemx qTsV
37894 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
37895 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
37896 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
37897 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
37898 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
37899 trace state variables.
37900
37901 @item qTfSTM
37902 @itemx qTsSTM
37903 @anchor{qTfSTM}
37904 @anchor{qTsSTM}
37905 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
37906 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
37907 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
37908 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
37909 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
37910 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
37911
37912 Reply:
37913 @table @samp
37914 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
37915 A single marker
37916 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
37917 a comma-separated list of markers
37918 @item l
37919 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
37920 @item E @var{nn}
37921 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37922 @item @w{}
37923 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
37924 stub.
37925 @end table
37926
37927 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
37928 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
37929
37930 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
37931 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
37932 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
37933 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
37934 @dfn{last}).
37935
37936 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
37937 @anchor{qTSTMat}
37938 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
37939 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
37940 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
37941 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
37942 tracepoint markers.
37943
37944 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
37945 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
37946 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
37947 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
37948 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
37949 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
37950
37951 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
37952 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
37953 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
37954 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
37955 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
37956 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
37957 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
37958 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
37959 available.
37960
37961 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
37962 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
37963 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
37964
37965 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
37966 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
37967 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
37968 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
37969 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
37970 use whatever size it prefers.
37971
37972 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
37973 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
37974 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
37975 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
37976 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
37977
37978 @end table
37979
37980 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
37981 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
37982 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
37983 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
37984 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
37985 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
37986 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
37987 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
37988 it had executed in the original location.
37989
37990 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
37991 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
37992 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
37993 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
37994 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
37995 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
37996 format of the request is:
37997
37998 @table @samp
37999 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
38000
38001 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
38002 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
38003 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
38004 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
38005 memory starting at @var{to}.
38006 @end table
38007
38008 Replies:
38009 @table @samp
38010 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
38011 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
38012 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
38013 @item E @var{NN}
38014 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
38015 relocating the instruction.
38016 @end table
38017
38018 @node Host I/O Packets
38019 @section Host I/O Packets
38020 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
38021 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
38022
38023 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
38024 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
38025 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
38026 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
38027 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
38028 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
38029 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
38030 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
38031 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
38032 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
38033
38034 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
38035 its arguments. They have this format:
38036
38037 @table @samp
38038
38039 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
38040 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
38041 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
38042 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
38043 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
38044 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
38045 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
38046 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
38047 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
38048
38049 @end table
38050
38051 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
38052
38053 @table @samp
38054
38055 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
38056 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
38057 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
38058 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
38059 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
38060 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
38061 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
38062 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
38063 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
38064 @var{attachment}.
38065
38066 @item @w{}
38067 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
38068
38069 @end table
38070
38071 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
38072
38073 @table @samp
38074 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
38075 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
38076 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
38077 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
38078 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
38079 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
38080 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
38081
38082 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
38083 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
38084 -1 if an error occurs.
38085
38086 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
38087 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
38088 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
38089 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
38090 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
38091 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
38092 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
38093 @var{count} was zero.
38094
38095 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38096 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38097 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38098 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38099 some characters were escaped.
38100
38101 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
38102 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
38103 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
38104 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
38105 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
38106 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
38107 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
38108 error occurred.
38109
38110 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
38111 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
38112 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
38113 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
38114 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
38115 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
38116
38117 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
38118 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
38119 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
38120
38121 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
38122 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
38123 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
38124
38125 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
38126 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
38127 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
38128 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
38129 some characters were escaped.
38130
38131 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
38132 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
38133 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
38134 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
38135 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
38136 inferior(s).
38137
38138 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
38139 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
38140 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
38141 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
38142 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
38143 operation.
38144
38145 @end table
38146
38147 @node Interrupts
38148 @section Interrupts
38149 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
38150 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
38151
38152 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
38153 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
38154 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
38155 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
38156
38157 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
38158 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
38159 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
38160 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
38161 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
38162
38163 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
38164 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
38165 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
38166 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
38167 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
38168 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
38169 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
38170 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
38171
38172 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
38173 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
38174 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
38175
38176 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
38177 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
38178 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
38179 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
38180 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
38181 @code{0x03}.
38182
38183 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
38184 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
38185 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
38186 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
38187 currently-executing threads and processes.
38188 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
38189 running program, it should send one of the stop
38190 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
38191 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
38192 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
38193 Interrupts received while the
38194 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
38195 it is resumed next time.
38196
38197 @node Notification Packets
38198 @section Notification Packets
38199 @cindex notification packets
38200 @cindex packets, notification
38201
38202 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
38203 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
38204 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
38205 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
38206 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
38207 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
38208 is not a problem.
38209
38210 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
38211 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
38212 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
38213 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
38214 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
38215 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
38216 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
38217
38218 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
38219 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
38220
38221 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
38222 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
38223 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
38224 not they understand it.
38225
38226 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
38227 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
38228 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
38229 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
38230 recipients.
38231
38232 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
38233 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
38234 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
38235 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
38236 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
38237
38238 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
38239 @table @samp
38240 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
38241 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
38242 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
38243 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
38244 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
38245 @item @var{ack}
38246 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
38247 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
38248 @end table
38249
38250 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
38251 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
38252
38253 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
38254 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
38255 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
38256 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
38257 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
38258 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
38259 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
38260 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
38261 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
38262 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
38263
38264 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
38265 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
38266 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
38267 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
38268 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
38269 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
38270
38271 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
38272 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
38273 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
38274 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
38275 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
38276
38277 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
38278 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
38279 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
38280 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
38281 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
38282 normally.
38283
38284 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
38285 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
38286 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
38287 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
38288 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
38289 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
38290 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
38291 the process shall be repeated.
38292
38293 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
38294 following example:
38295 @smallexample
38296 <- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
38297 @code{...}
38298 -> @code{vStopped}
38299 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
38300 -> @code{vStopped}
38301 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
38302 -> @code{vStopped}
38303 <- @code{OK}
38304 @end smallexample
38305
38306 The following notifications are defined:
38307 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
38308
38309 @item Notification
38310 @tab Ack
38311 @tab Event
38312 @tab Description
38313
38314 @item Stop
38315 @tab vStopped
38316 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
38317 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
38318 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
38319 @value{GDBN}.
38320 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
38321
38322 @end multitable
38323
38324 @node Remote Non-Stop
38325 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
38326
38327 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
38328 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
38329 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
38330 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38331
38332 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
38333 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
38334 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
38335 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
38336 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
38337 probe the target state after a mode change.
38338
38339 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
38340 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
38341 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
38342 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
38343 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
38344 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
38345 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
38346 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
38347 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
38348 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
38349 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
38350
38351 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
38352 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
38353 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
38354 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
38355 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
38356 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
38357 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
38358 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
38359 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
38360 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
38361 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
38362 @samp{OK}.
38363
38364 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
38365 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
38366 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
38367 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
38368 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
38369 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
38370 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
38371 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
38372 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
38373 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
38374 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
38375 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
38376 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
38377
38378 @node Packet Acknowledgment
38379 @section Packet Acknowledgment
38380
38381 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38382 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
38383 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
38384 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
38385 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
38386 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
38387 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
38388
38389 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
38390 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
38391 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
38392 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
38393 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
38394
38395 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
38396 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
38397 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
38398 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
38399
38400 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
38401 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
38402 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
38403 @pxref{qSupported}.
38404 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
38405 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
38406 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
38407 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
38408 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
38409 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
38410 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
38411
38412 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
38413 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
38414 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
38415 connection.
38416 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
38417 new connection is established,
38418 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
38419 for the current connection, once disabled.
38420
38421 @node Examples
38422 @section Examples
38423
38424 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
38425 does not get any direct output:
38426
38427 @smallexample
38428 -> @code{R00}
38429 <- @code{+}
38430 @emph{target restarts}
38431 -> @code{?}
38432 <- @code{+}
38433 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38434 -> @code{+}
38435 @end smallexample
38436
38437 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
38438
38439 @smallexample
38440 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
38441 <- @code{+}
38442 -> @code{s}
38443 <- @code{+}
38444 @emph{time passes}
38445 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
38446 -> @code{+}
38447 -> @code{g}
38448 <- @code{+}
38449 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
38450 -> @code{+}
38451 @end smallexample
38452
38453 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38454 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
38455 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
38456
38457 @menu
38458 * File-I/O Overview::
38459 * Protocol Basics::
38460 * The F Request Packet::
38461 * The F Reply Packet::
38462 * The Ctrl-C Message::
38463 * Console I/O::
38464 * List of Supported Calls::
38465 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
38466 * Constants::
38467 * File-I/O Examples::
38468 @end menu
38469
38470 @node File-I/O Overview
38471 @subsection File-I/O Overview
38472 @cindex file-i/o overview
38473
38474 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
38475 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
38476 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
38477 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
38478 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
38479 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
38480
38481 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
38482 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
38483 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
38484 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
38485 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
38486
38487 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
38488 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
38489 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
38490 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
38491 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
38492 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
38493 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
38494
38495 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
38496 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
38497 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
38498 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
38499 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
38500
38501 @smallexample
38502 (@value{GDBP}) continue
38503 <- target requests 'system call X'
38504 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
38505 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
38506 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
38507 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
38508 @end smallexample
38509
38510 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
38511 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
38512 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
38513 system are not supported by this protocol.
38514
38515 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
38516
38517 @node Protocol Basics
38518 @subsection Protocol Basics
38519 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
38520
38521 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
38522 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
38523 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
38524 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
38525 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
38526 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
38527 to call the appropriate host system call:
38528
38529 @itemize @bullet
38530 @item
38531 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
38532
38533 @item
38534 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
38535 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
38536 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
38537 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
38538
38539 @end itemize
38540
38541 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
38542
38543 @itemize @bullet
38544 @item
38545 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
38546 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
38547 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
38548 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
38549 packet.
38550
38551 @item
38552 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
38553 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
38554
38555 @item
38556 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
38557
38558 @item
38559 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
38560
38561 @item
38562 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
38563 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
38564 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
38565 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
38566 packet.
38567
38568 @end itemize
38569
38570 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
38571 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
38572
38573 @itemize @bullet
38574 @item
38575 Return value.
38576
38577 @item
38578 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
38579
38580 @item
38581 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
38582
38583 @end itemize
38584
38585 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
38586 the latest continue or step action.
38587
38588 @node The F Request Packet
38589 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
38590 @cindex file-i/o request packet
38591 @cindex @code{F} request packet
38592
38593 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
38594
38595 @table @samp
38596 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
38597
38598 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
38599 This is just the name of the function.
38600
38601 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
38602 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
38603 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
38604 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
38605 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
38606 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
38607 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
38608
38609 @end table
38610
38611
38612
38613 @node The F Reply Packet
38614 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
38615 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
38616 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
38617
38618 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
38619
38620 @table @samp
38621
38622 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
38623
38624 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
38625
38626 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
38627 representation.
38628 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
38629
38630 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
38631 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
38632 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
38633
38634 @smallexample
38635 F0,0,C
38636 @end smallexample
38637
38638 @noindent
38639 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
38640
38641 @smallexample
38642 F-1,4,C
38643 @end smallexample
38644
38645 @noindent
38646 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
38647
38648 @end table
38649
38650
38651 @node The Ctrl-C Message
38652 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
38653 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
38654
38655 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
38656 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
38657 the target should behave as if it had
38658 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
38659 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
38660 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
38661 packet.
38662
38663 It's important for the target to know in which
38664 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
38665
38666 @itemize @bullet
38667 @item
38668 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
38669
38670 @item
38671 The system call on the host has been finished.
38672
38673 @end itemize
38674
38675 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
38676 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
38677 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
38678 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
38679 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
38680 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
38681
38682 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
38683 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
38684 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
38685 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
38686 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
38687 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
38688 or the full action has been completed.
38689
38690 @node Console I/O
38691 @subsection Console I/O
38692 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
38693
38694 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
38695 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
38696 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
38697 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
38698 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
38699 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
38700 conditions is met:
38701
38702 @itemize @bullet
38703 @item
38704 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
38705 @code{read}
38706 system call is treated as finished.
38707
38708 @item
38709 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
38710 newline.
38711
38712 @item
38713 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
38714 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
38715
38716 @end itemize
38717
38718 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
38719 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
38720 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
38721 is stopped at the user's request.
38722
38723
38724 @node List of Supported Calls
38725 @subsection List of Supported Calls
38726 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
38727
38728 @menu
38729 * open::
38730 * close::
38731 * read::
38732 * write::
38733 * lseek::
38734 * rename::
38735 * unlink::
38736 * stat/fstat::
38737 * gettimeofday::
38738 * isatty::
38739 * system::
38740 @end menu
38741
38742 @node open
38743 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
38744 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
38745
38746 @table @asis
38747 @item Synopsis:
38748 @smallexample
38749 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
38750 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
38751 @end smallexample
38752
38753 @item Request:
38754 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
38755
38756 @noindent
38757 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
38758
38759 @table @code
38760 @item O_CREAT
38761 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
38762 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
38763 are concerned.
38764
38765 @item O_EXCL
38766 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
38767 an error and open() fails.
38768
38769 @item O_TRUNC
38770 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
38771 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
38772 truncated to zero length.
38773
38774 @item O_APPEND
38775 The file is opened in append mode.
38776
38777 @item O_RDONLY
38778 The file is opened for reading only.
38779
38780 @item O_WRONLY
38781 The file is opened for writing only.
38782
38783 @item O_RDWR
38784 The file is opened for reading and writing.
38785 @end table
38786
38787 @noindent
38788 Other bits are silently ignored.
38789
38790
38791 @noindent
38792 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
38793
38794 @table @code
38795 @item S_IRUSR
38796 User has read permission.
38797
38798 @item S_IWUSR
38799 User has write permission.
38800
38801 @item S_IRGRP
38802 Group has read permission.
38803
38804 @item S_IWGRP
38805 Group has write permission.
38806
38807 @item S_IROTH
38808 Others have read permission.
38809
38810 @item S_IWOTH
38811 Others have write permission.
38812 @end table
38813
38814 @noindent
38815 Other bits are silently ignored.
38816
38817
38818 @item Return value:
38819 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
38820 occurred.
38821
38822 @item Errors:
38823
38824 @table @code
38825 @item EEXIST
38826 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
38827
38828 @item EISDIR
38829 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
38830
38831 @item EACCES
38832 The requested access is not allowed.
38833
38834 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38835 @var{pathname} was too long.
38836
38837 @item ENOENT
38838 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
38839
38840 @item ENODEV
38841 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
38842
38843 @item EROFS
38844 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
38845 write access was requested.
38846
38847 @item EFAULT
38848 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
38849
38850 @item ENOSPC
38851 No space on device to create the file.
38852
38853 @item EMFILE
38854 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
38855
38856 @item ENFILE
38857 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
38858 has been reached.
38859
38860 @item EINTR
38861 The call was interrupted by the user.
38862 @end table
38863
38864 @end table
38865
38866 @node close
38867 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
38868 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
38869
38870 @table @asis
38871 @item Synopsis:
38872 @smallexample
38873 int close(int fd);
38874 @end smallexample
38875
38876 @item Request:
38877 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
38878
38879 @item Return value:
38880 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
38881
38882 @item Errors:
38883
38884 @table @code
38885 @item EBADF
38886 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
38887
38888 @item EINTR
38889 The call was interrupted by the user.
38890 @end table
38891
38892 @end table
38893
38894 @node read
38895 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
38896 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
38897
38898 @table @asis
38899 @item Synopsis:
38900 @smallexample
38901 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
38902 @end smallexample
38903
38904 @item Request:
38905 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
38906
38907 @item Return value:
38908 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
38909 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
38910 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
38911
38912 @item Errors:
38913
38914 @table @code
38915 @item EBADF
38916 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
38917 reading.
38918
38919 @item EFAULT
38920 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38921
38922 @item EINTR
38923 The call was interrupted by the user.
38924 @end table
38925
38926 @end table
38927
38928 @node write
38929 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
38930 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
38931
38932 @table @asis
38933 @item Synopsis:
38934 @smallexample
38935 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
38936 @end smallexample
38937
38938 @item Request:
38939 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
38940
38941 @item Return value:
38942 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
38943 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
38944 is returned.
38945
38946 @item Errors:
38947
38948 @table @code
38949 @item EBADF
38950 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
38951 writing.
38952
38953 @item EFAULT
38954 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38955
38956 @item EFBIG
38957 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
38958 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
38959
38960 @item ENOSPC
38961 No space on device to write the data.
38962
38963 @item EINTR
38964 The call was interrupted by the user.
38965 @end table
38966
38967 @end table
38968
38969 @node lseek
38970 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
38971 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
38972
38973 @table @asis
38974 @item Synopsis:
38975 @smallexample
38976 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
38977 @end smallexample
38978
38979 @item Request:
38980 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
38981
38982 @var{flag} is one of:
38983
38984 @table @code
38985 @item SEEK_SET
38986 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
38987
38988 @item SEEK_CUR
38989 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
38990 bytes.
38991
38992 @item SEEK_END
38993 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
38994 bytes.
38995 @end table
38996
38997 @item Return value:
38998 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
38999 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
39000 value of -1 is returned.
39001
39002 @item Errors:
39003
39004 @table @code
39005 @item EBADF
39006 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
39007
39008 @item ESPIPE
39009 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
39010
39011 @item EINVAL
39012 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
39013
39014 @item EINTR
39015 The call was interrupted by the user.
39016 @end table
39017
39018 @end table
39019
39020 @node rename
39021 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
39022 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
39023
39024 @table @asis
39025 @item Synopsis:
39026 @smallexample
39027 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
39028 @end smallexample
39029
39030 @item Request:
39031 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
39032
39033 @item Return value:
39034 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39035
39036 @item Errors:
39037
39038 @table @code
39039 @item EISDIR
39040 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
39041 directory.
39042
39043 @item EEXIST
39044 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
39045
39046 @item EBUSY
39047 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
39048 process.
39049
39050 @item EINVAL
39051 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
39052 of itself.
39053
39054 @item ENOTDIR
39055 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
39056 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
39057 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
39058
39059 @item EFAULT
39060 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
39061
39062 @item EACCES
39063 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39064
39065 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39066
39067 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
39068
39069 @item ENOENT
39070 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
39071
39072 @item EROFS
39073 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39074
39075 @item ENOSPC
39076 The device containing the file has no room for the new
39077 directory entry.
39078
39079 @item EINTR
39080 The call was interrupted by the user.
39081 @end table
39082
39083 @end table
39084
39085 @node unlink
39086 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
39087 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
39088
39089 @table @asis
39090 @item Synopsis:
39091 @smallexample
39092 int unlink(const char *pathname);
39093 @end smallexample
39094
39095 @item Request:
39096 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
39097
39098 @item Return value:
39099 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39100
39101 @item Errors:
39102
39103 @table @code
39104 @item EACCES
39105 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39106
39107 @item EPERM
39108 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
39109
39110 @item EBUSY
39111 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
39112 being used by another process.
39113
39114 @item EFAULT
39115 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39116
39117 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39118 @var{pathname} was too long.
39119
39120 @item ENOENT
39121 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
39122
39123 @item ENOTDIR
39124 A component of the path is not a directory.
39125
39126 @item EROFS
39127 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
39128
39129 @item EINTR
39130 The call was interrupted by the user.
39131 @end table
39132
39133 @end table
39134
39135 @node stat/fstat
39136 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
39137 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
39138 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
39139
39140 @table @asis
39141 @item Synopsis:
39142 @smallexample
39143 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
39144 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
39145 @end smallexample
39146
39147 @item Request:
39148 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
39149 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
39150
39151 @item Return value:
39152 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
39153
39154 @item Errors:
39155
39156 @table @code
39157 @item EBADF
39158 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
39159
39160 @item ENOENT
39161 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
39162 path is an empty string.
39163
39164 @item ENOTDIR
39165 A component of the path is not a directory.
39166
39167 @item EFAULT
39168 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39169
39170 @item EACCES
39171 No access to the file or the path of the file.
39172
39173 @item ENAMETOOLONG
39174 @var{pathname} was too long.
39175
39176 @item EINTR
39177 The call was interrupted by the user.
39178 @end table
39179
39180 @end table
39181
39182 @node gettimeofday
39183 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
39184 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
39185
39186 @table @asis
39187 @item Synopsis:
39188 @smallexample
39189 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
39190 @end smallexample
39191
39192 @item Request:
39193 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
39194
39195 @item Return value:
39196 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
39197
39198 @item Errors:
39199
39200 @table @code
39201 @item EINVAL
39202 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
39203
39204 @item EFAULT
39205 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
39206 @end table
39207
39208 @end table
39209
39210 @node isatty
39211 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
39212 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
39213
39214 @table @asis
39215 @item Synopsis:
39216 @smallexample
39217 int isatty(int fd);
39218 @end smallexample
39219
39220 @item Request:
39221 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
39222
39223 @item Return value:
39224 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
39225
39226 @item Errors:
39227
39228 @table @code
39229 @item EINTR
39230 The call was interrupted by the user.
39231 @end table
39232
39233 @end table
39234
39235 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
39236 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
39237 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
39238 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
39239 needed.
39240
39241
39242 @node system
39243 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
39244 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
39245
39246 @table @asis
39247 @item Synopsis:
39248 @smallexample
39249 int system(const char *command);
39250 @end smallexample
39251
39252 @item Request:
39253 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
39254
39255 @item Return value:
39256 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
39257 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
39258 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
39259 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
39260 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
39261 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
39262 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
39263
39264 @item Errors:
39265
39266 @table @code
39267 @item EINTR
39268 The call was interrupted by the user.
39269 @end table
39270
39271 @end table
39272
39273 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
39274 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
39275 the host is simplified before it's returned
39276 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
39277 is discarded, and the return value consists
39278 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
39279
39280 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
39281 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
39282 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
39283
39284 @table @code
39285 @item set remote system-call-allowed
39286 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
39287 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
39288 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
39289
39290 @item show remote system-call-allowed
39291 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
39292 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
39293 protocol.
39294 @end table
39295
39296 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39297 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
39298 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39299
39300 @menu
39301 * Integral Datatypes::
39302 * Pointer Values::
39303 * Memory Transfer::
39304 * struct stat::
39305 * struct timeval::
39306 @end menu
39307
39308 @node Integral Datatypes
39309 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
39310 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
39311
39312 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
39313 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
39314 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
39315
39316 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
39317 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
39318
39319 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
39320
39321 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
39322 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
39323
39324 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
39325
39326 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
39327 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
39328 byte order.
39329
39330 @node Pointer Values
39331 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
39332 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
39333
39334 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
39335 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
39336 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
39337 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
39338
39339 @smallexample
39340 @code{1aaf/12}
39341 @end smallexample
39342
39343 @noindent
39344 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
39345 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
39346 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
39347 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
39348
39349 @smallexample
39350 @code{123456/d}
39351 @end smallexample
39352
39353 @node Memory Transfer
39354 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
39355 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
39356
39357 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
39358 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
39359 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
39360 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
39361 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
39362 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
39363 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
39364
39365
39366 @node struct stat
39367 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
39368 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
39369
39370 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
39371 is defined as follows:
39372
39373 @smallexample
39374 struct stat @{
39375 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
39376 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
39377 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
39378 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
39379 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
39380 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
39381 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
39382 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
39383 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
39384 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
39385 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
39386 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
39387 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
39388 @};
39389 @end smallexample
39390
39391 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39392 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39393 structure is of size 64 bytes.
39394
39395 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
39396 range of values.
39397
39398 @table @code
39399
39400 @item st_dev
39401 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
39402
39403 @item st_ino
39404 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39405
39406 @item st_mode
39407 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
39408 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
39409
39410 @item st_uid
39411 @itemx st_gid
39412 @itemx st_rdev
39413 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
39414
39415 @item st_atime
39416 @itemx st_mtime
39417 @itemx st_ctime
39418 These values have a host and file system dependent
39419 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
39420 support exact timing values.
39421 @end table
39422
39423 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
39424 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
39425 continuing.
39426
39427 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
39428 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
39429 get truncated on the target.
39430
39431 @node struct timeval
39432 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
39433 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
39434
39435 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
39436 is defined as follows:
39437
39438 @smallexample
39439 struct timeval @{
39440 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
39441 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
39442 @};
39443 @end smallexample
39444
39445 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
39446 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
39447 structure is of size 8 bytes.
39448
39449 @node Constants
39450 @subsection Constants
39451 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
39452
39453 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
39454 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
39455 values before and after the call as needed.
39456
39457 @menu
39458 * Open Flags::
39459 * mode_t Values::
39460 * Errno Values::
39461 * Lseek Flags::
39462 * Limits::
39463 @end menu
39464
39465 @node Open Flags
39466 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
39467 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
39468
39469 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
39470
39471 @smallexample
39472 O_RDONLY 0x0
39473 O_WRONLY 0x1
39474 O_RDWR 0x2
39475 O_APPEND 0x8
39476 O_CREAT 0x200
39477 O_TRUNC 0x400
39478 O_EXCL 0x800
39479 @end smallexample
39480
39481 @node mode_t Values
39482 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
39483 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
39484
39485 All values are given in octal representation.
39486
39487 @smallexample
39488 S_IFREG 0100000
39489 S_IFDIR 040000
39490 S_IRUSR 0400
39491 S_IWUSR 0200
39492 S_IXUSR 0100
39493 S_IRGRP 040
39494 S_IWGRP 020
39495 S_IXGRP 010
39496 S_IROTH 04
39497 S_IWOTH 02
39498 S_IXOTH 01
39499 @end smallexample
39500
39501 @node Errno Values
39502 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
39503 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
39504
39505 All values are given in decimal representation.
39506
39507 @smallexample
39508 EPERM 1
39509 ENOENT 2
39510 EINTR 4
39511 EBADF 9
39512 EACCES 13
39513 EFAULT 14
39514 EBUSY 16
39515 EEXIST 17
39516 ENODEV 19
39517 ENOTDIR 20
39518 EISDIR 21
39519 EINVAL 22
39520 ENFILE 23
39521 EMFILE 24
39522 EFBIG 27
39523 ENOSPC 28
39524 ESPIPE 29
39525 EROFS 30
39526 ENAMETOOLONG 91
39527 EUNKNOWN 9999
39528 @end smallexample
39529
39530 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
39531 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
39532
39533 @node Lseek Flags
39534 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
39535 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
39536
39537 @smallexample
39538 SEEK_SET 0
39539 SEEK_CUR 1
39540 SEEK_END 2
39541 @end smallexample
39542
39543 @node Limits
39544 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
39545 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
39546
39547 All values are given in decimal representation.
39548
39549 @smallexample
39550 INT_MIN -2147483648
39551 INT_MAX 2147483647
39552 UINT_MAX 4294967295
39553 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
39554 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
39555 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
39556 @end smallexample
39557
39558 @node File-I/O Examples
39559 @subsection File-I/O Examples
39560 @cindex file-i/o examples
39561
39562 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39563 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
39564
39565 @smallexample
39566 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
39567 @emph{request memory read from target}
39568 -> @code{m1234,6}
39569 <- XXXXXX
39570 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
39571 -> @code{F6}
39572 @end smallexample
39573
39574 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
39575 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
39576
39577 @smallexample
39578 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39579 @emph{request memory write to target}
39580 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39581 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
39582 -> @code{F6}
39583 @end smallexample
39584
39585 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
39586 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
39587
39588 @smallexample
39589 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39590 -> @code{F-1,9}
39591 @end smallexample
39592
39593 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
39594 host is called:
39595
39596 @smallexample
39597 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39598 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
39599 <- @code{T02}
39600 @end smallexample
39601
39602 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
39603 host is called:
39604
39605 @smallexample
39606 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39607 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39608 <- @code{T02}
39609 @end smallexample
39610
39611 @node Library List Format
39612 @section Library List Format
39613 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39614
39615 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
39616 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
39617 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
39618 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
39619 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
39620 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
39621 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
39622 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
39623 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
39624 are loaded.
39625
39626 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
39627 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
39628 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
39629 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
39630
39631 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
39632 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
39633 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
39634 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
39635 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
39636 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
39637
39638 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39639 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39640
39641 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
39642 offset, looks like this:
39643
39644 @smallexample
39645 <library-list>
39646 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
39647 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
39648 </library>
39649 </library-list>
39650 @end smallexample
39651
39652 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
39653 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
39654
39655 @smallexample
39656 <library-list>
39657 <library name="sharedlib.o">
39658 <section address="0x10000000"/>
39659 <section address="0x20000000"/>
39660 <section address="0x30000000"/>
39661 </library>
39662 </library-list>
39663 @end smallexample
39664
39665 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
39666
39667 @smallexample
39668 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
39669 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
39670 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39671 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
39672 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39673 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
39674 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39675 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
39676 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39677 @end smallexample
39678
39679 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
39680 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
39681 section for each library.
39682
39683 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39684 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39685 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39686
39687 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
39688 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
39689 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
39690 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
39691
39692 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
39693 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
39694 target, the following parameters are reported:
39695
39696 @itemize @minus
39697 @item
39698 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
39699 @code{struct link_map}.
39700 @item
39701 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
39702 (Thread Local Storage) access.
39703 @item
39704 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
39705 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
39706 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
39707 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
39708 @item
39709 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
39710 @end itemize
39711
39712 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
39713 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
39714 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
39715
39716 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39717 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39718
39719 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
39720 looks like this:
39721
39722 @smallexample
39723 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
39724 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
39725 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
39726 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
39727 l_ld="0x152350"/>
39728 </library-list-svr>
39729 @end smallexample
39730
39731 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
39732
39733 @smallexample
39734 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
39735 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
39736 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39737 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
39738 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
39739 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39740 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
39741 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
39742 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
39743 @end smallexample
39744
39745 @node Memory Map Format
39746 @section Memory Map Format
39747 @cindex memory map format
39748
39749 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
39750 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
39751 memory map.
39752
39753 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
39754 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
39755 lists memory regions.
39756
39757 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39758 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
39759
39760 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39761
39762 @smallexample
39763 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39764 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
39765 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
39766 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
39767 <memory-map>
39768 region...
39769 </memory-map>
39770 @end smallexample
39771
39772 Each region can be either:
39773
39774 @itemize
39775
39776 @item
39777 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
39778 bytes from there:
39779
39780 @smallexample
39781 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39782 @end smallexample
39783
39784
39785 @item
39786 A region of read-only memory:
39787
39788 @smallexample
39789 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39790 @end smallexample
39791
39792
39793 @item
39794 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
39795 bytes in length:
39796
39797 @smallexample
39798 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
39799 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
39800 </memory>
39801 @end smallexample
39802
39803 @end itemize
39804
39805 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
39806 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
39807 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
39808
39809 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
39810
39811 @smallexample
39812 <!-- ................................................... -->
39813 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
39814 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
39815 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
39816 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
39817 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
39818 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
39819 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
39820 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
39821 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
39822 and its type, or device. -->
39823 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
39824 start CDATA #REQUIRED
39825 length CDATA #REQUIRED
39826 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
39827 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
39828 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
39829 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39830 @end smallexample
39831
39832 @node Thread List Format
39833 @section Thread List Format
39834 @cindex thread list format
39835
39836 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
39837 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
39838 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
39839 the following structure:
39840
39841 @smallexample
39842 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39843 <threads>
39844 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
39845 ... description ...
39846 </thread>
39847 </threads>
39848 @end smallexample
39849
39850 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
39851 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
39852 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
39853 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
39854 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
39855 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
39856 auxiliary information.
39857
39858 @node Traceframe Info Format
39859 @section Traceframe Info Format
39860 @cindex traceframe info format
39861
39862 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
39863 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
39864 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
39865 collected in a traceframe.
39866
39867 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
39868 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
39869
39870 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39871 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39872
39873 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39874
39875 @smallexample
39876 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39877 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
39878 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
39879 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
39880 <traceframe-info>
39881 block...
39882 </traceframe-info>
39883 @end smallexample
39884
39885 Each traceframe block can be either:
39886
39887 @itemize
39888
39889 @item
39890 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
39891 @var{length} bytes from there:
39892
39893 @smallexample
39894 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39895 @end smallexample
39896
39897 @item
39898 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
39899 collected:
39900
39901 @smallexample
39902 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
39903 @end smallexample
39904
39905 @end itemize
39906
39907 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
39908
39909 @smallexample
39910 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
39911 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39912
39913 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
39914 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
39915 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
39916 <!ELEMENT tvar>
39917 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
39918 @end smallexample
39919
39920 @node Branch Trace Format
39921 @section Branch Trace Format
39922 @cindex branch trace format
39923
39924 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
39925 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
39926 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
39927 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
39928
39929 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
39930 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
39931
39932 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39933 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39934
39935 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39936
39937 @smallexample
39938 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39939 <!DOCTYPE btrace
39940 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
39941 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
39942 <btrace>
39943 block...
39944 </btrace>
39945 @end smallexample
39946
39947 @itemize
39948
39949 @item
39950 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
39951 and ending at @var{end}:
39952
39953 @smallexample
39954 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
39955 @end smallexample
39956
39957 @end itemize
39958
39959 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
39960
39961 @smallexample
39962 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
39963 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39964
39965 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
39966 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
39967 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
39968
39969 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
39970
39971 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
39972
39973 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
39974 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
39975 family CDATA #REQUIRED
39976 model CDATA #REQUIRED
39977 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
39978
39979 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
39980 @end smallexample
39981
39982 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
39983 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
39984 @cindex branch trace configuration format
39985
39986 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
39987 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
39988 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
39989
39990 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
39991 settings for that format. The following information is described:
39992
39993 @table @code
39994 @item bts
39995 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
39996 @table @code
39997 @item size
39998 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
39999 @end table
40000 @item pt
40001 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
40002 PT}) format.
40003 @table @code
40004 @item size
40005 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
40006 @end table
40007 @end table
40008
40009 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40010 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
40011
40012 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
40013
40014 @smallexample
40015 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
40016 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
40017
40018 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
40019 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40020
40021 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
40022 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
40023 @end smallexample
40024
40025 @include agentexpr.texi
40026
40027 @node Target Descriptions
40028 @appendix Target Descriptions
40029 @cindex target descriptions
40030
40031 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
40032 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
40033 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
40034 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
40035 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
40036 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
40037 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
40038
40039 @itemize @bullet
40040 @item
40041 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
40042 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
40043 @item
40044 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
40045 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
40046 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
40047 @item
40048 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
40049 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
40050 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
40051 @end itemize
40052
40053 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
40054 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
40055 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
40056 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
40057 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
40058
40059 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
40060 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
40061
40062 @menu
40063 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
40064 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
40065 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
40066 descriptions.
40067 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
40068 @end menu
40069
40070 @node Retrieving Descriptions
40071 @section Retrieving Descriptions
40072
40073 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
40074 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
40075 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
40076 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
40077 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
40078 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
40079 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
40080 Format}.
40081
40082 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
40083 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
40084 specify a file are:
40085
40086 @table @code
40087 @cindex set tdesc filename
40088 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
40089 Read the target description from @var{path}.
40090
40091 @cindex unset tdesc filename
40092 @item unset tdesc filename
40093 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
40094 will use the description supplied by the current target.
40095
40096 @cindex show tdesc filename
40097 @item show tdesc filename
40098 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
40099 @end table
40100
40101
40102 @node Target Description Format
40103 @section Target Description Format
40104 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
40105
40106 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
40107 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
40108 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
40109 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
40110 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
40111 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
40112 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
40113
40114 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
40115 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
40116 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
40117 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
40118 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
40119
40120 Here is a simple target description:
40121
40122 @smallexample
40123 <target version="1.0">
40124 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
40125 </target>
40126 @end smallexample
40127
40128 @noindent
40129 This minimal description only says that the target uses
40130 the x86-64 architecture.
40131
40132 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
40133 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
40134 are explained further below.
40135
40136 @smallexample
40137 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40138 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
40139 <target version="1.0">
40140 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
40141 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
40142 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
40143 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
40144 </target>
40145 @end smallexample
40146
40147 @noindent
40148 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
40149 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
40150 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
40151 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
40152 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
40153 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
40154 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
40155 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
40156 the version mismatch.
40157
40158 @subsection Inclusion
40159 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
40160 @cindex XInclude
40161 @ifnotinfo
40162 @cindex <xi:include>
40163 @end ifnotinfo
40164
40165 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
40166 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
40167 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
40168 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
40169 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
40170
40171 @smallexample
40172 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
40173 @end smallexample
40174
40175 @noindent
40176 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
40177 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
40178 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
40179 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
40180 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
40181 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
40182 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
40183 original description.
40184
40185 @subsection Architecture
40186 @cindex <architecture>
40187
40188 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
40189
40190 @smallexample
40191 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
40192 @end smallexample
40193
40194 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40195 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40196
40197 @subsection OS ABI
40198 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
40199
40200 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40201 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40202
40203 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
40204
40205 @smallexample
40206 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
40207 @end smallexample
40208
40209 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
40210 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
40211
40212 @subsection Compatible Architecture
40213 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
40214
40215 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
40216 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
40217
40218 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
40219
40220 @smallexample
40221 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
40222 @end smallexample
40223
40224 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
40225 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
40226
40227 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
40228 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
40229 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
40230 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
40231 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
40232 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
40233 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
40234
40235 @smallexample
40236 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
40237 <compatible>spu</compatible>
40238 @end smallexample
40239
40240 @subsection Features
40241 @cindex <feature>
40242
40243 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
40244 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
40245 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
40246 has this form:
40247
40248 @smallexample
40249 <feature name="@var{name}">
40250 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
40251 @var{reg}@dots{}
40252 </feature>
40253 @end smallexample
40254
40255 @noindent
40256 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
40257 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
40258 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
40259 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
40260
40261 @subsection Types
40262
40263 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
40264 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
40265 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
40266 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
40267 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
40268
40269 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
40270 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
40271 Types must be defined before they are used.
40272
40273 @cindex <vector>
40274 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
40275 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
40276 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
40277 @var{count}:
40278
40279 @smallexample
40280 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
40281 @end smallexample
40282
40283 @cindex <union>
40284 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
40285 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
40286 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
40287 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
40288
40289 @smallexample
40290 <union id="@var{id}">
40291 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40292 @dots{}
40293 </union>
40294 @end smallexample
40295
40296 @cindex <struct>
40297 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
40298 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
40299 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
40300 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
40301 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
40302 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
40303 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
40304 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
40305
40306 @smallexample
40307 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40308 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
40309 @dots{}
40310 </struct>
40311 @end smallexample
40312
40313 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
40314 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
40315
40316 @smallexample
40317 <struct id="@var{id}">
40318 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
40319 @dots{}
40320 </struct>
40321 @end smallexample
40322
40323 @cindex <flags>
40324 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
40325 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
40326 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
40327 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
40328 are supported.
40329
40330 @smallexample
40331 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
40332 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
40333 @dots{}
40334 </flags>
40335 @end smallexample
40336
40337 @subsection Registers
40338 @cindex <reg>
40339
40340 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
40341
40342 @smallexample
40343 <reg name="@var{name}"
40344 bitsize="@var{size}"
40345 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
40346 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
40347 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
40348 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
40349 @end smallexample
40350
40351 @noindent
40352 The components are as follows:
40353
40354 @table @var
40355
40356 @item name
40357 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
40358
40359 @item bitsize
40360 The register's size, in bits.
40361
40362 @item regnum
40363 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
40364 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
40365 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
40366 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
40367 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
40368 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
40369 in order of increasing register number.
40370
40371 @item save-restore
40372 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
40373 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
40374 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
40375 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
40376 ABI.
40377
40378 @item type
40379 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
40380 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
40381 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
40382 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
40383 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
40384 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
40385
40386 @item group
40387 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
40388 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
40389 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
40390 in @code{info registers}.
40391
40392 @end table
40393
40394 @node Predefined Target Types
40395 @section Predefined Target Types
40396 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
40397
40398 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
40399 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
40400 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
40401 types. The currently supported types are:
40402
40403 @table @code
40404
40405 @item int8
40406 @itemx int16
40407 @itemx int32
40408 @itemx int64
40409 @itemx int128
40410 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40411
40412 @item uint8
40413 @itemx uint16
40414 @itemx uint32
40415 @itemx uint64
40416 @itemx uint128
40417 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
40418
40419 @item code_ptr
40420 @itemx data_ptr
40421 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
40422 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
40423 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
40424 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
40425 may be marked as data pointers.
40426
40427 @item ieee_single
40428 Single precision IEEE floating point.
40429
40430 @item ieee_double
40431 Double precision IEEE floating point.
40432
40433 @item arm_fpa_ext
40434 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
40435
40436 @item i387_ext
40437 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
40438
40439 @item i386_eflags
40440 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
40441
40442 @item i386_mxcsr
40443 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
40444
40445 @end table
40446
40447 @node Standard Target Features
40448 @section Standard Target Features
40449 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
40450
40451 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
40452 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
40453 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
40454 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
40455 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
40456 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
40457 can recognize them.
40458
40459 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
40460 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
40461 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
40462 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
40463 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
40464 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
40465 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
40466 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
40467
40468 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
40469 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
40470 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
40471
40472 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
40473 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
40474 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
40475 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
40476
40477 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
40478 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
40479 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
40480
40481 @menu
40482 * AArch64 Features::
40483 * ARM Features::
40484 * i386 Features::
40485 * MicroBlaze Features::
40486 * MIPS Features::
40487 * M68K Features::
40488 * Nios II Features::
40489 * PowerPC Features::
40490 * S/390 and System z Features::
40491 * TIC6x Features::
40492 @end menu
40493
40494
40495 @node AArch64 Features
40496 @subsection AArch64 Features
40497 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
40498
40499 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
40500 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
40501 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
40502
40503 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
40504 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
40505 and @samp{fpcr}.
40506
40507 @node ARM Features
40508 @subsection ARM Features
40509 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
40510
40511 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
40512 ARM targets.
40513 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
40514 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
40515
40516 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
40517 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
40518 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
40519 and @samp{xpsr}.
40520
40521 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
40522 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
40523
40524 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
40525 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
40526 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
40527 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
40528
40529 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
40530 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
40531 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
40532 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
40533 halves of the double-precision registers.
40534
40535 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
40536 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
40537 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
40538 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
40539 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
40540 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
40541
40542 @node i386 Features
40543 @subsection i386 Features
40544 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
40545
40546 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
40547 targets. It should describe the following registers:
40548
40549 @itemize @minus
40550 @item
40551 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
40552 @item
40553 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
40554 @item
40555 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
40556 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
40557 @item
40558 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
40559 @item
40560 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
40561 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
40562 @end itemize
40563
40564 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
40565
40566 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
40567 describe registers:
40568
40569 @itemize @minus
40570 @item
40571 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
40572 @item
40573 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
40574 @item
40575 @samp{mxcsr}
40576 @end itemize
40577
40578 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
40579 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
40580 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
40581
40582 @itemize @minus
40583 @item
40584 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
40585 @item
40586 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
40587 @end itemize
40588
40589 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
40590 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
40591
40592 @itemize @minus
40593 @item
40594 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
40595 @item
40596 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
40597 @end itemize
40598
40599 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
40600 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
40601
40602 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
40603 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
40604 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
40605
40606 @itemize @minus
40607 @item
40608 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40609 @end itemize
40610
40611 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
40612
40613 @itemize @minus
40614 @item
40615 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40616 @end itemize
40617
40618 It should
40619 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
40620
40621 @itemize @minus
40622 @item
40623 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
40624 @item
40625 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
40626 @end itemize
40627
40628 It should
40629 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
40630
40631 @itemize @minus
40632 @item
40633 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40634 @end itemize
40635
40636 @node MicroBlaze Features
40637 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
40638 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
40639
40640 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
40641 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
40642 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
40643 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
40644 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
40645
40646 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
40647 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
40648
40649 @node MIPS Features
40650 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
40651 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
40652
40653 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
40654 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
40655 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
40656 on the target.
40657
40658 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
40659 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
40660 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40661
40662 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
40663 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
40664 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
40665 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40666
40667 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
40668 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
40669 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
40670 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40671
40672 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
40673 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
40674 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
40675
40676 @node M68K Features
40677 @subsection M68K Features
40678 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
40679
40680 @table @code
40681 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
40682 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
40683 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
40684 One of those features must be always present.
40685 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
40686 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
40687 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
40688 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
40689
40690 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
40691 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
40692 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
40693 @samp{fpiaddr}.
40694 @end table
40695
40696 @node Nios II Features
40697 @subsection Nios II Features
40698 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
40699
40700 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
40701 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
40702 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
40703 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
40704 @samp{mpuacc}).
40705
40706 @node PowerPC Features
40707 @subsection PowerPC Features
40708 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
40709
40710 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
40711 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
40712 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
40713 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40714
40715 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
40716 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
40717
40718 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
40719 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
40720 and @samp{vrsave}.
40721
40722 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
40723 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
40724 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
40725 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
40726 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
40727 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
40728
40729 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
40730 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
40731 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
40732 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
40733 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
40734 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
40735 user.
40736
40737 @node S/390 and System z Features
40738 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
40739 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
40740 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
40741
40742 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
40743 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
40744 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
40745 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
40746 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
40747 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
40748 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
40749 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
40750 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
40751
40752 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
40753 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
40754 @samp{fpc}.
40755
40756 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
40757 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
40758
40759 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
40760 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
40761 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
40762 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
40763 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
40764 32-bit wide.
40765
40766 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
40767 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
40768 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
40769
40770 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
40771 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
40772 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
40773 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
40774 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
40775 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
40776 @samp{v31}.
40777
40778 @node TIC6x Features
40779 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
40780 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
40781 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
40782 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
40783 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
40784 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
40785
40786 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
40787 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
40788 through @samp{B31}.
40789
40790 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
40791 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
40792
40793 @node Operating System Information
40794 @appendix Operating System Information
40795 @cindex operating system information
40796
40797 @menu
40798 * Process list::
40799 @end menu
40800
40801 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
40802 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
40803 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
40804 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
40805 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
40806 on a different aspect of target.
40807
40808 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
40809 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
40810 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
40811 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
40812
40813 @node Process list
40814 @appendixsection Process list
40815 @cindex operating system information, process list
40816
40817 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
40818 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
40819 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
40820 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
40821
40822 An example document is:
40823
40824 @smallexample
40825 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40826 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
40827 <osdata type="processes">
40828 <item>
40829 <column name="pid">1</column>
40830 <column name="user">root</column>
40831 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
40832 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
40833 </item>
40834 </osdata>
40835 @end smallexample
40836
40837 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
40838 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
40839 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
40840 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
40841 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
40842 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
40843 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
40844
40845 @node Trace File Format
40846 @appendix Trace File Format
40847 @cindex trace file format
40848
40849 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
40850 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
40851
40852 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
40853 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
40854 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
40855 in the future.
40856
40857 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
40858 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
40859 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
40860 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
40861 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
40862 of this section.
40863
40864 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
40865
40866 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
40867 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
40868 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
40869 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
40870 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
40871 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
40872 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
40873 endianness.
40874
40875 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
40876
40877 @table @code
40878 @item R @var{bytes}
40879 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
40880 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
40881 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
40882 hexadecimal encoding.
40883
40884 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
40885 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
40886 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
40887 @var{length} bytes.
40888
40889 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
40890 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
40891 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
40892
40893 @end table
40894
40895 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
40896 of blocks.
40897
40898 @node Index Section Format
40899 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
40900 @cindex .gdb_index section format
40901 @cindex index section format
40902
40903 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
40904 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
40905 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
40906 description.
40907
40908 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
40909 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
40910 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
40911 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
40912 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
40913 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
40914
40915 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
40916
40917 @enumerate
40918 @item
40919 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
40920 unless otherwise noted:
40921
40922 @enumerate
40923 @item
40924 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
40925 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
40926 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
40927 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
40928 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
40929 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
40930 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
40931
40932 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
40933 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
40934 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
40935 currently not flagged as deprecated.
40936
40937 @item
40938 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
40939
40940 @item
40941 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
40942 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
40943 to the next offset.
40944
40945 @item
40946 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
40947
40948 @item
40949 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
40950
40951 @item
40952 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
40953 @end enumerate
40954
40955 @item
40956 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
40957 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
40958 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
40959 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
40960 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
40961 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
40962 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
40963 CU indices.
40964
40965 @item
40966 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
40967 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
40968 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
40969 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
40970
40971 @item
40972 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
40973 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
40974
40975 @enumerate
40976 @item
40977 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
40978
40979 @item
40980 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
40981 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
40982
40983 @item
40984 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
40985 @end enumerate
40986
40987 @item
40988 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
40989 the hash table is always a power of 2.
40990
40991 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
40992 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
40993 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
40994 constant pool.
40995
40996 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
40997 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
40998 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
40999
41000 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
41001 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
41002 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
41003 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
41004 index version:
41005
41006 @table @asis
41007 @item Version 4
41008 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
41009
41010 @item Versions 5 to 7
41011 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
41012 @end table
41013
41014 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
41015
41016 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
41017 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
41018 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
41019 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
41020 collision.
41021
41022 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
41023 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
41024 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
41025 the code.
41026
41027 @item
41028 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
41029 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
41030 strings.
41031
41032 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
41033 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
41034 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
41035 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
41036 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
41037 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
41038
41039 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
41040 @end enumerate
41041
41042 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
41043 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
41044 CU index+attributes value for each use.
41045
41046 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
41047 (bit 0 = LSB):
41048
41049 @table @asis
41050
41051 @item Bits 0-23
41052 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
41053 @item Bits 24-27
41054 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
41055 @item Bits 28-30
41056 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
41057
41058 @table @asis
41059 @item 0
41060 This value is reserved and should not be used.
41061 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
41062 with previous versions of the index.
41063 @item 1
41064 The symbol is a type.
41065 @item 2
41066 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
41067 @item 3
41068 The symbol is a function.
41069 @item 4
41070 Any other kind of symbol.
41071 @item 5,6,7
41072 These values are reserved.
41073 @end table
41074
41075 @item Bit 31
41076 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
41077
41078 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
41079 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
41080 @value{GDBN} sources.
41081
41082 @end table
41083
41084 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
41085 global/static attributes in the index.
41086
41087 @smallexample
41088 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
41089 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
41090 switch (die->tag)
41091 @{
41092 case DW_TAG_typedef:
41093 case DW_TAG_base_type:
41094 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
41095 kind = TYPE;
41096 is_static = 1;
41097 break;
41098 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
41099 kind = VARIABLE;
41100 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
41101 break;
41102 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
41103 kind = FUNCTION;
41104 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
41105 break;
41106 case DW_TAG_constant:
41107 kind = VARIABLE;
41108 is_static = ! is_external;
41109 break;
41110 case DW_TAG_variable:
41111 kind = VARIABLE;
41112 is_static = ! is_external;
41113 break;
41114 case DW_TAG_namespace:
41115 kind = TYPE;
41116 is_static = 0;
41117 break;
41118 case DW_TAG_class_type:
41119 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
41120 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
41121 case DW_TAG_union_type:
41122 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
41123 kind = TYPE;
41124 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
41125 break;
41126 default:
41127 assert (0);
41128 @}
41129 @end smallexample
41130
41131 @node Man Pages
41132 @appendix Manual pages
41133 @cindex Man pages
41134
41135 @menu
41136 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
41137 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
41138 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
41139 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
41140 @end menu
41141
41142 @node gdb man
41143 @heading gdb man
41144
41145 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
41146
41147 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
41148 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
41149 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
41150 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
41151 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
41152 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
41153 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
41154 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
41155 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
41156 @c man end
41157
41158 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
41159 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
41160 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
41161 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
41162
41163 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
41164 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
41165
41166 @itemize @bullet
41167 @item
41168 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
41169
41170 @item
41171 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
41172
41173 @item
41174 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
41175
41176 @item
41177 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
41178 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
41179 @end itemize
41180
41181 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
41182 Modula-2.
41183
41184 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
41185 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
41186 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
41187 by using the command @code{help}.
41188
41189 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
41190 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
41191 executable program as the argument:
41192
41193 @smallexample
41194 gdb program
41195 @end smallexample
41196
41197 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
41198
41199 @smallexample
41200 gdb program core
41201 @end smallexample
41202
41203 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
41204 to debug a running process:
41205
41206 @smallexample
41207 gdb program 1234
41208 gdb -p 1234
41209 @end smallexample
41210
41211 @noindent
41212 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
41213 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
41214 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
41215
41216 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
41217
41218 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
41219 @table @env
41220 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{functiop}
41221 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
41222
41223 @item run [@var{arglist}]
41224 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
41225
41226 @item bt
41227 Backtrace: display the program stack.
41228
41229 @item print @var{expr}
41230 Display the value of an expression.
41231
41232 @item c
41233 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
41234
41235 @item next
41236 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
41237 function calls in the line.
41238
41239 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41240 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
41241
41242 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
41243 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
41244
41245 @item step
41246 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
41247 function calls in the line.
41248
41249 @item help [@var{name}]
41250 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
41251 about using @value{GDBN}.
41252
41253 @item quit
41254 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
41255 @end table
41256
41257 @ifset man
41258 For full details on @value{GDBN},
41259 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41260 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
41261 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
41262 @end ifset
41263 @c man end
41264
41265 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
41266 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
41267 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
41268 encountered with no
41269 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
41270 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
41271 Many options have
41272 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
41273 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
41274 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
41275 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
41276 more usual convention.)
41277
41278 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
41279 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
41280 option is used.
41281
41282 @table @env
41283 @item -help
41284 @itemx -h
41285 List all options, with brief explanations.
41286
41287 @item -symbols=@var{file}
41288 @itemx -s @var{file}
41289 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
41290
41291 @item -write
41292 Enable writing into executable and core files.
41293
41294 @item -exec=@var{file}
41295 @itemx -e @var{file}
41296 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
41297 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
41298 dump.
41299
41300 @item -se=@var{file}
41301 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
41302 file.
41303
41304 @item -core=@var{file}
41305 @itemx -c @var{file}
41306 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
41307
41308 @item -command=@var{file}
41309 @itemx -x @var{file}
41310 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
41311
41312 @item -ex @var{command}
41313 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
41314
41315 @item -directory=@var{directory}
41316 @itemx -d @var{directory}
41317 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
41318
41319 @item -nh
41320 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
41321
41322 @item -nx
41323 @itemx -n
41324 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
41325
41326 @item -quiet
41327 @itemx -q
41328 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
41329 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
41330
41331 @item -batch
41332 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
41333 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
41334 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
41335 commands in the command files.
41336
41337 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
41338 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
41339 more useful, the message
41340
41341 @smallexample
41342 Program exited normally.
41343 @end smallexample
41344
41345 @noindent
41346 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
41347 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
41348
41349 @item -cd=@var{directory}
41350 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
41351 instead of the current directory.
41352
41353 @item -fullname
41354 @itemx -f
41355 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
41356 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
41357 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
41358 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
41359 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
41360 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
41361 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
41362 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
41363
41364 @item -b @var{bps}
41365 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
41366 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
41367
41368 @item -tty=@var{device}
41369 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
41370 @end table
41371 @c man end
41372
41373 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
41374 @ifset man
41375 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41376 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41377 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41378
41379 @smallexample
41380 info gdb
41381 @end smallexample
41382
41383 @noindent
41384 should give you access to the complete manual.
41385
41386 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41387 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41388 @end ifset
41389 @c man end
41390
41391 @node gdbserver man
41392 @heading gdbserver man
41393
41394 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
41395 @format
41396 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
41397 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
41398
41399 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41400
41401 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41402 @c man end
41403 @end format
41404
41405 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
41406 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
41407 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
41408
41409 @ifclear man
41410 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
41411 @end ifclear
41412 @ifset man
41413 Usage (server (target) side):
41414 @end ifset
41415
41416 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
41417 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
41418 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
41419 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
41420
41421 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
41422 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
41423 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
41424
41425 @smallexample
41426 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
41427 @end smallexample
41428
41429 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
41430
41431 @smallexample
41432 @ifset man
41433 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
41434 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
41435 @end ifset
41436 @ifclear man
41437 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
41438 @end ifclear
41439 @end smallexample
41440
41441 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
41442 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
41443 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
41444
41445 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
41446
41447 @smallexample
41448 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
41449 @end smallexample
41450
41451 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
41452 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
41453 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
41454 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
41455 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
41456 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
41457 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
41458 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
41459 print an error message and exit.
41460
41461 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
41462 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
41463
41464 @smallexample
41465 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41466 @end smallexample
41467
41468 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
41469 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
41470
41471 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
41472 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
41473 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
41474 the program you want to debug.
41475
41476 @smallexample
41477 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41478 @end smallexample
41479
41480 @ifclear man
41481 @subheading Usage (host side)
41482 @end ifclear
41483 @ifset man
41484 Usage (host side):
41485 @end ifset
41486
41487 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
41488 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
41489 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
41490 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
41491 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
41492 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
41493 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
41494 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
41495 descriptor. For example:
41496
41497 @smallexample
41498 @ifset man
41499 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
41500 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
41501 @end ifset
41502 @ifclear man
41503 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
41504 @end ifclear
41505 @end smallexample
41506
41507 @noindent
41508 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
41509
41510 @smallexample
41511 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
41512 @end smallexample
41513
41514 @noindent
41515 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
41516 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
41517 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
41518 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
41519 `Connection refused'.
41520
41521 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
41522 described in
41523 @ifset man
41524 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
41525 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
41526 @end ifset
41527 @ifclear man
41528 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
41529 @end ifclear
41530 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
41531
41532 @smallexample
41533 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
41534 @end smallexample
41535
41536 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
41537 case.
41538 @c man end
41539
41540 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
41541 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
41542
41543 @itemize @bullet
41544
41545 @item
41546 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
41547
41548 @smallexample
41549 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
41550 @end smallexample
41551
41552 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
41553 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
41554 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
41555 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
41556 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
41557 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
41558 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
41559
41560 @item
41561 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
41562 program:
41563
41564 @smallexample
41565 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41566 @end smallexample
41567
41568 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
41569 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
41570 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
41571 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
41572
41573 @item
41574 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
41575
41576 @smallexample
41577 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41578 @end smallexample
41579
41580 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
41581 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
41582 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
41583 debug several processes in the same session.
41584 @end itemize
41585
41586 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
41587
41588 @table @env
41589
41590 @item --help
41591 List all options, with brief explanations.
41592
41593 @item --version
41594 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
41595
41596 @item --attach
41597 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
41598
41599 @smallexample
41600 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
41601 @end smallexample
41602
41603 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
41604 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
41605
41606 @item --multi
41607 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
41608 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
41609 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
41610 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
41611
41612 @smallexample
41613 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
41614 @end smallexample
41615
41616 @item --debug
41617 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
41618 process.
41619 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
41620 the developers.
41621
41622 @item --remote-debug
41623 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
41624 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
41625 the developers.
41626
41627 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
41628 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
41629 of debugging output.
41630 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
41631
41632 @item --wrapper
41633 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
41634 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
41635 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
41636 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
41637
41638 @item --once
41639 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
41640 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
41641 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
41642 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
41643
41644 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
41645
41646 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
41647 @c QDisableRandomization.
41648
41649 @end table
41650 @c man end
41651
41652 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
41653 @ifset man
41654 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41655 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41656 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41657
41658 @smallexample
41659 info gdb
41660 @end smallexample
41661
41662 should give you access to the complete manual.
41663
41664 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41665 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41666 @end ifset
41667 @c man end
41668
41669 @node gcore man
41670 @heading gcore
41671
41672 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
41673
41674 @format
41675 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
41676 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
41677 @c man end
41678 @end format
41679
41680 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
41681 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
41682 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
41683 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
41684 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
41685 running without any change.
41686 @c man end
41687
41688 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
41689 @table @env
41690 @item -o @var{filename}
41691 The optional argument
41692 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
41693 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
41694 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
41695 @end table
41696 @c man end
41697
41698 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
41699 @ifset man
41700 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41701 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41702 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41703
41704 @smallexample
41705 info gdb
41706 @end smallexample
41707
41708 @noindent
41709 should give you access to the complete manual.
41710
41711 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41712 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41713 @end ifset
41714 @c man end
41715
41716 @node gdbinit man
41717 @heading gdbinit
41718
41719 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
41720
41721 @format
41722 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
41723 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41724 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
41725 @end ifset
41726
41727 ~/.gdbinit
41728
41729 ./.gdbinit
41730 @c man end
41731 @end format
41732
41733 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
41734 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
41735 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
41736 described in
41737 @ifset man
41738 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
41739 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
41740 @end ifset
41741 @ifclear man
41742 @ref{Sequences}.
41743 @end ifclear
41744
41745 Please read more in
41746 @ifset man
41747 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
41748 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
41749 @end ifset
41750 @ifclear man
41751 @ref{Startup}.
41752 @end ifclear
41753
41754 @table @env
41755 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41756 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
41757 @end ifset
41758 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41759 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
41760 @end ifclear
41761 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
41762 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
41763 See more in
41764 @ifset man
41765 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
41766 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
41767 @end ifset
41768 @ifclear man
41769 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
41770 @end ifclear
41771
41772 @item ~/.gdbinit
41773 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
41774 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
41775
41776 @item ./.gdbinit
41777 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
41778 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
41779 See more in
41780 @ifset man
41781 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
41782 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
41783 @end ifset
41784 @ifclear man
41785 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
41786 @end ifclear
41787 @end table
41788 @c man end
41789
41790 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
41791 @ifset man
41792 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
41793
41794 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41795 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41796 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41797
41798 @smallexample
41799 info gdb
41800 @end smallexample
41801
41802 should give you access to the complete manual.
41803
41804 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41805 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41806 @end ifset
41807 @c man end
41808
41809 @include gpl.texi
41810
41811 @node GNU Free Documentation License
41812 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
41813 @include fdl.texi
41814
41815 @node Concept Index
41816 @unnumbered Concept Index
41817
41818 @printindex cp
41819
41820 @node Command and Variable Index
41821 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
41822
41823 @printindex fn
41824
41825 @tex
41826 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
41827 % meantime:
41828 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
41829 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
41830 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
41831 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
41832 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
41833 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
41834 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
41835 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
41836 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
41837 \page\colophon
41838 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
41839 @end tex
41840
41841 @bye
This page took 1.062129 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.